17.01.2015 Views

ED-MEDIA 1999 Proceedings Book - Association for the ...

ED-MEDIA 1999 Proceedings Book - Association for the ...

ED-MEDIA 1999 Proceedings Book - Association for the ...

SHOW MORE
SHOW LESS

You also want an ePaper? Increase the reach of your titles

YUMPU automatically turns print PDFs into web optimized ePapers that Google loves.

Designing an Interactive Learning Environment to Support Children's<br />

Understanding in Complex Domains<br />

Background<br />

Marcelo Milrad<br />

The Institute <strong>for</strong> Media Technology (IMT)<br />

Box 450, 551 16 Jönköping<br />

Sweden<br />

E-mail: marcelo.milrad@tm.imt.se<br />

Current and emerging technological advances in In<strong>for</strong>mation and Communication Technology (ICT) make it<br />

possible to develop interactive learning environments to support new ways of learning. Interactive learning<br />

environments (ILEs) are having an increasing role in teaching and learning and are likely to play an important<br />

role in <strong>the</strong> future (Wasson, 1997). In particular those tools that encourage and enhance discovery, creativity,<br />

thinking and expression are very much needed. The main point of our research focuses within <strong>the</strong> design of an<br />

ILE to support learning in complex domains <strong>for</strong> young learners. We argue that because children are learning<br />

<strong>for</strong> real life and preparing to solve real complex problems in <strong>the</strong> future, <strong>the</strong> complexity of <strong>the</strong> world should be<br />

taken into account much more and much earlier than usually happens.<br />

Interactive Learning Environments and Learning Theories<br />

Emerging trends in education are increasingly moving towards learner-centered approaches. In <strong>the</strong>se, learning<br />

becomes an active process of discovery and participation based on self-motivation ra<strong>the</strong>r than on more passive<br />

acquaintance of facts and rules (Sfard, 1998). The role of <strong>the</strong> teacher is coming more to be seen as mentor or<br />

guide, facilitating and playing an essential role in this process. From this perspective, learning can be<br />

considered as a dynamic process in which <strong>the</strong> learner actively "constructs" new knowledge as he or she is<br />

engaged and immersed in a learning activity (Papert, 1993). The <strong>the</strong>ory of constructivism is at <strong>the</strong> core of <strong>the</strong><br />

movement to shift <strong>the</strong> center of instruction away from delivery in order to allow <strong>the</strong> learner to actively direct<br />

and choose a personal learning path. Jonassen (1998) claims that designers committed to designing and<br />

implementing constructivist learning environments need an appropriate set of design tools and methods which<br />

are consistent with <strong>the</strong> fundamental assumptions of those environments <strong>for</strong> analyzing learning outcomes and<br />

designing constructivist learning environments.<br />

Our approach to <strong>the</strong> design of ILEs is to strike a proper balance between <strong>the</strong> constructionist (Resnick, 1996)<br />

and <strong>the</strong> instructionism learning approaches. Moreover, we are attempting to explore <strong>the</strong> design implications of<br />

learning <strong>the</strong>ories such as constructivism and socioculturism (Nardi, 1996) that have hereto<strong>for</strong>e received less<br />

attention than, say, behaviorism (upon which computer-assisted instruction (CAI) is built) and cognitive<br />

psychology (upon which intelligent tutoring systems are built). These two <strong>the</strong>oretical perspectives are<br />

consistent with each o<strong>the</strong>r; <strong>the</strong>y just emphasize different <strong>the</strong>mes: <strong>the</strong> <strong>for</strong>mer speaks to <strong>the</strong> individual's<br />

cognition, while <strong>the</strong> latter speaks to <strong>the</strong> contributions of <strong>the</strong> surroundings to that cognition. From socioconstructivism,<br />

<strong>the</strong>n, guidelines <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> design of learning environments and <strong>the</strong> supporting scaffolding can be<br />

developed.<br />

Designing an Interactive Learning Environment to Support Children's Understanding<br />

of Complexity<br />

One of <strong>the</strong> purposes with this research is to develop an interactive learning environment to support children's<br />

understanding in <strong>the</strong> domains of environmental sciences and ecology. The basic assumption is that<br />

environmental issues will become increasingly significant and much more complex in <strong>the</strong> next century. In


order to meet new challenges and sustain an inhabitable global environment, we need to dramatically improve<br />

education at all levels in <strong>the</strong> environmental sciences. There<strong>for</strong>e, <strong>the</strong>re is a need <strong>for</strong> new tools to support<br />

complex learning in this domain. Our approach is based on analysis of previous research on designing ILEs<br />

<strong>for</strong> complex learning (Arias et al., 1997; Enkenberg, 1995; Eden et al., 1996; Forrester, 1994; Spector, &<br />

Davidsen, 1997a) and differs from <strong>the</strong>se in three major aspects:<br />

• It assumes that <strong>the</strong> integration of constructionism and systems dynamics is a powerful combination <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong><br />

design of a new kind of complex task environment <strong>for</strong> simulating and thinking about real-life phenomena.<br />

• It focuses on <strong>the</strong> significance and attainability of au<strong>the</strong>nticity in learning scenarios.<br />

• It supports that <strong>the</strong> design of ILEs <strong>for</strong> lifelong learning cannot be investigated in isolation by looking just<br />

at one small part of it, such as K-12 education, University education, or designers.<br />

This work has been developed in conjunction with <strong>the</strong> Kreate-IT (Creativity, Technology and IT at elementary<br />

schools) project carried out by <strong>the</strong> Institute <strong>for</strong> Media Technology. This project aims at creating an ILE that<br />

fosters learning based on ideas of apprenticeship (Lave & Wenger, 1991), and at developing a set of tools to<br />

facilitate <strong>the</strong> understanding of complex phenomena among young learners. In our view <strong>the</strong> methods of<br />

cognitive apprenticeship learning are useful in a wider context in examining and learning about complex<br />

phenomena. Since September 1997, we have been working in <strong>the</strong> Kreate-IT project toge<strong>the</strong>r with three schools<br />

at <strong>the</strong> municipality of Vetlanda, Sweden. Target population of <strong>the</strong> project are students of <strong>the</strong> ages of 12 to 13.<br />

The ecological and environmental topics and <strong>the</strong> technological tools are chosen to fit <strong>the</strong> students' level and<br />

field of interest.<br />

The technological tools that are suggested to <strong>the</strong> students are: <strong>the</strong> Lego-Dacta Control-Lab, <strong>the</strong> Lego-Dacta<br />

Robotics System and <strong>the</strong> ROBOLAB programming language. The heart of <strong>the</strong> system is <strong>the</strong> RCX or<br />

programmable brick (Resnick et al., 1998), an autonomous LEGO microcomputer that can be programmed<br />

using a PC. This device uses sensors to take input from its environment, to process data, and to control signals<br />

and devices involved in different processes. ROBOLAB is <strong>the</strong> software <strong>for</strong> controlling <strong>the</strong> RCX and is based<br />

on LAB VIEW . This powerful, real-life professional software is made accessible <strong>for</strong> young learners since<br />

ROBOLAB uses a user interface that is appropriate <strong>for</strong> children.<br />

Since our domain of interest is related to complex phenomena in environmental sciences, we have developed a<br />

computer controlled greenhouse by utilizing <strong>the</strong> learning tools described above. This technological<br />

environment provides an experimental arena <strong>for</strong> learning in and about complex systems. In particular, we<br />

believe that children, by playing, building and programming with <strong>the</strong>se learning materials, can gain a deeper<br />

understanding of how dynamic systems behave. Three major principles <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> design of educational<br />

environments based on Vygotsky's (Nardi, 1996) and Papert's (1993) work have been applied in our<br />

development:<br />

• Au<strong>the</strong>ntic activities: Children should have access to, and participate in, similar cultural activities to those<br />

of adults and should be using age-appropriate tools and artifacts modeled on those used by adults,<br />

• Construction: Children should be constructing artifacts and sharing <strong>the</strong>m with <strong>the</strong>ir community,<br />

• Collaboration: Educational environments should involve collaboration between experts and students and<br />

between individual learners and fellow learners.<br />

According to Resnick (1998) <strong>the</strong>se new kind of learning material enable children to explore a new set of<br />

concepts (in particular, "systems concepts" such as feedback and emergence) that have previously been<br />

considered "too advanced" <strong>for</strong> children to learn. Our primary goal in this project is not to help young learners<br />

accomplish some task faster or more effectively, but ra<strong>the</strong>r to engage <strong>the</strong>m in new ways of thinking and<br />

learning about complex domains, in particular those concerning environmental sciences. We are conducting<br />

more in-depth empirical studies, by means of observations and interviews, of how and what children learn<br />

through <strong>the</strong>ir interactions with this learning environment. These issues are being evaluated through smallscale<br />

cases. We will compare results and experiences across <strong>the</strong>se cases. The evaluation is qualitative and it<br />

has been carried out through <strong>the</strong> entire project. Fur<strong>the</strong>rmore, we are exploring <strong>the</strong> use of system dynamics to


develop an educationally meaningful way to exhibit <strong>the</strong> relationship between <strong>the</strong> structure and <strong>the</strong> behavior of<br />

dynamic systems. More broadly, we hope that <strong>the</strong>se studies will help us to develop a richer <strong>the</strong>oretical<br />

framework <strong>for</strong> understanding <strong>the</strong> role of <strong>the</strong>se new kind of learning environments <strong>for</strong> learning about complex<br />

domains.<br />

References<br />

Arias, E., Eden, H., & Fischer, G. (1997). Enhancing Communication, Facilitating Shared Understanding,<br />

and Creating Better Artifacts by Integrating Physical and Computational Media. Designing Interactive<br />

Systems (DIS 97): Processes, Practices, Methods and Techniques Conference <strong>Proceedings</strong>. ACM Press.<br />

Eden, H., Eisenberg, M., Fischer, G., & Repenning, A. (1996) Making Learning a Part of Life.<br />

Communications of <strong>the</strong> ACM. Vol 39.No. 4. (40-49).<br />

Enkenberg, Jorma. (1995). Complex Technology-Based Learning Environment. In R. Tennyson & A. Barron<br />

(Eds.), Automating Instructional Design: Computer-Based Development and Delivery Tools (245-264).<br />

NATO ASI Series.<br />

Forrester, J. (1994). Learning through System dynamics as Preparation <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> 21st Century. Keynote Address<br />

<strong>for</strong> Systems Thinking and Dynamic Modeling Conference <strong>for</strong> K-12 Education, June 27-29, 1994 at Concord,<br />

MA, USA.<br />

Jonassen, D.H. (1998). Designing constructivist learning environments. In C.M. Reigeluth (Ed.),<br />

Instructional-design <strong>the</strong>ories and models, 2 nd Ed. Mahwah, NJ: Lawrence Erlbaum Associates.<br />

Lave, J. & Wenger, E. (1991). Situated Learning: Legitimate Peripheral Participation. Cambridge University<br />

Press.<br />

Nardi B. (1996). Context and consciousness: Activity Theory in Human-Computer Interaction. Cambridge,<br />

MA: MIT Press.<br />

Papert, S. (1993). The Children's Machine: Rethinking School in <strong>the</strong> Age of <strong>the</strong> Computer. New York: Basic<br />

<strong>Book</strong>s.<br />

Resnick, M. (1996). Distributed Constructionism. In <strong>Proceedings</strong> of <strong>the</strong> International Conference on <strong>the</strong><br />

Learning Sciences, <strong>Association</strong> <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> Advancement of Computing in Education, Northwesten University,<br />

July 1996.<br />

Resnick, M., Martin, F., Berg, R., Borovoy, R., Colella, V., Kramer, K., Silverman, B. (1998). Digital<br />

Manipulatives: New Toys to Think With. <strong>Proceedings</strong> of <strong>the</strong> CHI '98 conference. ACM Press.<br />

Sfard, A. (1998). On two metaphors <strong>for</strong> learning and <strong>the</strong> dangers of choosing just one. Educational Research,<br />

27(2), 4-12.<br />

Spector, M & Davidsen, P. (1997a). Creating Engaging Courseware Using Systems Dynamics. Computers in<br />

Human Behavior, Volume 13, Number 2 (pp. 127-156).<br />

Spector, M & Davidsen, P. (1997b). Constructing effective interactive learning environments using System<br />

Dynamics methods and tools: Interim report. Report NR 1. EIST Publications & Reports.<br />

Wasson, B. (1997). Advanced educational technologies: The learning environment. Computers in Human<br />

Behaviour, 13(4), 571-594.


Experiences with <strong>the</strong> BSCW Shared Workspace System as <strong>the</strong> Backbone<br />

of a Virtual Learning Environment <strong>for</strong> Students.<br />

Wolfgang Appelt and Peter Mambrey<br />

GMD - German National Research Center <strong>for</strong> In<strong>for</strong>mation Technology<br />

Schloß Birlinghoven, D-53754 Sankt Augustin, Germany<br />

appelt@gmd.de mambrey@gmd.de<br />

Abstract: The BSCW system is a Web based groupware tool <strong>for</strong> asynchronous and synchronous<br />

cooperation. We describe <strong>the</strong> system and <strong>the</strong> experiences we made with it serving as <strong>the</strong> backbone<br />

of a virtual learning environment <strong>for</strong> students. The field study took place in summer 1998. It<br />

demonstrated <strong>the</strong> usefulness of <strong>the</strong> system <strong>for</strong> students and teachers as well as <strong>the</strong> need <strong>for</strong> fur<strong>the</strong>r<br />

research and socio-technical redesign.<br />

1. Introduction<br />

The World Wide Web (WWW) is an addressing system, network protocol, document mark-up language and clientserver<br />

architecture. In some sense it is also a collaboration technology, allowing people to share in<strong>for</strong>mation in a<br />

manner which is not restricted to a particular system environment. The WWW has a number of advantages as <strong>the</strong><br />

technological foundation <strong>for</strong> tools to support collaborative in<strong>for</strong>mation sharing and teleteaching applications:<br />

• WWW browsers are available <strong>for</strong> all important plat<strong>for</strong>ms and provide access to in<strong>for</strong>mation in a plat<strong>for</strong>m<br />

independent manner;<br />

• Browsers offer a simple and consistent user interface across different plat<strong>for</strong>ms;<br />

• Browsers are already part of <strong>the</strong> computing environment of students.<br />

GMD has developed <strong>the</strong> BSCW (Basic Support <strong>for</strong> Cooperative Work) Shared Workspace system within <strong>the</strong> last<br />

four years with <strong>the</strong> goal to trans<strong>for</strong>m <strong>the</strong> Web from a primarily passive in<strong>for</strong>mation repository to an active<br />

cooperation medium. The BSCW system is an application which extends <strong>the</strong> browsing and in<strong>for</strong>mation download<br />

features of <strong>the</strong> Web with more sophisticated features <strong>for</strong> document upload, version management, member and group<br />

administration and more, to provide a set of features <strong>for</strong> more collaborative in<strong>for</strong>mation sharing accessible using<br />

standard Web browsers.<br />

Since Web technology supports primarily asynchronous cooperation – people communicate and cooperate at<br />

different points in time – it can be used most rapidly <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> construction of so-called virtual workspaces:<br />

in<strong>for</strong>mation repositories <strong>for</strong> groups where <strong>the</strong>y deposit any kind of in<strong>for</strong>mation <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong>ir co-operation tasks and<br />

which <strong>the</strong>y visit on a regular basis to retrieve <strong>the</strong> necessary in<strong>for</strong>mation <strong>the</strong>y need <strong>for</strong> fulfilling <strong>the</strong>ir tasks. In <strong>the</strong><br />

meantime, <strong>the</strong> BSCW system has become quite popular particularly in <strong>the</strong> academic area and is used at a number of<br />

universities <strong>for</strong> a variety of applications.<br />

We have used <strong>the</strong> system to establish a virtual learning environment [1; 2] <strong>for</strong> M.A. students of <strong>the</strong> Social Science<br />

Department of <strong>the</strong> Gerhard-Mercator University in Duisburg, Germany [3]. The system should technically assist <strong>the</strong><br />

collaborative learning of <strong>the</strong> class and fur<strong>the</strong>rmore guarantee <strong>for</strong> all (students and teacher):<br />

• The availability of all working materials and results;<br />

• The transparency of <strong>the</strong> participants' actions to offer an orientation frame and social context;<br />

• The awareness about <strong>the</strong> history of documents;<br />

• The immediacy to communicate one-to-one, one-to-many, or many-to-many;<br />

• The ubiquitous access independent from a prescribed place.<br />

The students agreed to be part of <strong>the</strong> field trial and its evaluation. By this we wanted to gain knowledge about <strong>the</strong><br />

collaborative learning of students via synchronous and asynchronous media (see chapter 3).


2. Functionality of <strong>the</strong> BSCW System<br />

The BSCW Shared Workspace system is an extension of a standard Web server through <strong>the</strong> server CGI Application<br />

Programming Interface. A BSCW server (Web server with <strong>the</strong> BSCW extension) manages a number of shared<br />

workspaces, i.e. repositories <strong>for</strong> shared in<strong>for</strong>mation, accessible to members of a group using a simple user name and<br />

password scheme. In general, a BSCW server will manage workspaces <strong>for</strong> different groups, and users may be<br />

members of several workspaces (e.g. one workspace corresponding to each project a user is involved with or, in <strong>the</strong><br />

case of teleteaching, each course that a student has selected).<br />

A shared workspace can contain different kinds of in<strong>for</strong>mation such as documents, pictures, URL links to o<strong>the</strong>r Web<br />

pages, threaded discussions, member contact in<strong>for</strong>mation and more. The contents of each workspace are represented<br />

as in<strong>for</strong>mation objects arranged in a folder hierarchy.<br />

In addition to <strong>the</strong> normal download of in<strong>for</strong>mation from a Web site, users can also upload in<strong>for</strong>mation from <strong>the</strong>ir<br />

local file system into a BSCW workspace. For example, a teacher may upload exercises into a workspace. Students<br />

download <strong>the</strong>m onto <strong>the</strong>ir computers and later upload <strong>the</strong> "homework" <strong>the</strong>y were expected to per<strong>for</strong>m back into a<br />

workspace <strong>for</strong> review by <strong>the</strong> teacher. The following are <strong>the</strong> main features of <strong>the</strong> system (<strong>for</strong> more details see [4]):<br />

• Au<strong>the</strong>ntication: People have to identify <strong>the</strong>mselves by name and password be<strong>for</strong>e <strong>the</strong>y have access to BSCW<br />

workspaces.<br />

• Version management: Documents within a workspace can be put under version control which is particularly<br />

useful <strong>for</strong> joint document production.<br />

• Discussion <strong>for</strong>ums: Users may start a discussion on any topic <strong>the</strong>y like and <strong>the</strong> system presents <strong>the</strong> threads in a<br />

user friendly manner.<br />

• Access rights: The system contains a sophisticated access rights model which allows, <strong>for</strong> example, that some<br />

users may have complete control over an object in a workspace whereas o<strong>the</strong>rs have only read access or no<br />

access at all.<br />

• Search facilities: Users can specify queries to find objects within BSCW workspaces based on names, content<br />

or specific properties such as document author or document modification date. Fur<strong>the</strong>rmore, queries may be<br />

submitted to Web search engines and <strong>the</strong> result of <strong>the</strong> query can be imported into workspaces.<br />

• Document <strong>for</strong>mat conversion: These facilities allow users to trans<strong>for</strong>m a document into <strong>the</strong>ir <strong>for</strong>mat of choice,<br />

e.g., a proprietary document <strong>for</strong>mat into HTML, be<strong>for</strong>e downloading it.<br />

• Interface to synchronous communication: Through this interface users can specify synchronous sessions and<br />

launch respective tools, e.g., audio/video conferencing software or shared whiteboard applications.<br />

• Customization: Through user preferences <strong>the</strong> users can modify <strong>the</strong> system interface to some extent, e.g.,<br />

whe<strong>the</strong>r or not <strong>the</strong>y want to use an Javascript or ActiveX enhanced interface.<br />

• Multi-language support: The interface of <strong>the</strong> system can be tailored to a particular language by straight-<strong>for</strong>ward<br />

extensions. Several languages (e.g., French, Spanish, Catalan) have been created by users of <strong>the</strong> system and are<br />

publicly available.<br />

A cooperative system should provide awareness in<strong>for</strong>mation to allow users to coordinate <strong>the</strong>ir work. The event<br />

service (activity reports) of <strong>the</strong> BSCW system is an attempt to provide users with in<strong>for</strong>mation on <strong>the</strong> activities of<br />

o<strong>the</strong>r users, with respect to <strong>the</strong> objects within a shared workspace.<br />

Events are triggered whenever a user per<strong>for</strong>ms an action in a workspace, such as uploading a new document,<br />

downloading ('reading') an existing document, renaming a document and so on. The system records <strong>the</strong> events, and<br />

presents <strong>the</strong> recent events to each user. 'Recent' in this context means events which have occurred <strong>for</strong> an object since<br />

<strong>the</strong> user last 'caught up' action, an operation by which users can tell <strong>the</strong> system <strong>the</strong>y are aware of <strong>the</strong> events that have<br />

occurred so far and no longer wish to see <strong>the</strong>m in <strong>the</strong> workspace. Events can be caught up at different levels, from<br />

individual objects to complete workspace folder hierarchies.<br />

Each event entry describes what was done, when and by whom. Although this approach <strong>for</strong> providing group<br />

awareness is very simple, feedback from users of <strong>the</strong> BSCW system indicates that in<strong>for</strong>mation such as 'A uploaded a<br />

new version of document X', or 'B has read document Y' is often very useful <strong>for</strong> group members in coordinating


<strong>the</strong>ir work and gaining an overview of what has happened since <strong>the</strong>y last logged in.<br />

Figure 1 is an example of <strong>the</strong> user interface of <strong>the</strong> BSCW system. It shows a listing of a folder containing three subfolders<br />

("bug reports", "proposals & remarks", "software"), a link object ("Public Server"), A MS Word document<br />

("What's New"), an object containing <strong>the</strong> results of a WWW query at a search engine ("Altavista Search Results"), a<br />

meeting object ("final make (beta)") and a discussion object ("What do you think about ..."). The icon in front of<br />

each object's name indicates <strong>the</strong> type of <strong>the</strong> object. Behind each object is <strong>the</strong> name of <strong>the</strong> person who created <strong>the</strong><br />

object and <strong>the</strong> date when it was created or most recently modified.<br />

Figure 1. HTML user interface to a BSCW shared workspace<br />

At <strong>the</strong> top of <strong>the</strong> screen <strong>the</strong>re are buttons <strong>for</strong> triggering operations such as "Add Member" to provide access to this<br />

folder to o<strong>the</strong>r persons, or "Add Document", "Add Folder", "Add URL", etc., to create new objects within <strong>the</strong> folder.<br />

O<strong>the</strong>r actions such as "Catch up", "Copy" or "Archive" can be applied to objects which have been marked through<br />

<strong>the</strong> tick boxes in front of each objects' name. Fur<strong>the</strong>r action buttons appear in a line below each object (e.g.,<br />

"Modify", "Replace", "Convert", "Edit Query", or "Reply") since <strong>the</strong>y are only applicable to one particular object.<br />

Behind three objects ("proposals & remarks", "software", "What do you think about ...") <strong>the</strong>re are so-called event<br />

icons which indicate that an event occurred, e.g., <strong>the</strong> "What do you think about ..." discussion object is new since<br />

user "elke" visited this folder <strong>the</strong> last time and <strong>the</strong>re have been modifications within <strong>the</strong> folders "proposals &<br />

remarks" and "software". Clicking on <strong>the</strong>se event icons would give more details about <strong>the</strong> event, e.g., which user(s)<br />

triggered <strong>the</strong>se events.


3. First empirical findings<br />

During a three months period a class of 15 (5 female) students and <strong>the</strong>ir teacher (one of <strong>the</strong> authors) evaluated <strong>the</strong><br />

usefulness of <strong>the</strong> system as an augmentation to <strong>the</strong> usual classroom teaching where interaction among students or<br />

students and teacher usually is limited to <strong>the</strong> face-to-face meetings and learning occurs usually as an individual<br />

cognitive task. It was our aim to add social aspects of interaction and collaboration to create a social collaborative<br />

learning environment to enhance <strong>the</strong> traditional approach. The data collection was done by <strong>the</strong> system (log files,<br />

screen shots, archiving of text chats etc.), <strong>the</strong> students <strong>the</strong>mselves (amount of email, communication partners,<br />

personal impressions, self description of usage patterns), and by <strong>the</strong> teacher (use of <strong>the</strong> mailing list, <strong>the</strong> BSCW<br />

activity reports, activities on a CUSeeMe video server, interviews etc.). The study followed <strong>the</strong> principles of an<br />

ethnographic analysis [5] of cooperative work in practice under real life conditions [6]. The common goal of <strong>the</strong><br />

course was to collaborately analyse and rate <strong>the</strong> web pages of <strong>the</strong> factions of <strong>the</strong> German Bundestag. The<br />

telecommunications expenses of <strong>the</strong> students were paid by <strong>the</strong> GMD.<br />

Known teaching media like face-to-face lectures, papers, slides, and telephone were used. New was <strong>the</strong> BSCW<br />

system including a mailing list, email to persons or groups, and synchronous group meetings (virtual lectures)<br />

including video, audio chat, and text chat on a CUSeeMe video server situated in <strong>the</strong> GMD. These virtual<br />

synchronous group meetings lasted approximately two hours and were held instead of face-to-face meetings in <strong>the</strong><br />

university. The students usually used <strong>the</strong>ir PCs at home to take part asynchronously as well as in <strong>the</strong> synchronous<br />

meetings. The students lived distributed in an area of 60 miles distance round <strong>the</strong> university. Few knew each o<strong>the</strong>r<br />

be<strong>for</strong>e.<br />

As very often found in explorative studies, <strong>the</strong> amount of factors to monitor were so huge and even dynamically<br />

evolving, that it was hard to draw definite conclusions. That is why during Winter 1998 / 99 a second attempt is on<br />

its way to gain more and profound in<strong>for</strong>mation . In this paper we name some interesting findings which could be<br />

condensed as first heuristic hypo<strong>the</strong>ses.<br />

Establishing social relations in a collaborative virtual learning environment is as important and even takes<br />

longer than establishing <strong>the</strong> technical prerequisites<br />

To establish a social relationship among those who collaboratively learn is a process which takes time. It is an<br />

evolving process of mutual understanding, <strong>the</strong> development of conventions, and trust. It is an activity which has to<br />

be initialized and organized by <strong>the</strong> teacher. It is at least as important as teaching <strong>the</strong> use of <strong>the</strong> system. Although <strong>the</strong><br />

students differed in hardware and software knowledge, <strong>the</strong> "technical" basis to interact could be established within<br />

one month of time.<br />

Hardware and software has to be trained and cannot be left to self organization processes<br />

Although <strong>the</strong> basic system functionalities are easy to learn a training concept is necessary to achieve equal options<br />

<strong>for</strong> all. Training included hours of practical homework <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> students. To guarantee <strong>the</strong> success of <strong>the</strong> training it<br />

was followed by intensive coaching which lasted over <strong>the</strong> whole course. Leaving <strong>the</strong> responsibility of hardware and<br />

software training to <strong>the</strong> students (in <strong>the</strong> beginning of <strong>the</strong> field trial) created divergencies among <strong>the</strong>m: power users<br />

evolved as well as reluctant users, which in few cases remained observers in <strong>the</strong> CUSeeMe sessions til <strong>the</strong> end of <strong>the</strong><br />

course.<br />

The role of video in synchronous virtual meetings is important but audio comes first, followed by text chat<br />

In synchronous group meetings those who used actively video were active discussants and attracted more<br />

contributions than those who were lurkers. During this virtual conferences <strong>the</strong> main problems occurred with <strong>the</strong><br />

audio chat. The problems were twofold: on <strong>the</strong> technical side <strong>the</strong> bandwith (modem with 33.6 Kbps or ISDN) was to<br />

narrow <strong>for</strong> a sufficient transmission over a longer period; on <strong>the</strong> social side <strong>the</strong> discussions had to be explicitely<br />

moderated by <strong>the</strong> teacher. Despite this it happened several times that we missed <strong>the</strong> leading thread and bypartisan<br />

discussions evolved instead of group discussions. As a conclusion we all judged unanymously, that CUSeeMe<br />

actually is not useful <strong>for</strong> teaching and group discussions but <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> exchange of short infos, <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> settlement of<br />

organizational questions, or <strong>for</strong> coordination and control.


Transparency and control is <strong>the</strong> Janus head of a virtual learning environment: both increased drastically<br />

As shown in <strong>the</strong> previous chapters transparency, awareness, and immediacy of action were basic goals to achieve by<br />

applying a virtual learning environment. These are necessary requirements to add context to documents, actions,<br />

and individuals inhabiting <strong>the</strong> virtual environment. On <strong>the</strong> o<strong>the</strong>r hand it led to changes in behavior which reduced<br />

<strong>the</strong> positive effects. At <strong>the</strong> beginning students tended to present very cautiously working materials or results of <strong>the</strong>ir<br />

work. They were afraid of making mistakes or being compared and rated minor than <strong>the</strong>ir colleagues. Different<br />

styles evolved related to <strong>the</strong> gender. The female students tended to name <strong>the</strong>ir contributions e.g. as first, in<strong>for</strong>mal<br />

versions while most of <strong>the</strong>ir male colleagues presented <strong>the</strong>mselves and <strong>the</strong>ir work more actively although <strong>the</strong>re was<br />

no objective reason based in <strong>the</strong> contributions. This behavior equalized to <strong>the</strong> end of <strong>the</strong> course. In synchronous<br />

meetings some women behaved different than in <strong>the</strong> beginning. One could see <strong>the</strong>m sitting at home drinking tea,<br />

smoking cigarettes and once <strong>the</strong> group was asked by a female student: "hi all, I am a bit late, did I miss something<br />

important" This assumes that accomodation to <strong>the</strong> new situation is a relevant factor in virtual learning<br />

environments. To take <strong>the</strong> concerns about making "mistakes and bad exposures" serious a learning environment<br />

should offer protected areas or "play grounds" <strong>for</strong> those who first want to exercise.<br />

The quantative and qualitative amount of interaction among students as well as students and teacher<br />

increased heavily<br />

During <strong>the</strong> three months <strong>the</strong> "average" student sent app. 150 - 200 e-mails to his or her colleagues, 60 e-mails were<br />

distributed via <strong>the</strong> mailing list, <strong>the</strong> shared common folders of <strong>the</strong> group were used daily. We had 6 virtual group<br />

sessions on <strong>the</strong> reflector which lasted each time about two hours. Beside this <strong>the</strong> reflector was used <strong>for</strong> smaller<br />

group meetings or to directly address <strong>the</strong> teacher via video and audio. In <strong>the</strong> beginning most of <strong>the</strong> communication<br />

dealt with <strong>the</strong> use of technology (T) and organizational questions (O) later on unspecific (social) chat (C) and <strong>the</strong><br />

discussion of <strong>the</strong> common task (I) dominated. The extensive use of <strong>the</strong> media did not lead to singularization or<br />

isolation of <strong>the</strong> students or <strong>the</strong> substitution of real life contacts. The contrary was <strong>the</strong> case: often once a week<br />

students invited <strong>the</strong> group <strong>for</strong> a physical meeting in a pub near <strong>the</strong> campus.<br />

The new additional requirements like training, coaching, preparing and moderating electronically need much<br />

more time and work than <strong>the</strong> conventional teaching<br />

The activities to initialize and vitalize <strong>the</strong> collaborative learning environment by <strong>the</strong> teacher and by <strong>the</strong> students<br />

<strong>the</strong>mselves caused great ef<strong>for</strong>ts, at least threefold than usual. Everything - except <strong>the</strong> system - had to be established<br />

from <strong>the</strong> scratch. It was clearly shown, that a collaborative learning environment lives because of <strong>the</strong><br />

communications and actions of <strong>the</strong> participants. The technical systems is an important but not sufficient basis. It can<br />

foster or hinder interaction. In our case <strong>the</strong> BSCW system was a great advantage <strong>for</strong> all.<br />

New metaphors show <strong>the</strong> emergence of a new commonly shared virtual space <strong>for</strong> learning<br />

Is <strong>the</strong> description 'virtual collaborative learning environment' pure rhetoric or reality In <strong>the</strong> final interviews with <strong>the</strong><br />

students at <strong>the</strong> end of <strong>the</strong> course we asked if <strong>the</strong> extensive exchange of in<strong>for</strong>mation among <strong>the</strong> group led to <strong>the</strong><br />

shared idea of a common virtual space. This was agreed by all. As approvements several arguments were given: <strong>the</strong><br />

emergence of new roles (e.g. <strong>the</strong> supporter), <strong>the</strong> emergence of new behavior patterns (e.g. check mail in <strong>the</strong> morning<br />

and in <strong>the</strong> evening), <strong>the</strong> emergence of new socio-technical conventions (e.g. own video must have <strong>the</strong> same size as<br />

<strong>the</strong> o<strong>the</strong>rs), <strong>the</strong> emergence of new metaphors understood by all especially during <strong>the</strong> video sessions (e.g. "Klaus is<br />

frozen" = only picture, no video; "let us meet on <strong>the</strong> daidalos" = name of <strong>the</strong> reflector etc.) and <strong>the</strong> fact, that<br />

although <strong>the</strong> course ended in July <strong>the</strong> shared workspaces of <strong>the</strong> BSCW and <strong>the</strong> mailing list is still in use (Oct. 98).<br />

4. Conclusions<br />

From <strong>the</strong> psychological point of view learning is an individual action. From <strong>the</strong> pedagogical point of view learning<br />

can be assisted by context and collaboration. Our field study showed that <strong>the</strong> BSCW system was a useful and<br />

promising tool to establish a network of communication and collaboration among students and teacher. The findings<br />

will be used to evolutionary redesign <strong>the</strong> system which <strong>the</strong>reby can be augmented by <strong>the</strong> perspectives and demands


of <strong>the</strong> users as participating actors of <strong>the</strong> design and use of virtual collaborative learning environments. From <strong>the</strong><br />

students point of view <strong>the</strong> availability of working materials and results as well as <strong>the</strong> immediacy to communicate to<br />

o<strong>the</strong>rs was considered as a great advantage and raised <strong>the</strong> level of motivation and ef<strong>for</strong>t. For <strong>the</strong> teacher <strong>the</strong><br />

immediacy of communication and <strong>the</strong> options to overview <strong>the</strong> actions and results of each student was <strong>the</strong> most<br />

important effect.<br />

References<br />

[1] Verdejo, Felisa, Davies, Gordon, eds., The Virtual Campus. Trends <strong>for</strong> higher education and training: Chapman<br />

& Hall, London et al. 1998.<br />

[2] Liao, Thomas T., ed., Advanced Educational Technology: Research Issues and Future Potential. Springer:<br />

Berlin, Heidelberg, New York 1996.<br />

[3] http://orgwis.gmd.de/~mambrey/ss98<br />

[4] Bentley, R., Appelt, W., Busbach. U., Hinrichs, E., Kerr, D., Sikkel, S., Trevor, J. and Woetzel, G. (1997)<br />

"Basic Support <strong>for</strong> Cooperative Work on <strong>the</strong> World Wide Web" in International Journal of Human-Computer<br />

Studies 46 (6): 827-846; Special issue on Innovative Applications of <strong>the</strong> World Wide Web (Available on-line as<br />

PostScript (http://bscw.gmd.de/Papers/IJHCS/IJHCS.ps) and HTML document<br />

(http://bscw.gmd.de/Papers/IJHCS/IJHCS.html.)<br />

[5] Hughes, John A., Randall, Davis, Shapiro, Dan, Faltering from Ethnography to Design. In: <strong>Proceedings</strong> of<br />

ACM CSCW '92 Conference on Computer Supported Cooperative Work, 115-122. ACM, 1992.<br />

[6] Bowers, John, The Work to make a Network Work: Studying CSCW in Action. In: <strong>Proceedings</strong> of <strong>the</strong> ACM<br />

CSCW '94 Conference on Computer Supported Cooperative Work, 287-298. ACM, 1994.


Multimedia <strong>for</strong> Kids<br />

Antonio R. Bartolomé<br />

University of Barcelona, Spain<br />

bartolom@doe.d5.ub.es<br />

Karl Steffens<br />

University of Koeln , Germany<br />

karl.steffens@rs1.rrz.uni-koeln.de<br />

"Multimedia <strong>for</strong> Kids" ("Mediakids") is a project of research and development in <strong>the</strong> field of multimedia design<br />

and production, funded by “Eductional Multimedia Joint Call” from <strong>the</strong> European Commission, with <strong>the</strong><br />

participation of 5 universities, 4 schools and 2 private companies of 6 European countries. The project began in<br />

September 1998, and will last <strong>for</strong> is 2 years. This is a short description of this project and its main distinctive<br />

items.<br />

1. Objectives and basic description<br />

Research on educational multimedia shows that <strong>the</strong>re are a number of key aspects that in general receive little<br />

attention. To <strong>the</strong>se, we want to pay particular interest:<br />

. The fit of multimedia programs to <strong>the</strong> curriculum.<br />

. Individual differences between teachers.<br />

. Cultural differences.<br />

. The level of participation of end-users in <strong>the</strong> development process.<br />

. The consideration of metacognitive and non-cognitive dimensions in learning.<br />

. The integration of CD-ROM multimedia material and Internet based material into instructional processes.<br />

The project will evaluate <strong>the</strong> design, development and integration of multimedia materials into instruction<br />

processes through two parallel conceptions. The objective of <strong>the</strong> research is not to compare both ones but to<br />

analyze how end users participation in design and production process affects <strong>the</strong> final integration of products,<br />

and how two different multimedia designs could be integrated in actual educational environments.<br />

"Geometry <strong>for</strong> Kids" is a CD-ROM multimedia program, with Internet based communication elements, in an<br />

open -modular, flexible, interchangeable- design, to be developed by software companies but with participation<br />

of end-users -students and teachers- during <strong>the</strong> production process, and in a context of a methodological<br />

approach that takes into consideration <strong>the</strong> national and individual differences between countries, schools and<br />

teachers, as well as <strong>the</strong> metacognitive and non-cognitive aspects of learning.<br />

"As we were" is a Internet multimedia environment -<strong>the</strong> history of childhood in Europe- with some CD-ROM<br />

based resources. This environment af<strong>for</strong>ds a high level of communication of schools involved ei<strong>the</strong>r at national<br />

or European level. The environment is composed of elements and tools as well as methodological suggestions<br />

that teacher and students could integrate freely into <strong>the</strong>ir own curricular design. The CD-ROM offers multimedia<br />

elements -e.g. tools, samples as designs, video sequences, and sounds- compiled by schools that participate in<br />

<strong>the</strong> project.<br />

Our evaluative research will aim at clarifying if <strong>the</strong>se proposals answer schools needs and, at <strong>the</strong> same time, how<br />

<strong>the</strong>y will offer possibilities of being developed in an cost-efficiency way in an open market.<br />

This is a complex and important project, funded with half a million of dollars. There are o<strong>the</strong>r lines of research<br />

as well. One linked to pedagogical research is to develop solutions that try to apply to commercial products <strong>the</strong><br />

results of recent research about learning and related metacognitive aspects.


2. O<strong>the</strong>r Characteristics of <strong>the</strong> Project:<br />

Direct participation of 4 schools as associated partners, and 2 more schools in development and evaluation<br />

phases. Participation of 30 schools in <strong>the</strong> implementation phase through National Agencies and Schools<br />

<strong>Association</strong>s and networks as well as Teachers Training Institutions.<br />

The two multimedia computer programs (CD-ROM and Internet based technology) will be part of a learning<br />

environment that takes into consideration constructivist, situated cognition and contingent instruction aspects.<br />

Schools will benefits from <strong>the</strong> results of this project in terms of innovative MM models based in edutainment<br />

conceptions, 3D representations, context learning, object oriented design, as well as in terms of models <strong>for</strong> a<br />

transnational teaching and a cooperation with university and industry.<br />

The programs will be validated at schools, private and public, with telematics connection, MM level 2<br />

equipment, one KEY person -a teacher interested, motivated, and English speaking, and 8-10 and 10-12 year<br />

old students. Schools will be connected though national agencies and/or private schools associations.<br />

The project will benefit from cognitive/metacognitive/non-cognitive research, instructional studies, particularly<br />

in <strong>the</strong> field of Geometry and History. The first 3 months of project (work packages 2 and 5) are oriented to<br />

prepare <strong>the</strong> pedagogical basis <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> multimedia design.<br />

The partners involved in <strong>the</strong> project are: Universitat de Barcelona (coordinator) (E), Universtät zu Köln (D), The<br />

Nottingham Trent University (UK), Universidade Catolica Portuguesa (PT), Leiden University (NL), Colegio<br />

Senara (E), Col.legi públic Salvador Espriu (E), College House Junior School (UK), Scuola Statale Fabio Besta<br />

(I), Giunti Multimedia (I), Plaza & Janés Editores (Bertelsman group) (E).<br />

3. Project Management<br />

The work has been organized in 9 workpackages (WP), each one with several tasks.<br />

WP 1 Project management.<br />

WP 2 Research on children´s cognitive, metacognitive, and non-cognitive activities in working<br />

at geometry problems with computers<br />

WP 3 Development of a pedagogical framework <strong>for</strong> a multimedia geometry environment <strong>for</strong> primary schools<br />

WP 4 Development of a multimedia course on geometry <strong>for</strong> primary schools<br />

WP 5 Research on children´s technology enhanced historical reasoning in primary schools<br />

WP 6 Development of a pedagogical framework <strong>for</strong> an open software (shell) <strong>for</strong> a multimedia course<br />

on <strong>the</strong> history of childhood in Europe<br />

WP 7 Development of an open software (shell) <strong>for</strong> creating a multimedia course<br />

on <strong>the</strong> history of childhood in Europe <strong>for</strong> primary schools<br />

WP 8 Formative evaluation of <strong>the</strong> two MM programs<br />

WP 9 Dissemination of <strong>the</strong> two programs and evaluation of <strong>the</strong>ir use in specific learning environments..<br />

WP2 and WP5 have been completed. Reports have been produced in paper, Web and CD-ROM. The CD-ROM<br />

version includes also a database of references (Mac and Win plat<strong>for</strong>ms). All are available at:<br />

http://www.doe.d5.ub.es/mediakids


Grimm Project. ICT at School<br />

Antonio R. Bartolomé<br />

University of Barcelona, Spain<br />

bartolom@doe.d5.ub.es<br />

Mariona Grané<br />

University of Barcelona, Spain<br />

Mariona.Grane@doe.d5.ub.es<br />

Anna Rubio<br />

University of Barcelona, Spain<br />

Anna.Rubio@doe.d5.ub.es<br />

1. The History<br />

GRIMM is a research + development (R+D) project between schools, universities and companies, whose aim is<br />

to introduce In<strong>for</strong>mation and Communication Technologies into education. As an umbrella project, it includes<br />

several and different subprojects.<br />

Spring, 1993. One teacher at <strong>the</strong> Marinada public school, and one professor <strong>for</strong>m <strong>the</strong> University of Barcelona<br />

thought: What about to introduce standard computers in 3 years old classrooms as o<strong>the</strong>r space in <strong>the</strong> learning<br />

environment In Spain, 3-6 years old is <strong>the</strong> first level school system. During a month <strong>the</strong>y found that touch<br />

screen was not necessary -except <strong>for</strong> filling <strong>the</strong> computer screen with chocolate, that computers were as natural<br />

<strong>for</strong> children as books -or more, that <strong>the</strong>y could work developing strategies and organizing <strong>the</strong>m selves, that <strong>the</strong>y<br />

did not need sophisticated computers but standard Macintosh... During <strong>the</strong> next year Apple, two o<strong>the</strong>r<br />

universities and 12 more schools across Spain involved in <strong>the</strong> project. From <strong>the</strong>m, several universities,<br />

companies and schools have been added to <strong>the</strong> project becoming <strong>the</strong> most important non-official project <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong><br />

introduction of ICT at <strong>the</strong> school at <strong>1999</strong>.<br />

2. Some descriptors<br />

Grimm does not limit participation. It is flexible and members could participate at <strong>the</strong>ir own way, with different<br />

targets, technical evolution, social organization, educational needs,... Public and private, religious and nonreligious<br />

schools are members of <strong>the</strong> project. However, respecting democratic principles and children rights is<br />

one of <strong>the</strong> rules of <strong>the</strong> project.<br />

GRIMM started with <strong>the</strong> idea of exploring computers being introduced in a given framework: childhood<br />

classrooms, organized as interest centers, being <strong>the</strong> computer one of this interest centers. Now <strong>the</strong> projects<br />

includes Primary and Secondary levels until 16 years old. A key aspect is <strong>the</strong> collaboration of companies,<br />

schools and universities in a common project. Also local and regional authorities participate or have expressed<br />

<strong>the</strong>ir interest in participating.<br />

Computers are considered as communication tools. The coordinators (mainly universities and some schools) act<br />

stimulating educational strategies where <strong>the</strong> use of computers is introduced in a natural way. Schools have an<br />

important role in <strong>the</strong> direction of project <strong>for</strong> developing teaching methodology and multimedia software.<br />

Universities direct <strong>the</strong> research lines and works. Companies support <strong>the</strong> framework, communication channels<br />

and hardware and software needs. Companies and universities are responsible <strong>for</strong> facilitating <strong>the</strong> introduction of<br />

new models, innovations and actions in this learning process.<br />

A key idea is <strong>the</strong> incorporation of R+D concept in education field: concrete research projects are being carried<br />

out - global research is about how to introduce new technologies into childhood classrooms. Software and new


education resources are being produced ei<strong>the</strong>r by teachers or by developers with <strong>the</strong> support and evaluation of<br />

teachers. Teachers training is considered as a development task.<br />

3. Structure of <strong>the</strong> project<br />

Schools and universities works in a autonomous way, through local and regional groups. A nation wide Task<br />

Force group activates <strong>the</strong> project and represents <strong>the</strong> interests of <strong>the</strong> whole group. Nowadays, <strong>the</strong> leaders of <strong>the</strong><br />

project are some institutions, centers and enterprises: Irabia School, University of Tarragona, University of<br />

Malaga, University of Barcelona and Apple Computer Spain. These leaders, <strong>the</strong> national coordinators team<br />

(Grimm Task Force), promote <strong>the</strong> participation in <strong>the</strong> project and pretend to coordinate and facilitate <strong>the</strong><br />

communication between <strong>the</strong> participants.<br />

The communication is based in a distributed concept. Irabia School, Apple and University of Barcelona support<br />

<strong>the</strong> main Web sites with specific goals (resources exchange, data in<strong>for</strong>mation, project management,...) One of<br />

<strong>the</strong>se sites is restricted to project partners. O<strong>the</strong>r universities support teachers and coordinators lists (University<br />

of Tarragona), paper printed materials distribution (University of Malaga), etc. Some specific projects are<br />

supported e.g. <strong>the</strong> Finderina childhood distribution list project is supported from Barcelona, while <strong>the</strong> Teachers<br />

instructional web pages project is supported by Irabia, etc.<br />

Apple and o<strong>the</strong>r companies support <strong>the</strong> Internet access, <strong>the</strong> CD-ROM six-month distribution with <strong>the</strong> materials<br />

developed in <strong>the</strong> project, <strong>the</strong> organization of task <strong>for</strong>ce meetings and <strong>the</strong> annual National Conference. The<br />

teachers training projects include <strong>the</strong> local and regional actions, <strong>the</strong> Grimm real and virtual campus, <strong>the</strong><br />

technical introduction courses from companies, and o<strong>the</strong>r training actions.<br />

4. Results<br />

Grimm has played a first role in <strong>the</strong> introduction of computers at childhood school in Spain and it has supported<br />

several research works in ICT school introduction field. It has destroyed some myths about <strong>the</strong> isolation<br />

produced by computers, <strong>the</strong> collaborative work, <strong>the</strong> emotional development of young computers users, etc. The<br />

computers use training of teachers have showed as an emotional process more than a skills developing one.<br />

Schools have discovered that it is possible to collaborate with commercial companies, and <strong>the</strong>se have found that<br />

is is necessary to consider <strong>the</strong> teachers ideas.<br />

More in<strong>for</strong>mation -always in Spanish- from web sites, or asking <strong>for</strong> CD-ROM or books at.<br />

http://www.doe.d5.ub.es/grimm2000<br />

http://www.apple.es/educacion/proyectogrimm/Welcome.html


CourseMaster: Modeling A Pedagogy <strong>for</strong> On-line Distance Instruction<br />

Benjamin Bell<br />

Department of Human Development<br />

Teachers College, Columbia University<br />

United States of America<br />

benjamin.bell@columbia.edu<br />

Danielle Kaplan<br />

Department of Human Development<br />

Teachers College, Columbia University<br />

United States of America<br />

danielle.kaplan@columbia.edu<br />

Abstract: As attention becomes increasingly focused on distance education, in <strong>the</strong> public eye and<br />

within <strong>the</strong> academic community, a sense of urgency to develop on-line course offerings is taking<br />

hold among institutions that wish to be responsive to student needs (real or perceived) and that do<br />

not want to be "left behind" as peer institutions tool up <strong>for</strong> distance instruction. With <strong>the</strong> host of<br />

software tools available, adapting courses to <strong>the</strong> on-line learning environment does not pose<br />

insurmountable technical obstacles, and can be almost routine. What becomes a challenge is<br />

preserving <strong>the</strong> original value of <strong>the</strong> instructional design and adapting <strong>the</strong> pedagogical nuances of a<br />

course to best leverage <strong>the</strong> modalities of on-line instruction. This paper illustrates how a graduate<br />

level course at Teachers College, tailored <strong>for</strong> face-to-face instruction, was adapted <strong>for</strong> distant<br />

learners, and how <strong>the</strong> instructional design was captured and replicated by a web-based distance<br />

education authoring tool.<br />

Introduction<br />

Recently, Teachers College, Columbia University expanded <strong>the</strong> boundaries of its campus by offering on-line distance<br />

learning courses <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> first time. Three graduate courses, in three different areas, were selected <strong>for</strong> this pilot initiative:<br />

Computer-Mediated Communication, The Teaching of Writing, and Instructional Design of Educational Technology. The<br />

courses, previously designed <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> classroom, were adapted to on-line settings, and in <strong>the</strong> spirit of experimentation, each course<br />

adopted a different development path. We will discuss <strong>the</strong> design of <strong>the</strong> course in Instructional Design of Educational<br />

Technology, which poses several challenges to <strong>the</strong> distance <strong>for</strong>mat, among <strong>the</strong>m, its emphasis on discussion, <strong>the</strong> importance of<br />

technology demonstrations, and <strong>the</strong> centrality of group project work. We also summarize <strong>the</strong> evolution of <strong>the</strong> CourseMaster<br />

Authoring Environment, a database-driven tool that is derived centrally from a model of distance instruction that guided <strong>the</strong><br />

construction of <strong>the</strong> original course application.<br />

Goals<br />

The goals of this project were to build a reproducible distance learning model, within which rich classroom interactions<br />

among participants can be replicated, and to shed light on potential obstacles to <strong>the</strong> success of this approach. We were guided in<br />

part by our previous distance learning research that calls <strong>for</strong> a resource space, discussion space and collaboration space as<br />

components of successful computer-supported distributed learning (Bell & Meyer,1997). In <strong>the</strong> pilot course, we focussed on<br />

specific design techniques <strong>for</strong> fostering group interaction. We developed several facets of <strong>the</strong> course with community-building in<br />

mind: a student database where participants would share personal profiles; a suite of technology demonstrations and<br />

corresponding assignments aimed at getting students to share reactions to those demonstrations; a terminal project that engaged<br />

teams of students in remote collaboration; and regular discussion and chat sessions to foster and sustain whatever communal<br />

momentum had been achieved. The creation and implementation of Instructional Design Online (as <strong>the</strong> distance version came to<br />

be called) presented an opportunity to invent a web-based learning environment, adapt an onsite class to an on-line course and<br />

capture its design in a mold, thus providing a test-bed <strong>for</strong> studying learning at a distance.<br />

Pilot Course Design: Instructional Design Online<br />

Instructional Design of Educational Technology is a graduate class that surveys contemporary frameworks <strong>for</strong><br />

intelligent learning environments and that engages students in designing and executing collaborative projects (e.g., an interactive<br />

web-based environment, stand-alone instructional multimedia, etc.). The class thus emphasizes learning by doing. In order to<br />

support this approach through computer-mediated instruction, <strong>the</strong> course site includes five sections, each of which can be reached


y using a drop-down menu: In<strong>for</strong>mation Desk, Course Central, Instructor's Corner, Student Lounge, and Help Center. Each<br />

section has its own sub-menu <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> sites located within that section.<br />

The In<strong>for</strong>mation Desk includes an overview of <strong>the</strong> course, an orientation session, a course outline, and registration<br />

in<strong>for</strong>mation. The overview offers a summary of <strong>the</strong> class and a list of required readings. The orientation is intended to welcome<br />

students, guide <strong>the</strong>m into practicing tasks common to an on-line class and prepare <strong>the</strong>m with <strong>the</strong> tools necessary <strong>for</strong> exploring <strong>the</strong><br />

learning environment. Initial assignments are designed to engage students in Internet communication. Orientation assignments<br />

include viewing a video welcome from <strong>the</strong> instructors (Fig. 1) and creating a student profile.<br />

Figure 1: Streamed Video Greeting<br />

Course Central consists of a syllabus, on-line demonstrations of educational technology, course lecture slides, and<br />

course assignments. The syllabus is divided into topic-specific modules, each including links to <strong>the</strong> corresponding lecture slides,<br />

assignments <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> week and related technology demonstrations. The readings <strong>for</strong> that module are available via hypertext links<br />

to external web sites.<br />

Web-based educational technology demonstrations represent an important element of this course. The principles and<br />

frameworks discussed in <strong>the</strong> readings can remain largely static or abstract in <strong>the</strong> absence of applications of those ideas in <strong>the</strong><br />

<strong>for</strong>m of interactive illustrations. To preserve this central aspect of <strong>the</strong> course, we adapted several works-in-progress at Teachers<br />

College <strong>for</strong> on-line viewing, including Wx-Brief (Bell, Vaughn & Reibel 1997), Aviation Story Archive (Bell, Gold & Kaplan,<br />

1998), and <strong>the</strong> Virtual Hall of Fame (Zirkel, Bell & Gold, 1998). Each Demonstration is accessible on-line (Fig. 2) and<br />

supplemented by an assignment in which students share observations and critiques of <strong>the</strong> demonstration.<br />

Figure 2: Educational Technology Demonstration<br />

Lecture Slides are available in modules, each consisting of slides that can be navigated in succession or through direct<br />

links. Assignments are designed to encourage students to explore technology tools and Instructional Design <strong>the</strong>ories, and to<br />

integrate <strong>the</strong>m in discussion responses and project creations. Assignments range from regular responses to issues raised in <strong>the</strong><br />

reading to creating interactive exemplars of concepts treated during <strong>the</strong> course.


The Student Lounge includes a database of student profiles, a meeting room and a student projects area. The Student<br />

Profiles section facilitates <strong>the</strong> distribution and sharing of individual profile and contact in<strong>for</strong>mation. A participant database (Fig.<br />

3) receives profile <strong>for</strong>ms submitted by <strong>the</strong> student, and permits <strong>the</strong> browsing and searching of participant profiles, pictures and<br />

contact data. Profiles include direct links to student mailboxes and world wide web addresses, personal interests, and academic<br />

and professional histories. The instructors’ profiles and office hours are in <strong>the</strong> Instructors’ Corner. The profiles include<br />

Instructor academic background, links to personal web sites, and office hours (which are conducted face-to-face, by telephone,<br />

via text chat, or using audio conferencing).<br />

Figure 3: Student Profile Database<br />

The Meeting Room, supporting synchronous (chat) and asynchronous (bulletin board) interaction, is <strong>the</strong> primary<br />

communication area. The chat room permits live scheduled group discussions, including multiple simultaneous one-to-one<br />

private chats, about topics related to course content, assignments and group projects. Class-wide chats are transcribed and<br />

published on <strong>the</strong> course site. The discussion room supports group communication through individual message postings.<br />

Early in <strong>the</strong> course, students are asked to <strong>for</strong>m groups and to begin proposing final projects. As <strong>the</strong> semester<br />

progresses, students are asked to prepare incremental reports, such as a storyboard, documenting <strong>the</strong>ir progress in <strong>the</strong> final<br />

project. The Student Projects area centralizes in<strong>for</strong>mation regarding final projects, <strong>the</strong> culminating product of <strong>the</strong> students'<br />

experience in <strong>the</strong> course. Suggestions (in <strong>the</strong> <strong>for</strong>m of online technology demonstrations) are offered as potential group projects,<br />

though students are invited to propose <strong>the</strong>ir own ideas as well. A project database collects and publishes in<strong>for</strong>mation about<br />

project group members, member email addresses, and project URLs, so that group members and projects are easily accessible.<br />

Formative Evaluation<br />

Participants<br />

The course was offered during <strong>the</strong> spring, summer and fall semesters of 1998 and is currently in session <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> spring,<br />

<strong>1999</strong> term. Eight students enrolled <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> spring semester, 7 students <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> summer, and 17 <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> fall. In each semester's class,<br />

more than half of <strong>the</strong> students registered <strong>for</strong> credit. All of <strong>the</strong> students in each semester had completed or were pursuing ei<strong>the</strong>r a<br />

Masters or Doctoral degree. Most of <strong>the</strong> students registered <strong>for</strong> credit were part-time students who work full-time as ei<strong>the</strong>r<br />

classroom teachers or technology professionals. Several of <strong>the</strong> non-credit students were faculty at o<strong>the</strong>r institutions who were<br />

interested in exploring examples of distance learning courses. Students were physically situated in locations throughout <strong>the</strong> U.S.<br />

(with some international participation from Japan and Brazil).<br />

Methods<br />

Pre- and post-course surveys and scheduled chat interviews were used to ga<strong>the</strong>r qualitative in<strong>for</strong>mation about on-line<br />

students and on-line student experiences in <strong>the</strong> pilot course. Chat sessions, discussion postings and group projects served as<br />

additional evidence documenting student per<strong>for</strong>mance. The objective of this <strong>for</strong>mative evaluation was to learn more about how<br />

students made use of <strong>the</strong> tools we supplied with <strong>the</strong> course, <strong>the</strong> extent to which those tools fur<strong>the</strong>red <strong>the</strong> students' capacity to<br />

engage in <strong>the</strong> class activities, and to explore potential research questions <strong>for</strong> fur<strong>the</strong>r studies. The study did not attempt to<br />

measure learning outcomes beyond a qualitative assessment of <strong>the</strong>ir productivity as required <strong>for</strong> grading purposes. Our<br />

evaluation was guided in part by <strong>the</strong> expectation that understanding <strong>the</strong> learning needs of students is crucial to successful on-line<br />

course experiences (Reid, 1996; Warren, 1996; Willis, 1995). Pre-course surveys were aimed at gauging student backgrounds<br />

and skills and <strong>the</strong>ir reasons <strong>for</strong> enrolling in <strong>the</strong> course. Post-course surveys were aimed at ga<strong>the</strong>ring student perceptions about<br />

<strong>the</strong>ir experience in <strong>the</strong> course and <strong>the</strong> design of <strong>the</strong> learning environment.


Results<br />

Computing ability and exposure to <strong>the</strong> Internet varied widely among incoming students. In each class <strong>the</strong>re were<br />

individuals who reported that <strong>the</strong>y did not feel confident in <strong>the</strong>ir computing skills, as well as o<strong>the</strong>rs who reported that <strong>the</strong>y were<br />

com<strong>for</strong>table with a variety of computer and Internet applications. Variation in computer literacy also became evident as <strong>the</strong><br />

semesters progressed. Many of <strong>the</strong> individuals who had expressed a lack in computing skills moved through <strong>the</strong> syllabus at a<br />

much slower rate and seemed to be less involved in group communication. There were also individuals who came in with weak<br />

computing skills and gained proficiency at a rapid rate. During one semester, a vision-impaired student participating in <strong>the</strong><br />

course provided valuable feedback on <strong>the</strong> extent to which our course site accommodates visually-impaired students in accessing<br />

in<strong>for</strong>mation and navigating <strong>the</strong> site.<br />

The Discussion room was <strong>the</strong> most active component of <strong>the</strong> courses in each semester, primarily used <strong>for</strong> discussion<br />

about course assignments and scheduling. Assignment postings took on a quality that seemed to be a cross between written<br />

language and spoken conversation, with ideas expressed in a blending of in<strong>for</strong>mal and <strong>for</strong>mal language styles. A large proportion<br />

of <strong>the</strong> postings in <strong>the</strong> discussion threads were responses to assignments or questions from <strong>the</strong> Instructor or Teaching Assistant.<br />

Students did not begin to initiate spontaneous postings until later in <strong>the</strong> semester. The discussion room was not used <strong>for</strong> dialog<br />

with o<strong>the</strong>r students until <strong>the</strong> Instructor suggested that students respond to <strong>the</strong> postings of o<strong>the</strong>r students. Once this suggestion<br />

was made, peer-to-peer interaction became more frequent and substantive.<br />

Statements from students indicate that communication among students also took place via private email messages and<br />

by telephone. While much of <strong>the</strong> communication from <strong>the</strong> Instructor and Teaching Assistant occurred in <strong>the</strong> public<br />

communication space, spontaneous communication from students to instructors usually took place in private email or telephone<br />

messages. Email messages and telephone calls from students to <strong>the</strong> Instructor or TA were primarily about administrative and<br />

technical issues, such as course credit, and only occasionally contained content related communication. Instances of project<br />

related mail and phone calls did occur just be<strong>for</strong>e <strong>the</strong> final projects were due during <strong>the</strong> spring and summer semesters.<br />

Students in <strong>the</strong> spring and summer semesters did not frequently meet in <strong>the</strong> Chat Room unless <strong>the</strong> Instructor had<br />

scheduled <strong>the</strong> chat. Students in <strong>the</strong> fall course appeared to be making more use of <strong>the</strong> Chat Room <strong>for</strong> peer-to-peer<br />

communication. One fall semester group met in <strong>the</strong> Chat Room <strong>for</strong> several hours a week. The main differences between groups<br />

in <strong>the</strong> fall course and groups in <strong>the</strong> spring and summer appeared to be group size (<strong>the</strong> fall class had larger groups) and individual<br />

computing ability (<strong>the</strong> fall class had more individuals with strong computing ability). In each term, <strong>the</strong> Chat Room was used on<br />

just one occasion as an entire class (time-zone differences caused scheduling difficulties). Not all of <strong>the</strong> students attended <strong>the</strong><br />

scheduled chats. For <strong>the</strong> participants who did attend, <strong>the</strong>se sessions were productive. Several students mentioned that Chat<br />

Room discussions were most like <strong>the</strong> communication that takes place in <strong>the</strong> classroom. All of <strong>the</strong> Chat participants<br />

spontaneously shared thoughts and ideas.<br />

Not all of <strong>the</strong> individuals in <strong>the</strong> spring and summer courses completed a final group project. The group projects that<br />

were completed were of high quality. There had been some concern about whe<strong>the</strong>r students in <strong>the</strong> on-line class would have<br />

access to <strong>the</strong> same materials as students in <strong>the</strong> classroom, such as commercial, licensed authoring software, so it was decided that<br />

on-line student projects would be created with publicly available materials. Despite <strong>the</strong> potential difference in student resources,<br />

<strong>the</strong> on-line students' final project was comparable to final projects created by students in <strong>the</strong> classroom. Students in both online<br />

and in classroom courses produced original technology-based learning environments that showed some integration of <strong>the</strong>ories<br />

discussed in <strong>the</strong> course.<br />

Student comments suggested that <strong>the</strong>y appreciated <strong>the</strong> variety of delivery methods and in<strong>for</strong>mation resources provided,<br />

such as lecture notes, public readings and discussion threads. However, <strong>the</strong>y also expressed frustration in accessing <strong>the</strong>se<br />

resources. Several students mentioned that <strong>the</strong>y had consistently had connectivity problems and problems during chat sessions<br />

and in downloading plug-ins and o<strong>the</strong>r course in<strong>for</strong>mation. Advanced components took too long to download or made <strong>the</strong>ir<br />

computer crash. These students indicated that much of <strong>the</strong> problem was with <strong>the</strong>ir hardware. Suggestions were made to make<br />

graphics, video and o<strong>the</strong>r hard to access in<strong>for</strong>mation available through o<strong>the</strong>r means. Generally, <strong>the</strong> comments acknowledged <strong>the</strong><br />

importance of speedy and reliable connections and up-to-date hardware. Also, based on <strong>the</strong> comments made during <strong>the</strong> final chat<br />

session in which students were directly queried (in <strong>the</strong> absence of <strong>the</strong> instructor), students appeared overwhelmed by <strong>the</strong><br />

technical requirements combined with <strong>the</strong> content of <strong>the</strong> course. These students did not feel that <strong>the</strong>ir knowledge of computer<br />

technology supported <strong>the</strong>ir learning needs and suggested a hands-on prerequisite, which would enable students to learn <strong>the</strong><br />

technology apart from <strong>the</strong> content. All students who have completed <strong>the</strong> course thus far responded that <strong>the</strong>y would consider<br />

taking ano<strong>the</strong>r distance learning course.<br />

Discussion<br />

Our exploratory findings provide some in<strong>for</strong>mation about <strong>the</strong> needs of distance learners, how our design functions in<br />

practice, and how to focus our future research ef<strong>for</strong>ts. While many distance courses are promoted to provide flexibility and<br />

convenience, <strong>the</strong>y may in fact be more time consuming than classroom courses, depending upon <strong>the</strong> skill level and resources of<br />

individual participants and <strong>the</strong> quantity of participants. For students who were not com<strong>for</strong>table with Internet communication or<br />

had inadequate resources, downloading data and keeping up with communication was more time consuming than <strong>the</strong>y had<br />

expected. It is clear when examining both student needs and instructional design that explicit in<strong>for</strong>mation regarding minimum<br />

and suggested hardware and software requirements be made available to students.


There appear to be both similarities and differences in student participation in classroom and distance learning<br />

environments. Similarly to on-site classes, students who were not taking <strong>the</strong> course <strong>for</strong> credit were not as active as students who<br />

were enrolled <strong>for</strong> credit. In contrast to on-site classes, students in <strong>the</strong> on-line class did not seem as accountable <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong>ir work.<br />

On-line students did not complete all of <strong>the</strong> assignments and did not attend all <strong>the</strong> scheduled meetings. Overall, <strong>the</strong> on-line<br />

students in this class required more guidance and imperatives. On-line students did not seem as self-disciplined, perhaps because<br />

<strong>the</strong>y did not have physical access to <strong>the</strong> Instructor or Teaching Assistant. Despite <strong>the</strong> challenges involved in this on-line setting,<br />

students were able to utilize <strong>the</strong> tools, navigate and participate within <strong>the</strong> learning environment. Most students more than<br />

sufficiently completed <strong>the</strong> entire course on-line.<br />

These preliminary studies have been helpful in our ef<strong>for</strong>ts to develop more systematic means of investigation. Based<br />

on student comments and student participation in <strong>the</strong> spring and summer courses, a new set of database-driven pre-course and<br />

post-course surveys was developed and distributed in <strong>the</strong> fall semester online and classroom courses. Survey questions are<br />

designed to capture in<strong>for</strong>mation regarding student skill level, reasons <strong>for</strong> taking <strong>the</strong> course, predictions about <strong>the</strong> learning<br />

outcomes and challenges in on-line courses versus <strong>the</strong> learning outcomes and challenges of students in classroom courses, and<br />

perceptions of student-professor and student-student relationships. Questions in <strong>the</strong> new surveys invite both open-ended (as in<br />

previous surveys) answers and precalculated answers (based on open-ended answers from previous semesters). The overall goal<br />

of this new addition to <strong>the</strong> design of <strong>the</strong> course is to provide an improved structure <strong>for</strong> examining on-line student learning,<br />

evaluating course design, discovering student perceptions about on-line learning in comparison to classroom learning and<br />

ga<strong>the</strong>ring preliminary evidence about whe<strong>the</strong>r or not intimacy levels among individuals within a distance learning environment<br />

are different than intimacy levels among students in a classroom environment.<br />

Bringing <strong>the</strong> Model to Life<br />

Upon building what proved to be an effective course design given current technological conditions, we <strong>the</strong>n<br />

successfully crafted CourseMaster (Fig. 4) by abstracting <strong>the</strong> original course and implementing that abstracted model as a set of<br />

relationally-linked database templates. The result is a sophisticated courseware authoring tool that not only renders <strong>the</strong> course<br />

production process less mechanically burdensome, but also adheres to (and derives its power from) this specific design model.<br />

Because it is created in a fully web-compliant database environment, CourseMaster can be used remotely by authors, and design<br />

commitments are immediately reflected in <strong>the</strong> materials published on <strong>the</strong> web. We can now create a new on-line course modeled<br />

on this design, within any subject area, with relative ease.<br />

Figure 4: CourseMaster Interface<br />

CourseMaster presents us with three research opportunities. First, comparisons can be made using <strong>the</strong> same design<br />

among different content areas. Second, aspects of group interaction across all content areas and design frameworks can be<br />

explored with <strong>the</strong> use of survey evaluation databases. Third, questions can be asked about instructional design in terms of<br />

particular on-line learning components, such as chats, discussion rooms and visual aids, by building identical courses that vary<br />

only in terms of <strong>the</strong> use of particular components.<br />

Conclusion<br />

One common deficiency among distance instruction materials we have encountered is <strong>the</strong> absence of an explicit<br />

instructional approach (Bell & Meyer, 1997). This paper described a distance courseware design in which we adopted a<br />

pedagogy that emphasizes peer interaction and group collaboration. An overall objective of this research is to develop<br />

frameworks <strong>for</strong> distance course design, appropriate <strong>for</strong> given subject domains, that preserve <strong>the</strong> positive elements of face-to-face


instructional designs while introducing new strategies that take advantage of <strong>the</strong> properties of desktop telecommunication and<br />

web-based interchange. Our experiences with <strong>the</strong> design of Instructional Design Online have suggested some positive aspects of<br />

on-line distance learning and have indicated some directions <strong>for</strong> future research and course development. A principal conclusion<br />

is that successful distance learning must be at least as (if not more) firmly grounded in communication as traditional classroom<br />

instruction. Our success with <strong>the</strong> use of student profiles, collaborative project work, and extensive discussion lend supports to <strong>the</strong><br />

claim that distance learning is effective to <strong>the</strong> degree that it creates and maintains learning communities that support knowledge<br />

construction. The emergence of collaborative tools that allow students to create and refine knowledge artifacts on-line is<br />

encouraging (Harasim, Calvert & Groeneboer, 1996). Web-based communications technologies will no doubt continue to evolve<br />

to support more real time communication and a more seamless interface among communication, collaboration, and in<strong>for</strong>mationga<strong>the</strong>ring<br />

resources (Harasim, 1990). Flexible tools, such as CourseMaster, that help course designers to organize <strong>the</strong>ir<br />

in<strong>for</strong>mation and incorporate emerging communication and collaborative learning tools support an extension beyond <strong>the</strong> current<br />

model of an HTML template <strong>for</strong> didactic presentation, toward virtual communities of learning.<br />

References<br />

Bell, B.L., Gold, S., and D. Kaplan (1998). Hangar Flying as story-based instruction: Capturing expertise via on-line video<br />

libraries, <strong>Proceedings</strong> of <strong>the</strong> International Conference on Human-Computer Interaction in Aeronautics, Montreal, Canada.<br />

Bell, B.L., and R.R. Meyer (1997). Distributed Learning by Distributed Doing, <strong>Proceedings</strong> of <strong>the</strong> World Conference on<br />

Educational Multimedia and Hypermedia, Calgary, Canada.<br />

Bell, B.L., Vaughn, H., and J.H. Reibel (1997). Wx-Brief: Aviation Forecasting as Earth Science Inquiry, <strong>Proceedings</strong> of <strong>the</strong><br />

World Conference on Educational Multimedia and Hypermedia, Calgary, Canada.<br />

Harasim, L. (1990). Online education: An environment <strong>for</strong> collaboration and intellectual amplification. In L. Harasim (Ed.)<br />

Online Education: Perspectives on a new environment, New York: Praeger Publishers.<br />

Harasim, L, Calvert, T., and Groeneboer, C. (1996). Virtual-U: A Web-based environment customized to support collaborative<br />

learning and knowledge building in post secondary courses, <strong>Proceedings</strong> of <strong>the</strong> Second International Conference on <strong>the</strong> Learning<br />

Sciences, Evanston, IL.<br />

Reid, K.A. (1996). Student Attitudes Toward Distance Learning. Research Abstract, Center <strong>for</strong> Excellence in Distance<br />

Learning, Lucent Technologies.<br />

Warren, R. (1996). Needs of Distance Learners. Research Abstract, Center <strong>for</strong> Excellence in Distance Learning, Lucent<br />

Technologies.<br />

Willis, B. (1995). Distance Education at a Glance. Engineering Outreach, College of Engineering, University of Idaho.<br />

Zirkel, J., Bell, B.L., and Gold, S. (1998). The Virtual Baseball Hall of Fame: Object-Oriented Learning in a Virtual<br />

Environment, <strong>Proceedings</strong> of <strong>the</strong> Third International Conference on <strong>the</strong> Learning Sciences, Atlanta, GA.<br />

Acknowledgements<br />

The authors would like to thank Dr. Rob Steiner and Kevin Wolff at <strong>the</strong> Center <strong>for</strong> Educational Outreach and Innovation at<br />

Teachers College, Columbia University <strong>for</strong> support of this research. The authors acknowledge <strong>the</strong> valuable assistance of Eduard<br />

Izraylovsky, Hun-heon Cho, Jon Michals, Theron Feist and Tawana Murphy, all of Teachers College, and Rob Shea, of<br />

Instructional Systems Inc.


ASU-Online, 3 Years of Digital Design in <strong>the</strong> Desert: Implementing and<br />

facilitating Web Based Instruction at Arizona State University, an<br />

Experiential Account<br />

William M. Bercu, M.Ed.<br />

College of Extended Education<br />

Arizona State University, Tempe, Arizona, USA<br />

bercu@asu.edu, ASUonline: http://asuonline.asu.edu<br />

ASUOnline is a central course development and management system providing online courses <strong>for</strong> fourteen<br />

academic colleges on three urban campuses. Since our first Internet course, spring 1996, ASUOnline has<br />

helped faculty produce and deliver 95 university courses. There are sixty courses planned <strong>for</strong> Summer and<br />

Fall <strong>1999</strong> at Arizona State University.<br />

This presentation will provide an experiential account of successes and challenges that have occurred over<br />

<strong>the</strong> three years that Distance Learning Technology (DLT): College of Extended Education has offered webbased<br />

instruction.<br />

Included will be issues concerning <strong>the</strong> design, delivery and service of Internet courses from both <strong>the</strong><br />

faculty/student perspective and <strong>the</strong> administrative challenges to meet <strong>the</strong>ir needs.


Global Educational Multimedia Server – GEM<br />

Clive Best, Philip Shiels, Monica de Paola<br />

JRC, Ispra, European Commission<br />

http://gem.jrc.it<br />

System Outline<br />

Abstract: GEM is <strong>the</strong> acronym <strong>for</strong> Global Educational Multimedia Server. It is a project initiated by <strong>the</strong><br />

Multimedia Education Task<strong>for</strong>ce of <strong>the</strong> European Commission. The concept of GEM is to develop a European<br />

scale clearing house of in<strong>for</strong>mation, products and services in <strong>the</strong> domain of emerging multimedia technology<br />

applied to education and training. The vision of a new educational model based on high speed networks,<br />

multimedia content and distance learning is already being pursued by many teaching institutions and<br />

companies. The difficulty facing suppliers and users of such systems is to find existing services, planned<br />

services and general in<strong>for</strong>mation. This need is likely to increase greatly in <strong>the</strong> future as <strong>the</strong> market begins to<br />

expand. One of <strong>the</strong> needs will be to help teachers and potential students to discover each o<strong>the</strong>r and to put<br />

providers and customers in touch.<br />

GEM is conceived as a dynamic database accessible through <strong>the</strong> Web, whose in<strong>for</strong>mation and data content are<br />

submitted and updated by <strong>the</strong> suppliers, teachers and to some extent students. It aims to be a focal point in<br />

Europe <strong>for</strong> locating in<strong>for</strong>mation and services in this growing domain.<br />

GEM allows any Internet user to search <strong>for</strong> courses, educational products and educational events ei<strong>the</strong>r through<br />

simple free text or classified by <strong>the</strong>matic keywords and media types. However GEM is more than an ordinary<br />

Web site. Users and organisations, students and teachers, providers and customers can register on <strong>the</strong> system.<br />

After registering, users can “advertise” products if <strong>the</strong>y are providers or requests <strong>for</strong> services if <strong>the</strong>y are users.<br />

Similarly Jobs, conferences notices and courses can be announced.<br />

Each item of in<strong>for</strong>mation entered by a user can be modified on-line by that user. There will soon be discussion<br />

groups and Fora provided with <strong>the</strong> system. It is possible to upload multimedia content (images, audio and<br />

video) from <strong>the</strong> users PC to <strong>the</strong> database.<br />

GEM will also be able to host full interactive courses in a general framework. A database design and Web<br />

interface will be implemented that can allow <strong>for</strong> a general course framework. This framework allows students to<br />

register <strong>for</strong> courses and teachers to monitor progress. At this stage <strong>the</strong> system is envisaged as a solution <strong>for</strong><br />

small organisations without <strong>the</strong> facilities to run <strong>the</strong>ir own distance learning courses, but will be able to use GEM<br />

to host <strong>the</strong>m. Future developments envisage a federation of servers coupled through GEM.<br />

GEM today is a dynamic database interfaced to <strong>the</strong> Internet. Users can interface to GEM using a standard Web<br />

browser. Users search <strong>the</strong> database, submit in<strong>for</strong>mation and update <strong>the</strong>ir entries in <strong>the</strong> database. Results of user<br />

interaction are Web pages generated on <strong>the</strong> fly, shown schematically here as a presentation layer. The system has an<br />

object design layer , where all components of <strong>the</strong> system are defined in object classes. The database will be a<br />

freeware RDBMS and this interfaces through an SQL API layer. The system can be customised by user access eg.<br />

Language preferences. This is shown schematically here as User racking. The interface of <strong>the</strong> system to <strong>the</strong> http<br />

server is through <strong>the</strong> Common Gateway Interface or CGI.<br />

The figure shows a simple schematic overview of GEM and how it will be interfaced to <strong>the</strong> network.<br />

Internet<br />

HTTP server<br />

CGI Layer<br />

Presentation Layer<br />

User Tracking<br />

Object Layer<br />

SQL Layer


GEM uses an object based database which can be dynamically updated over <strong>the</strong> Internet. The core database is an<br />

SQL relational database with an overlying object based design. GEM only uses public domain software as a basic<br />

requirement is that ano<strong>the</strong>r party can host a GEM Server without incurring licensing costs. The GEM data model is<br />

based on metadata. A review of existing systems like IMS (1) , <strong>the</strong> ARIADNE(2) project and IEEE standards<br />

ef<strong>for</strong>ts(3) has recently been made. As a result <strong>the</strong> GEM data model has now been aligned with <strong>the</strong>se systems. A two<br />

way transfer of metadata between ei<strong>the</strong>r system is now possible.<br />

The following functionality is currently available.<br />

• Free and public access to Internet users to search and locate services and data. This access is called anonymous<br />

access and will require no log in.<br />

• Full support <strong>for</strong> four languages is offered – English, French, Italian and German. All four user interfaces are<br />

available including keyword searching. Users can save a language preference.<br />

• Possibility <strong>for</strong> any user or organisation to register on GEM. Once registered each user can enter or upload new<br />

in<strong>for</strong>mation. Each user has a password which can be changed on-line.<br />

• Each user has a personal Web “visiting card” whose in<strong>for</strong>mation can be updated by <strong>the</strong> user online. Each<br />

organisation has a Web presentation space to present <strong>the</strong> organisation and to provide contact and commercial<br />

in<strong>for</strong>mation.<br />

• Organisations will be categorised into commercial, governmental, college, schools etc. Each organisation can<br />

advertise products and services in GEM. The adverts can be in any of <strong>the</strong> four languages supported by GEM.<br />

• Users and organisations can announce meetings, conferences etc. Those events which fall on specific dates will<br />

appear automatically in a Calendar. The Calendar can be browsed by all users.<br />

• Users and organisations will be able to upload “binary data”. This can be an audio clip an image, an MPEG<br />

animation etc. There<strong>for</strong>e in addition to <strong>the</strong> metadata <strong>the</strong> database can hold <strong>the</strong> media itself.<br />

Searching<br />

• Users are able to search <strong>for</strong> products by free text entry. This can be fielded search on a given attribute or a<br />

general free text search over all fields. It will be investigated if an automatic translation of <strong>the</strong> search query so<br />

as to search across multiple languages is feasible.<br />

• Users are able to search <strong>for</strong> products using controlled structured keywords. The relevant attributes and<br />

keywords are defined in later in <strong>the</strong> paper. Numbers of entries are generated automatically.<br />

Browsing<br />

• Users can browse around <strong>the</strong> database using a Yahoo style interface. The software automatically classifies<br />

entries according to valid types and keywords. A refinement of choices can be made by selecting a particular<br />

attribute value.<br />

• Users can browse <strong>for</strong> events in <strong>the</strong> calendar<br />

Future Developments<br />

GEM is currently available in pilot operations at http://gem.jrc.it. New functionality is planned and will be added<br />

over <strong>the</strong> next year. The hosting of course material through a structured course database is under design. Each course<br />

can be updated by <strong>the</strong> author/maintainer, and a database of registered students will be available to <strong>the</strong> maintainer.<br />

Discussion groups, bulletin boards and virtual meetings are in preparation. Linkage to o<strong>the</strong>r systems through search<br />

interfaces based on Z39.50 are planned, as well as through standard http interfaces. The user interface will be<br />

reviewed and updated in <strong>the</strong> light of user feedback, and new requirements of <strong>the</strong> European Commission.<br />

References<br />

Educause IMS Project http://www.imsproject.org<br />

IEEE Learning Standards Comittee http://x3.ieee.org/p1484/<br />

Ariadne Project http://ariadne.unil.ch<br />

Generic In<strong>for</strong>mation Server Toolkit- GIST http://gist.jrc.it


Assured Access/Mobile Computing Initiatives<br />

on Five University Campuses<br />

Craig Blurton, Chair<br />

Advisor on In<strong>for</strong>mation Technology in Education<br />

Head - IT Unit, CAUT<br />

University of Hong Kong<br />

Hong Kong SAR<br />

craigb@hkucc.hku.hk<br />

Yam San Chee<br />

Dept. of In<strong>for</strong>mation Systems & Computer Science<br />

National University of Singapore<br />

Republic of Singapore<br />

Cheeys@comp.nus.edu.sg<br />

Phillip D. Long<br />

Director, Teaching, Learning, Technology Center, and,<br />

Director University Computing User Support Services<br />

Seton Hall University<br />

United States of America<br />

longpd@shu.edu<br />

Mark Resmer<br />

Associate Vice President - In<strong>for</strong>mation Technology<br />

Sonoma State University<br />

United States of America<br />

resmer@sonoma.edu<br />

Craig Runde<br />

Director - International Center <strong>for</strong> Computer Enhanced Learning<br />

Wake Forest University<br />

United States of America<br />

runde@wfu.edu<br />

Overview of Panel Topic<br />

"Mobile computing" and "assured access" are becoming popular phrases to describe a growing number of<br />

university programmes which take advantage of ubiquitous network access points and <strong>the</strong> portability of<br />

notebook computers to ensure all students have access to digital tools and resources. However, <strong>the</strong><br />

implementation of such programmes vary widely from campus to campus. This session will bring toge<strong>the</strong>r<br />

representatives from five campuses, <strong>the</strong> University of Hong Kong, <strong>the</strong> National University of Singapore,<br />

and three U.S. institutions - Seton Hall University, Sonoma State University, and Wake Forest University -<br />

to describe and discuss how each is providing notebook computers and assured access to network resources<br />

to all students.<br />

Mobile Computing and Students at <strong>the</strong> University of Hong Kong-A Good Match<br />

Craig Blurton, University of Hong Kong<br />

Responding to developments in learning technologies, tertiary institutions around <strong>the</strong> world are exploring<br />

new methods of teaching and learning, developing new programme delivery mechanisms, and addressing<br />

<strong>the</strong> educational needs of new types of students. John F. Kennedy, an American president, once noted:


"Change is <strong>the</strong> law of life, and those who look only to <strong>the</strong> past or <strong>the</strong> present are certain to miss <strong>the</strong> future."<br />

In a time of diminishing resources and increasing competition <strong>for</strong> students, universities can ill af<strong>for</strong>d to<br />

ignore future directions of IT use in education.<br />

The University of Hong Kong has made a firm commitment to be a leader in <strong>the</strong> use of in<strong>for</strong>mation<br />

technology in education. It is <strong>the</strong> University's intent to move ahead rapidly to create a technology-rich<br />

environment in which teaching, learning and research can thrive, and our students and staff can make<br />

effective use of <strong>the</strong> latest advances in IT.<br />

Our main strategy in this regard is <strong>the</strong> creation of a mobile computing environment on campus in which a<br />

new "digital culture" can be fostered. Beginning September 1998, all incoming freshman are encouraged<br />

and subsidized to own a notebook computer. In <strong>the</strong> first class under <strong>the</strong> new programme, approximately<br />

2,600 students (86%) chose to participate.<br />

To provide network access, over 10,000 access points are being installed across campus, off-campus dial-in<br />

access is being significantly upgraded, and <strong>the</strong> University is experimenting with wireless networking<br />

technologies. By <strong>the</strong> year 2001, in is envisaged that a technology-rich teaching and learning environment<br />

will have been created at HKU. By that time, all HKU students may own a notebook computer with which<br />

<strong>the</strong>y will be able to access networked tools and resources from anywhere at anytime, both on and off<br />

campus.<br />

To achieve <strong>the</strong>se goals, HKU invited creative partnership proposals from corporations interested in<br />

working towards a common vision of using in<strong>for</strong>mation technologies to improve educational opportunities<br />

<strong>for</strong> students. We sought an innovation, visionary corporate partner who would not only offer us deeply<br />

discounted hardware <strong>for</strong> students and staff, but also invest in collaborative research and development<br />

ef<strong>for</strong>ts. After an exhausting process, <strong>the</strong> IBM Corporation was selected.<br />

While creating a "mobile computing environment" at <strong>the</strong> University, we are also engaging in re<strong>for</strong>m ef<strong>for</strong>ts<br />

to make better use of IT in:<br />

* Curriculum,<br />

* Teaching & Learning Methodologies,<br />

* Educational Resource Development & Access, Academic Staff Development,<br />

* Infrastructure,<br />

* Technical support,<br />

* In<strong>for</strong>mation Services,<br />

* Financial Planning, and<br />

* Administrative Processes.<br />

These re<strong>for</strong>ms will enable all students and staff at <strong>the</strong> University to take full advantage of access to<br />

notebook computers, networks, and networked in<strong>for</strong>mation.<br />

The Global Campus Project at <strong>the</strong> National University of Singapore<br />

Yam San Chee, National University of Singapore<br />

Several years ago, <strong>the</strong> National University of Singapore framed an IT Strategic Plan to lay <strong>the</strong> foundation<br />

<strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> pervasive use of IT on campus: in teaching, learning, research, and adminstration. In<br />

operationalizing this plan, an extensive IT infrastructure has been set up, embracing <strong>the</strong> following<br />

elements: campus-wide networking, global networking, client-server based integrated in<strong>for</strong>mation systems,<br />

smart card based insfrastructure, remote lecturing and computing, high per<strong>for</strong>mance computing, online<br />

transactions, library based in<strong>for</strong>mation systems, and video-based services. These developments have taken<br />

place against <strong>the</strong> backdrop of Singapore ONE, <strong>the</strong> nation's high-speed, ATM-based broadband network,<br />

and collectively constitute <strong>the</strong> Global Campus Project.


The University has set up a secure plug and play network system with some 10,000 connection points<br />

installed across <strong>the</strong> campus. In <strong>the</strong> academic year commencing July 1998, freshmen in selected faculties<br />

were strongly encouraged to make use of notebook computers <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong>ir studies, <strong>for</strong> communicating with<br />

faculty, as well as <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> conduct of administrative tasks (eg. course registration). In addition, a campuswide<br />

Integrated Virtual Learning Environment (IVLE) has been set up. It provides a one-stop interface <strong>for</strong><br />

faculty and students from which to access relevant resources and per<strong>for</strong>m tasks. For example, faculty are<br />

able to make use of an electronic <strong>for</strong>m to set up <strong>the</strong>ir course web pages while students can participate in<br />

both asynchronous course discussion as well as real-time, Web-based chat.<br />

In early <strong>1999</strong>, <strong>the</strong> University established <strong>the</strong> Centre <strong>for</strong> Instructional Technology. The Centre has <strong>the</strong><br />

mission of intensifying <strong>the</strong> use of IT in both teaching and learning on campus. In addition to <strong>the</strong> IVLE<br />

service mentioned previously, <strong>the</strong> new Centre now also supports courseware development, multimedia<br />

conferencing, multimedia production, Webcast of lectures, and provides a student assistant plan to assist<br />

faculty in <strong>the</strong> production of courseware. The establishemnt of <strong>the</strong> Centre reflects <strong>the</strong> University's strong<br />

commitment to <strong>the</strong> creation of an IT-pervasive global learning environment on campus.<br />

Implementing and Assessing Mobile Computing at Seton Hall University<br />

A Revolution Going On:<br />

Phillip D. Long, Seton Hall University<br />

"There is a revolution going on at Seton Hall University because <strong>the</strong>re is a revolution going on in society.<br />

In<strong>for</strong>mation technology is a means <strong>for</strong> us to achieve our mission to prepare future leaders in a global<br />

society. Seton Hall University's In<strong>for</strong>mation Technology Long Range Plan represents our commitment to<br />

<strong>the</strong> use of in<strong>for</strong>mation technology to achieve our mission and goals." Msgr. Robert T. Sheeran, President,<br />

Seton Hall University<br />

Equity and Access:<br />

To take advantage of this trans<strong>for</strong>mation to an in<strong>for</strong>mation culture people must be in<strong>for</strong>mation literate: that<br />

is, <strong>the</strong>y must be able to locate, assess, analyze, and effectively communicate in<strong>for</strong>mation. As a nation, we<br />

cannot af<strong>for</strong>d to have a portion of our citizenry that is left behind in this transition. As a Catholic<br />

institution of higher education, Seton Hall believes that learning is both a private good and a public<br />

responsibility. The University must <strong>the</strong>re<strong>for</strong>e equip all its students to take full advantage of <strong>the</strong><br />

opportunities af<strong>for</strong>ded by an in<strong>for</strong>mation society.<br />

Implementing this a program to create an in<strong>for</strong>mation culture within <strong>the</strong> University provides guarantees.<br />

Faculty can reasonably expect that students assigned work that requires technology will have access to it,<br />

and be equipped to per<strong>for</strong>m <strong>the</strong> work required. We are less concerned with distance learning, and more<br />

concerned with 'connected learning.' That is, while recognizing <strong>the</strong> convenience that is af<strong>for</strong>ded by online<br />

access to instructional material, Seton Hall has concentrated on what elements of technology enhanced<br />

instruction best integrate with traditional liberal arts education that emphasizes small classes and interpersonal<br />

communication.<br />

Piloting <strong>the</strong> Process:<br />

Seton Hall piloted <strong>the</strong> laptop distribution program <strong>for</strong> three years, starting with 27 students in an initial<br />

mobile computing cohort. This year 1366 laptops were distributed in two days to our first fully enabled<br />

freshman class. Piloting <strong>the</strong> process enabled us to examine:<br />

* Faculty support and training<br />

* Curriculum revision strategies<br />

* Asset management and distribution<br />

* Software distribution


* Technical support<br />

* Assessment practices and strategies<br />

The Support Service Crisis and a Response:<br />

Support <strong>for</strong> a large-scale technology deployment takes what already is a support service crisis and raises<br />

<strong>the</strong> specter of creating a support service catastrophe. While increasing IT staff is an unavoidable<br />

component, no higher education institution can hope to nei<strong>the</strong>r hire enough nor pay enough to keep<br />

sufficient numbers of IT professional staff. Ra<strong>the</strong>r, Seton Hall has pursued an approach, which brings <strong>the</strong><br />

students <strong>for</strong>ward as partners in <strong>the</strong> in<strong>for</strong>mation technology support solution. The Student Technology<br />

Assistant Program teaches students to participate with technologists and faculty in supporting <strong>the</strong><br />

community technology needs. In addition to <strong>the</strong> more traditional peer support, training and technical<br />

repair responsibilities, students directly with faculty in curriculum revision teams. Their role is mediated<br />

through a contract with <strong>the</strong> faculty establishing an intellectual barter - technical expertise of <strong>the</strong> student in<br />

exchange <strong>for</strong> mentorship and faculty disciplinary guidance. The overall enterprise is designed to be student<br />

run and student led. It addresses one of <strong>the</strong> most common oversights in student technology support<br />

programs by building in leadership and supervision redundantly across <strong>the</strong> program, at all levels. This<br />

project has become a national initiative of <strong>the</strong> AAHE/TLT Group and led to <strong>the</strong> designation of Seton Hall<br />

University as a TLT Group Leadership Center. Currently seventeen campuses in three countries are<br />

actively developing Student Technology Assistant Programs to address <strong>the</strong>ir local support service crises.<br />

Knowing Where You've Been, Influencing Where You're Going:<br />

Since <strong>the</strong> first laptops were distributed to students and faculty getting a handle on <strong>the</strong> student learning<br />

experience and <strong>the</strong> faculty teaching experience has been an on-going initiative. Through collaboration with<br />

<strong>the</strong> Flashlight Project (AAHE/TLT Group) and local development, an assessment process focusing on <strong>the</strong><br />

institutional level has resulted in a set of survey instruments, focus group protocols and journaling<br />

guidelines that provide a consistent 'wide and shallow' indication of <strong>the</strong> impact of Mobile Computing on<br />

teaching and learning at Seton Hall. The value of this approach has led to <strong>the</strong> creation of <strong>the</strong> Institute <strong>for</strong><br />

Technology Assessment to make <strong>the</strong>se tools more widely available to interested institutions of higher<br />

education. In return, <strong>the</strong> Institute seeks to collaborate with participating institutions to incorporate <strong>the</strong>ir data<br />

into a longitudinal data repository to build an increasingly valuable community resource assessing <strong>the</strong><br />

impact technology intensive deployments have on teaching and learning.<br />

Seton Hall is committed to higher education instilling in our graduates an ethic <strong>for</strong> community service and<br />

leadership in <strong>the</strong> global affairs. Technology plays a central role in <strong>the</strong> liberal arts, in our community of<br />

scholarship, and in seeking <strong>the</strong> to rein<strong>for</strong>ce <strong>the</strong> connectedness that o<strong>the</strong>rwise tends to dissipate in<br />

in<strong>for</strong>mation rich, values poor environments.<br />

Implementing Assured Access/Mobile Computing at Sonoma State University<br />

Mark Resmer, Sonoma State University<br />

Recognizing that without a universal access policy, we risked creating a society of in<strong>for</strong>mation haves and<br />

have-nots among our students. In Fall 1995, Sonoma State University became one of <strong>the</strong> first two public<br />

universities in <strong>the</strong> country to require that all incoming freshmen should have access to a networked<br />

personal computer. This year, <strong>the</strong> requirement was extended to include incoming Junior transfer students.<br />

By Fall 1998, all undergraduate students will be subject to <strong>the</strong> requirement.<br />

Why do we need assured access to computers<br />

The driving <strong>for</strong>ce behind our Assured Access strategy is to make it possible <strong>for</strong> anyone to learn, any time,<br />

any place. In doing so, we are reflecting <strong>the</strong> following factors:<br />

* The growing amount and changing nature of knowledge


* Changes in educational paradigms<br />

* The need <strong>for</strong> improved communications<br />

* Workplace demands<br />

* Legislative requirements<br />

* A need <strong>for</strong> equity<br />

* Technological change and obsolescence<br />

Implementing <strong>the</strong> requirement did not relieve <strong>the</strong> university of all responsibility <strong>for</strong> in<strong>for</strong>mation technology<br />

access. To <strong>the</strong> contrary, assured access is a partnership, wherein <strong>the</strong> student provides basic access, while<br />

<strong>the</strong> campus provides not only infrastructure support, but also specialized labs with high-end machines <strong>for</strong><br />

applications beyond <strong>the</strong> capacity of student owned machines.<br />

From a business perspective, we treat student computers just like textbooks. Unlike o<strong>the</strong>r universities, we<br />

do not require students to purchase a notebook computer from a specific vendor. The institution makes a<br />

recommendation, but it is up to <strong>the</strong> student to make <strong>the</strong> business decisions associated with <strong>the</strong> purchase, i.e.<br />

exactly what to obtain, where to buy it, and indeed whe<strong>the</strong>r to buy it. Just as with textbooks, we recognize<br />

that while instructors can expect that students will have access to <strong>the</strong> required computer, <strong>the</strong>re is no<br />

en<strong>for</strong>cement associated with <strong>the</strong> recommendation. Sonoma has no "computer police"!<br />

Our students can:<br />

• Purchase <strong>the</strong> computer outright: Vendors have offered computers at specially discounted prices, and<br />

<strong>the</strong> campus bookstore has limited its profit margins on computer sales.<br />

• Obtain a loan, and use it to purchase a computer: A local credit union offers loan programs that are<br />

tailored to student needs.<br />

• Use financial aid: Financial aid facilitates <strong>the</strong> purchase of computers by a significant number of<br />

students.<br />

• Borrow a computer from a loan pool: Students who cannot af<strong>for</strong>d any of <strong>the</strong> options above are offered<br />

a yearlong loan of a computer from a pool of machines maintained <strong>for</strong> this purpose. To date, 180<br />

computers have been loaned to <strong>the</strong> most needy students.<br />

Our universal access program has elicited an extraordinary degree of enthusiasm and support from both<br />

employers and <strong>the</strong> media, based on <strong>the</strong> perception that it is highly relevant to <strong>the</strong> needs of our "customers" -<br />

both <strong>the</strong> students, and society at large. Indeed, in <strong>the</strong> business community, <strong>the</strong> program is seen as a move<br />

by <strong>the</strong> university away from <strong>the</strong> isolationism of <strong>the</strong> "ivory tower" towards recognition of <strong>the</strong> real needs of<br />

<strong>the</strong> outside world.<br />

Motivating and Facilitating Learning with IT at Wake Forest University<br />

Craig Runde, Wake Forest University<br />

The special challenge <strong>for</strong> a college or a university is to create an environment with <strong>the</strong> people, policies, and<br />

traditions that motivate and facilitate learning. In 1993, faculty, students and administrators of Wake Forest<br />

University began work on a blueprint to enrich <strong>the</strong> quality of undergraduate education at <strong>the</strong> institution,<br />

already nationally recognized as one of <strong>the</strong> finest private liberal arts universities in <strong>the</strong> country.<br />

Wake Forest University decided to create a ubiquitous computing environment where students, faculty, and<br />

staff members all had laptop computers and network access from on campus and remote access to <strong>the</strong><br />

campus network available via <strong>the</strong> IBM Global Network.<br />

The University sought to use technology to provide a more customized learning experience <strong>for</strong> students.<br />

This approach built on strength of providing an education that is both personal and individual. Be<strong>for</strong>e <strong>the</strong><br />

computer revolution, <strong>the</strong> way to personalize and customize education was to focus vast quantities of faculty<br />

time upon teaching and students. Although faculty time and attention is still <strong>the</strong> key to personalization, a<br />

student's education can now be customized through computer access.


If Wake Forest is to maintain its comparative advantage in both personal and individual education, it must<br />

streng<strong>the</strong>n its means to personalize (which means more faculty) and streng<strong>the</strong>n its capacity to customize<br />

(which means more computers). The Plan <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> Class of 2000 incorporates both elements.<br />

Professors, staff and students starting with <strong>the</strong> class of 2000 receive IBM ThinkPad computers which are<br />

refreshed every two years. Software includes <strong>the</strong> Windows 95 operating system, <strong>the</strong> Netscape Navigator<br />

Internet browser, Microsoft Office (Word, Excel, and PowerPoint) <strong>for</strong> word processing, financial analysis,<br />

and presentations.<br />

Virtually all Wake Forest offices, residence hall rooms, and classroom seats are directly linked to <strong>the</strong><br />

campus E<strong>the</strong>rnet network, which is based on IBM RS/6000 SP* servers and ATM switches. Special<br />

laboratories have been equipped <strong>for</strong> Music, Writing, Business, Physics, Chemistry, <strong>the</strong> Languages, and<br />

elsewhere.<br />

A number of programs have been added to help both faculty and students effectively use <strong>the</strong> new<br />

technology. These have included a Computer Enhanced Learning Initiative <strong>for</strong> faculty that provides<br />

speakers, release time and training on how to incorporate technology in teaching and learning. It also<br />

includes <strong>the</strong> Student Technology Advisors programs where faculty and students are paired on course<br />

related technology projects.


Using Computer Imagery and Visualisation in Teaching, Learning and<br />

Assessment<br />

Dr N. Bouchlaghem, Dr N Beacham and William Sher<br />

Department of Civil and Building Engineering<br />

Loughborough University<br />

Loughborough<br />

Leicestershire<br />

LE11 3TU<br />

UK<br />

Email: N.M.Bouchlaghem@lboro.ac.uk, N.Beacham@lboro.ac.uk and W.D.Sher@lboro.ac.uk<br />

Abstract<br />

Construction is an intrinsically visual discipline as many construction processes are underpinned by an<br />

understanding of how structures are constructed and how constituent components fit toge<strong>the</strong>r. This<br />

paper describes CAL-Visual - a project funded by <strong>the</strong> Teaching Learning and Technology<br />

Programme, Phase 3. It aims to implement <strong>the</strong> use of computer imagery to support teaching, learning<br />

and assessment in subject areas where <strong>the</strong> visualisation of objects and processes is an intrinsic part of<br />

<strong>the</strong> educational experience. Project partners include Loughborough University, De Mont<strong>for</strong>t<br />

University, University of Westminster, University of <strong>the</strong> West England and an industrial partner<br />

(Tarmac Professional Services). In addition The Chartered Institute of Building (CIOB) also actively<br />

supports <strong>the</strong> project.<br />

The main objectives of <strong>the</strong> project include:<br />

• making effective use of existing image archives as teaching, learning and assessment aids <strong>for</strong><br />

undergraduate and graduate use and CPD programmes.<br />

• promoting <strong>the</strong> wide use of <strong>the</strong>se archives in teaching building design and construction by<br />

embedding <strong>the</strong> project deliverables in “Construction” programmes.<br />

• promoting deep learning by using improved visualisation techniques.<br />

The deliverables and outcomes expected from <strong>the</strong> project are:<br />

• a report detailing methodologies <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> use of images in teaching and assessment applicable to<br />

<strong>the</strong> construction sector.<br />

• a set of CD-ROMs <strong>for</strong> undergraduate, graduate and CPD use in <strong>the</strong> field of building design and<br />

construction.<br />

• training packs <strong>for</strong> academic and CPD tutors.<br />

• transferable methodologies <strong>for</strong> using images in o<strong>the</strong>r disciplines.<br />

The deliverables and outcomes of <strong>the</strong> project have direct application in all Higher Education<br />

Institutions offering construction related courses (in <strong>the</strong> <strong>for</strong>m of CD-ROMs, and teaching and training<br />

packs). In addition we argue that <strong>the</strong>se are equally relevant to o<strong>the</strong>r disciplines which use images in<br />

teaching (such as Chemical Engineering, Mechanical Engineering, Pharmacology, Art and Design and<br />

so on).


This paper describes progress on <strong>the</strong> CAL-Visual project so far. The partners are currently<br />

providing <strong>the</strong> project with <strong>the</strong>ir existing archives of construction images. When <strong>the</strong>se have been<br />

classified and entered into CAL-Visual, <strong>the</strong>y will constitute a comprehensive databank. To date<br />

we have found that <strong>the</strong>se images are used in an uncoordinated manner. A significant task<br />

addressed by our project has thus been <strong>the</strong> development of a digital framework to support <strong>the</strong><br />

efficient use of existing and new imagery.<br />

The framework development has involved investigating a number of classifications systems <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong><br />

indexing of visual material and a review of hybrid systems <strong>for</strong> publishing visual material on <strong>the</strong><br />

Internet, intranet and CD-ROM.<br />

Finally, <strong>the</strong> project is investigating <strong>the</strong> use of virtual reality (VR) models as teaching aids in<br />

lectures and as exploratory tool <strong>for</strong> students to use in place of construction site visits. These VR<br />

models represent a type of building through which tutors and students can navigate and access <strong>the</strong><br />

in<strong>for</strong>mation in <strong>the</strong> databank.


Publishing an imej Journal <strong>for</strong> Computer-Enhanced Learning<br />

Jennifer Burg, Yue-Ling Wong, Dan Pfeifer, Anne Boyle, and Ching-Wan Yip<br />

Wake Forest University<br />

Winston-Salem, NC 27109<br />

imej@wfu.edu<br />

Abstract: Interactive multimedia electronic journals (imej journals) are a publication<br />

medium particularly suited <strong>for</strong> research in computer-enhanced learning. In this paper, we<br />

describe <strong>the</strong> challenges and potential rewards in publishing such a journal; present ideas <strong>for</strong><br />

design and layout; and discuss issues of collaboration, copyrighting, and archiving unique to<br />

imej publications.<br />

Introduction<br />

Electronic journals have proliferated in <strong>the</strong> past five years, popularized by <strong>the</strong>ir accessibility, searchability,<br />

timeliness, and dynamism. Many publishers, universities, professional associations, and grant-supported agencies now<br />

offer extensive electronic libraries. Notable among <strong>the</strong>se are Johns Hopkins' Project Muse, VPI's Scholarly<br />

Communications Project, Stan<strong>for</strong>d's Highwire Press, Springer's Link collection, ACM's Digital Library, and <strong>the</strong> Mellon<br />

Foundation's JSTOR (Schatz and Chen <strong>1999</strong>). (Also see (Treloar 1998) <strong>for</strong> a short summary of electronic scholarly<br />

publishing projects.) The majority of <strong>the</strong> online publications spawned in <strong>the</strong>se projects are direct translations of existing<br />

hard-cover journals to electronic <strong>for</strong>m. But along with <strong>the</strong>se, a large number of entirely new Web-only journals are<br />

appearing as well. A good sampling of online journals can be found at http://gort.ucsd.edu/newjour/, which lists<br />

thousands.<br />

Web publishers all over <strong>the</strong> world are attracted to <strong>the</strong> electronic medium by low start-up costs and <strong>the</strong> potential<br />

<strong>for</strong> wide and varied kinds of communication. Pictures, scrolling messages, online interviews, and music have become<br />

common on popular and commercial Web sites, and scholarly electronic journals are beginning to explore <strong>the</strong><br />

possibilities of multimedia presentation as well. Art, music, and science journals have been among <strong>the</strong> first to use<br />

multimedia effectively, drawing obvious benefit from <strong>the</strong> ability to display pictures, play music, or allow readers to<br />

visualize <strong>the</strong> o<strong>the</strong>rwise unseeable.<br />

The o<strong>the</strong>r special facility of online communication -- interactivity -- remains relatively unexplored in scholarly<br />

communication. Few of <strong>the</strong> new journals allow readers to interact with what <strong>the</strong>y are reading in ways that go beyond<br />

clicking on a play button, following a link, or joining a discussion <strong>for</strong>um. Interactivity is one of <strong>the</strong> most engaging<br />

features of <strong>the</strong> Web, and <strong>the</strong> one which promises to evolve most strikingly as Web technology is developed. Web users<br />

are intrigued by <strong>the</strong>ir window to <strong>the</strong> world, through which <strong>the</strong>y can reach in, grab in<strong>for</strong>mation, find out how things work,<br />

and communicate with o<strong>the</strong>rs far away with an immediacy that never ceases to amaze. In <strong>the</strong> scholarly world,<br />

interactivity has great potential, since it might allow a reader to see, handle, replicate, verify, and truly understand <strong>the</strong><br />

work of a colleague. Data can be manipulated, graphs redisplayed, programs run, 3-D images rotated, and experiments<br />

per<strong>for</strong>med. Such uses of multimedia interactivity would distinguish Web journals as unique and valuable <strong>for</strong>ums <strong>for</strong><br />

scholarly communication.<br />

Multimedia interactivity of this type is more useful in some academic areas than in o<strong>the</strong>rs, and computerenhanced<br />

learning is clearly one area where an interactive multimedia presentation would be most to <strong>the</strong> point. What<br />

better way to explain effective uses of <strong>the</strong> computer in teaching than to show <strong>the</strong> readers what can be done, allowing<br />

<strong>the</strong>m to try things out <strong>the</strong>mselves in a dynamic and interactive way These thoughts were our motivation <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong><br />

founding of a new interactive multimedia electronic journal at Wake Forest University -- The IMEJ of Computer-<br />

Enhanced Learning (imej.wfu.edu). In this paper, we tell how we have dealt with <strong>the</strong> unique problems that arise in <strong>the</strong><br />

creation of an imej journal, and offer our ideas on design and editorial policy. Our comments are directed to those<br />

interested in developing <strong>the</strong>ir own imej journal, publishing <strong>the</strong>ir research in such a journal, or considering <strong>the</strong> evolution<br />

of scholarly publication in <strong>the</strong> light of new technology.


Content<br />

Computer-Enhanced Learning<br />

Our development of The IMEJ of Computer-Enhanced Learning is motivated from three directions. First, we<br />

are intrigued by <strong>the</strong> under-utilized potential of electronic publication. Second, we can see that educators have urgent<br />

questions about <strong>the</strong> value of learning technology, and <strong>the</strong>re are very few places where <strong>the</strong>y can find practicable answers.<br />

Many universities -- including Wake Forest -- have adopted new policies <strong>for</strong> student computer ownership, in some cases<br />

providing a laptop <strong>for</strong> all students, in o<strong>the</strong>rs requiring that all students buy computers with certain minimum<br />

specifications (Brown, Burg, and Dominick 1998). Faculty feel pressed to find good uses <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> computers, and <strong>the</strong>ir<br />

questions are of quite a practical nature: What can I do and how can I do it Will my students learn more or differently<br />

Our third motivation is to provide a <strong>for</strong>um where faculty can share <strong>the</strong>ir work in computer-enhanced learning most<br />

effectively so that <strong>the</strong>y can get feedback and be recognized <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong>ir innovations. An imej journal is an ideal medium <strong>for</strong><br />

<strong>the</strong>ir publications.<br />

A great deal has been written in <strong>the</strong> abstract about computer-enhanced learning. There has been <strong>the</strong> usual hype<br />

and over-raising of expectations, followed by <strong>the</strong> usual disappointment or skepticism. Many of <strong>the</strong> articles are thoughtprovoking,<br />

but more often than not <strong>the</strong>y lack particulars. The purpose of IMEJ is to respond to <strong>the</strong> public's interest in a<br />

useful and concrete way. We would like to allow educators to tell how <strong>the</strong>y have used learning technology, to describe<br />

what has worked and what has failed. Our intent is that readers can take away an idea applicable to <strong>the</strong>ir own teaching.<br />

Assessment<br />

The element most lacking in research about computer-enhanced learning is objective assessment of <strong>the</strong><br />

effectiveness of particular applications. In many cases, educators have only begun experimenting with <strong>the</strong>ir ideas. The<br />

arguments <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> success of <strong>the</strong>ir projects are often intuitive and anecdotal -- because assessing how much students learn<br />

is, after all, very difficult. In <strong>the</strong> main, <strong>the</strong> validity of anecdotal results is apparent. At <strong>the</strong> same time, we also desire to<br />

promote fur<strong>the</strong>r research based on objective, statistical analysis.<br />

We encourage IMEJ authors to include evaluation as an integral part of <strong>the</strong>ir ideas and projects. IMEJ seeks<br />

articles that describe -- in real terms and with testable interactive examples -- how computers have been used in<br />

learning, including a description of <strong>the</strong> pedagogical results of <strong>the</strong>ir ef<strong>for</strong>ts. We anticipate that a more rigorous<br />

assessment of learning technology will emerge as we build on our collective experiences, especially with <strong>the</strong> urging of<br />

scholarly publications.<br />

Form<br />

Multimedia Interactivity<br />

Having acknowledged <strong>the</strong> great potential of multimedia interactivity, we'd now like to retrench a bit, <strong>for</strong> our<br />

first admonition to ourselves in <strong>the</strong> creation of IMEJ has been a reminder to use multimedia interactivity purposefully. It<br />

is tempting at times to do things simply because you can do <strong>the</strong>m -- add a scrolling L<strong>ED</strong> sign, make an image move,<br />

insert ano<strong>the</strong>r picture, or plug in ano<strong>the</strong>r audio file. But <strong>the</strong>re are two very good reasons <strong>for</strong> restraint. The first is that if<br />

an academic journal hopes to be taken seriously, cultivating a glitzy image is certainly not <strong>the</strong> way to do it. Even more<br />

important is to keep in mind what a journal is all about. If <strong>the</strong> purpose of a journal is to in<strong>for</strong>m or present new ideas, <strong>the</strong>n<br />

its multimedia elements should be directed to that end. This isn't as boring as it sounds, as if we no longer value<br />

engaging our readers by first capturing <strong>the</strong>ir attention. Yes, we want a journal to be engaging, but we want, after all, to<br />

engage <strong>the</strong> readers in ideas and substance, and this can be done most effectively by focusing <strong>the</strong>ir attention and not<br />

annoying <strong>the</strong>m with distractions.<br />

It's just as easy to get carried away with hyperlinks. Hyperlinks have been a source of great enthusiasm among<br />

technology-minded writers. In <strong>the</strong> imaginative vein, <strong>the</strong>y offer a non-linearity of text that opens new avenues <strong>for</strong><br />

creative expression. In expository writing, hyperlinks proliferate <strong>for</strong> a different reason. Writers often see <strong>the</strong>m as a<br />

service to <strong>the</strong> readers, pointing <strong>the</strong>m to relevant in<strong>for</strong>mation. Yet ra<strong>the</strong>r than offering an abundance of helpful<br />

in<strong>for</strong>mation and related thoughts, as <strong>the</strong> writer may intend, <strong>the</strong>se links can overwhelm <strong>the</strong> reader with a labyrinth of<br />

sidetracks, detours, and dead ends.


In summary, we offer <strong>the</strong> following guidelines <strong>for</strong> multimedia development, and recommend analogous ones to<br />

developers of imej journals in o<strong>the</strong>r subject areas.<br />

• Use multimedia elements <strong>for</strong> clarification, explanation, and illustration. Allow <strong>the</strong> user to experiment and try things<br />

out, in an environment where it is clear what to do (Figure 1).<br />

• For demonstrations of applications or programs implemented by <strong>the</strong> author, consider using scaled-down simulations<br />

ra<strong>the</strong>r than providing external links to <strong>the</strong> full application. (See http://imej.wfu.edu/articles/WFUAcadia/index.asp,<br />

which simulates exploring a Lotus Notes/Wake Forest Template database.) This has a number of advantages: The<br />

readers' attention can be directed to <strong>the</strong> features under discussion; <strong>the</strong> readers can be instructed more clearly in how<br />

to run <strong>the</strong> example; and <strong>the</strong> simulation can be maintained at <strong>the</strong> journal's own Web site, avoiding <strong>the</strong> danger of a<br />

dead link 1 in <strong>the</strong> paper if <strong>the</strong> author's application is later moved.<br />

Figure 1: Instructions <strong>for</strong> interactive multimedia are clearly labeled and marked with arrows.<br />

Figure 2: Reader has a choice between a self-propelled demo and an interactive one.<br />

Links to full applications at external Web sites are marked as such.<br />

1 Dead links are links that lead to Web pages that no longer exist or are o<strong>the</strong>rwise inaccessible.


• Consider offering self-propelled demos (in <strong>the</strong> <strong>for</strong>m of screencams, Java applets, etc.) alongside interactive ones so<br />

that readers can see how things are supposed to work be<strong>for</strong>e <strong>the</strong>y try <strong>the</strong>m out <strong>the</strong>mselves (Figure 2).<br />

• As much as possible, limit external links 2 in <strong>the</strong> text of an article. This helps <strong>the</strong> readers stay focused, since external<br />

links can lead to large Web sites that can be confusing or distracting. It also limits <strong>the</strong> number of hyperlinks that can<br />

later become dead links, which are a real annoyance to readers. Links to an author's fully-implemented application<br />

or to o<strong>the</strong>r external Web sites should be set aside from <strong>the</strong> text and marked as external (Figure 2). This points <strong>the</strong><br />

readers to fur<strong>the</strong>r in<strong>for</strong>mation without sidetracking <strong>the</strong>m as <strong>the</strong>y are trying to understand particular points.<br />

Design and Layout<br />

In <strong>the</strong> design of IMEJ, we have sought a clean, uncluttered look and interactive elements that are easy to use<br />

and adaptable to different user environments. Again, <strong>the</strong> versatility of Web publication can be a trap, leading to screens<br />

crowded with frames, toolbars, and buttons, and requiring too many steps from one page to <strong>the</strong> next. Simplicity, clarity,<br />

and usability should remain <strong>for</strong>emost design principles, as outlined in <strong>the</strong> following suggestions:<br />

• Make windows as uncluttered as possible. Too many <strong>for</strong>mat selections, frames, and toolbars take up too much space<br />

and detract from user-friendliness.<br />

• In navigation, make it easy <strong>for</strong> readers to return to previous pages. Have accessible arrows that lead back to <strong>the</strong> top.<br />

Don't spawn a new window unnecessarily.<br />

• For portability, use <strong>the</strong> most general file <strong>for</strong>mats in multimedia development, in <strong>the</strong> sense that <strong>the</strong>y run on <strong>the</strong> widest<br />

variety of plat<strong>for</strong>ms. When more than one <strong>for</strong>mat is being offered, present concise and clearly labeled choices<br />

(Figure 2). If possible, dynamically detect <strong>the</strong> reader's environment so that multimedia elements can be presented in<br />

<strong>the</strong> appropriate <strong>for</strong>mat in a manner that is transparent to <strong>the</strong> user.<br />

• Make articles easily printable and scrollable. We prefer allowing <strong>the</strong> reader to scroll continuously through an article<br />

ra<strong>the</strong>r than click through pages with a link. In this way, <strong>the</strong> full article can be easily printed directly from <strong>the</strong> Web<br />

page.<br />

• Maximize in<strong>for</strong>mation accessibility. Allow searches from multiple points of entry. In addition to global keyword<br />

searching, we also offer more precise queries on date of publication, author's name, and pedagogical approach. In<br />

addition, <strong>the</strong> reader can browse <strong>the</strong> search engine's list of pedagogical approaches<br />

• Use a consistent <strong>for</strong>mat <strong>for</strong> articles. An article template can ultimately save time <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> Web developers and ensure<br />

consistency of <strong>for</strong>mat, especially when new Web developers are brought onto <strong>the</strong> journal staff.<br />

Unique Challenges and Issues <strong>for</strong> imej Journals<br />

Collaboration<br />

One of <strong>the</strong> unique characteristics of online publication is its collaborative nature. On <strong>the</strong> one hand, an imej<br />

journal should have its own multimedia development team who have developed standards <strong>for</strong> multimedia design and<br />

layout. On <strong>the</strong> o<strong>the</strong>r hand, authors contributing articles to imej journals -- especially on <strong>the</strong> subject of computerenhanced<br />

learning -- are likely to be adept computer-users <strong>the</strong>mselves. Some may have created <strong>the</strong>ir own applications in<br />

learning technology, <strong>the</strong>y generally have <strong>the</strong>ir own ideas about how <strong>the</strong>ir material should be presented, and in many<br />

cases <strong>the</strong>y have already put it online. Creating <strong>the</strong> appropriate multimedia elements <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong>ir articles, however, does not<br />

involve merely inserting a link to <strong>the</strong>ir already-existing Web site. We envision a journal that is coherent in design and<br />

layout and articles that are focused and self-contained, with restraints on <strong>the</strong> number of links leading to Web sites that we<br />

cannot maintain ourselves. Consequently, development of an imej article necessitates a kind of collaboration between<br />

author, editors, and multimedia developers not required in o<strong>the</strong>r kinds of journals.<br />

Thus far, <strong>the</strong> collaboration has gone more easily than one might expect. We've had to give up publication of<br />

only one article so far, by mutual consent with <strong>the</strong> authors, who preferred a multimedia layout inconsistent with our<br />

design. All o<strong>the</strong>r articles have been developed fairly smoothly through an exchange of ideas, suggestions, and files in<br />

<strong>the</strong> needed <strong>for</strong>mat.<br />

2 We define an external link as a link to a Web page not maintained on our own server.


Discussion Forums and Peer Review<br />

Feedback from readers of imej journals can come from two sources: <strong>the</strong> initial peer review of articles, and<br />

subsequent comments from readers through online discussion <strong>for</strong>ums. Some electronic journals are combining <strong>the</strong>se two<br />

steps in <strong>the</strong>ir overall procedure <strong>for</strong> editorial review of submitted articles (Shum and Sumner 1998).<br />

All articles in The IMEJ of Computer-Enhanced Learning are carefully peer reviewed. Publishing articles from<br />

all disciplines of higher education (and a few from K-12), IMEJ has Editorial Board members from a wide variety of<br />

fields. Our editorial procedure is to assign <strong>the</strong> coordination of review of an article to an Editorial Board member in a<br />

discipline close to that of <strong>the</strong> article's content. That Board member finds three readers and handles <strong>the</strong> review process.<br />

Details are at http://imej.wfu.edu/info<strong>for</strong>author.asp.<br />

IMEJ offers a discussion <strong>for</strong>um <strong>for</strong> an article at <strong>the</strong> request of its authors. The <strong>for</strong>um is a service both to <strong>the</strong><br />

authors, who often would like feedback on what <strong>the</strong>y're doing, and <strong>the</strong> readers, who may seek more in<strong>for</strong>mation or<br />

exchange of ideas. The discussion <strong>for</strong>ums are generally unmoderated. However, we urge <strong>the</strong> authors to read <strong>the</strong>ir<br />

discussion <strong>for</strong>um and respond to comments. We also will delete any harassing comments from <strong>the</strong> <strong>for</strong>um at <strong>the</strong> authors'<br />

request.<br />

Copyright and Archiving<br />

Ano<strong>the</strong>r unique feature of online publication is its dynamic nature. As opposed to hard-copy publications,<br />

online articles are easily edited and changed. However, <strong>for</strong> practical reasons -- so that <strong>the</strong>y can be copyrighted, properly<br />

cited, and archived, <strong>for</strong> example -- it is necessary to arrive at a final version of articles.<br />

IMEJ's policy is to post preprints of articles about a month be<strong>for</strong>e final publication of an issue, giving authors a<br />

last chance to make changes. At <strong>the</strong> release of an issue, <strong>the</strong> article is fixed in <strong>for</strong>m. After that time, <strong>the</strong> only changes we<br />

<strong>for</strong>esee are <strong>the</strong> possible labeling of dead links or <strong>the</strong> addition of dated addenda or errata pages by <strong>the</strong> author.<br />

IMEJ requires copyright <strong>for</strong> all articles. The copyright agreement states that <strong>the</strong> article has not been and will<br />

not be republished elsewhere, it will not be reproduced without permission of IMEJ, and it will not be made available<br />

online at any Web site o<strong>the</strong>r than IMEJ's. Links to <strong>the</strong> article can be made from any o<strong>the</strong>r Web site, however. The<br />

copyright agreement also allows us to make copies of any issue <strong>for</strong> transport or archiving on portable secondary storage<br />

such as CD's or DVD's. Our copyright in<strong>for</strong>mation is available at http://imej.wfu.edu/info<strong>for</strong>author.asp#copyright.<br />

Archiving raises new problems in electronic journals. If an article is to be considered a reference of some<br />

lasting value, it must be accessible over time. A number of questions arise. How long should issues remain online In<br />

what <strong>for</strong>mat should <strong>the</strong>y be archived after this time If <strong>the</strong>y are kept on disk, how much disk space will be required If<br />

<strong>the</strong>y are kept in some o<strong>the</strong>r <strong>for</strong>mat, how long will that <strong>for</strong>mat last physically (e.g., what is <strong>the</strong> shelf-life of a CD) How<br />

long will that <strong>for</strong>mat be viable technologically (e.g., will <strong>the</strong>re be CD players around 20 years from now) How will<br />

<strong>the</strong> journal handle requests <strong>for</strong> copies of articles that are archived What happens if a journal folds Who will handle<br />

requests <strong>for</strong> archived articles if <strong>the</strong>re is no longer anyone on <strong>the</strong> journal staff<br />

Our policy decision at present is to keep issues online <strong>for</strong> at least two years. After that, <strong>the</strong>y will remain on<br />

secondary storage, but active links to back issues may no longer be available at <strong>the</strong> journal's Web site. Archives will be<br />

protected by a standard backup policy. We are considering making archive copies in o<strong>the</strong>r <strong>for</strong>mats as well, such as CD's,<br />

DVD's, and/or traditional printed <strong>for</strong>m. The journal staff will handle requests <strong>for</strong> archived articles by sending electronic<br />

copies or printed versions. Back issues will be stored in <strong>the</strong> Wake Forest University Archives.<br />

Conclusion<br />

We have offered <strong>the</strong> conclusions drawn from our experience in developing an imej journal in <strong>the</strong> hope that <strong>the</strong>y<br />

may be of use to o<strong>the</strong>rs with similar interests. This is where we are in our thinking in April of <strong>1999</strong>, with IMEJ's<br />

inaugural issue to appear at <strong>the</strong> end of <strong>the</strong> month. The potential value of interactive multimedia scholarly publication is<br />

certainly worth exploring, and our initial <strong>for</strong>ay into <strong>the</strong> area indicates that <strong>the</strong> special editorial and production challenges<br />

are not a bar to its development.


References<br />

Brown, D. G., Burg, J., and Dominick, J. L. (1998). A Strategic Plan <strong>for</strong> Ubiquitous Laptop Computing.<br />

Communications of <strong>the</strong> ACM, 41 (1), 26-35.<br />

Shum, S. B., and Sumner, T. (1998). New Scenarios in Scholarly Publishing and Debate. In The Knowledge Web:<br />

Learning and Collaborating on <strong>the</strong> Net. Marc Eisenstadt and Tom Vincent, eds. London: Kogan Page.<br />

Schatz, B. and Chen, H. (<strong>1999</strong>) Digital Libraries: Technological Advances and Social Impacts. Computer, Feb. <strong>1999</strong>,<br />

45-87.<br />

Treloar, A. E. Libraries' New Role in Electronic Scholarly Publishing. Communications of <strong>the</strong> ACM, 41 (4), 88-89.


Languages and Statistics: Solutions <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> support of online learning.<br />

Andrew Burrell<br />

Macquarie University<br />

The University Online Teaching Facility is used across all disciplines to support both on- and off-campus<br />

students. The facility incorporates both WebCT and locally written software including an online evaluation<br />

service. This poster/demonstration will outline how <strong>the</strong> University has used <strong>the</strong> facility to provide solutions <strong>for</strong><br />

three educational problems: <strong>the</strong> support of <strong>for</strong>eign language teaching in distance mode; using <strong>the</strong> quiz module to<br />

provide an accessible assessment facility <strong>for</strong> Introductory Statistics; and collecting and evaluating survey data.<br />

WebCT allows <strong>the</strong> <strong>for</strong>eign language instructor to use diacritic characters (French and German), 2-byte characters<br />

(Japanese) and audio in most tools using <strong>the</strong> target language. Problems with using Internet-based communication<br />

that does not preserve diacritics are overcome by using WebCT. Japanese 2-byte characters are handled by<br />

software that works in conjunction with WebCT and audio can be embedded in <strong>the</strong> quizzes to allow automatic<br />

correction of listening exercises.<br />

A network-based statistics quiz assessment package used weekly by some 2000 students could only be accessed<br />

in two laboratories. Access in both terms of location and time has been expanded by using WebCT. Solutions<br />

were also developed to cope with handling <strong>the</strong> large numbers of students in <strong>the</strong> WebCT student management<br />

database.<br />

Online evaluation tools are used to survey students as part of <strong>the</strong> <strong>for</strong>mative and summative evaluation process<br />

incorporated into many of <strong>the</strong> online courses. Unit convenors can select from banks of questions covering areas<br />

such as access, assessment and feedback, communication, flexibility, resources, learning and understanding,<br />

usability, guidance and training, and also add <strong>the</strong>ir own questions to <strong>the</strong> survey module. The results are<br />

presented in three different ways: by individual<br />

question, by respondent and by question type. A special feature is hyperlinking between <strong>the</strong> different <strong>for</strong>mats<br />

which allows <strong>for</strong> easy cross-matching of in<strong>for</strong>mation.<br />

Units in o<strong>the</strong>r disciplines and programs such as Geography, Creative Arts, and Early Childhood will also be<br />

available <strong>for</strong> demonstration.


Meaningfully Incorporating Technology into Graduate and Undergraduate Courses<br />

In A College of Education<br />

Ni Chang, Ed.D.<br />

University of Wisconsin<br />

800 W. Main St.<br />

Whitewater, WI 53190<br />

changn@uwwvax.uww.edu<br />

414-472-5798<br />

Introduction<br />

With <strong>the</strong> germination of incorporating technology into students’ learning at <strong>the</strong> college and university level, literature has<br />

shown that technology benefits students’ learning (Bazillion, & Braun, 1998; Berger, 1998; Grossman,<strong>1999</strong>; McCandless,<br />

1998; Raschke,1998). The merits attribute to different software and technology applied in <strong>the</strong> education of college students.<br />

However, it is an inappropriate practice to infuse technology into curriculum without a careful consideration of possible<br />

outcomes how <strong>the</strong> application of a type of technology can affect students’ understanding of concepts. The pedagogical goal<br />

aims at assisting students’ understanding of content of coursework with technology ra<strong>the</strong>r than about technology.<br />

Demographically, it is true that characteristics of students’ needs and demands to instruction and learning are matchless.<br />

Even teaching a same course in a same university over years, an instructor finds that he may encounter groups of students<br />

with different attributes and competence in learning. How to use technology effectively requires a careful examination and<br />

investigation from <strong>the</strong> instructor on <strong>the</strong> impact of uses of technology on students’ maximal development in learning.<br />

There exists ano<strong>the</strong>r reason associated with <strong>the</strong> inappropriateness in teaching students about technology. In <strong>the</strong><br />

contemporary technology world, many children are capable of handling a certain type of technology. Many more will soon<br />

join <strong>the</strong> club. Being pre-service teachers, students have to be aware of how to stimulate and promote children mastering<br />

concepts effectively with technology. In this sense, college instructors should first and <strong>for</strong>emost be trained properly. It is<br />

imperative <strong>for</strong> an instructor to pay attention to how learning process with technology is structured. What and how an<br />

instructor per<strong>for</strong>ms in class will surely affect how pre-service teachers will manage <strong>the</strong>ir classroom instruction with<br />

technology in <strong>the</strong> future. Meaningless integration of technology contributes little to an in-depth exploration of learning that<br />

plays an unimportant role in <strong>the</strong> enhancement of students’ comprehension of content work.<br />

Reflective Practices<br />

To bring about <strong>the</strong> effective learning results, it requires an instructor to motivate learners’ desire in lore. With respect to<br />

employing technology to teach, an instructor should possess rich ideas of how to integrate technology meaningfully into<br />

college curriculum, which should result from trials and errors. Much reflection and self- analysis should be part of this<br />

process. It is advocated that an instructor provides a wide array of opportunities to invite students’ voices regarding <strong>the</strong><br />

effect on <strong>the</strong> application of technology as tools in <strong>the</strong> assistance of learning as a means to ameliorate outcomes of teaching<br />

and learning.<br />

Respecting feedback and views from students is crucial in <strong>the</strong> situation where an instructor is concurrently responsible <strong>for</strong><br />

four courses in one semester. It is a usual case that a group of same students take two or three out of <strong>the</strong> four courses that<br />

this instructor is teaching during a semester. In this situation, an instructor is required to come up with diversified<br />

approaches in teaching and in assigning homework using technology. Employing an analogous method in this regard<br />

throughout one semester may decrease o<strong>the</strong>rwise <strong>the</strong> great desire that students hold <strong>for</strong> learning. By virtue of this analysis,<br />

technology should be incorporated appropriately into <strong>the</strong> curricular content ra<strong>the</strong>r than as a discrete task besides intellectual<br />

learning requirement. For example, searching resources from <strong>the</strong> Internet is an advisable approach <strong>for</strong> students to extend<br />

<strong>the</strong>ir knowledge base that may not be encompassed in a class lecture. Locating important and useful in<strong>for</strong>mation from <strong>the</strong><br />

Internet as an assignment or a part of a class makeup apparently increases <strong>the</strong> academic growth of students. However, if this<br />

mode of technology crops up in each of <strong>the</strong> four courses, <strong>for</strong> which this particular instructor is responsible, a minimum<br />

learning effect may take place. Students may grow a feeling of tiredness out of this repeated usage of technology and find<br />

learning monotonous and tedious. Exhaustion may distract <strong>the</strong>ir attention away from major learning tasks.


Kelly and Leckbee (1998) indicate, “Simply adding technology to existing instructional process and structure have, in many<br />

instances, proven to be ineffective . . . What is needed is a meaningful integration of technology into <strong>the</strong> instruction<br />

process” (p. 24). Based on Kelly and Leckbee and due to <strong>the</strong> reasons provided above, I have cautioned and been concerned<br />

about <strong>the</strong> productiveness of students’ learning. To take an appropriate action, I have experimented in different ways to<br />

incorporate technology into <strong>the</strong> content of learning, which affirms my pedagogical philosophy. My pedagogical philosophy<br />

is heavily rooted in <strong>the</strong> principle of constructivism. A constructivist classroom is built based on mutual respect between<br />

students and an instructor, constant improvement of instructional strategies and risk-taking. I firmly believe that in<br />

constructivist classroom, students’ learning is meaningful and purposeful with <strong>the</strong> incorporation of technology. Assigning<br />

students grades is not an instructor’s destination of teaching. Ra<strong>the</strong>r, exerting great ef<strong>for</strong>ts to help students construct an<br />

understanding with methods of technology is an end of learning and instruction.<br />

Infusion Technology into Instruction and Inquiry<br />

Listserv across <strong>the</strong> World: As such, I created different ways of infusing technology in courses that I hold full<br />

accountability. Previous teaching experience in<strong>for</strong>med me that <strong>the</strong> majority of students had few chances communicating<br />

with teachers out in <strong>the</strong> field when <strong>the</strong> students are studying in a college of education. To expand <strong>the</strong>ir knowledge spectrum<br />

and to grasp every opportunity to foster <strong>the</strong>ir growth, I guided one of classes to launch conversation electronically with <strong>the</strong><br />

teachers working with young children. This activity brought about more profits than problems and difficulties that my<br />

students and I experienced in this learning process. Some of <strong>the</strong> students even wanted to continue <strong>the</strong>ir communication with<br />

teachers across <strong>the</strong> world after graduating from my class.<br />

Listserv on Campus: In ano<strong>the</strong>r class, I hooked up with one ano<strong>the</strong>r by email created on <strong>the</strong> campus. I came up with this<br />

idea due to <strong>the</strong> fact that in <strong>the</strong> contemporary society, <strong>the</strong> majority of people have busy schedules. Personal communications,<br />

<strong>the</strong>re<strong>for</strong>e, become less possible. My students faced <strong>the</strong> same problem. This communicative means provides possibilities to<br />

extend in-class discussion and enrich <strong>the</strong> discussion content. The students in <strong>the</strong> meanwhile are able to learn from one<br />

ano<strong>the</strong>r via negotiation and teamwork.<br />

The Application of <strong>the</strong> Hypernews: The hypernews is well known as asynchronous plat<strong>for</strong>m, which I have been guiding my<br />

students to use it since <strong>the</strong> summer of 1997. And yet, I have gone beyond this focus to more meaningful and purposeful<br />

ends.<br />

For asynchronous discussion: While giving credit to <strong>the</strong> use of listserv created on campus <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> students to<br />

communicate with one ano<strong>the</strong>r outside <strong>the</strong> classroom, this type of learning tool still set limits to users (Graves, 1998). In<br />

contrast, <strong>the</strong> hypernews to serve this purpose is promising because it provides convenience to <strong>the</strong> users. Students, while<br />

conversing with one ano<strong>the</strong>r electronically and advancing <strong>the</strong>ir understandings of topics under discussion, attained<br />

technological skills, such as typing, deleting, sending, and retrieving messages in addition to unexpected problem-solving<br />

skills. The skills that students will use in <strong>the</strong>ir later courses or personal and professional growth (Graves, 1998).<br />

Publicizing learning products: In addition to communication via <strong>the</strong> HyperNews, I also used <strong>the</strong> tool of <strong>the</strong><br />

HyperNews to encourage students to learn from one ano<strong>the</strong>r by publishing papers, bookmarks, and writing comments after<br />

reading relevant papers, enriching <strong>the</strong> traditional classroom learning experiences (Graves, 1998).<br />

Distance learning: I organized my graduate students to have a synchronous discussion when every student had<br />

time but it was not in a originally scheduled time. Graduates from this university are mostly full-time teachers, who have to<br />

hold Teacher-Parent conferences once every semester. To ensure <strong>the</strong> quality of learning, I tried to use <strong>the</strong> hypernews <strong>for</strong><br />

make-up time purpose.<br />

Power Point: Power Point was used in instruction to inspire students to seek answers <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong>mselves when taking into<br />

account <strong>the</strong> issues like computers and young children. Power Point raised many questions to <strong>the</strong> students who were<br />

encouraged to ponder over “At what age do young children learn with computers” “How to evaluate software <strong>for</strong> young<br />

children appropriately” “How to teach young children learn with technology” “How to introduce technology<br />

appropriately to <strong>the</strong> learning of young children” “Should young children be left unnoticed at <strong>the</strong> computer” “Should<br />

computers be clustered in a computer lab or should computers be installed in individual classrooms” The presentation<br />

through this means activated <strong>the</strong> heated discussion among <strong>the</strong> students.<br />

Conclusion<br />

Generally, <strong>the</strong> multiple ways of infusing technology into curricular learning at a college of education in a meaningful and<br />

purposeful manner creates non-linear learning phenomenon. Technology has paved <strong>the</strong> way <strong>for</strong> many of us to ease and<br />

solve certain problems that we have encountered in our daily life. Let’s put technology to work (Grossman, <strong>1999</strong>). “The<br />

more involving <strong>the</strong> learning techniques are, <strong>the</strong> greater <strong>the</strong> chance that learning will be retained. Students who interact with


course materials make commitments and predictions try out ideas, and get response to those ideas—all of which may be<br />

fostered through <strong>the</strong> use of technology—have <strong>the</strong> greatest chance of overall retention and integration of learning” (Berger,<br />

1998, p. 20). “Using computer, An instructor has been able to go beyond <strong>the</strong> traditional linear regression curriculum to<br />

cover cluster analysis and <strong>the</strong> rudiments of factor analysis.” Get rid of linear learning mode but take up to complex and selfpaced<br />

learning.<br />

Learning and teaching with technology encourages active inquiry, making learning complex but making possible learning<br />

events taking place at anytime, anyplace. Students construct knowledge at pace needed by individual student while<br />

accelerating learning capabilities in negotiation and team ef<strong>for</strong>ts. Participating in on-line discussion asynchronously as well<br />

synchronously, students are compelled to think critically and learn from o<strong>the</strong>rs, which creates contextual learning<br />

experiences and making learners “go beyond traditional memorization of facts and fundamentals”. This learning approach<br />

broadens <strong>the</strong> students’ concepts but also enhance <strong>the</strong>ir acquisition of learning skills, such as electronic learning skills that<br />

may be used in <strong>the</strong>ir future courses or later personal and professional growth (Bazillion & Braun, 1998, p. 37).<br />

Reference<br />

Bazillion, R. & Braun, C. (1998). Teaching on <strong>the</strong> web and in <strong>the</strong> studio classroom. Syllabus, Vol. 11(8), 37-39.<br />

Berger, C. (1998). Ann Jackson and <strong>the</strong> four myths of integrating technology into teaching. Syllabus, Vol. 11(7), 18-20.<br />

Kelly, J. T., & Leckbee, R. (1998). Reality check: What do we really know about technology, and how do we know about<br />

it Syllabus, Vol. 12(1), 24-26.<br />

Graves, W. (1998). Learning as an expedition, technology as a unifying tool. Syllabus,Vol. 12(1), 20-22.<br />

Grossman, S. (<strong>1999</strong>). Introduction Speech in Democratic National Committee Meeting. Democratic National Committee<br />

Meeting, Mar. 20, <strong>1999</strong>.<br />

McCandless, G. (1998). Creating a level playing field <strong>for</strong> campus computing: Universal access. Syllabus, Vol. 11(6), 12-14<br />

and 29.<br />

Raschke, C. (1998). Digital culture, <strong>the</strong> third knowledge revolution, and <strong>the</strong> coming of <strong>the</strong> hyperuniversity. Syllabus, Vol.<br />

11(7), 14-16.


A Wide Array of Uses: Inquiry and Instruction with <strong>the</strong> HyperNews<br />

In University Courses<br />

Ni Chang, Ed.D.<br />

Assistant Professor<br />

University of Wisconsin<br />

800 W. Main St.<br />

Whitewater, WI 53190<br />

changn@uwwvax.uww.edu<br />

414-472-5798<br />

Problem<br />

Many instructors are using <strong>the</strong> HyperNews in <strong>the</strong>ir courses at college or university levels. The HyperNews is<br />

commonly employed <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> purpose of asynchronous discussions. This discussion arena provides students an<br />

avenue to know and communicate with one ano<strong>the</strong>r outside a classroom. In <strong>the</strong> contemporary society, given <strong>the</strong> fact<br />

that <strong>the</strong> majority of people have busy schedules, personal communications become less possible. My students face<br />

<strong>the</strong> same problem. They meet with one ano<strong>the</strong>r when sharing a class, but soon after <strong>the</strong> class is dismissed, my<br />

students have to run due to work demands or o<strong>the</strong>r requirements. Time constraint permits students to exchange little<br />

view that <strong>the</strong> content of a class impossibly covers but is concerned by many people in <strong>the</strong> same field. This dilemma<br />

deprives <strong>the</strong> students of chances to exchange concerned ideas and of potential opportunities to expand knowledge.<br />

This limitation also leaves me little room to dispense necessary in<strong>for</strong>mation that a class period usually does not<br />

permit but that may interest those who desire to know more.<br />

Resolution<br />

How to solve this problem is <strong>the</strong> center point of my concern. Like many o<strong>the</strong>r faculty members in <strong>the</strong> higher<br />

education, I eventually offered <strong>the</strong> students a plat<strong>for</strong>m where <strong>the</strong>y were able to launch a dialogue regarding<br />

interested concepts or issues and pose questions. This plat<strong>for</strong>m also enabled me to communicate with my students<br />

<strong>the</strong> needed in<strong>for</strong>mation. This plat<strong>for</strong>m is <strong>the</strong> HyperNews. The HyperNews made it possible to meet <strong>the</strong> needs of <strong>the</strong><br />

students and <strong>the</strong> instructor. Many issues and ideas were discussed and <strong>the</strong> scope of knowledge was expanded. I was<br />

able to communicate with <strong>the</strong> students whenever as needed. Apparently, <strong>the</strong> students found beneficial in this mode<br />

of learning. I was agreeable with <strong>the</strong> students based on experience of using <strong>the</strong> HyperNews as a communication tool<br />

<strong>for</strong> several semesters. Students, while conversing with one ano<strong>the</strong>r electronically and advancing <strong>the</strong>ir<br />

understandings, attained technological skills, such as typing, deleting, sending, and retrieving messages in addition<br />

to unexpected problem-solving skills.<br />

O<strong>the</strong>r Uses of <strong>the</strong> Hypernews<br />

Besides of <strong>the</strong> fact that <strong>the</strong> hypernews is used as a tool <strong>for</strong> students and instructors to transmit and convey ideas and<br />

suggestions in <strong>the</strong>ir teaching and learning, what o<strong>the</strong>r functions does <strong>the</strong> hypernews play in educational instruction<br />

This is always one of my o<strong>the</strong>r concerns in infusing technology into a classroom setting to make learning easy and<br />

understandable.<br />

Cooperative Learning Tool: I value students’ time and results of learning and encourage students to learn from one<br />

ano<strong>the</strong>r by reading and sharing each o<strong>the</strong>r’s ideas and learning results. To serve this end, it was a usual practice that<br />

a considerable amount of time and paper was used <strong>for</strong> printing out all projects that students presented in <strong>the</strong> class at<br />

<strong>the</strong> end of each semester. Gradually, I discovered that after much paper and time devoted on this product, some<br />

students did not read o<strong>the</strong>rs’ work due to a time restraint. To avoid fur<strong>the</strong>r waste and bring about <strong>the</strong> productive<br />

learning, I bravely took a risk in instruction. Encouraging students to publish <strong>the</strong>ir projects on <strong>the</strong> hypernews was<br />

thus rendered. In this demonstration, I will share with <strong>the</strong> audience <strong>the</strong> insight into this mode of teaching. The<br />

difficulties that my students and I encountered and <strong>the</strong> profits <strong>the</strong> students gained from this practice in <strong>the</strong> past years<br />

will also be part of this demonstration..


Sharing with o<strong>the</strong>rs in a class serves one end of learning and teaching. Cooperative learning serves <strong>the</strong> o<strong>the</strong>r. I did<br />

not feel content by assigning grades to students’ paper but satisfied with <strong>the</strong> genuine achievement that students<br />

made. Obtaining knowledge and increasing understanding actually is <strong>the</strong> central point of <strong>the</strong> interaction between<br />

college students and me. The role of an instructor plays in <strong>the</strong> education of students is vital and fundamental. It is an<br />

instructor who orchestrates students to achieve <strong>the</strong> desirable outcome of learning in a systematic way.<br />

Acknowledging <strong>the</strong> importance, I went fur<strong>the</strong>r by utilizing <strong>the</strong> hypernews in <strong>the</strong> learning and teaching process. As<br />

ano<strong>the</strong>r assignment that invited students to extend <strong>the</strong>ir knowledge base, I requested <strong>the</strong> students to read from <strong>the</strong><br />

screen what <strong>the</strong>ir classmates have done and to finish this assignment by providing appropriate comments in response<br />

to <strong>the</strong>ir readings. From what <strong>the</strong>y wrote, I was able to collect additional data regarding how my students understood<br />

learned concepts and how I would continue modifying my instructional strategies. In this demonstration, pros and<br />

cons will be discussed and shared with <strong>the</strong> audience.<br />

Distance Learning: When having a group of graduate students who are teachers in public schools, an instructor may<br />

have to face a situation that one or two students cannot attend a certain class during a semester. Frequent absence<br />

caused by one or two students in each class period affected <strong>the</strong> flow of teaching and students’ understanding of <strong>the</strong><br />

content of work. To solve <strong>the</strong> problem, I took ano<strong>the</strong>r risk by utilizing <strong>the</strong> hypernews as a distance learning device.<br />

Having students be in front of computers ei<strong>the</strong>r at <strong>the</strong>ir own homes or places near <strong>the</strong>ir houses, my students and I<br />

launched conversations in a scheduled time when everybody had was free from an obligation given by a school. Our<br />

flexibility and new way of teaching and learning elicited advantages and merits. In this demonstration, I would like<br />

to present to <strong>the</strong> audience how I did this learning project, gains and difficulties my students and I experienced.<br />

Again, in graduate classes, I sustained <strong>the</strong> spirit of collaborative learning by encouraging <strong>the</strong> students to share what<br />

<strong>the</strong>y found from <strong>the</strong> Internet. To share with one ano<strong>the</strong>r on line, I adapted <strong>the</strong> means of <strong>the</strong> hypernews again: <strong>the</strong><br />

students attained new ideas from each o<strong>the</strong>r in respect to <strong>the</strong>ir located resources from <strong>the</strong> Internet by using<br />

<strong>Book</strong>marks. None of <strong>the</strong> graduate students that I taught knew how to use bookmarks. Within a short period of time<br />

along with my instruction on <strong>the</strong> use of <strong>Book</strong>marks, <strong>the</strong>y mastered <strong>the</strong> skill. Via <strong>the</strong> hypernews, <strong>the</strong> students<br />

publicized <strong>the</strong>ir bookmarks on <strong>the</strong> hypernews linking to <strong>the</strong> found resources. The students found enjoyable<br />

exchanging <strong>the</strong>ir findings with one ano<strong>the</strong>r on line. They grew much academically. Yet, this innovation experienced<br />

unexpected problems that will be reported and discussed with <strong>the</strong> audience in this demonstration.<br />

Summary<br />

Generally, <strong>the</strong> infusion of <strong>the</strong> hypernews into <strong>the</strong> instruction and inquiry of graduate and undergraduate plays a<br />

significant role in <strong>the</strong> students’ construction of knowledge, providing <strong>the</strong>m with flexibility and opportunities to learn<br />

at <strong>the</strong>ir own paces and <strong>the</strong>ir convinced time. Through a wide variety of methods of using <strong>the</strong> hypernews as a tool or<br />

device, students accomplished and achieved in a meaningful way. Although much thoughts and time have been<br />

given to ways of how to incorporate <strong>the</strong> hypernews into students' learning and inquiry, I personally feel fulfilled and<br />

take a pride in what I have succeeded. However, although it is a rewarding practice, it is my belief that <strong>the</strong>re is a<br />

need <strong>for</strong> improvement. I will continue to explore with o<strong>the</strong>rs <strong>the</strong> effective utilization of <strong>the</strong> hyeprnews in college<br />

instructions and inquiry.


Effects of Question-Based Learning in a Hypermedia<br />

Intelligent-Assisted Learning Environment<br />

Ching Hui Alice Chen<br />

Department of In<strong>for</strong>mation Management<br />

Ming Chuan University<br />

Taipei, R. O. C.<br />

Achen@mcu.edu.tw<br />

Feng-Hsu Wang<br />

Department of In<strong>for</strong>mation Management<br />

Ming Chuan University<br />

Taipei, R. O. C.<br />

Fhwang@mcu.edu.tw<br />

The Problems<br />

Due to <strong>the</strong> entry-examination system, almost all <strong>the</strong> schools in Taiwan emphasize more on memorization and<br />

test-taking skills. Although students have high scores in ma<strong>the</strong>matics examinations, <strong>the</strong>ir problem solving skills<br />

are still in <strong>the</strong> low-level of thinking stage. Students spent hundreds of hours in <strong>the</strong> crane schools <strong>for</strong> test-taking<br />

skill in order to get high test scores. Students do not have <strong>the</strong> ability and have no attention to enhance <strong>the</strong>ir highorder<br />

thinking skill. In this manner, teachers have no liberty and time to design meaningful learning<br />

environment. The purpose of this study is to find a solution <strong>for</strong> both <strong>the</strong> students and teachers, to provide<br />

students <strong>the</strong> opportunity to enhance <strong>the</strong>ir knowledge and skills, to provide teachers an alternative way to enrich<br />

classroom learning activities.<br />

Theoretical Framework<br />

For most feedback studies, <strong>the</strong> in<strong>for</strong>mation contained in <strong>the</strong> feedback session is presented to <strong>the</strong> learner.<br />

Most posttests and retention tests require learners to recall what <strong>the</strong>y have learned from <strong>the</strong> instruction, and <strong>the</strong><br />

level of learning rarely extends beyond rote memorization. In this manner, learners have no opportunity to<br />

engage in what Salomon and Globerson (1987) described as "mindful behavior". In order to engage in mindful<br />

behavior, <strong>the</strong> learning situation should be introduced in a way that learners will be able to examine and elaborate<br />

situational cues, to generate alternative learning strategies, to ga<strong>the</strong>r in<strong>for</strong>mation, and to draw connections<br />

between old and new in<strong>for</strong>mation. Some feedback studies have reported significant results on immediate tests,<br />

but not on retention tests. During most feedback instruction, learners received feedback in<strong>for</strong>mation passively<br />

without actively organizing and applying <strong>the</strong>ir knowledge. In most feedback research, in<strong>for</strong>mation is stored as<br />

facts ra<strong>the</strong>r than as tools. There<strong>for</strong>e, in<strong>for</strong>mation is not spontaneously used to solve problems. A few studies<br />

suggested that when in<strong>for</strong>mation is introduced in a problem-solving context, it is more likely to be used in new<br />

contexts than remain inert (Lockhart, Lamon, & Gick, 1988; Perkins & Salomon, 1989).<br />

In <strong>the</strong> learning process, <strong>the</strong> learner is more easily to understand and acquire factual knowledge, while it is<br />

more difficult <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong>m to generate critical thinking and to obtain higher-order thinking skills. A number of<br />

<strong>the</strong>orists have emphasized <strong>the</strong> importance of helping students to engage in generative ra<strong>the</strong>r than passive<br />

learning activities (Chi, et. al., 1989; Minstrell, 1989). It is assumed that learning is an active, constructive<br />

process whereby learners generate meaning <strong>for</strong> in<strong>for</strong>mation by accessing and applying existing knowledge<br />

(Jonassen, 1991). Relating knowledge and personal experience in learning is one of <strong>the</strong> major components in<br />

situated cognition (Brown, Collins, & Duguid, 1989). In situated learning, learners should be able to see how<br />

knowledge may be applied in new situations through analogies and similarities to <strong>the</strong> situations <strong>the</strong>y learned in<br />

(Collins, 1991). There<strong>for</strong>e, knowledge is more likely to be stored in a way that is usable in novel contexts.<br />

The notion of situated learning is parallel to constructivistic learning. Constructivists tend to favor problemsolving<br />

activities that are linked to student interests, that have some attributes of real-world problem, and that are<br />

meaningful and satisfying <strong>for</strong> students to solve. From <strong>the</strong> constructivitics perspective, interest is <strong>the</strong> fuel of <strong>the</strong><br />

constructive process. Without interest, <strong>the</strong> learners will never make <strong>the</strong> constructive ef<strong>for</strong>t to make sense out of<br />

experience (DeVries, 1993). There<strong>for</strong>e, it is very important to design instruction in which learners are motivated<br />

to be mentally active in <strong>the</strong> context of instructional activities.


Learning Environment<br />

This research proposes a hypermedia intelligent-assisted learning system (HIALS) which provides<br />

hypermedia learning courseware and intelligent knowledge. The learning environment was produced using<br />

Authorware (4.0), Director (6.0) and XClips. The content of <strong>the</strong> instruction is learning physics knowledge <strong>for</strong><br />

middle school students. Three real world scenarios are used as <strong>the</strong> body of <strong>the</strong> instruction, each scenario<br />

contains stories related to <strong>the</strong> daily life experiences. Students have <strong>the</strong> full control over <strong>the</strong> sequence of <strong>the</strong><br />

instruction.<br />

After viewing <strong>the</strong> scenarios, students have to answer questions. The questions are video clips from <strong>the</strong><br />

scenarios that require students to identify physics <strong>the</strong>ories to explain <strong>the</strong> phenomena occurred in <strong>the</strong> video.<br />

Students need to check <strong>the</strong> answers from a list of physics <strong>the</strong>ories. When students produce incorrect responses,<br />

<strong>the</strong> intelligent tutor will provide guiding. The intelligent tutor ei<strong>the</strong>r refers students to <strong>the</strong> related video clips, or<br />

provides hints or explanations. Students are encouraged to navigate <strong>the</strong> hypermedia database and search <strong>for</strong><br />

solutions under <strong>the</strong> guidance of our intelligent tutoring system. The system records students' navigation<br />

processes; <strong>the</strong>re<strong>for</strong>e, researchers will be able to trace learners' learning paths, and analyze <strong>the</strong>ir learning patterns.<br />

Pilot Study<br />

Two instruments were used in this study. The physics knowledge test has 30 items and <strong>the</strong> 5 Likert scale<br />

science attitude test consists of 35 items. Both instruments were created from <strong>the</strong> researchers and two content<br />

experts. The reliability <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> attitude test is 0.9. 16 third-year senior high school students from a suburban area<br />

of Taipei City participated in this pilot study. One week be<strong>for</strong>e <strong>the</strong> experiment, subjects took both <strong>the</strong><br />

knowledge and attitude tests as <strong>the</strong> pretest score. Subjects took both tests again one week after <strong>the</strong> experiment as<br />

<strong>the</strong> posttest score. Two t-test were per<strong>for</strong>med using Statistic program to examine <strong>the</strong> differences between <strong>the</strong><br />

two sets of scores. The t-test <strong>for</strong> knowledge did not reveal any significant result. There was a significant<br />

difference (P


The EFFECTS of TRAINGING METHOD on LANGUAGE LEARNING PERFORMANCE<br />

Huey-Wen Chou<br />

Associate Professor, Department of In<strong>for</strong>mation Management<br />

National Central University<br />

#38 Wu-Chuan Li, Chungli city, Taiwan, ROC<br />

E-mail: hwchou@im.mgt.ncu.edu.tw<br />

Abstract: The purpose of <strong>the</strong> present study was to compare <strong>the</strong> effects of two cooperative computer-assisted<br />

language learning (CALL) environments on learners' spelling per<strong>for</strong>mance and learning attitude. The two<br />

cooperative CALL environments are face-to-face and distance cooperative CALL environments. Traditional<br />

classroom lecture learning environment and self-directed CALL environment are employed as control groups.<br />

Learning per<strong>for</strong>mance and learning attitude, including interpersonal relationships, learning interests, and selfesteem,<br />

were <strong>the</strong> dependent variables.<br />

64 seventh graders from a local public junior high school were randomly assigned to four treatments. An<br />

experiment was conducted <strong>for</strong> data collection. The experiment lasted <strong>for</strong> ten days with a thirty-minute learning<br />

session on each day. It was found that <strong>the</strong>re were significant per<strong>for</strong>mance differences among learning<br />

environments. No significant group differences were found in any dimension of attitudinal measures. Plausible<br />

explanations about <strong>the</strong> findings are provided and future implications follow.<br />

1. INTRODUCTION<br />

The use of computer-assisted learning (CAL) in various pedagogical settings is rapidly increasing. Researchers have<br />

reported CAL to be effective in many training situations. Its applications on language learning, <strong>for</strong> example, has been verified<br />

that it can enhance learners' language learning. Many of <strong>the</strong> CALs are based on a system-driven design and are used as an aid<br />

<strong>for</strong> self-directed study.<br />

Recently, one of <strong>the</strong> research lines in CAL is <strong>the</strong> remote (distance) learning through educational network (Hoppe et al.<br />

1994), that may be attributed to <strong>the</strong> relative novelty of <strong>the</strong> rapidly evolving network technology. Multi-user telecommunicationenabled<br />

cooperative learning environment on CAL becomes feasible in many pedagogical applications (Alavi 1994; Lin 1992).<br />

In addition, with <strong>the</strong> rapid growth of related technology and dropping of hardware prices, multimedia applications are receiving<br />

considerable worldwide attention within <strong>the</strong> field of instructional technology. By accessing and integrating versatile<br />

in<strong>for</strong>mation, such as video, sound, image, and text, multimedia applications in education af<strong>for</strong>d a great potential in improving<br />

teaching quality.<br />

2. LITERATURE REVIEW<br />

This section reviews literature on (1) cooperative learning environment, (2) self-directed learning environment, (3) CALL,<br />

(4) cooperative CALL environment and distance cooperative CAL environment.<br />

2.1 COOPERATIVE LEARNING ENVIRONMENT<br />

It was argued that learning environment with various degrees of social context would affect learners' learning motives,<br />

which, in turn, will have differential effects on learners' per<strong>for</strong>mance (Berlyne 1978). The origin of cooperative learning can be<br />

traced far back to <strong>the</strong> ancient Rome Times (Hooper, 1992). Slavin (1983) employed behavior, task structure, motivation, and<br />

incentive structure to define cooperative learning. Researchers proclaimed that under cooperative learning context, a learner<br />

can make a contribution to ano<strong>the</strong>r learner's both cognitive and emotional consequences by providing hints, advice, feedback,<br />

correction, evaluation, and encouragement. Table 1 showed a summary on it.<br />

Researcher(s) Year Type Per<strong>for</strong>mance Attitudinal Measures<br />

Sharan 1980 I Better learning per<strong>for</strong>mance<br />

Johnson et al 1981 M Better learning per<strong>for</strong>mance<br />

Bryant 1982 I Conceptual change<br />

Slavin 1983 M Favored low-achievers Improved relationships among<br />

different racial students<br />

Scott 1974 I No significant differences Better attitude to schooling<br />

Johnson et al 1985 I 1.Better than o<strong>the</strong>r types of learning<br />

2.Improved problem solving<br />

Enhanced interaction among various<br />

abilities students<br />

Yager<br />

Yager, et al<br />

1985<br />

1986<br />

I<br />

1.Better learning transfer<br />

2.Better long-term retention<br />

3.Better learning per<strong>for</strong>mance<br />

1.Higher learners interaction<br />

2.Better attitude towards o<strong>the</strong>rs<br />

3.Improved self-esteem


Brown & 1987 Benefits of members' combined knowledge<br />

Reeve<br />

and shared expertise<br />

Slavin 1987 I Significant at elementary level<br />

Dalton et al. 1989 I Better per<strong>for</strong>mance<br />

Chang 1990 I Superior to self-directed learning Feel bored about learning tasks<br />

Hooper et al 1993 I better learning outcome<br />

* : In <strong>the</strong> 3 rd column, "I" represents an individual study and "M" represents a meta study.<br />

Table 1. The Effects of Cooperative Learning on Per<strong>for</strong>mance and attitudinal measures * .<br />

In <strong>the</strong> cooperative learning, group members share a variety of thinking roles. Research results indicated that in group<br />

setting, peers are important models <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong>ir age-mates. In a cooperative learning environment, peers serve as effective tutors<br />

and cooperators. In o<strong>the</strong>r cases, <strong>the</strong>y can also serve as good or bad examples (Piaget 1965), <strong>the</strong>y can learn through social<br />

contact with peers to shape or correct his/her logical structure. Piaget (1965) suggested that <strong>the</strong> exposure to social context by<br />

peer interactions is a valuable experience and provides precious asset to learners in shaping internal cognitive structures. He<br />

indicated that peer interaction can offer three advantages in individual's learning process. Firstly, <strong>the</strong> different point views<br />

brought from peer interactions provide <strong>the</strong> learner an opportunity to experience cognitive conflicts. Secondly, through <strong>the</strong><br />

process of adjusting with cognitive conflicts, <strong>the</strong> learner will become less-egocentrismed in developing cognitive structure.<br />

Thirdly, The internal state of disequilibrium resulted from cognitive conflicts, which is one of <strong>the</strong> most important factors in<br />

affecting <strong>the</strong> learner's self-identity <strong>for</strong>mulation, will be gradually resolved under his/her subsequent knowledge re-organization.<br />

From <strong>the</strong> literature review, <strong>the</strong> advantages of cooperative learning environment can be summed up as follows: 1. Improving<br />

learners' social relationship, 2. Stimulating peer interaction, 3. Increasing confidence and self-esteem, and 4. Enhancing<br />

learning per<strong>for</strong>mance.<br />

2.2 SELF-DIRECT<strong>ED</strong> LEARNING ENVIRONMENT<br />

Although <strong>the</strong>ories of social learning have gained more and more emphasis in educational psychology, self-directed learning<br />

<strong>the</strong>ory does play a valuable role in explaining learning process. It is difficult to explain human beings learning process merely<br />

by self-directed learning <strong>the</strong>ories or by social-learning <strong>the</strong>ories alone. Brown and Reeve (1987) and Gelman and Brown<br />

(1985b) suggested that a coordination of <strong>the</strong> two extremes, self-directed and social learning, comes somewhat nearer <strong>the</strong> truth<br />

Self-directed learning environment is defined as an user-controlled independent learning environment. Under such<br />

environment, learning per<strong>for</strong>mance is subject to <strong>the</strong> extent to which a learner can direct his/her own learning process<br />

independently (Shyu & Brown 1992). Gelman and Brown (1985a,b) pointed out that self-directed learning is guided by systems<br />

of internal structure, principles, or constraints that seek support in <strong>the</strong> environment <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong>ir growth and development. They<br />

also indicated that human beings come equipped with a tendency to navigate <strong>the</strong> world by systematically monitoring <strong>the</strong> results<br />

of <strong>the</strong>ir own active experimentation with <strong>the</strong> surroundings. Developmental psychologists support that learning is happened by<br />

self-driven motives to explore <strong>the</strong> outside uncertainty and results in knowledge extension.<br />

Studies have suggested that by providing students self-directed learning environment, learners can better learn how to learn<br />

(Merrill 1975). Lepper (1985) indicated that in self-directed learning environment, individuals feel <strong>the</strong> learning activity has<br />

greater personal meaning and intrinsic interests. In <strong>the</strong> self-directed CAL environment, learners are given control to decide<br />

<strong>the</strong>ir own learning pace, sequencing, and difficulty levels. In Papert's study with LOGO (1980), it was found that increasing<br />

control enhances learners' feelings of self-efficacy.<br />

2.3. COMPUTER ASSIST<strong>ED</strong> LANGUAGE LEARNING (CALL)<br />

The effects of computer assisted language learning (CALL) were often contrasted to that of traditional classroom learning.<br />

A literature review on comparing <strong>the</strong> learning per<strong>for</strong>mance in CALL with that in classroom lecture was summarized by Lin<br />

(1992) and found that in overall, CALL obtained better learning per<strong>for</strong>mance.<br />

2.4 COOPERATIVE CALL ENVIRONMENT<br />

In <strong>the</strong> cooperative CALL context, Okamoto (1994) analyzed <strong>the</strong> interaction among learners in a group-type learning<br />

situation, and emphasized <strong>the</strong> importance of interaction such as discussion, collaboration, and competition between learners.<br />

He insisted that such interaction promote efficiency in <strong>the</strong>ir understanding and confirmation. From literature review, it is<br />

generally acknowledged that cooperative task based learning is an appropriate paradigm <strong>for</strong> <strong>for</strong>eign language teaching.<br />

Foubister et al. (1996) found members in group setting share a variety of thinking roles and enhance communication skills.<br />

Traditional CALL environment is self-directed which may constrain learners' social interaction with peers and teachers and<br />

<strong>the</strong>reby result in a poor social relationship. As to <strong>the</strong> impacts of distance cooperative CAL learning environment, Alavi (1994)<br />

found that students in such group obtained significantly higher per<strong>for</strong>mance and better experience.<br />

2.5 RESEARCH GOALS<br />

In <strong>the</strong> present study, an experiment was conducted to explore possible learning differences between face-to-face cooperative<br />

CALL environment and distance cooperative CALL environment. The self-directed CALL environment and <strong>the</strong> traditional<br />

classroom lecture learning environment were employed as <strong>the</strong> control groups. The target system is an English spelling lesson<br />

<strong>for</strong> seventh grade pupils.


3. RESEARCH METHODOLOGY<br />

A 10-day experiment with 8-session learning units was conducted <strong>for</strong> data collection. The material covered in <strong>the</strong> learning<br />

unit is English words spelling task. 100 of seventh graders were randomly chosen from a public junior high school at a nor<strong>the</strong>rn<br />

city in Taiwan, ROC. An English vocabulary spelling pretest was administered to screen out <strong>the</strong> students with top and bottom<br />

scores. After <strong>the</strong> pretest, 64 students were chosen to participate <strong>the</strong> study and were <strong>the</strong>n randomly assigned to four groups..<br />

3.1 PROC<strong>ED</strong>URE<br />

The classroom lecture group took a 30-minute instruction from an English teacher in <strong>the</strong> morning. Whereas <strong>the</strong> three CALL<br />

groups took <strong>the</strong> same instruction from CALL system in <strong>the</strong> afternoon. The different time allocation, which may contribute to<br />

possible treatment effects, is due to <strong>the</strong> limited availability of <strong>the</strong> computer room. 16 subjects in <strong>the</strong> two cooperative CALL<br />

groups were randomly assigned to <strong>for</strong>m 8 pairs. Individuals in <strong>the</strong> pairs within <strong>the</strong> two cooperative CALL groups would daily<br />

switch roles as <strong>the</strong> peer-tutor and <strong>the</strong> learner.<br />

3.2 RESEARCH VARIABLES<br />

Three types of research variable: independent, dependent, and control, variables were examined. The independent variable<br />

was learning environment, including traditional classroom lectures, self-directed CALL, face-to-face cooperative CALL, and<br />

distance cooperative CALL. Two dependent variables included in <strong>the</strong> present study were learning per<strong>for</strong>mance and learning<br />

attitude. Learning per<strong>for</strong>mance was measured by an achievement test. Three dimensions of learning attitude, i.e., interpersonal<br />

relationships, learning interests, and confidence, were included in a self-developed learning attitude scale. Two control<br />

variables were <strong>the</strong> learner's prior English spelling achievement and <strong>the</strong> learner's ability. The <strong>for</strong>mer was controlled out by a<br />

pretest and <strong>the</strong> latter was controlled by random sampling.<br />

3.3 RESEARCH HYPOTHESES<br />

The present study is designed to test <strong>the</strong> superiority of cooperative CAL environment in language learning. The hypo<strong>the</strong>ses<br />

to be examined in <strong>the</strong> present study include:<br />

1. H o: There is no difference in learning per<strong>for</strong>mance and attitude among four learning environments.<br />

2. H o: There is no difference in learning per<strong>for</strong>mance and attitude between three CALL groups and traditional classroom<br />

lecture learning group.<br />

3. H o: There is no difference in learning per<strong>for</strong>mance and attitude between two cooperative CALL group and self-directed<br />

CALL group.<br />

4. H o: There is no difference in learning per<strong>for</strong>mance and attitude between distance cooperative CALL group and face-to-face<br />

cooperative CALL group.<br />

3.5 RESEARCH INSTRUMENT<br />

Three types of research instrument, including a target system, an attitude scale, and an achievement test, were used in <strong>the</strong><br />

present study. The target system was developed in Microsoft Windows environment using Visual Basic tools. The target system<br />

included two versions: single-user and real time multi-user versions. The <strong>for</strong>mer version was <strong>for</strong> face-to-face cooperative and<br />

self-directed CALL environments, and <strong>the</strong> latter was <strong>for</strong> distance cooperative CALL environment.<br />

The self-developed attitude scale, syn<strong>the</strong>sized from previous studies (Lin, 1992; Yang, 1989; Konttinen, 1985; Laine, 1977;<br />

Gardner & Lambert, 1972), contained 24 questions in <strong>the</strong> 3 dimensions: interpersonal relations, learning interests, and selfconfidence.<br />

The attitude scale obtained a moderate split-half reliability coefficient of 0.62 by using Sperman-Brown <strong>for</strong>mula.<br />

The achievement test contained all 36 words taught in <strong>the</strong> experiment. Group interviews were conducted <strong>for</strong> data collection<br />

about subjects' experiences in using CALL systems. Subjects were asked to rate on <strong>the</strong> system's features as well its usefulness.<br />

4. STUDY RESULTS AND DISCUSSIONS<br />

One-way ANOVA technique and Sheffe's a posteriori test were employed to analyze data. It was found that <strong>the</strong>re existed<br />

significant differences in learning per<strong>for</strong>mance among four groups. Sheffe's a posteriori test was employed to test all possible<br />

contrasts among <strong>the</strong> means. It was found that subjects in classroom lecture learning environment outper<strong>for</strong>med <strong>the</strong> rest. In<br />

addition, <strong>the</strong> results indicated that <strong>the</strong>re existed significant per<strong>for</strong>mance differences among specific groups, namely, classroom<br />

lecture, distance cooperative CALL, and face-to-face cooperative CALL learning groups.<br />

Source DF Sum of Squares Mean of Squares F Value P<br />

Model 3 403.43 134.48 6.01 0.0012<br />

Error 60 1320.31 22.39<br />

Total 63 1723.75<br />

Note: * represents a significance at .01 level.<br />

Table 2. ANOVA Table of Different Learning Environments<br />

Mean STD N<br />

Classroom<br />

Lecture<br />

Distance<br />

Cooperative CALL<br />

Face-to-Face<br />

Cooperative CALL


Classroom Lecture 13.19 6.45 16<br />

Distance Cooperative 6.44 2.73 16 6.75*<br />

CALL<br />

Face-to-Face<br />

8.00 3.02 16 5.19* -1.56<br />

Cooperative CALL<br />

Self-Directed CALL 8.56 5.51 16 4.63 -2.12 -0.56<br />

Note: * represents a significance at .05 level.<br />

Table 3. Means, Standard Deviation, and Sheffe's a Posteriori Test<br />

Regarding to <strong>the</strong> attitudinal differences in three dimensions: interpersonal relations, learning interests, and confidence, it<br />

was found no significant group differences existed. Never<strong>the</strong>less, group interview results showed subjects in two cooperative<br />

CALL groups expressed highly positive experiences in helping o<strong>the</strong>rs. A sense of achievement and learning interests were<br />

proliferated in those groups during <strong>the</strong> experiment. Regarding to <strong>the</strong> target system evaluation, subjects commented <strong>the</strong> system<br />

as "vivid, interesting, well-represented, and user-friendly". They described <strong>the</strong> learning process is full of happiness and fun.<br />

4.3 DISCUSSIONS<br />

The most astonishing finding in this study is <strong>the</strong> significant per<strong>for</strong>mance differences that favor classroom lecture learning<br />

environment. The o<strong>the</strong>r three CALL environments did not generate as good per<strong>for</strong>mance as classroom lecture learning<br />

environment did. Two similar results were found in literature. Firstly, <strong>the</strong> Plait Report conducted in North Ireland (Hammond,<br />

1994) was to examine if students would do better in homework with <strong>the</strong> help of a notebook computer at home. After one year's<br />

experiment, <strong>the</strong> results indicated that no significant better per<strong>for</strong>mance was found.<br />

Secondly, <strong>the</strong> ImpacT Report (Hammond 1994), a longitudinal study conducted in England, indicated two important<br />

findings in explaining <strong>the</strong> insignificant outcomes in <strong>the</strong> cooperative group. First, <strong>the</strong> degree that learners actually cooperate was<br />

a critical factor of learner's per<strong>for</strong>mance. Second, <strong>the</strong>re may exist a threshold <strong>for</strong> cooperative learning to be effective. In o<strong>the</strong>r<br />

words, learning outcome needs to be accumulated to pass over a "threshold" to be significant.<br />

After a close examination on <strong>the</strong> research design and experiment procedure, three plausible explanations to <strong>the</strong> study<br />

results are drawn.<br />

1. Although total learning time was <strong>the</strong> same across groups, <strong>the</strong> time allocated to active learning varied. Students in<br />

three CALL groups needed to spend sometime in adjusting to <strong>the</strong> CALL environment. The actual learning time <strong>for</strong><br />

CALL groups would be less than that in <strong>the</strong> classroom lecture group and that might result in inferior per<strong>for</strong>mance<br />

in <strong>the</strong> CALL groups.<br />

2. Although <strong>the</strong> quality of spelling lesson was manipulated to be identical across groups, <strong>the</strong> active learning time in<br />

doing spelling exercise varied. Subjects in <strong>the</strong> classroom lecture and self-directed CALL groups did <strong>the</strong> spelling<br />

exercise all by <strong>the</strong>mselves, which would take a longer active learning time. Whereas in <strong>the</strong> two cooperative groups,<br />

due to <strong>the</strong> daily peer-tutor vs learner role change, subjects only spelled half of <strong>the</strong> words in <strong>the</strong> spelling exercise on<br />

average. This might significantly reduce <strong>the</strong> active learning time. The two reasons may well explain why <strong>the</strong><br />

classroom lecture group and <strong>the</strong> self-directed CALL group obtained <strong>the</strong> highest two mean achievement scores.<br />

3. Finally, <strong>the</strong> actual cooperation level may help explaining <strong>the</strong> per<strong>for</strong>mance differences in two cooperative CALL<br />

groups. In <strong>the</strong> face-to-face cooperative CALL group, subjects seated next to each o<strong>the</strong>r and <strong>the</strong>re<strong>for</strong>e could<br />

cooperative more effectively. In <strong>the</strong> distance cooperative CALL group, subjects helped each o<strong>the</strong>r via microphone<br />

communication, which is more time-consuming. When exposed in a time constraint situation, <strong>the</strong> above different<br />

patterns may contribute to <strong>the</strong> quality of cooperation and result in inferior per<strong>for</strong>mance in <strong>the</strong> distance cooperative<br />

CALL group. The fact that distance cooperative CALL group obtained <strong>the</strong> lowest achievement scores was not<br />

surprising.<br />

5. CONCLUSION AND IMPLICATION<br />

Researches of <strong>the</strong> learning environment effects on learning per<strong>for</strong>mance and on motivation have been a lot, <strong>the</strong> results are<br />

not consistent - some are even contradictory. How to choose representative learning models with significant factors is still a big<br />

challenge. This study outlines a research in examining <strong>the</strong> possible environmental effects on learning per<strong>for</strong>mance and on<br />

learning attitude. Research results suggest significant per<strong>for</strong>mance differences exist among different learning environments.<br />

Plausible explanations to <strong>the</strong> differences include: 1. There may exist a threshold <strong>for</strong> accumulated learning per<strong>for</strong>mance to be<br />

significant. The 8-day learning task may not be long enough to achieve <strong>the</strong> threshold. 2. The amount of various active learning<br />

time may contribute to learning per<strong>for</strong>mance. 3. The actual cooperation level may vary.O<strong>the</strong>r plausible explanation may be that<br />

<strong>the</strong> cognitive complexity of <strong>the</strong> English word spelling task is not suited <strong>for</strong> cooperative learning.<br />

In order to acquire a more complete picture on <strong>the</strong> effects of learning environment on learners, it is suggested to revise <strong>the</strong><br />

system based on <strong>the</strong> subjects' comments and replicate <strong>the</strong> study with a larger sample. It is also suggested that ano<strong>the</strong>r learning<br />

task with higher level of cognitive complexity be employed. In addition, a complete instruction should be given to <strong>the</strong> CALL<br />

groups be<strong>for</strong>e <strong>the</strong> study to ensure subjects acquire <strong>the</strong> computer skills prerequisites.<br />

By building up such a distance social learning environment with multimedia support, it is <strong>the</strong> researcher's hope to provide a


prototype <strong>for</strong> futuristic learning environment and bring impacts on education revolution in <strong>the</strong> coming centuries.<br />

6. REFERENCES<br />

1. Alavi M, (1994). "Computer-Mediated Collaborative Learning: An Empirical Evaluation," MIS Quarterly, June, 159-<br />

174.<br />

2. Berlyne, D.E. (1978). "Curiosity and learning," Motivation and Emotion, 2, 97-175.<br />

3. Brown, A.L. and R.A. Reeve (1987). "Bandwidths of competence: The role of supportive contexts in learning and<br />

development," In L.S. Liben (Ed.), Developmental and Learning: Conflict or Congruence 177-223, Hillsdale, NJ:<br />

Lawrence Erlbaum Associates.<br />

4. Bryant, P. (1982). "The role of conflict and of agreement between intellectual strategies in children's ideas about<br />

measurement," British Journal of Psychology, 73, 243-251.<br />

5. Chang, J.S., (1990). The Effects of Cooperative Learning on Learning Effects, Mater Thesis, National Cheng-Chi<br />

University, Taiwan, ROC. (in Chinese)<br />

6. Dalton, D.W., M.J. Hannafin, and S. Hooper (1989). "The effects of individual versus cooperative computer-assisted<br />

instruction on student per<strong>for</strong>mance and attitude," Educational Technology Research and Development, 37(2), 15-24.<br />

7. Foubister, S.P., P. McAndrew and T. Mayes (1996). "The evaluation of a distributed multimedia <strong>for</strong>eign language<br />

learning system," Proceeding of Educational Multimedia and Hypermedia, Boston.<br />

8. Gardner, R. and Lambert, W. (1972). Attitudes and Motivation in Second Language Learning, MA: Rowley, Newbury<br />

House.<br />

9. Gelman, R. and A.L. Brown (1985a). "Early foundations of cognitive development," The 1985 Annual Report <strong>for</strong><br />

Center <strong>for</strong> Advanced Study in <strong>the</strong> Behavioral Sciences, Stan<strong>for</strong>d, CA.<br />

10. Gelman, R. and A.L. Brown (1985b). "Changing views of cognitive competence in <strong>the</strong> young," In N.J.Smelser and<br />

D.R.Gerstein, (Eds.), Knowledge in <strong>the</strong> Social and Behavioral Sciences: Discovery and Trends over Fifty Years<br />

(<strong>Proceedings</strong> of a Commemorative Symposium on <strong>the</strong> Fiftieth Anniversary of <strong>the</strong> Ogburn Report, Recent social trends<br />

in <strong>the</strong> United States). New York: Academic Press.<br />

11. Hammond, M. (1994). "Measuring <strong>the</strong> impact of IT on learning," Journal of Computer Assisted Learning, 10, 251-260.<br />

12. Hoppe, H.U., N. Baloian and J. Zhao (1994). Computer support <strong>for</strong> teacher-centered classroom interaction,<br />

<strong>Proceedings</strong> of <strong>the</strong> 1993 International Conference on Computers in Education, 215-217, Taipei, Taiwan, ROC.<br />

13. Hooper, S.(1992), "Cooperative Learning and Computer-Based Instruction," Educational Technology Research and<br />

Development, 40(3), 21-38.<br />

14. Hooper, S., C. Temiyakarn, and M.D. Williams (1993), "The Effects of Cooperative Learning and Learner Control on<br />

High- and Average-Ability Students," Educational Technology Research and Development, 41(2), 5-18.<br />

15. Johnson, R.T. and D.W. Johnson (1981). "Effects of cooperative and individualistic learning experiences on interethnic<br />

interaction," Journal of Educational Psychology, 73(3), 444-449.<br />

16. Johnson, R.T., D.W. Johnson, and M.B. Stanner (1985a). "Effects of cooperative and competitive, and individualistic<br />

goal structures on computer-assisted instruction," Journal of Educational Psychology, 77(6), 668-677.<br />

17. Johnson, R.T., D.W. Johnson and M.B. Stanner (1985b). "Comparison of computer-assisted cooperative, competitive,<br />

and individualistic learning," American Educational Research Journal, 23(3), 32-46.<br />

18. Konttinen, R. (Ed.) (1985). Some Experiences in Using Non-Dedicated Computer Software in FL Teaching, Jyväskylä,<br />

University of Jyväskylä.<br />

19. Laine, E. (1977). Foreign Language Learning Motivation in Finland, Part I, Turku, AfinLa.<br />

20. Lepper, M. (1985). "Microcomputers in education: Motivational and social issues," American Psychologist, 40, 1-18.<br />

21. Lin, Y.H. (1992). Computer-Assisted English Composition Instruction: Curriculum Design and Evaluation, Master<br />

Thesis, National Ching-Hwa Unviersity, Taiwan, ROC. (in Chinese)<br />

22. Merrill, M.D. (1975). "Learner control: Beyond aptitude-treatment interaction," AV Communications Review, 23, 217-<br />

226.<br />

23. Mevarech, Z.R (1993). "Who benefits from cooperative computer-assisted instruction," Journal of Educational<br />

Computing Research, 9,451-464.<br />

24. Okamoto, T. (1994). "The current situations and future directions of intelligent CAI research/development," IEICE<br />

Trans. Inf. & Sys., E77-D(1).<br />

25. Papert, S. (1980). Mindstorms: Children, Computers and Powerful Ideas, New York: Basic <strong>Book</strong>s.<br />

26. Piaget, J. (1965). The Moral Judgment of <strong>the</strong> Child, New York: The Free Press.<br />

27. Scott, W. and D. Cherrington, (1974). "Effects of competitive, cooperative, and individualized rein<strong>for</strong>cement<br />

contingencies," Journal of Personality and Social Psychology, 30, 748-759.<br />

28. Shyu, H.Y. and S.W. Brown (1992). "Learner control versus program control in interactive videodisc instruction: What


are <strong>the</strong> effects in procedural learning" International Journal of Instructional Media, 19(2), 85-96.<br />

29. Slavin, R.E. (1983). "When does cooperative learning increase student achievement" Psychological Bulletin, 94, 429-<br />

445.<br />

30. Slavin, R.E. (1987). Cooperative Learning: Student Teams (2nd Ed.), National Education <strong>Association</strong>, Washington,<br />

D.C.<br />

31. Yager, S. (1985). "The effects of cooperative and individualistic learning experience on positive and negative crosshandicap<br />

relationships," Contemporary Educational Psychology, 10, 127-138.<br />

32. Yager, S. and O<strong>the</strong>rs (1986). "The impact of group processing on achievement in cooperative learning groups," Journal<br />

of Social Psychology, 126, 388-397.<br />

33. Yang, W.L. (1989). The Relationships among Goal-setting, Achievement Motive, Self-Efficacy and Per<strong>for</strong>mance,<br />

Master Thesis, National Chang-Chi University, Taiwan, ROC. (In Chinese)


Designing a Course Web-Site to Supplement <strong>the</strong> Teaching of Part-Time<br />

Engineering Ma<strong>the</strong>matics Course in Singapore Polytechnic:<br />

Introduction to Calculus (A prototype) [1]<br />

Chao Yunn Chyi<br />

Maths/Science Department<br />

Singapore Polytechnic, Singapore<br />

(Chaoyc@sp.edu.sg)<br />

1. Introduction<br />

A problem one encounters when teaching <strong>the</strong> part-time Engineering math courses in Singapore<br />

Polytechnic (SP) is <strong>the</strong> lack of resources available <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> part-time (PT) students outside of classes. The typical<br />

PT student is a person who works full-time and attends classes at night part time. In this scenario, <strong>the</strong>re is<br />

typically a continuous 3-hour lecture, once per week. PT students are expected to master <strong>the</strong> material as it is<br />

being presented, complete homework based on those topics, and quite often be ready to demonstrate <strong>the</strong>ir<br />

knowledge by completing a quiz or turning in homework at <strong>the</strong> next meeting. Variability in ability among <strong>the</strong><br />

students and <strong>the</strong> short meeting time make it hard <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> instructor to meet <strong>the</strong> needs of individual students and<br />

<strong>the</strong>re<strong>for</strong>e <strong>the</strong> ones who need <strong>the</strong> most help do not get adequate attention. This lack of individual attention often<br />

leads to PT students having difficulty with <strong>the</strong> homework exercises. In <strong>the</strong> case of Calculus, help from friends is<br />

rare due to <strong>the</strong> nature of <strong>the</strong> subject. And to travel to <strong>the</strong> campus to seek <strong>the</strong> instructor would make sense only if<br />

<strong>the</strong> instructor is a full-time employee, and besides, PT students may not have <strong>the</strong> time to find <strong>the</strong> instructor outside<br />

of class. These difficulties are tackled by designing a web-site to supplement <strong>the</strong> first semester Calculus course.<br />

We called it <strong>the</strong> ITC (Introduction to Calculus) web-site.<br />

2. The ITC web-site (A prototype) http://www.sp.edu.sg/department/ms/Math/ITC/index.html<br />

The site aims at helping <strong>the</strong> PT students to obtain a more thorough understanding of <strong>the</strong> topics, and<br />

allows more advanced students to go in-depth and explore, making use of <strong>the</strong> vast resources from <strong>the</strong> Internet.<br />

Students and <strong>the</strong> instructor may use <strong>the</strong> discussion corner in ITC to conduct discussion asynchronously and work<br />

collaboratively. The site discusses <strong>the</strong> topics of Calculus on a weekly basis, following <strong>the</strong> syllabus of Calculus I.<br />

In <strong>the</strong> prototype presented here, a single topic on "Newton’s Method - an application of derivatives" is selected.<br />

The ITC web-site is presently on trial to a class of PT Mechanical and Manufacturing Engineering students taking<br />

<strong>the</strong> Engineering Ma<strong>the</strong>matics 2 (EM2) module in Singapore Polytechnic.<br />

2. The Design<br />

The ITC web-site was designed to allow self-paced learning and to tap <strong>the</strong> af<strong>for</strong>dances of networks and<br />

webs, i.e. increase access to in<strong>for</strong>mation; to communication; and to collaboration (Brackett, 1998). Eight<br />

components: Lecture Notes, Guided practice, On-line quiz, Homework, Beyond <strong>the</strong> Basics, Discussion Corner,<br />

Tools and FAQ were included in <strong>the</strong> web-site to achieve <strong>the</strong> objectives.<br />

(1) Lecture Notes--This component gives a summary of <strong>the</strong> face-to-face lecture on <strong>the</strong> topic of <strong>the</strong> week. Students<br />

could check in on this page to revise <strong>the</strong>ir own notes at <strong>the</strong>ir own pace. In particular, interactive examples (Java<br />

applets) are incorporated to allow <strong>the</strong> learners to observe <strong>the</strong> graphical representations of Newton’s Method with<br />

different inputs.<br />

(2) Guided Practice--This is a place where students can go over more examples in detail. This component<br />

contains samples of questions with guided solutions in a step by step manner. The students will have <strong>the</strong> option to<br />

supply <strong>the</strong> “next step” or ask <strong>for</strong> fur<strong>the</strong>r hints or solutions.<br />

[1] This project was first developed to fulfill <strong>the</strong> course requirement of T525-Designing Educational Experiences <strong>for</strong> Networks<br />

and Webs (Prof. George Brackett) at Harvard University. It was a joint project with my friends Maria Coulson and Robin<br />

Losey. The URL of <strong>the</strong> web-site: http://www.sp.edu.sg/department/ms/Math/ITC/index.html


(3) On-line Quiz--This component will be helpful <strong>for</strong> self-assessment. The quiz contains close-ended questions<br />

that can be used to gauge one’s understanding of <strong>the</strong> necessary skills and concepts of <strong>the</strong> topic.<br />

(4) Homework--This component provides <strong>the</strong> necessary in<strong>for</strong>mation and tools <strong>for</strong> working on <strong>the</strong> assignments.<br />

(5) Beyond <strong>the</strong> Basics--For <strong>the</strong> more advanced students, this component contains links to o<strong>the</strong>r relevant web pages<br />

and in<strong>for</strong>mation that encourage exploration beyond <strong>the</strong> minimum.<br />

(6) Discussion Corner--This area takes <strong>the</strong> <strong>for</strong>m of a threaded discussion. This is <strong>the</strong> place where <strong>the</strong> students can<br />

have asynchronous discussions and work collaboratively with <strong>the</strong>ir peers and <strong>the</strong> instructor. Students who have<br />

interesting questions or problems will be able to post <strong>the</strong>m to <strong>the</strong> discussion corner. O<strong>the</strong>r students, as well as <strong>the</strong><br />

instructor, will join in <strong>the</strong> discussions by providing answers, or hints to <strong>the</strong>se questions.<br />

(7) Tools--This component contains a collection of Java applets that are helpful in understanding and exploring<br />

<strong>the</strong> topic. These Java applets provide an opportunity to give a richer interaction with <strong>the</strong> material in terms of<br />

graphical exploration and calculations.<br />

(8) FAQ--Frequently Asked Questions from each topic will be included under <strong>the</strong> topic of <strong>the</strong> week. This<br />

component focuses on students’ questions ra<strong>the</strong>r than <strong>the</strong> instructor’s ideas.<br />

3. Pedagogical Approach<br />

In this setting, <strong>the</strong> web-site, toge<strong>the</strong>r with <strong>the</strong> email facility are integrated with <strong>the</strong> regular class meeting,<br />

class textbook, and lecture notes. The site is used as ano<strong>the</strong>r channel <strong>for</strong> students to seek feedback and help from<br />

<strong>the</strong> instructor and peers, to understand and explore more about <strong>the</strong> topics. The ultimate aim is to achieve teaching<br />

(as well as learning) <strong>for</strong> understanding. (Perkins, 1992)<br />

Basically, <strong>the</strong> ITC site is a second chance <strong>for</strong> a student who missed or needed to review <strong>the</strong> lesson(s) to<br />

acquire <strong>the</strong> clear in<strong>for</strong>mation of <strong>the</strong> topic. The Lecture Notes of <strong>the</strong> lesson of <strong>the</strong> week, in this case, Newton’s<br />

Method, not only teaches <strong>the</strong> learners <strong>the</strong> technique of applying <strong>the</strong> method, but also emphasizes how and when to<br />

use <strong>the</strong> method, in a concise manner. For students who need extra guidance, <strong>the</strong> step by step Guided Practice will<br />

equip <strong>the</strong> users with <strong>the</strong> necessary skills and concepts. The understanding of <strong>the</strong> concepts will be fur<strong>the</strong>r enhanced<br />

at <strong>the</strong> Discussion Corner and <strong>the</strong> FAQ, where <strong>the</strong> doubts and misconceptions will be discussed and clarified. The<br />

Java applets examples and tools will also help to make understanding <strong>the</strong> concept easier, both during <strong>the</strong> lecture<br />

and self-revision.<br />

From our experience as teachers, we know that if one can correctly explain a concept, she truly<br />

understands <strong>the</strong> concept. Thoughtful practices are enhanced by <strong>the</strong> assignments that focussed on assessing<br />

students’ understanding through open-ended questions (…/ITC/assign/index.html). Students are also encouraged<br />

to pose and answer questions, helping each o<strong>the</strong>r in <strong>the</strong> Discussion Corner (where <strong>the</strong>ir grades will be boosted by<br />

taking part actively in <strong>the</strong> discussions). In this way, <strong>the</strong> instructor, as well as <strong>the</strong> members of <strong>the</strong> class, will be <strong>the</strong><br />

key components in providing in<strong>for</strong>mative feedback to each o<strong>the</strong>r.<br />

On <strong>the</strong> whole, <strong>the</strong> existence of <strong>the</strong> web-site provides motivation. Older, re-entry students in general are<br />

back in school to achieve a specific goal: a diploma. They are (<strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> most part) extremely motivated to do well.<br />

Any opportunity <strong>for</strong> extra help and support will be motivating. Even if <strong>the</strong> student is not in a position to need<br />

extra help with <strong>the</strong> requirements, he will receive motivation in <strong>the</strong> extended opportunities in Beyond <strong>the</strong> Basics.<br />

Computer technology and <strong>the</strong> web make it possible to present graphs, figures, equations and text in an eyecatching<br />

appearing and meaningful manner. This might be enough to hook even <strong>the</strong> most nonchalant student.<br />

4. Discussion<br />

Some difficulties encountered during <strong>the</strong> trial run are: (1) Only half of <strong>the</strong> class (16 out of 31) have <strong>the</strong><br />

access to <strong>the</strong> WWW out of <strong>the</strong> campus, and not many students are posting and answering questions at <strong>the</strong><br />

Discussion Corner. It is thought that <strong>the</strong> situation could be improved by granting some financial aids in helping<br />

<strong>the</strong> students to gain access to <strong>the</strong> WWW. (2) Housing <strong>the</strong> web-site in <strong>the</strong> Polytechnic’s Internet server is<br />

inconvenient, not only in uploading files, but also in posting comments/questions at <strong>the</strong> ITC site. It is<br />

recommended that we should set up our own department’s server to alleviate some of <strong>the</strong>se problems.<br />

References:<br />

Perkins, D. (1992). Smart Schools: Better Thinking and Learning <strong>for</strong> Every Child. New York: The Free Press.<br />

Perkins, D. et al (1995). Software Goes to School: Teaching <strong>for</strong> Understanding with New Technologies. New<br />

York: Ox<strong>for</strong>d University Press.<br />

Brackett, G (1998). T525 course web-site. [Online: web]. Cited 22 Aug. 1998. URL:<br />

http://hgseclass.harvard.edu/t525/index.html


International Collaborative Learning – The Facilitation Process<br />

A.G. (Tony) Clear<br />

Academic Leader, Computing - Systems & Technology<br />

Auckland Institute of Technology<br />

New Zealand.<br />

Tony.Clear@ait.ac.nz<br />

Abstract: International collaborative learning is becoming more viable through a variety of Internet enabled software products. Group<br />

Support Systems appear to offer promise. But how to facilitate <strong>the</strong> teaching and learning process in electronic environments is not well<br />

understood. If education is to involve an interactive process of collaborative inquiry and dialogue between remote groups of learners, <strong>the</strong>n<br />

how to design meaningful learning experiences presents challenges in logistics, technology support, software design, and pedagogy. To better<br />

model <strong>the</strong> facilitation process in such environments, a <strong>the</strong>oretical framework based upon an extension of Adaptive Structuration Theory is<br />

suggested. This framework is <strong>the</strong>n related to experiences with custom application software development using Lotus Notes Domino,<br />

internal trials and a limited scale collaborative learning exercise between students at Auckland Institute of Technology and Uppsala<br />

University. The paper concludes with some recommendations <strong>for</strong> redesign of <strong>the</strong> application, suggests revisions to <strong>the</strong> collaborative process<br />

based upon <strong>the</strong> framework above and discusses fur<strong>the</strong>r extensions to <strong>the</strong> trials<br />

Introduction<br />

Numerous teaching and learning initiatives, frequently cited in conferences such as this, now include an Internet dimension. Different products such as<br />

<strong>the</strong> common “chat”, “email”, and “newsgroups”, are being used to support collaborative learning (Siviter, Petre & Klein, 1997). In <strong>the</strong> business<br />

environment, organisations seeking to link disparate global teams are increasingly using groupware products such as Lotus Notes (Lloyd &<br />

Whitehead 1996), and this <strong>for</strong>m of product appears to have much to offer to support collaborative learning processes (Galpin & Birchall 1996). In this<br />

paper when talking of collaborative learning, <strong>the</strong> term is being used in <strong>the</strong> sense suggested by Siviter, Petre & Klein, 1997. They place it in <strong>the</strong><br />

context of “groupwork”, broken down into three interrelated components of “communication, collaboration and coordination”. These activities in turn<br />

may be supported by groupware – a term “adopted to describe systems that support groupwork” (Siviter, Petre & Klein, 1997). “Groupware<br />

technologies provide electronic networks that support communication, collaboration and coordination through facilities such as in<strong>for</strong>mation exchange,<br />

shared repositories, discussion <strong>for</strong>ums and messaging. Such technologies are typically designed with an open architecture that is adaptable by end<br />

users allowing <strong>the</strong>m to customize existing features and create new applications”. (Orlikowski & Hofman, 1997) The Lotus Notes Domino<br />

application discussed in this paper can be categorised as an example of an open ended customizable groupware product, and of different time, different<br />

place groupware.<br />

Group Support Systems (GSS) is an alternative term <strong>for</strong> groupware. Previously termed Group Decision Support Systems (GDSS), which covered<br />

particularly that class of systems known as electronic meeting systems, <strong>the</strong> GDSS research generated <strong>the</strong> Adaptive Structuration Theory model<br />

(DeSanctis & Poole, 1994) discussed in this paper. Group Support Systems has been suggested as a generic term <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> field (Nunamaker et al.,<br />

1989), and defined by Whitworth (1997) as:<br />

"GSS: any system which supports a group interaction by becoming an integral part of that interaction"<br />

In this paper <strong>the</strong> terms GSS and groupware will be used somewhat interchangeably.<br />

Facilitation and Group Support Systems<br />

The Group Support Systems (GSS) field has turned its focus from more technocentric aspects, to broader study of how effective <strong>the</strong> technology is in<br />

use. Dennis and Gallupe (1993) have identified five stages of GSS research, which evidence this trend. Stage four covered field studies of <strong>the</strong><br />

organisational impact of GSS, and stage five an in depth focus on specific aspects - one of which is <strong>the</strong> role of <strong>the</strong> facilitator. A fur<strong>the</strong>r stage seems<br />

to be evolving, which focuses on organizational issues associated with <strong>the</strong> mutual influence of technology and social processes. This stage<br />

represents an extension from stage four’s focus on <strong>the</strong> more deterministic organizational impact of GDSS. A research approach based upon <strong>the</strong> study<br />

of <strong>the</strong>se interaction effects seems particularly suited to investigating <strong>the</strong> role of <strong>the</strong> facilitator in conjunction with GSS.<br />

It is apparent <strong>for</strong> instance, that <strong>the</strong> complexities of GSS use in <strong>the</strong> Electronic Meeting Support context, cannot sensibly be understood without inquiry<br />

into <strong>the</strong> interaction effects between dimensions of <strong>the</strong> group and <strong>the</strong> group process, <strong>the</strong> skills of <strong>the</strong> facilitator and <strong>the</strong> technology. Likewise in<br />

asynchronous groupware contexts an analysis of interaction effects may prove a productive approach to understanding <strong>the</strong> complexities of groupwork<br />

in <strong>the</strong>se distributed electronic environments. It has been suggested that “organizations need <strong>the</strong> experience of using groupware technologies in<br />

particular ways and in particular contexts to better understand how <strong>the</strong>y may be most useful in practice”. (Orlikowski & Hofman, 1997)<br />

This paper discusses a general framework <strong>for</strong> analysing technology facilitation roles. It is shown how this model might be applied to <strong>the</strong> facilitator<br />

role and provide a basis <strong>for</strong> an “interactionist” model <strong>for</strong> GSS’s, which may be extended to improve our understanding of <strong>the</strong> processes involved in<br />

electronic collaborative learning.<br />

Structuring Processes and In<strong>for</strong>mation Technology


Orlikowski and several colleagues have been following an interactionist line of research into In<strong>for</strong>mation Technology <strong>for</strong> some time. Their model of<br />

technology is structurationist in approach, based upon <strong>the</strong> work of Giddens (1984) and <strong>the</strong> concept of technology as an “occasion <strong>for</strong><br />

structuring”(Barley, 1986). Initial work identified <strong>the</strong> reflexive nature of In<strong>for</strong>mation Technology (IT) in which IT both shapes and is shaped by <strong>the</strong><br />

actions of users and <strong>the</strong> organisational context (Orlikowski, 1992). Subsequently <strong>the</strong> concepts of metastructuring and technology –use mediation<br />

(Orlikowski et al., 1995) are introduced as fur<strong>the</strong>r sources of structure. These two key terms of <strong>the</strong> Orlikowski model are defined as:<br />

1) Metastructuring While “The research on technology structuring...tends to focus primarily on <strong>the</strong> activities of users who shape <strong>the</strong>ir technology<br />

as <strong>the</strong>y use it in particular contexts”, [<strong>the</strong>re are] “ano<strong>the</strong>r set of activities that, although carried out by users, are not activities of use. Ra<strong>the</strong>r<br />

<strong>the</strong>y involve <strong>the</strong> shaping of o<strong>the</strong>r users activities of use, a process we designate as Metastructuring…The notion of metastructuring allows us to<br />

see that interventions in users’ use of technology occur frequently over time, in a variety of ways, and are often very influential”.(Orlikowski et<br />

al., 1995)<br />

2) Technology-use mediation Orlikowski et al. refer to “a particular type of metastructuring, technology-use mediation, and find that it<br />

structures users’ use of technology by influencing <strong>the</strong>ir interpretations and interactions, by changing <strong>the</strong> institutional context of use and by<br />

modifying <strong>the</strong> technology itself. Because technology-use mediation is a sanctioned, explicit, deliberate and ongoing set of activities, we argue<br />

that it is a particularly powerful mechanism in <strong>the</strong> context of dynamic organisations, enabling rapid and customised adaptations of <strong>the</strong><br />

technology and its use to changes in circumstances, organizational <strong>for</strong>m and work practices”.(Orlikowski et al., 1995)<br />

In <strong>the</strong>ir study of <strong>the</strong> use of a computer conferencing system in a Japanese R&D project group (Orlikowski et al., 1995), identified four different types<br />

of mediating activities that <strong>the</strong> network administration group members per<strong>for</strong>med. These were: 1) establishment: established role, determined and<br />

built consensus around use of <strong>the</strong> communication technology, established guidelines etc. <strong>for</strong> its use; 2) rein<strong>for</strong>cement: training, monitoring, and<br />

follow-up with members and <strong>the</strong> group to rein<strong>for</strong>ce <strong>the</strong> established guidelines; 3) adjustment: on <strong>the</strong> basis of feedback obtained from members,<br />

adjusted <strong>the</strong> definitions and usage rules <strong>for</strong> specific newsgroups and occasionally added new newsgroups on request; 4) episodic change: twice<br />

during <strong>the</strong> project, NAGA initiated major changes to <strong>the</strong> news system as a whole.<br />

Structuring and Facilitation Processes<br />

“Facilitation is a dynamic process that involves managing relationships between people, tasks and technology, as well as structuring tasks<br />

and contributing to <strong>the</strong> effective accomplishment of <strong>the</strong> meeting’s outcome”(Bostrom et al. 1993). It is argued here that both metastructuring<br />

and technology-use mediation are closely allied to <strong>the</strong> concept of facilitation in GSS environments, whe<strong>the</strong>r in synchronous or asynchronous modes.<br />

The Structure of a “Meeting”<br />

Bostrom et al. (1993) define a meeting as “a goal- or outcome-directed interaction between two or more people (teams, groups) that can take place in<br />

any of four environments (same time/same place, same time/different place, different time/same place, different time / different place)...Most GSS<br />

facilitation research has focused on face-to-face environments (same time/same place)”. In this paper by contrast, <strong>the</strong> collaborative learning trials<br />

have been designed to operate as an extended meeting, in <strong>the</strong> different time, different place environment.<br />

Bostrom et al. (1993) fur<strong>the</strong>r note that “meetings rarely die, <strong>the</strong>y just keep rolling along in a cycle of premeeting, meeting and postmeeting<br />

activities...The actual meeting is but one phase of a three-phase cycle of activities that constitute a meeting”. This fits with <strong>the</strong> shift from <strong>the</strong> earlier<br />

decisionist view of GDSS towards more of a concept of Group Support Systems, where <strong>the</strong> group decision-making processes are more ones of<br />

managing “issue streams”(Langley, Mintzberg et al., 1995), a model better suited to asynchronous than synchronous GSS. Elaborating upon<br />

Bostrom’s structure, Ackermann (1996) defines <strong>the</strong> concept of a “meeting” as broken into several stages:<br />

• <strong>the</strong> pre-meeting stage;<br />

• <strong>the</strong> meeting itself with three substages<br />

• introductory,<br />

• exploration and development,<br />

• closure<br />

• <strong>the</strong> post-meeting stage.<br />

Electronic Collaborative learning trial<br />

A collaborative electronic learning trial is now briefly described to enable a concrete exercise to be related to <strong>the</strong> concepts being developed in this<br />

paper. Some pilot trials had been conducted intra-institution at Auckland Institute of Technology with an experimental generic collaborative<br />

database developed using Lotus Notes Domino (Clear, 1998). Subsequently a cross institution collaborative trial had been arranged. This trial<br />

involved a Computer Science class at Uppsala University, collaborating with a class of Business students at Auckland Institute of Technology. The<br />

Uppsala group consisted of approximately 80 students and <strong>the</strong> New Zealand group approximately 20. Both groups were to collaborate on a common<br />

task involving a role play. The Auckland group were to be business analysts consulting to a local client, while <strong>the</strong> Uppsala group were a group of<br />

software game developers, with whom <strong>the</strong> Auckland consultants had to liaise. The purpose of <strong>the</strong> exercise was to jointly develop a feasibility study <strong>for</strong><br />

a computer game to support <strong>the</strong> client's need <strong>for</strong> a software product. The software product was to help young pharmacy assistants become more<br />

in<strong>for</strong>med about <strong>the</strong> client's nailcare product range. By better diagnosis of customers’ problems, greater sales of products and reduced instances of<br />

misdiagnosis and nail damage were expected to result. The project scenario thus represented an opportunity <strong>for</strong> problem based learning, (Boud, 1985)<br />

based upon a live business case.<br />

The trial took place over a 3-week period between September 22 nd and October 22 nd 1998. By <strong>the</strong> end of <strong>the</strong> exercise many of <strong>the</strong> students had made<br />

some progress in mastering <strong>the</strong> system, which had significant usability problems. The variety of different approaches and features used indicated a<br />

degree of ingenuity. Each combined group had come up with at least one design concept <strong>for</strong> a game, showing <strong>the</strong>y had thought about <strong>the</strong> problem,<br />

variously using <strong>the</strong> database or e-mail alone to express it with.<br />

In <strong>the</strong> definition of Bostrom et al (1993) above, this trial could be deemed a meeting.


Facilitation frameworks<br />

Bostrom et al. (1993) propose a framework <strong>for</strong> understanding and investigating facilitation in GSS environments. “ A given source of facilitation<br />

(external facilitator, leader, member, GSS) provides structures (e.g. agenda, procedures, GSS tools) and/or support (e.g. <strong>the</strong> facilitator administers a<br />

procedure, or deals with a disruptive participant) to a group in order to positively influence how <strong>the</strong> group accomplishes its outcomes. Structures<br />

provide an overall frame or context to activate individuals or groups to behave in a particular way. On <strong>the</strong> o<strong>the</strong>r hand support activities are used<br />

primarily to maintain and promote <strong>the</strong>se structures, encourage effective task and relational behaviors, and deal with disruptive influences in <strong>the</strong><br />

meeting. A facilitator, by his or her actions, attempts to influence three general targets: meeting process, relationships, and task outcomes. This<br />

facilitation framework may support several different levels of analysis - <strong>the</strong> individual, subgroup or entire group.<br />

Adaptive Structuration Theory (AST) has been suggested, as a <strong>the</strong>oretical perspective which “provides a general framework <strong>for</strong> investigations” of <strong>the</strong><br />

facilitation process. “From an AST perspective, <strong>the</strong> role of facilitation is to select and present beneficial structures to groups in a manner that<br />

encourages <strong>the</strong>ir faithful appropriation. A key construct within AST is appropriation. Appropriation is <strong>the</strong> process by which participants invoke or<br />

enact available structures (e.g. GSS, agenda, etc.) and <strong>the</strong>reby give meaning to <strong>the</strong>m...AST posits that <strong>the</strong> success of an appropriation is determined<br />

by three dimensions, <strong>the</strong> faithfulness (in respect to <strong>the</strong> structure’s design principles) of <strong>the</strong> appropriation, <strong>the</strong> group’s attitudes towards <strong>the</strong> structures,<br />

and <strong>the</strong> group’s level of consensus (i.e. agreement on how structures should be used). As we discussed earlier, a facilitator affects all three of <strong>the</strong>se<br />

modes through support activities: faithfulness through promotion and maintenance of structure; attitudes through activities that develop positive<br />

affect; and consensus through monitoring <strong>the</strong> group’s reactions and making appropriate adjustments.” (Bostrom et al., 1993)<br />

The AST model (DeSanctis & Poole, 1994) developed largely from a view of technology “as an occasion <strong>for</strong> structuring”(Barley, 1986), which<br />

reflects <strong>the</strong> interactions between <strong>the</strong> technology, <strong>the</strong> institutional features of <strong>the</strong> organization and <strong>the</strong> actions of individuals. The extensions to this<br />

brought through <strong>the</strong> concepts of metastructuring and <strong>the</strong> notion of technology-use mediation offer <strong>the</strong> opportunity to augment <strong>the</strong> AST model in a<br />

manner which should more directly and discretely support investigation of <strong>the</strong> facilitation process.<br />

Be<strong>for</strong>e developing <strong>the</strong> AST model to accommodate <strong>the</strong>se dimensions, some threads from this paper will be tied toge<strong>the</strong>r. The facilitator role is clearly<br />

difficult to model in any simple manner, and <strong>the</strong> different frameworks contrasted so far, help to fur<strong>the</strong>r confuse <strong>the</strong> picture. Which dimensions relate<br />

to one ano<strong>the</strong>r, and how should <strong>the</strong>y be depicted The classic GSS design constructs of “process support”, “process structure”, “task support, and<br />

“task structure” (Nunamaker et al., 1993), who define <strong>the</strong>m as follows, provide a useful starting point:<br />

• “Process Support - refers to <strong>the</strong> communication infrastructure (media, channels, and devices, electronic or o<strong>the</strong>rwise) that facilitates<br />

communication among members…such as an electronic communication channel or blackboard.<br />

• Process Structure - refers to process techniques or rules that direct <strong>the</strong> pattern, timing or content of this communication…such as an agenda or<br />

process methodology such as nominal Group Technique.<br />

• Task Support - refers to <strong>the</strong> in<strong>for</strong>mation and computation infrastructure <strong>for</strong> task-related activities…such as external databases and pop-up<br />

calculators.<br />

• Task Structure - refers to techniques, rules, or models <strong>for</strong> analyzing task related in<strong>for</strong>mation to gain new insight…such as those within computer<br />

models or Decision Support Systems (DSS).” (Nunamaker et al., 1993)<br />

Domains and Mechanisms <strong>for</strong> GSS Facilitation<br />

The table below attempts to link some aspects of <strong>the</strong> structuring and facilitation processes earlier described, to assess <strong>the</strong> role of <strong>the</strong> facilitator in <strong>the</strong><br />

context of <strong>the</strong> Uppsala – Auckland collaborative trial (Clear, <strong>1999</strong>).<br />

Domain Design Contingency Facilitation Means Facilitation Avenue<br />

Technology Process Support GSS parallel communication<br />

group memory<br />

group and individual contributions identifiable<br />

(as opposed to <strong>the</strong> usual anonymity in GSS)<br />

Scanner, Photoshop, Word<br />

Excel, text editors & GSS<br />

media effects (photos, diagrams files etc. as well<br />

as text)<br />

email<br />

Individual or mail group messages, combined<br />

with external/ internal facilitation and GSS use<br />

External/ internal electronic Registration database, database <strong>for</strong>ms and<br />

Institutional and<br />

Technology<br />

Institutional and<br />

Technology<br />

Process Structure<br />

Task Structure<br />

facilitation<br />

External/ internal facilitator,<br />

telephone, fax, email and GSS (in<br />

part)<br />

GSS<br />

External/ internal facilitator and<br />

GSS in Combination<br />

views, fax (as a last resort)<br />

Global process structuring<br />

e.g. establish collaboration, determine client,<br />

task & groups and advise, agree collaboration<br />

window setting, remote trial coordinators,<br />

project/group leaders<br />

Internal process structuring<br />

e.g. project, task, document, section, discussion<br />

threads, file attachments, on-line help,<br />

questionnaires, communication & use of naming<br />

standards<br />

use of GSS features such as project, document,<br />

and discussion thread hierarchies, views,<br />

hyperlinks and file attach/detach features plus<br />

remote trial coordinators, & project/group


Technology and<br />

institutional<br />

Task Support<br />

GSS<br />

External facilitator & email<br />

leaders<br />

Access to repository of std templates, group<br />

data, links with o<strong>the</strong>r applications e.g. Word or<br />

Excel. Specialised views and Database<br />

hierarchies. Database or email advice to groups<br />

and individuals<br />

Table 1 Domains and Mechanisms <strong>for</strong> GSS facilitation<br />

While <strong>the</strong> table shows some meaningful in<strong>for</strong>mation, it does not provide a clear framework <strong>for</strong> understanding <strong>the</strong> facilitator role. For instance, <strong>the</strong><br />

domain of individual’s actions, while implicit in each of <strong>the</strong> rows, is omitted, as is <strong>the</strong> area of relationships and specific support activities.<br />

Temporal Analysis of Mediating Activities and Relationships with GSS Facilitation<br />

In this next analysis a time dimension is included, and <strong>the</strong> four mediation activities of Orlikowski et al. (1995) are used to structure <strong>the</strong> comparison.<br />

Illustrative examples are again drawn from <strong>the</strong> collaborative trial. (Clear, <strong>1999</strong>)<br />

Mediating<br />

Activity<br />

Meeting Phase Design<br />

Contingency<br />

Facilitator Actions<br />

Establishment Pre-Meeting Process Support Set up physical<br />

parameters and features<br />

of <strong>the</strong> technology<br />

Pre-Meeting & Process<br />

Modify institutional<br />

Meeting -<br />

Structure properties of <strong>the</strong><br />

introductory (global)<br />

organization to facilitate<br />

technology assimilation<br />

Pre-Meeting &<br />

Meeting -<br />

introductory<br />

Rein<strong>for</strong>cement Meeting -<br />

exploration and<br />

development<br />

Meeting - closure<br />

Adjustment Meeting -<br />

exploration and<br />

development<br />

Meeting - closure<br />

Post meeting<br />

Meeting -<br />

exploration and<br />

development<br />

Meeting - closure<br />

Post meeting<br />

Episodic<br />

Change<br />

Process Support<br />

Process<br />

Structure<br />

Process Support<br />

Process<br />

Structure<br />

(internal)<br />

Task Support<br />

Task Structure<br />

Articulate <strong>the</strong> cognitive<br />

and behavioral routines<br />

through which <strong>the</strong><br />

technology may be<br />

appropriated by users<br />

maintain <strong>the</strong> operational<br />

fidelity of <strong>the</strong> technology<br />

help users adopt and use<br />

appropriate cognitive and<br />

behavioral routines to use<br />

<strong>the</strong> technology<br />

Adjust technical features<br />

of <strong>the</strong> technology to<br />

promote use<br />

Alter usage rules and<br />

procedures to facilitate<br />

<strong>the</strong> use of <strong>the</strong> technology<br />

Post meeting Process Support Redesign <strong>the</strong> technical<br />

functions and features of<br />

<strong>the</strong> technology<br />

Post meeting<br />

Post meeting<br />

Process<br />

Structure<br />

Process<br />

Structure<br />

Modify institutional<br />

properties of <strong>the</strong><br />

organization to facilitate<br />

change in technology use<br />

Redefine cognitive and<br />

behavioral routines to<br />

facilitate change in users<br />

appropriation of <strong>the</strong><br />

technology<br />

Example<br />

Confirm resources (system capacity, technical support etc.)<br />

Organise creation of collaboration database and registration<br />

database <strong>for</strong> participants<br />

Establish collaboration parameters (scope, purpose, content,<br />

participants & timing with partnering institution’s facilitator)<br />

Confirm suitability of task<br />

Determine assessment regime<br />

Communicate intentions and obtain participants’ consent<br />

Ensure a match is made between <strong>the</strong> problem task, and <strong>the</strong><br />

participants & facilitator’s skill levels<br />

Determine and communicate group numbers and membership<br />

Provide a clearly defined task or set of objectives and<br />

corresponding agenda<br />

Create and communicate an overview of <strong>the</strong> issue/problem (via<br />

facilitator at each site and posting instructions in database<br />

Advise process to register users<br />

Clarify roles and expectations<br />

Advise of help or o<strong>the</strong>r tutoring features available, such as guides,<br />

sample templates, naming standards etc.<br />

Check registration process, monitor entries, resolve access<br />

problems (<strong>for</strong>gotten passwords etc.).<br />

Check <strong>for</strong> activity level of participants, and resolve bugs,<br />

problems<br />

The GSS itself as facilitator (shaping of o<strong>the</strong>r user’s activities of<br />

use) - enabling participants to contribute freely<br />

Providing <strong>the</strong> participants with some <strong>for</strong>m of control<br />

Facilitator promotes use of <strong>the</strong> GSS system<br />

Facilitator communicates and educates re. use of GSS<br />

If facilitator is a developer, may fine tune views, <strong>for</strong>ms etc. to<br />

enhance usability<br />

Facilitator may advise technical support staff of problems needing<br />

attention (e.g. “out of file space” errors etc.)<br />

Facilitator may decide to deviate from plan of action and use<br />

different facilities of <strong>the</strong> GSS to support <strong>the</strong> meeting activity (e.g.<br />

attached files vs. document section entries)<br />

May advise new naming or o<strong>the</strong>r standards to enhance use<br />

May create new features e.g. on-line questionnaire <strong>for</strong> evaluations<br />

Facilitator as researcher may decide to recommend changes to<br />

clumsy or ineffective aspects of technology (e.g. upgrade views,<br />

redesign hierarchies that are too deep, improve navigation etc.<br />

Facilitator may recommend extensions or enhancements to GSS<br />

e.g. automatic links between registration and collaboration<br />

Databases to share email addresses within and between groups, or<br />

use of agents to link mail features more tightly with <strong>the</strong> GSS<br />

Determine a general ethical approval process <strong>for</strong> collaborations<br />

Set policy regarding summative vs. <strong>for</strong>mative assessment in trials<br />

Streamline <strong>the</strong> process of establishing fur<strong>the</strong>r collaborations, or<br />

extending <strong>the</strong> model to o<strong>the</strong>r courses<br />

Facilitator may decide to use different features of <strong>the</strong> technology<br />

<strong>for</strong> next collaboration (e.g. a ranking feature may be used to judge<br />

<strong>the</strong> merits of <strong>the</strong> design proposals submitted)<br />

Table 2 Temporal Analysis of Mediating Activities and Relationships with GSS Facilitation


From table 2 it can be seen that technology-use mediation does add to our understanding of <strong>the</strong> facilitation process, and can be incorporated into<br />

existing perspectives on <strong>the</strong> field of GSS and group facilitation.<br />

The Extended AST Model - Including GSS Facilitation<br />

Returning to <strong>the</strong> AST model, <strong>the</strong> above frameworks have suggested <strong>the</strong> value of technology-use mediation, but are relatively static as a base <strong>for</strong><br />

fur<strong>the</strong>r analysis. Given <strong>the</strong> inherently dynamic nature of <strong>the</strong> facilitation process, a model capable of reflecting that is required. The base AST<br />

constructs have been built upon to incorporate <strong>the</strong> technology-use mediation dimension. This now gives us an Extended AST Model, which<br />

includes technology-use mediation as a fur<strong>the</strong>r source and <strong>for</strong>m of structure within <strong>the</strong> model. At this stage <strong>the</strong> concept is generic, and could include<br />

o<strong>the</strong>r mediation roles such as systems administrators or designers, but <strong>the</strong> term technology-use mediator should be read to mean facilitator <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong><br />

purposes of this paper.<br />

Structure of Advanced<br />

In<strong>for</strong>mation Technology<br />

* structural features<br />

restrictiveness<br />

level of sophistication<br />

comprehensiveness<br />

* spirit<br />

decision process<br />

leadership<br />

efficiency<br />

conflict management<br />

atmosphere<br />

O<strong>the</strong>r Sources of Structure<br />

* task<br />

* organization environment<br />

* technology-use mediator<br />

(establishment &<br />

rein<strong>for</strong>cement)<br />

Group's Internal System<br />

* Styles of interacting<br />

* knowledge and experience<br />

with structures<br />

* perceptions of o<strong>the</strong>r's knowledge<br />

* agreement on appropriation<br />

P2<br />

P1<br />

Social Interaction<br />

Appropriation of Structures<br />

Decision Processes<br />

* Appropriation moves<br />

P5 * idea generation<br />

* faithfulness of appropriation<br />

* participation<br />

* instrumental uses<br />

* conflict management<br />

* persistent attitudes<br />

* influence behaviour<br />

toward appropriation<br />

* task management<br />

P3<br />

Emergent Sources of Structure<br />

P6<br />

* AIT outputs<br />

* task outputs<br />

* organization environment outputs<br />

* Technology-use mediator<br />

(adjustment)<br />

Decision outcomes<br />

* efficiency<br />

* quality<br />

* consensus<br />

* commitment<br />

P7<br />

P4<br />

New Social Structure<br />

* rules<br />

* resources<br />

* technology-use<br />

mediator (episodic)<br />

Figure 1 Summary of Major Constructs and Propositions of Extended AST Model [based upon figure 1 ex (DeSanctis & Poole, 1994)]<br />

The modified constructs are highlighted in <strong>the</strong> redrawn model (bold italics). Basically <strong>the</strong> three constructs dealing with sources and <strong>for</strong>ms of structure<br />

have been augmented;<br />

• O<strong>the</strong>r Sources of Structure<br />

• has had <strong>the</strong> technology-use mediator (facilitator) added, with <strong>the</strong> assumption that much of this intervention would occur during<br />

ei<strong>the</strong>r <strong>the</strong> establishment or rein<strong>for</strong>cement modes of activity as shown in table 2 above<br />

• Emergent Sources of Structure<br />

• has had <strong>the</strong> technology-use mediator (facilitator) added, with <strong>the</strong> assumption that much of this intervention would occur during <strong>the</strong><br />

adjustment mode of activity from table 2<br />

• New Social Structure<br />

• has had <strong>the</strong> technology-use mediator (facilitator) added, with <strong>the</strong> assumption that much of this intervention would occur during <strong>the</strong><br />

episodic mode of activity from table 2<br />

Conclusions<br />

The complexities of developing new <strong>for</strong>ms of collaborative electronic pedagogy defy simple analysis. The above model is an extension of a model<br />

developed to support research in <strong>the</strong> GSS field. It may be criticised <strong>for</strong> assuming that meetings result in decision outcomes. None<strong>the</strong>less it allows <strong>for</strong><br />

“meetings” to be broadly defined, and some aspects of <strong>the</strong> “outcomes” construct do apply to educational activities of this nature. Its strength lies in its<br />

ability to encompass <strong>the</strong> several dimensions at play in such learning environments.<br />

For instance in <strong>the</strong> Auckland-Uppsala trial several issues required attention. The collaborative task needed reconsideration, its scope was too<br />

ambitious in <strong>the</strong> time available and <strong>the</strong> degree of group interactivity demanded was too low. The process of establishing and assigning groups needs<br />

greater structure, probably through extra workflow features of <strong>the</strong> GSS. The organising elements and views of <strong>the</strong> database need simplification, and<br />

structures <strong>for</strong> rein<strong>for</strong>cing naming standards need to be more inbuilt than open to group selection. If anything <strong>the</strong> degree of genericity needs to be<br />

reduced and <strong>the</strong> application designed to more specifically suit <strong>the</strong> educational group collaborative context. The question of appropriation is an<br />

interesting one, given that half <strong>the</strong> groups were not faithful to <strong>the</strong> spirit of <strong>the</strong> groupware application, by choosing to use <strong>the</strong> more individualistic<br />

technology option of email. The extended AST model enables such issues to be discretely analysed in depth, but within a framework which does not<br />

omit <strong>the</strong> complex interaction effects.<br />

Initial uses of groupware <strong>for</strong> collaborative learning tend to occur at <strong>the</strong> intra-institution level (Siviter, Petre, Klein, 1997; Schrum 1997), but as interinstitutional<br />

collaborations grow, it becomes important that we find ways to increase <strong>the</strong>ir chances of success, and develop means to research <strong>the</strong><br />

effectiveness of such learning practices. The author intends to continue a programme of international collaborative learning trials. This extended<br />

AST model may be one means of better designing such trials, while considering all <strong>the</strong> relevant dimensions. It may also prove a useful means to<br />

analyse <strong>the</strong> complex interactions of actors, institutional factors and technology in groupware supported collaborative learning contexts.<br />

Acknowledgements


The author wishes to thank <strong>the</strong> NACCQ <strong>for</strong> a research grant to support this work, and <strong>the</strong> Auckland Institute of Technology <strong>for</strong> support through an<br />

Innovative Teaching Award. Thanks are due also to students and colleagues.<br />

References:<br />

Ackermann F. (1996), Participants Perceptions on <strong>the</strong> Role of Facilitators using Group Decision Support Systems, Group Decision and Negotiation 5; pp. 93 - 112<br />

Barley S., (1986), “Technology as an Occasion <strong>for</strong> Structuring: Evidence from Observation of CT Scanners and <strong>the</strong> Social Order of Radiology Departments”, Administrative<br />

Science Quarterly, 31, pp. 71 - 108<br />

Bostrom R., Anson R., Clawson K., (1993) Group Facilitation and Group Support Systems, In Jessup L. & Valacich J. (Eds) Group Support Systems: New Perspectives, New<br />

York, MacMillan<br />

Boud D., (1985) Problem Based Learning In Perspective. In D. Boud (Ed). Problem Based Learning In Education For The Professions (Pp 13 –18) Higher Education Research<br />

Society Of Australia.<br />

Clear A., (1998) A Generic Collaborative Database - Part of a strategy to internationalise <strong>the</strong> curriculum and develop teamwork and communication capabilities, <strong>Proceedings</strong> Of<br />

The ITICSE’98 Conference, p. 274, ACM Press<br />

Clear A., (<strong>1999</strong>) A Collaborative Learning Trial between New Zealand and Sweden – Using Lotus Notes Domino in Teaching <strong>the</strong> Concepts of Human Computer Interaction, in<br />

<strong>Proceedings</strong> of <strong>the</strong> ITiCSE’99 Conference Cracow Poland, ACM, in press<br />

Dennis A., Gallupe R.B., (1993), “A History of GSS Empirical Research: Lessons Learned and Future Directions.” in Jessup L, Valacich J,. (1993) Group Support Systems: New<br />

perspectives, New York MacMillan<br />

DeSanctis G., (1993), “Shifting Foundations In Group Support System Research.” in Jessup L, Valacich J,. Group Support Systems: New perspectives, New York MacMillan<br />

DeSanctis G., MS. Poole (1994), “Capturing The Complexity In Advanced Technology Use: Adaptive Structuration Theory”, Organization Science 5;2 pp.121 - 147<br />

Galpin F., & Birchall D., (1996), Henley College Of Management: Developing A Global Business School, in Lloyd P., Whitehead R., (Eds) Trans<strong>for</strong>ming Organisations<br />

Through Groupware: Lotus Notes In Action, pp. 101 – 108 Springer Verlag, London<br />

Giddens A., (1984), The Constitution of Society, Polity Press Cambridge<br />

Langley A., Mintzberg H., Pitcher P., Posada E. & J Saint-Macary, (1995) Opening Up Decision Making : The View From The Black Stool, Organization Science 6;3 May-Jun<br />

1995 pp. 260 -279<br />

Lloyd P., Whitehead R., (1996) (Eds) Trans<strong>for</strong>ming Organisations Through Groupware: Lotus Notes In Action, Springer Verlag, London<br />

Nunamaker J., Dennis A., Konsynski B. (1989), Interaction Of Task and Technology to Support Large Groups, Decision Support Systems, 5, 139-152, cited in Whitworth B.,<br />

(1997) below<br />

Nunamaker J., Dennis A., Valacich J., Vogel D., George J., (1993), “Group Support Systems Research: Experience from <strong>the</strong> Lab and Field” in Jessup L, Valacich J,. Group<br />

Support Systems: New perspectives Chapter 7, New York MacMillan<br />

Orlikowski W., (1992), The Duality Of Technology: Rethinking The Concept Of Technology In Organizations, Organization Science, 3;3 pp. 398 - 427<br />

Orlikowski W., Hofman J., (1997) An Improvisational Model For Change Management: The Case Of Groupware Technologies, Sloan Management Review, Winter, pp. 11 - 21<br />

Orlikowski W., Yates J., Okamura K., Fujimoto M., (1995) Shaping Electronic Communication: The Metastructuring of Technology in <strong>the</strong> Context of Use, Organization Science,<br />

6;4 pp. 423 - 444<br />

Schrum L., (1997), Creating Collaborative Learning Environments: The Challenge For Distant Learners, <strong>Proceedings</strong> of <strong>ED</strong>-M<strong>ED</strong>IA 97 & <strong>ED</strong>-TELECOM 97, pp. 51 –57,<br />

AACE, Virginia<br />

Siviter D., Petre M., Klein B., (1997), Harnessing technology <strong>for</strong> effective inter- and intra-institutional collaboration, Report Of The ITICSE’97 Working Group On Supporting<br />

Inter- And Intra-Institutional Collaboration, ITICSE’97 Working Group Reports and Supplemental <strong>Proceedings</strong>, pp. 70 –93 ACM Press<br />

Whitworth B., (1997), Generating Group Agreement In Cooperative Computer Mediated Groups: Towards An Integrative Model Of Group Interaction, PHD Thesis, University<br />

of Waikato


Learning in Safety and Com<strong>for</strong>t: Towards Managing On-Line Learning Transactions<br />

by<br />

Dianne L. Conrad (dianne.contrad@ualberta.ca)<br />

and<br />

Hea<strong>the</strong>r Kanuka (hea<strong>the</strong>r.kanuka@ualberta.ca)<br />

Abstract: How can <strong>the</strong> teaching-learning process serve distance learners as well as possible This paper presents a<br />

framework <strong>for</strong> accommodating learners’ transitions through <strong>the</strong> developmental stages associated with <strong>the</strong> introduction<br />

of technologies in learning.<br />

Introduction<br />

Although in <strong>the</strong> last few years we have witnessed tremendous growth in increasing access to higher education learning opportunities, <strong>the</strong>re are still many populations that are educationally<br />

marginalized. Individuals in <strong>the</strong>se areas experience situational barriers that prevent <strong>the</strong>m from accessing higher education - most notably, geographic isolation, wea<strong>the</strong>r, course and program<br />

scheduling, family commitments, employment and financial responsibilities. For <strong>the</strong> past 15 years, <strong>the</strong> University of Alberta's Faculty of Education has delivered a single-point outreach Bachelor<br />

of Education in Adult Education program to meet this need through a combination of print, on-site delivery, and audio-conferencing.<br />

As <strong>the</strong> demand <strong>for</strong> undergraduate and graduate programs in adult education <strong>for</strong> geographically dispersed learners continued to rise, <strong>the</strong> Department of Educational Policy Studies at <strong>the</strong> University<br />

of Alberta was granted approval to expand <strong>the</strong> Bachelor of Education (Adult Education specialty) and <strong>the</strong> Masters of Education in Adult and Higher Education to a multi-point delivery system.<br />

Extending <strong>the</strong> university's reach to a wider geographic audience required intelligent choices of available technological software and hardware. As McCullough & McCullough (1994) so aptly<br />

stated: "Finding a suitable match between <strong>the</strong> capabilities of <strong>the</strong> technology and <strong>the</strong> needs of learners is <strong>the</strong> key challenge" (p. 29). A decision was made to use a combination of web-based<br />

instruction, video or audio conferencing, and computer conferencing <strong>for</strong> a multi-point delivery program.<br />

While <strong>the</strong> integration of technologies to <strong>the</strong> outreach program supported <strong>the</strong> activities that traditional, on-campus classrooms supported, it was not without its own problems, <strong>the</strong> most notable of<br />

which was helping learners achieve a high level of com<strong>for</strong>t with <strong>the</strong> Internet as a learning environment. As we began delivering programs using <strong>the</strong> mixed technologies, among <strong>the</strong> many<br />

problems that became apparent was learner resistance to using <strong>the</strong> Internet in a way that constructively supported a community of learners.<br />

This paper will examine distance learning experiences in terms of learners' learning styles, <strong>the</strong> strategies <strong>the</strong>y developed to accommodate <strong>the</strong>ir learning tendencies, <strong>the</strong>ir motivation levels, and<br />

<strong>the</strong>ir communication processes.<br />

Learner Resistance: Shock, Surrender, and Success<br />

As institutions of higher education explore <strong>the</strong> use of technologies while implementing new distance learning programs, <strong>the</strong>y find that <strong>the</strong> learning curve <strong>for</strong> adults is a steep and slippery slope.<br />

Although <strong>the</strong>re has been enormous advancement in making Internet software user-friendly, research conducted on <strong>the</strong> use of technologies in <strong>the</strong> teaching-learning process reveals that using <strong>the</strong><br />

Internet as a learning environment continues to trouble more adult learners, and a recent poll indicates that <strong>the</strong> Internet ranks one of <strong>the</strong> least favorite ways to learn (Daniel, 1996). And while<br />

"online education offers a means to educators in assisting people in overcoming situational barriers... <strong>the</strong> very technology that has allowed us to overcome those situational barriers may <strong>for</strong>m <strong>the</strong><br />

basis of a dispositional barrier, namely computer anxiety" (Lauzon, 1991).<br />

Woods (1994) observes that students <strong>for</strong>ced to take major responsibility <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong>ir own learning experience some or all of <strong>the</strong> steps that psychologists associate with trauma and grief: shock,<br />

denial, strong emotion, resistance and withdrawal, surrender and acceptance, struggle and exploration, return of confidence, integration and success. Not surprisingly, traditional students using<br />

computer technologies experience <strong>the</strong> same pattern that Woods describes in his article, "Traditional students in a nontraditional class: A painful odyssey." Using Woods' model, following is a<br />

brief description of each stage that we observed in our program.<br />

1. Shock: I don't believe it! She really thinks she is going to make us use <strong>the</strong> computer <strong>for</strong> this course!<br />

2. Denial: She can't be serious! No way am I going to do it. She can't make me. This is not <strong>the</strong> way we do <strong>the</strong>se courses. She doesn't understand how we do things. There is no need to<br />

change <strong>the</strong> way we do things. She can't be serious...<br />

3. Strong emotion: Wow, she is serious! I can't do it. I don't know how to install <strong>the</strong> software. I can't do group work using <strong>the</strong> computer. I can't type well enough. I'll fail this course. I<br />

can't do it. I'd better drop <strong>the</strong> course. She can't make me do this. I'm going to complain to someone above her.<br />

4. Resistance and withdrawal: OK, I need this course. I can't drop out. But I am not going to do it her way. I will do it my way. No way is anyone going to make me use <strong>the</strong><br />

computer. I will get someone to print out all <strong>the</strong> in<strong>for</strong>mation. I will ei<strong>the</strong>r mail in or fax my assignments. I will do this-but it will be my way!<br />

5. Surrender and acceptance: OK, so I can't get through <strong>the</strong> course without having to do things her way. This is really stupid, but if I am going to do this course, I'll have to use <strong>the</strong><br />

computer. I'll probably get a really bad mark-but it is a bad course with a bad instructor.<br />

6. Struggle and exploration: Hmmm, o<strong>the</strong>rs seem to be doing fine. Maybe I can do this too. My colleagues at work think that it is sort of neat that I am using <strong>the</strong> Internet <strong>for</strong> my<br />

course. Maybe this isn't all bad. Maybe I need to try a little harder.<br />

7. Return of confidence: Hey, am I good at this or what! I had no idea how easy <strong>the</strong> computer is to use. I might even do well in this course.<br />

8. Integration and success: Using <strong>the</strong> computer <strong>for</strong> this course was one of <strong>the</strong> best learning experiences I have ever had! I don't know why I thought I would have a problem learning<br />

this way. It's been a great experience!<br />

Based on our instructional team's observations, interactions, and participants' learning journals, research showed that learners adapting to new technologies and methodologies experience<br />

resistance. This is in agreement with much of <strong>the</strong> literature that states most adult learners experience resistance based on <strong>the</strong>ir expectations, <strong>the</strong>ir learning histories, and <strong>the</strong>ir predisposition to<br />

learning (Garrison and Shale, 1990; Garrison, 1989). Moore and Kearsley (1996) claim that as many students have little experience learning at a distance, <strong>the</strong>y may be apprehensive about taking<br />

distance education course. This apprehension is fur<strong>the</strong>r confounded when <strong>the</strong> Internet is integrated into <strong>the</strong>ir learning environments.<br />

Instructional Strategies to Overcome Resistance<br />

Without <strong>the</strong> support provided by an instructor's physical presence and <strong>the</strong> com<strong>for</strong>t of a classroom, what should instructors know that can assist learners in making <strong>the</strong> transition through <strong>the</strong><br />

developmental stages associated with new experiences: from initial shock through <strong>the</strong> reluctance of surrender to ultimate integration and success (Woods, 1994). A number of strategies that we


found to be effective are well documented in <strong>the</strong> literature. For example, according to Moore and Kearsley (1996), <strong>the</strong> support that is provided <strong>for</strong> students should reflect factors related to both<br />

instructional credibility and au<strong>the</strong>nticity. That is, learners should be assured of <strong>the</strong> level of content solidity and reputability as well as feeling com<strong>for</strong>table that <strong>the</strong>ir needs are being met through<br />

<strong>the</strong> application of what have come to be known as humanistic tendencies – kindness, humanness, "walking-<strong>the</strong>-talk," or <strong>the</strong> alignment of what is said to what is done (Brookfield, 1990).<br />

Moore & Kearsley (1996) emphasize that <strong>the</strong> in<strong>for</strong>mation given to learners has to be perceived as up-to-date and relevant, and authoritative in its applicability. Content should be delivered<br />

flexibly in order to accommodate varying needs, learning styles, and schedules. But, beyond that, learners need to be buoyed by <strong>the</strong>ir confidence in <strong>the</strong> institutional au<strong>the</strong>nticity that envelopes <strong>the</strong><br />

delivery of first-class content. They probably require, and should receive, guidance in determining what and how to study; <strong>the</strong>y need to be provided with relevant opportunities to apply <strong>the</strong>ir<br />

learning, through <strong>the</strong> vehicles of assignments and projects; <strong>the</strong>y require constructive and timely feedback on <strong>the</strong>ir progress and assistance in dealing with program-related administrative problems<br />

and difficulties that arise along <strong>the</strong> way.<br />

Similarly, Willis (1993) argues that ef<strong>for</strong>ts should be made to better meet <strong>the</strong> needs of distance learners in a number of ways that, once again, emphasize <strong>the</strong> au<strong>the</strong>nticity of <strong>the</strong> institution, <strong>the</strong><br />

instructor, and reflect <strong>the</strong> andragogical understanding that participants must take active roles in <strong>the</strong> distance-delivered course. Learners should be made aware of, and made com<strong>for</strong>table with, <strong>the</strong><br />

communication methodology – hardware and software and accompanying processes – that will be used <strong>for</strong> course delivery. In an anticipatory fashion, learners should be prepared <strong>for</strong> dealing<br />

with <strong>the</strong> technical problems that will inevitably arise. They should be encouraged to build community across <strong>the</strong> distance through invitations to share <strong>the</strong>ir interests, backgrounds and <strong>the</strong>ir<br />

experiences; this activity can be modeled by <strong>the</strong> instructor. Resulting emphases on learners’ individuality will spark sensitivity to different communication styles and varying cultural histories.<br />

Learning’s affective domain, so often so well tended to in traditional classrooms by instructors sensitive to adults’ learning needs, is as important, if not more so, in <strong>the</strong> establishment of a<br />

com<strong>for</strong>table virtual classroom. Race’s (1994) description of a successful student support system includes making learners feel at ease and building <strong>the</strong>ir confidence by helping <strong>the</strong>m feel that<br />

<strong>the</strong>y’re not alone in <strong>the</strong>ir struggle. Learners should be reassured that o<strong>the</strong>r learners are having <strong>the</strong> same problems, that <strong>the</strong>y are not alone in <strong>the</strong> mistakes <strong>the</strong>y make. Open up <strong>the</strong> communication<br />

channels <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> exchange of in<strong>for</strong>mation – phone numbers and addresses and so on. These strategies remind learners that even <strong>the</strong> hardest things can be mastered one step at a time; in giving<br />

study skills advice, <strong>the</strong> instructor demonstrates that she is <strong>the</strong>re to help, not just to evaluate and assess. In a similar vein, instructors can share practical or personal advice on examination<br />

techniques and work to instill confidence in learners <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> writing of exams or <strong>the</strong> accomplishment of o<strong>the</strong>r <strong>for</strong>midable tasks. Keep learners focussed on <strong>the</strong> picture beyond <strong>the</strong> course: what will<br />

<strong>the</strong>y do next What are <strong>the</strong> next learning opportunities that will be presented<br />

The <strong>for</strong>egoing techniques are all essential parts of extending a learning community virtually – beyond <strong>the</strong> traditional classroom’s parameters. However, more importantly, <strong>the</strong> factors listed below<br />

should provide a broader, more conceptual framework <strong>for</strong> instructors introducing virtual education to <strong>the</strong>ir teaching methodologies. Specifically, it was our experience that understanding <strong>the</strong>se<br />

elements was essential to success when integrating technologies in a distance program.<br />

Good pedagogy will always reflect a human quality. The reality is that learning technologies will not miraculously metamorphose bad instructors into good ones. They will not increase <strong>the</strong><br />

quality of learning. Good pedagogy will <strong>for</strong>ever contain a human element that includes interaction in <strong>the</strong> learning process. In <strong>the</strong> end it is <strong>the</strong> level of <strong>the</strong> interaction between <strong>the</strong> learners, <strong>the</strong><br />

instructor, and <strong>the</strong> content that will determine <strong>the</strong> quality of a learner's educational experience—whe<strong>the</strong>r it is face-to-face or distributed learning using <strong>the</strong> Internet.<br />

Good pedagogy precedes good technology. The value of technologies as a communication medium in <strong>the</strong> learning process is directly related to <strong>the</strong> learners' need. A paramount problem with<br />

much of <strong>the</strong> current technically- enhanced instruction has to do with <strong>the</strong> fact that many instructors are finding that most technologies are relatively easy to learn and many of <strong>the</strong> features are<br />

seductive. This often results in good teaching practices (instructional design, significance, depiction, reflective thought) being subsumed because it is fun to play with <strong>the</strong> media. Almost anyone<br />

can learn how to use technologies; <strong>the</strong> difficult but critical component, however, is to integrate what we know about how our learners learn with technological expertise. Technology integration is<br />

nei<strong>the</strong>r economically nor educationally justifiable without meaningful interaction between <strong>the</strong> learners, <strong>the</strong> instructor and <strong>the</strong> content.<br />

Creating pedagogically sound technology enhanced instructional materials takes time and requires new skills. Most educators are usually surprised and <strong>the</strong>n overwhelmed at <strong>the</strong> time and skills<br />

required when developing distance education materials. YES! It takes time and requires new skills; it also requires <strong>the</strong> support of and collaboration from individuals who have competencies in<br />

using learning technologies.<br />

One technology alone is not effective. The web is a wonderful medium <strong>for</strong> disseminating in<strong>for</strong>mation, facilitating learner-content interaction and aiding assessment (instructor, learner, and<br />

course). Reading materials also facilitate learner-content interaction. Computer mediated communication helps to facilitate learner-learner and learner-instructor interaction in addition to building<br />

a community of learners, as do audio and videoconferencing and face-to-face instruction. Effective technology integration will include learner-learner interaction, learner-instructor interaction,<br />

learner-content interaction and support learning communities. The provision of <strong>the</strong>se elements necessitates <strong>the</strong> integration of a number of technologies such as web-based instruction, computermediated<br />

conferencing, video and audio communication, print based media, and face-to-face instruction.<br />

Know each technology's strength and weakness. Every educator's decision to integrate technologies in <strong>the</strong> learning process needs to be based upon an in<strong>for</strong>med understanding of <strong>the</strong>ir strengths<br />

and weakness. Upon deciding to use <strong>the</strong> technologies, educators should have a sound understanding of how to use <strong>the</strong>m as a learning environment, communication medium and as a tool in <strong>the</strong><br />

learning process.<br />

Conclusion<br />

The integration of technologies into <strong>the</strong> learning environment has tremendous potential to remove many situational barriers to learning opportunities. More importantly, however, technology<br />

integration can provide opportunities <strong>for</strong> learner-learner and learner-instructor interaction in a way that could not, previously, be economically or educationally justified in distance education. In<br />

spite of <strong>the</strong> problems outlined in this paper, <strong>the</strong>se developments offer very exciting opportunities <strong>for</strong> distance educators to provide rich and meaningful learning experiences <strong>for</strong> outreach students.<br />

References<br />

Brookfield. S. (1990). The Skillful Teacher. San Francisco: Jossey-Bass.<br />

Daniel, J. (1996). Mega-Universities and knowledge media: Technology strategies <strong>for</strong> higher education. Great Britain: Biddles Ltd.<br />

Garrison, D. R. & Shale, D. (1990). (Eds.) Education at a Distance: From Issues to Practice. Florida: Robert E. Krieger.<br />

Garrison, D. R. (1989). Understanding Distance Education: A framework <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> future. London: Routledge.<br />

Lauzon, A. (1991). Enhancing accessibility to meaningful earning opportunities: A pilot project in online education at <strong>the</strong> University of Guelph. Research in Distance Education. (3)4. 2-5.<br />

McCullough, K. & McCullough, J. S. (1994). The promise of <strong>the</strong> telecommunications superhighway: Conquering <strong>the</strong> limits of time and space in adult education. Adult Learning.<br />

November/December. 28-29.<br />

Moore, M. G. & Kearsley, G. (1996). Distance education: A systems view. Scarborough, ON.: Wadsworth Publishing Company.<br />

Race, P. (1994). The open learning handbook. London: Kogan Page.<br />

Willis, B. (1993). Distance education: A practical guide. Englewood Cliffs, NJ.: Educational technology publications.<br />

Woods, D. R. (1994). Problem-based learning: How to gain <strong>the</strong> most from PBL.Waterdown, ON.: Donald R. Woods.


Networking The Nation<br />

Noel Craske<br />

Senior Lecturer. Monash University, Australia.<br />

noel.craske@csse.monash.edu.au<br />

George Murdoch<br />

VISE Course Co-ordinator. Australia.<br />

gmurdock@tpgi.com.au<br />

Arno Besse<br />

IT Technician and Internet Trainer. Ballarat University, Australia.<br />

a.besse@ballarat.edu.au<br />

Marijke Heywood<br />

IT Trainer and Web Publications. Ballarat University, Australia.<br />

m.heywood@ballarat.edu.au<br />

Joy Nunn<br />

Course Co-ordinator/Project Manager. Ballarat University, Australia,<br />

j.nunn@ballarat.edu.au<br />

The Australian Government Networking <strong>the</strong> Nation Project is using <strong>the</strong> Internet to bring Educational and Community services to<br />

Isolated and Remote communities.<br />

The project training course creates a community of Internet trainers who <strong>the</strong>n become trainers in various hubs of <strong>the</strong> bush. As each<br />

training course and subsequent placements occur <strong>the</strong>re is an expansion in <strong>the</strong> number of people using e-mail, conferencing, news group, WWW<br />

and chat sessions. To people in <strong>the</strong> bush, isolated by enormous distances, this provides <strong>the</strong> com<strong>for</strong>t and support that many urban Australians take<br />

<strong>for</strong> granted. This project has placed a magnifying glass on <strong>the</strong> reality of telecommunication services in <strong>the</strong> outback where even a reliable power<br />

source is still a dream <strong>for</strong> many inhabitants.<br />

The Project<br />

“Internet to <strong>the</strong> Outback” is part-funded through <strong>the</strong> Federal Government’s “Networking <strong>the</strong> Nation” program - an initiative designed<br />

to give everyone, living anywhere in Australia, access to <strong>the</strong> Internet at <strong>the</strong> end of a five year period. All families in remote or isolated areas of<br />

country Australia are eligible to receive visits from Volunteers <strong>for</strong> Isolated Students’ Education (VISE).<br />

Summary of Progress (Specifics may be found at http://www.ballarat.edu.au/vise)<br />

Training<br />

The training syllabus used to instruct <strong>the</strong> trainers and which <strong>the</strong> trainers in turn use to instruct <strong>the</strong> isolated families/communities has<br />

been developed. Each trainer can link a family to <strong>the</strong> Web and train <strong>the</strong>m to use email and access <strong>the</strong> Web in less than <strong>the</strong> week originally<br />

suggested. Experience demonstrates it is possible to average two per week over a six-week period and allow <strong>for</strong> un<strong>for</strong>eseen problems and <strong>the</strong><br />

differing stages of development of families.<br />

Equipment<br />

We recommend buying from ei<strong>the</strong>r a reputable national retailer offering a good warranty and a reliable network of service centres or<br />

from a company offering a proven mail order service <strong>for</strong> high quality equipment who are able to support <strong>the</strong> equipment with warranties fully<br />

covering transportation costs in <strong>the</strong> event of a service requirement.<br />

Connection<br />

The quality of <strong>the</strong> modem has been <strong>the</strong> definitive factor in connecting to <strong>the</strong> World Wide Web, thus it would be better to buy a<br />

computer and add an external modem ra<strong>the</strong>r than buy a machine with an internal modem installed.<br />

Concerns and Problems<br />

Quality of Telephone Lines and Services.<br />

The single most outstanding feature with regard to <strong>the</strong> speed was variation in both <strong>the</strong> quality and reliability of existing<br />

communications links.<br />

The single most common problem associated with data communication was line noise. A good modem is essential as it has <strong>the</strong> error<br />

correction ability to compensate <strong>for</strong> a number of connection problems. However, no modem regardless of quality can provide adequate<br />

connection speeds in some of <strong>the</strong> areas tested.<br />

Availability of Communication Access


In many areas, access to communication links is becoming limited by congestion as <strong>the</strong> available number of simultaneous connections<br />

is reached. Internet connection and <strong>the</strong> resulting longer connection periods will only increase this problem.<br />

Quality of Power Supply<br />

This can indirectly affect communications. Many properties are on <strong>the</strong> SWER (Single Wire Earth Return). Power supplied was often<br />

inconsistent and subject to surges and brown-out which have <strong>the</strong> capacity to seriously damage computer and o<strong>the</strong>r communications equipment.<br />

Generators on properties where reticulated power is unavailable can also supply less than quality power. Electrical noise suppression equipment<br />

was in many cases below standard or non existent.<br />

The Cost of Telephone Calls to Access <strong>the</strong> Internet.<br />

Viruses<br />

There is a disparity in call charging and a total confusion about <strong>the</strong> multitude of options available to remote consumers.<br />

A virus attack in an isolated community, without local expertise or access to up-to-date virus eradication tools, could easily render <strong>the</strong><br />

system useless and instantly isolate <strong>the</strong> community from <strong>the</strong> Internet. A good anti virus program is essential, but because of <strong>the</strong> lack of local<br />

expertise more than just a good program is necessary. For this reason we recommend <strong>the</strong> locally produced “Vet” product from Computer<br />

Associates (<strong>for</strong>mally Cybec). Apart from being an internationally recognised leader in anti-virus technology <strong>the</strong> support services offered by<br />

Computer Associates are uniquely suited to isolated communities. (http://www.cybec.com.au).<br />

Lessons Learnt<br />

Firstly, it is much cheaper to take one trainer to ten people than is <strong>the</strong> reverse. Secondly our training <strong>the</strong> trainer model provides a<br />

valuable ongoing resource <strong>for</strong> Australian families in remote areas to access and use <strong>the</strong> Net.<br />

The inadequacies of <strong>the</strong> existing system will become more apparent as properties take advantage of <strong>the</strong> Internet to <strong>the</strong> Outback<br />

program and connect to <strong>the</strong> Internet. Telecommunications providers should be looking at providing data transfer at rates that match <strong>the</strong> best<br />

modem levels now available. A speed of no less than 33600 should be <strong>the</strong> minimum acceptable rate. Most remote areas would be happy to<br />

achieve speeds above 9600.<br />

Web Central<br />

Monash students are currently developing a web site to facilitate many aspects of <strong>the</strong> VISE project. The development address is be<br />

http://gupta.ct.monash.edu.au/vise.Visitors should appreciate that it will be in a state of developmental flux <strong>for</strong> most of <strong>1999</strong>, however visitor<br />

feedback will be carefully considered and gratefully appreciated.<br />

Conclusion<br />

Emerging satellite services may prove to be a more cost-effective method of providing reliable access to all Internet services. The<br />

response to <strong>the</strong> “Internet to <strong>the</strong> Outback” project by has demonstrated an overwhelming need <strong>for</strong> hands-on training to be delivered in <strong>the</strong> bush.<br />

Many of <strong>the</strong> people involved directly and indirectly in <strong>the</strong> project have indicated that previous projects, although providing hardware to outback<br />

properties, have not achieved <strong>the</strong>ir expected outcomes. The commitment of <strong>the</strong> volunteers to invest <strong>the</strong>ir time into <strong>the</strong> project is having multiple<br />

pay-offs <strong>for</strong> participants in taking <strong>the</strong> Internet to <strong>the</strong> bush. The project has listened to <strong>the</strong> needs of people in <strong>the</strong> bush and is delivering “bush<br />

solutions”. The success can be attributed to simply listening to <strong>the</strong> users, a strategy too often overlooked in our rush to spread <strong>the</strong> technological<br />

message with hardware alone.<br />

References<br />

Candy, P. (1991). Self-direction <strong>for</strong> life-long learning: A comprehensive guide to <strong>the</strong>ory and practice. San Francisco: Jossey-Bass.<br />

Freire, P. and Shor, I. (1987). A pedagogy <strong>for</strong> liberation: Dialogues on trans<strong>for</strong>ming education. London. Macmillan Education. IRL. (1998). IRL<br />

Seven Principles. Institute <strong>for</strong> Research on Learning, <br />

Kemmis, S. and McTaggart, R. (1988). The Action Research Planner, 3rd. ed. Deakin University Press.<br />

Laurillard, D. (1993). Rethinking university teaching: A framework <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> effective use of educational technology. London: Routledge.<br />

Negroponte, N. (1995). Being Digital: <strong>the</strong> road map <strong>for</strong> survival on <strong>the</strong> in<strong>for</strong>mation superhighway. Australia: Hodder & Stoughton.<br />

Oldenburg, R. (1989). The great good place. New York: Paragon House.<br />

Owen, J. (1993). Program evaluation: Forms and approaches. NSW: Allen and Unwin.<br />

Petre, D. (1996). The clever country: Australia's digital future. NSW: Landsdowne Publishing.<br />

Rogers, C. (1969). Freedom to learn. Ohio: Merrill Publishing.<br />

Rural Industries Research and Development Corporation (RIRDC) (1997). The Australian Farmers Guide to <strong>the</strong> Internet, Farmwide Pty Ltd,<br />

<br />

Sibillin, A., O'Sullivan, K., Letch, J., Higgins, D. and Heywood, K. (1996). The Virtual University Symposium 21-22 November, University of<br />

Melbourne.<br />

Moriarty, G. (1998). Telstra puts <strong>the</strong> Outback in front. Telstra Media Release, May.<br />

The Economist (1995). A survey of telecommunications: <strong>the</strong> death of distance-a giant ef<strong>for</strong>t. September 30.<br />

In<strong>for</strong>mation Sources<br />

In<strong>for</strong>mation <strong>for</strong> this paper has been ga<strong>the</strong>red from <strong>the</strong> following sources: Grazing Properties Baymore, Bunginderry, Dellerain, Su<strong>the</strong>rland and


Norfolk Stations.<br />

Schools of Distance Education or Schools of <strong>the</strong> Air: Hay, Broken Hill, Tibaburra, Cobar, Burke, Charleville, Emerald, Longreach, Charters<br />

Towers, Cairns, Mt Isa, Alice Springs and Port Augusta. Line testing was carried out in all <strong>the</strong> above locations as well as Richmond and Tennant<br />

Creek.<br />

Hardware support IBM, Corporate Community Relations.<br />

Related Web Sites<br />

Monash University<br />

http://gupta.ct.monash.edu.au/vise<br />

University of Ballarat<br />

http://www.ballarat.edu.au/vise<br />

Networking <strong>the</strong> Nation<br />

http://www.dca.gov.au<br />

Hyundai Country Music Muster<br />

http://www.muster.com.au


SCALING INFORMATION LITERACY AT THE UNIVERSITY OF IOWA:<br />

WEB-BAS<strong>ED</strong> APPROACHES<br />

Barbara I. Dewey, University of Iowa Libraries, University of Iowa, U.S.A., barbara-dewey@uiowa.edu<br />

This short paper discusses issues and strategies related to scaling in<strong>for</strong>mation literary programs in <strong>the</strong> large<br />

university setting. The University of Iowa Libraries’ multi-<strong>for</strong>mat approach in attempting to reach more of its<br />

28,000 students will be described with a focus on web-based delivery systems developed in partnership with<br />

Colleges and academic programs.<br />

THE NE<strong>ED</strong>:<br />

• The in<strong>for</strong>mation environment is too complex and changing too rapidly to expect students to acquire<br />

in<strong>for</strong>mation literacy without a planned, systematic, cumulative instructional program.<br />

• Students must learn critical thinking and research skills as preparation <strong>for</strong> a lifetime of changing<br />

in<strong>for</strong>mation needs.<br />

• Effective learning about in<strong>for</strong>mation retrieval, use, and analysis is tied to a particular in<strong>for</strong>mation need,<br />

often discipline-specific.<br />

• Students have different learning styles and acquire in<strong>for</strong>mation in different ways. Any in<strong>for</strong>mation literacy<br />

program must accommodate <strong>the</strong>se differences by using a variety of approaches that provide practice in<br />

<strong>the</strong>se skills.<br />

• The most effective way to reach students is through collaboration between <strong>the</strong> Libraries and academic<br />

departments and faculty in integrating in<strong>for</strong>mation skills into <strong>the</strong> curriculum and evaluating outcomes<br />

through a variety of means.<br />

INFORMATION LITERACY LEARNING OBJECTIVES:<br />

• Identify and articulate needs that require in<strong>for</strong>mation solutions;<br />

• Identify appropriate in<strong>for</strong>mation sources and execute search strategies appropriate <strong>for</strong> each resource;<br />

• Interpret and analyze search results;<br />

• Critically evaluate <strong>the</strong> in<strong>for</strong>mation retrieved;<br />

• Organize, syn<strong>the</strong>size, and apply <strong>the</strong> in<strong>for</strong>mation;<br />

• Understand <strong>the</strong> structure of <strong>the</strong> in<strong>for</strong>mation environment and <strong>the</strong> process by which both scholarly and<br />

popular in<strong>for</strong>mation is produced and disseminated; and<br />

• Understand <strong>the</strong> ethical issues related to access and use of in<strong>for</strong>mation.<br />

TIER ONE: A tiered approach that builds on knowledge acquired throughout <strong>the</strong> students’ career has been<br />

developed including streng<strong>the</strong>ning <strong>the</strong> current introductory research and in<strong>for</strong>mation seeking components in two<br />

products:<br />

• Online Iowa – updating/enhancing library section of a general university CD-ROM orientation program<br />

that provides a basic understanding of Main Library service points and examples of where to search <strong>for</strong><br />

in<strong>for</strong>mation resources (http://www.uiowa.edu~online/).<br />

• Library Explorer – streng<strong>the</strong>ning <strong>the</strong> existing partnership where library staff provide instruction on how to<br />

integrate <strong>the</strong> use of Library Explorer, a computer-based library instruction program with automated “quick<br />

tests of knowledge”, o<strong>the</strong>r in<strong>for</strong>mation sources, search strategies, and development of effective researchrelated<br />

assignments <strong>for</strong> teaching assistants within <strong>the</strong>ir training program. Librarians are subsequently paired


one-on-one with Teaching Assistants to provide customized support. Extensions underway <strong>for</strong> Library<br />

Explorer include subject-specific “chapters” <strong>for</strong> different disciplines and special CD-ROM “cuts” from<br />

Library Explorer to use with distance education students who do not have access to <strong>the</strong> Internet<br />

(http://www.lib.uiowa.edu/libexp/).<br />

TIER TWO – UTRIPLE I: Librarians work with faculty to determine a desirable combination of instructional<br />

<strong>for</strong>mats, assignments, and outcome evaluation methods building on experience derived from current and past<br />

partnerships with GER and upper division course instruction <strong>for</strong> tier two components in an initiative called<br />

UTripleI (University of Iowa In<strong>for</strong>mation Literacy Initiative) <strong>for</strong>:<br />

• General Education Requirement Courses -- introductory subject-based in<strong>for</strong>mation literacy component<br />

developed with faculty and built into selected GER courses selected from <strong>the</strong> Departments of English,<br />

Geography, History, Political Science, and Psychology including query <strong>for</strong>mulation, in<strong>for</strong>mation seeking<br />

strategies, basic evaluation of in<strong>for</strong>mation sources, and a basic understanding of copyright and intellectual<br />

freedom issues.<br />

• Science In<strong>for</strong>mation Literacy Initiative Project – development of specific in<strong>for</strong>mation literacy components<br />

related to <strong>the</strong> special needs of science disciplines and <strong>the</strong>ir courses.<br />

• Undergraduate “Majors” Component -- advanced and more complex subject-based in<strong>for</strong>mation seeking,<br />

retrieval, and analysis components built into selected courses <strong>for</strong> undergraduate majors.<br />

TIER THREE – FACULTY TRAINING AND SUPPPORT: Ef<strong>for</strong>ts to scale in<strong>for</strong>mation literacy ef<strong>for</strong>ts<br />

through faculty training include programs <strong>for</strong> on <strong>the</strong> application of learning technologies in <strong>the</strong>ir courses:<br />

• nTITLE (New Technologies in <strong>the</strong> Teaching and Learning Environment – website noted below) is a<br />

summer faculty training program taught largely by librarians. The Center also provides input into <strong>the</strong><br />

University Libraries’ TWIST (Teaching with Innovative Style and Technology) project<br />

(http://www.uiowa.edu/~ntitle).<br />

• TWIST (Teaching with Style and Innovative Technology) is a three year grant funded program whose major<br />

goal is to create a model program <strong>for</strong> training faculty to integrate networked in<strong>for</strong>mation into teaching as<br />

well as in<strong>for</strong>mation literacy components. TWIST project staff are sponsoring a series of late summer<br />

workshops <strong>for</strong> faculty and staff to explore ways of fully using in<strong>for</strong>mation technology in instructional<br />

settings. The sessions focus on building learning environments <strong>for</strong> students - how to help students learn to<br />

use electronic resources via OASIS (<strong>the</strong> University Libraries’ online catalog), <strong>the</strong> Web or CD -ROM; how<br />

to build instructional Web sites to guide students as <strong>the</strong>y learn critical thinking skills. One “scaling” factor<br />

in this program is <strong>the</strong> development of web-based tutorials <strong>for</strong> faculty to use at anytime. Ano<strong>the</strong>r scaling<br />

factor is <strong>the</strong> development of a TWIST “template” <strong>for</strong> faculty to develop course web pages with an emphasis<br />

on linkages to resources and in<strong>for</strong>mation literacy-based lessons (http://twist.lib.uiowa.edu).<br />

SUMMARY<br />

Issues and challenges to scaling ef<strong>for</strong>ts with be reviewed including <strong>the</strong> need to “mine” partnerships with faculty<br />

and technologists, <strong>the</strong> need <strong>for</strong> improved marketing of <strong>the</strong> inherent benefits of integrating an in<strong>for</strong>mation<br />

literacy component into one’s course, <strong>the</strong> difficulty of measuring and evaluating <strong>the</strong> success of a “scaled”<br />

in<strong>for</strong>mation literacy program, and <strong>the</strong> challenge of putting toge<strong>the</strong>r a coherent program or curriculum in an<br />

easily translatable modular <strong>for</strong>m.


Beyond Over-Integration: GENTLE<br />

Thomas Dietinger, Hermann Maurer, Klaus Schmaranz<br />

IICM, Graz University of Technology, Austria<br />

{tdieting, hmaurer, kschmar}@iicm.edu<br />

Abstract: In this paper we show that a good WBT plat<strong>for</strong>m has to provide structured courseware as<br />

well as good online and offline discussion features. Never<strong>the</strong>less it is not possible to fully integrate<br />

special online conferencing tools although <strong>the</strong>y must be usable in a high level WBT environment.<br />

For this reason GENTLE, <strong>the</strong> implementation of <strong>the</strong> WBT system proposed here, utilizes <strong>the</strong> loose<br />

synchronization paradigm that is also discussed more in detail in this paper.<br />

Introduction<br />

Since web-based training (WBT) has been one of <strong>the</strong> big buzz-words throughout <strong>the</strong> last years <strong>the</strong>re are many<br />

different opinions which features such a system should provide. Very often WBT is understood to simply consist of<br />

computer-based training (CBT) courses that are accessible via a Web server.<br />

In our opinion a good WBT system needs to provide more than just courseware, it has to be a higly interactive,<br />

collaboarative system that fully utilizes <strong>the</strong> possibilities of today's networks. WBT users should be able to browse<br />

through <strong>the</strong> courseware, ask questions, make comments and discuss unclear points with <strong>the</strong> trainer or also with o<strong>the</strong>r<br />

WBT users [see also Skillicorn 96].<br />

We are using <strong>the</strong> terms ``WBT user'' and ``trainer'' here instead of <strong>the</strong> widely used terms ``student'' and ``teacher''<br />

because WBT systems are more and more used in corporate intranets ra<strong>the</strong>r than only in schools and universities.<br />

Considering <strong>the</strong> different environments it becomes clear that a successful WBT system has to be highly adaptable to<br />

already existing training procedures and software in a special environment. In corporate environments internal<br />

communication and collaboration is usually standardized throughout <strong>the</strong> company. The success of a WBT system<br />

<strong>the</strong>re<strong>for</strong>e mainly depends on <strong>the</strong> ability of <strong>the</strong> system to utilize <strong>the</strong> well known communication channels instead of<br />

defining new ones. Also, WBT users do not want to deal with new software. Fur<strong>the</strong>r, and even more crucial<br />

companies have <strong>the</strong>ir standardized software packages installed on most of <strong>the</strong>ir computers and very often do not<br />

allow to install new ones.<br />

These considerations led to <strong>the</strong> design of GENTLE (GEneral Networked Teaching and Learning Environment) as a<br />

flexible WBT plat<strong>for</strong>m ra<strong>the</strong>r than a fully integrated software package [see also Maurer98]. In <strong>the</strong> following section<br />

we will point out <strong>the</strong> requirements and <strong>the</strong> resulting concept of <strong>the</strong> system implemented.<br />

The Concept of GENTLE<br />

The point that we found to be most important <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> acceptance of <strong>the</strong> system was that access to GENTLE has to be<br />

possible using standard Web browsers such as Netscape Navigator or MS Internet Explorer. Without having any<br />

o<strong>the</strong>r software package beyond a Web browser installed WBT users have to be able to navigate through <strong>the</strong><br />

courseware material and must have <strong>the</strong> possibility to make notes as well as to take part in offline discussions.<br />

For this reason we are using Hyperwave [see Maurer 96] as <strong>the</strong> server plat<strong>for</strong>m <strong>for</strong> GENTLE since it already<br />

provides many of <strong>the</strong> features needed:<br />

• Structured in<strong>for</strong>mation space: The courseware in <strong>the</strong> system as well as annotations and discussion groups<br />

have to be hierarchically structured to allow easy navigation through <strong>the</strong> system. Since Hyperwave allows that<br />

single documents can be members of more than one part of <strong>the</strong> hierarchy this feature also allows to define<br />

different views <strong>for</strong> different users and user groups. Consider <strong>for</strong> example two WBT users taking a course on


Java. One of <strong>the</strong>m is already an experienced programmer while <strong>the</strong> o<strong>the</strong>r is ra<strong>the</strong>r a newbie. The newbie will<br />

need much more explanatory material about basic programming paradigms that would be disturbing <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong><br />

expert. On <strong>the</strong> o<strong>the</strong>r hand most of <strong>the</strong> material directly dealing with Java will basically be <strong>the</strong> same. Instead of<br />

preparing <strong>the</strong> course twice Hyperwave allows it to share <strong>the</strong> material of a comprehensive course covering basic<br />

and expert knowledge and just hide <strong>the</strong> basics from <strong>the</strong> expert.<br />

• User and group management with profiles: Again taking <strong>the</strong> example above <strong>the</strong> system has to provide <strong>the</strong><br />

possibility <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> users to define <strong>the</strong>ir interests, special skills, etc. so that <strong>the</strong> system can automatically provide<br />

<strong>the</strong> desired view of a course. To achieve this Hyperwave's user and group management features come into play.<br />

Users can easily define <strong>the</strong>ir skill levels as well as personal interests and store <strong>the</strong>m in <strong>the</strong>ir user profile.<br />

Toge<strong>the</strong>r with Hyperwave's clustering features <strong>the</strong>y are <strong>the</strong>n presented exactly with <strong>the</strong> view of <strong>the</strong> course that<br />

matches <strong>the</strong>ir profile. Ano<strong>the</strong>r benefit is that users can change <strong>the</strong>ir view of <strong>the</strong> system on <strong>the</strong> fly by adapting<br />

<strong>the</strong>ir preferences.<br />

• Annotation facilities: Hyperwave supports insertion of annotations to documents <strong>for</strong> authorized users. This<br />

feature can be used <strong>for</strong> inserting notes to parts of <strong>the</strong> courseware into <strong>the</strong> server. These notes can <strong>the</strong>mselves be<br />

annotated again leading to an offline discussion. Annotations <strong>the</strong>mselves can have special types such as<br />

question, answer, agree, disagree and arbitrary o<strong>the</strong>rs. The types <strong>the</strong>mselves can be visualized by little icons and<br />

<strong>the</strong>re<strong>for</strong>e users can choose to follow a discussion thread without having to read all <strong>the</strong> messages to find out <strong>the</strong><br />

author's point of view. Besides publicly visible annotations it is also possible to insert private annotations into<br />

<strong>the</strong> system. Private annotations allow WBT users to make notes <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong>mselves without disturbing o<strong>the</strong>r users or<br />

being subject of discussions. With private annotations WBT users can even build up <strong>the</strong>ir personal view of <strong>the</strong><br />

courseware that can even be made up of parts of several different courses.<br />

• Automatic CD-ROM creation: Hyperwave supports automatic creation of CD-ROMs from parts of <strong>the</strong><br />

in<strong>for</strong>mation hierarchy. This feature can be used <strong>for</strong> archival purposes, however CD-ROMs can also be made <strong>for</strong><br />

WBT users that want to study <strong>the</strong>ir courses at home and have no permanent internet connection. Such CD-<br />

ROMs can be used <strong>for</strong> mere offline courses without <strong>the</strong> collaboration and discussion facilities, but <strong>the</strong>y also<br />

contain <strong>the</strong> pointers to <strong>the</strong> discussion areas on <strong>the</strong> server. If WBT users are taking <strong>the</strong> CD-ROM home <strong>for</strong><br />

studying offline and if <strong>the</strong>y have an internet connection at home <strong>the</strong>y can also decide to insert annotations<br />

directly from <strong>the</strong> offline CD-ROM without having to leave <strong>the</strong>ir course in order to reconnect to <strong>the</strong> public<br />

server.<br />

In addition to <strong>the</strong> offline features discussed above very strong emphasis has been put on online communication<br />

between WBT users and trainers as well as group discussions. This is also exactly <strong>the</strong> point where full integration of<br />

all possible features into one system becomes more or less infeasible. Just imagine to re-implement all <strong>the</strong> software<br />

<strong>for</strong> audio- and videoconferencing used at <strong>the</strong> moment <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> sake of integration! There are many different standards<br />

existing <strong>for</strong> audio conferencing, video conferencing and whiteboards, just to mention <strong>the</strong> most widely used online<br />

communication facilities. Some of <strong>the</strong>m rely on high-bandwidth MBone connections, some of <strong>the</strong>m use standard IP<br />

connections, some are commonly used <strong>for</strong> low quality communication such as Netmeeting, etc. Also different<br />

proprietary high quality (and expensive!) teleconferencing systems are in use in corporate networks. Very often it is<br />

not even possible to integrate <strong>the</strong> systems because <strong>the</strong>y are using special protocols that are not public knowledge,<br />

even worse, some systems are based on special hardware.<br />

These considerations led us to <strong>the</strong> point already stated above: GENTLE has to serve as a universal plat<strong>for</strong>m<br />

supporting <strong>the</strong> o<strong>the</strong>r systems ra<strong>the</strong>r than trying to fully integrate <strong>the</strong>m. To be able to support <strong>the</strong> different standards<br />

easy to use synchronization mechanisms had to be found. Since <strong>the</strong>se synchronization mechanisms have to be an<br />

integral part of <strong>the</strong> WBT system available on every single plat<strong>for</strong>m and in all different environments our choice was<br />

to use email and a simple Java chat applet. Even when execution of Java applets in <strong>the</strong> Web Browser is not allowed<br />

in a corporate environment (which is often <strong>the</strong> case!) email is a basic communication feature available everywhere.<br />

The Java chat applet is <strong>the</strong>n <strong>the</strong> more sophisticated online solution <strong>for</strong> environments that allow its execution.<br />

Let us now consider an example how an online discussion about a certain topic in <strong>the</strong> courseware can take place<br />

using a proprietary high quality video conferencing system and a whiteboard: WBT users that find out that <strong>the</strong>y need<br />

clarification of a certain topic <strong>for</strong> deeper understanding simply click on a button establish discussion session in <strong>the</strong>ir<br />

Web browser. A dialog pops up and <strong>the</strong> users can choose with who to discuss this, e.g. <strong>the</strong> trainer, o<strong>the</strong>r WBT users<br />

or a certain predefined group of persons. This dialog also automatically determines <strong>the</strong> part of <strong>the</strong> courseware that is<br />

currently loaded. Fur<strong>the</strong>r, users can also choose when to discuss <strong>the</strong> topic: ei<strong>the</strong>r immediately, which implies that <strong>the</strong>


discussion partners need to have <strong>the</strong>ir Java chat applet running so that <strong>the</strong>y can be in<strong>for</strong>med online, or later at a<br />

certain time.<br />

If immediate discussion is chosen and <strong>the</strong> discussion partners are online a text chat session is opened and <strong>the</strong> initial<br />

message that a user wants some online discussion about <strong>the</strong> previously determined topic is sent to all partners. The<br />

partners can now all open <strong>the</strong>ir video conferencing tools and whiteboards and start <strong>the</strong> discussion.<br />

The o<strong>the</strong>r case that ei<strong>the</strong>r <strong>the</strong> use of <strong>the</strong> Java chat applet is not permitted or <strong>the</strong> discussion partners are not online <strong>for</strong><br />

chat at <strong>the</strong> moment results in automatically sending an email to <strong>the</strong> partners that some discussion should take place<br />

<strong>for</strong> example at 3:00 pm <strong>the</strong> next day. If desired <strong>the</strong> system can also automatically post an announcement about <strong>the</strong><br />

topic and time of <strong>the</strong> discussion in <strong>the</strong> courseware communication section so that everybody who is interested can<br />

also take part in <strong>the</strong> discussion. At <strong>the</strong> desired time all <strong>the</strong> partners can <strong>the</strong>n open <strong>the</strong>ir video conferencing tools and<br />

whiteboards and start <strong>the</strong> discussion as stated above.<br />

When a discussion session is already established fur<strong>the</strong>r synchronization (if not already integrated in <strong>the</strong> special<br />

tools) can again take place using ei<strong>the</strong>r <strong>the</strong> Java chat applet or email. Something like e.g. ``please open <strong>the</strong> page at<br />

URL so and so'' can easily be sent to <strong>the</strong> partners.<br />

Using this loose synchronization paradigm all <strong>the</strong> features of highly specialized conferencing tools can be obtained<br />

in <strong>the</strong> WBT environment without having to integrate <strong>the</strong>m. In environments where GENTLE is installed <strong>the</strong> users<br />

can <strong>the</strong>mselves agree on certain tools to be used and do not have to leave <strong>the</strong>ir well-known environments. New<br />

developments in this area can easily be used without having to do <strong>the</strong> whole integration work <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> system.<br />

In addition to tool integration by loose synchronization we identified two o<strong>the</strong>r very important features that <strong>the</strong><br />

system has to provide: intelligent helpers and basic user agents. Intelligent helpers provide <strong>the</strong> ability to monitor <strong>the</strong><br />

users and store <strong>the</strong> data collected in <strong>the</strong> user profiles. User monitoring can take place by ei<strong>the</strong>r using questionnaires<br />

from time to time or by evaluating <strong>the</strong> kind of help users need. If <strong>for</strong> example users very often require help about<br />

basic system features such as ``where do I click to go to <strong>the</strong> study room'' <strong>the</strong> intelligent helper will deduce that <strong>the</strong><br />

user is new to <strong>the</strong> system.<br />

Evaluation of <strong>the</strong> monitoring data give <strong>the</strong> users feedback about <strong>the</strong>ir skills and can also be used to automatically<br />

generate different views of <strong>the</strong> system depending on <strong>the</strong> users' skills as has already been discussed above. Different<br />

views does not only mean different views of <strong>the</strong> courseware but also different levels of help. Users that are new to<br />

<strong>the</strong> system will get more general help on how to use <strong>the</strong> system than experienced ones. The longer (and more often)<br />

users work with <strong>the</strong> system and <strong>the</strong> fewer basic questions <strong>the</strong>y ask <strong>the</strong> less basic hints <strong>the</strong>y will obtain. Instead, help<br />

will provide more hints about advanced system features. The result is that WBT users do not only learn <strong>the</strong>ir<br />

courseware but also implicitly learn more about <strong>the</strong> system itself in a very natural way.<br />

Basic user agents in GENTLE are easy to configure helpers that run on <strong>the</strong> server side. Their tasks are to make <strong>the</strong><br />

users' lives easier when looking <strong>for</strong> new in<strong>for</strong>mation. For example users can have an agent in <strong>the</strong> system in<strong>for</strong>ming<br />

<strong>the</strong>m automatically whenever new courseware on a topic is inserted in <strong>the</strong> server. Ano<strong>the</strong>r feature should assure that<br />

users be in<strong>for</strong>med automatically whenever a discussion session on a certain topic takes place (if <strong>the</strong> discussion is not<br />

private!).<br />

After discussion of <strong>the</strong> basic concepts of GENTLE <strong>the</strong> following sections will deal more in detail with <strong>the</strong><br />

implementation of <strong>the</strong> system.<br />

The Structure of GENTLE<br />

As has already been discussed <strong>the</strong> core of GENTLE is a Hyperwave server providing all <strong>the</strong> basic features needed<br />

<strong>for</strong> implementation of <strong>the</strong> WBT plat<strong>for</strong>m scenario developed. The whole system is divided into <strong>the</strong> following<br />

modules:<br />

• Courseware structure management<br />

• WBT user registration management<br />

• Personal profile management


• Personal study room management<br />

• Offline discussion area management<br />

• Online discussion announcement management<br />

• Shared bookmark management<br />

These modules make up <strong>the</strong> basic integral system functionality of GENTLE as a flexible WBT plat<strong>for</strong>m. They also<br />

prepare <strong>the</strong> way to use highly specialized software using <strong>the</strong> loose synchronization paradigm. In what follows, <strong>the</strong><br />

tasks of <strong>the</strong> single modules are described in more detail. Again we want to mention here that no additional software<br />

except a standard Web browser is necessary to per<strong>for</strong>m <strong>the</strong> tasks discussed below.<br />

Courseware Structure Management<br />

As has already been mentioned courseware has to be structured in an easy to navigate hierarchy [see also Maglajlic<br />

98]. Providing a good structure also results in <strong>the</strong> possibility to provide different views of <strong>the</strong> system <strong>for</strong> different<br />

users and user groups. GENTLE allows courseware to be prepared in every desired <strong>for</strong>mat and is not limited to e.g.<br />

HTML pages or even worse to some special proprietary <strong>for</strong>mat. Trainers can choose <strong>the</strong> software most suitable <strong>for</strong><br />

<strong>the</strong>ir courses. The only point that has to be considered is which software is installed on <strong>the</strong> WBT users' computers.<br />

Mostly this is again a corporate decision because some software has already been internally used <strong>for</strong> a long time.<br />

Courses in GENTLE can now be structured in several different ways in parallel and <strong>the</strong> WBT users are <strong>the</strong>n<br />

automatically provided with <strong>the</strong> view best suitable <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong>ir skills. First of all single courses are divided into sections<br />

and knowledge areas. Second all <strong>the</strong> parts that make up <strong>the</strong> course are categorized by <strong>the</strong> skill levels that WBT users<br />

shall have to see <strong>the</strong>se parts. Third additional material and cross-references to o<strong>the</strong>r courses or parts of <strong>the</strong>m are also<br />

inserted in <strong>the</strong> hierarchy, again with <strong>the</strong> necessary users' skill levels. The skill level categorization of <strong>the</strong> courseware<br />

is <strong>the</strong>n used in combination with <strong>the</strong> personal user profiles to determine which parts to present to a certain user.<br />

WBT User Registration Management<br />

New users in GENTLE can be registered in ei<strong>the</strong>r of two ways:<br />

• Automatic user registration: If this mode is allowed by <strong>the</strong> system operators users can <strong>the</strong>mselves create a<br />

WBT user account on <strong>the</strong> system, register <strong>the</strong>ir desired username, password, email and o<strong>the</strong>r desired data. These<br />

users <strong>the</strong>n initially get <strong>the</strong> rights to read certain areas of <strong>the</strong> courseware and take part in some of <strong>the</strong> discussion<br />

areas as defined by <strong>the</strong> system administrators. Registration is simply per<strong>for</strong>med by filling out an HTML <strong>for</strong>m.<br />

• Centralized user registration: Again users fill out a simple HTML <strong>for</strong>m with all <strong>the</strong>ir data. Instead of<br />

automatically registering <strong>the</strong> users and giving <strong>the</strong>m initial rights <strong>the</strong> data is sent to <strong>the</strong> system administrator. The<br />

administrator <strong>the</strong>n ei<strong>the</strong>r accepts or rejects <strong>the</strong> registration and defines <strong>the</strong> initial rights of <strong>the</strong> certain WBT user.<br />

Once WBT users are registered <strong>the</strong>y also get <strong>the</strong>ir personal profiles and <strong>the</strong>ir personal study rooms <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong>ir work.<br />

Personal Profile Management<br />

Personal profiles exist <strong>for</strong> all registered WBT users. In <strong>the</strong> personal profiles two kinds of datasets are stored:<br />

• Personal data such as <strong>the</strong> real name, email address, etc. that need to be known by o<strong>the</strong>rs to get in contact with<br />

<strong>the</strong>m. Also special access rights, group memberships and o<strong>the</strong>r administrative data is stored here. The system<br />

administrators decide which part of <strong>the</strong> personal user data is accessible <strong>for</strong> users and which part is private.<br />

• Personal preferences to be evaluated by <strong>the</strong> system. The preferences contain <strong>the</strong> users' experience and skill<br />

levels as well as all o<strong>the</strong>r statistical data collected by <strong>the</strong> helpers. Also contained are <strong>the</strong> agents that <strong>the</strong> users<br />

have installed toge<strong>the</strong>r with <strong>the</strong>ir parameters. Besides and very important <strong>the</strong> preferences also contain<br />

in<strong>for</strong>mation about all loosely synchronized tools that certain users are wanting to use <strong>for</strong> online discussion such<br />

as <strong>the</strong> kind of video-conferencing software, <strong>the</strong> whiteboard, etc. With this in<strong>for</strong>mation <strong>the</strong> system can decide<br />

automatically if a request <strong>for</strong> discussion can be satisfied and <strong>the</strong> system can also automatically choose <strong>the</strong> way<br />

to loosely synchronize communication (e.g. to use email or <strong>the</strong> Java chat applet).<br />

Personal Study Room Management


As has already been mentioned all WBT users obtain <strong>the</strong>ir personal study room. This is <strong>the</strong> main environment <strong>for</strong><br />

WBT users that <strong>the</strong>y see when working with <strong>the</strong> system. The personal study room provides all <strong>the</strong> navigational<br />

features as well as all administrative features accessible to <strong>the</strong> users such as profile, helper and agent management,<br />

personal business cards and more.<br />

In <strong>the</strong> study room WBT users also always get a dynamic overview of actually enroled and already finished courses<br />

as well as suggested courses according to <strong>the</strong>ir interests and skills.<br />

If allowed by <strong>the</strong> system administrators WBT users also can get a limited amount of space on <strong>the</strong> server. This space<br />

can <strong>for</strong> example be used to upload additional material into <strong>the</strong>ir personal workspace in <strong>the</strong> study room. If desired<br />

WBT users can also declare parts of <strong>the</strong>ir personal workspace publicly readable if <strong>the</strong>y want to publish special<br />

additional material to a course.<br />

Ano<strong>the</strong>r part of <strong>the</strong> study room is a basic personal messaging system that works similar to email but via <strong>the</strong><br />

courseware server. Using this messaging system WBT users and teachers can communicate with each o<strong>the</strong>r and<br />

manage <strong>the</strong>ir message space as can be done with email. The advantage of this messaging system compared to email<br />

is <strong>the</strong> availability on <strong>the</strong> server. Users can quickly read and write messages from everywhere without needing access<br />

to <strong>the</strong>ir email system. This feature is especially important <strong>for</strong> trainers that are travelling a lot and do not want to scan<br />

all <strong>the</strong>ir email from somewhere in <strong>the</strong> world to find out about new questions asked.<br />

Offline Discussion Area Management<br />

Two different offline discussion facilities are part of GENTLE, offline discussion <strong>for</strong>ums and personal messaging<br />

which has already been discussed above. Offline discussion <strong>for</strong>ums are structured according to <strong>the</strong>ir topics and are<br />

usually belonging to certain courses. Depending on <strong>the</strong>ir course access rights WBT users have access to certain<br />

<strong>for</strong>ums and can insert questions, notes or opinions.<br />

As an example students could find an unclear <strong>for</strong>mulation in <strong>the</strong> courseware and want to clarify that point. In this<br />

case <strong>the</strong>y only have to mark <strong>the</strong> unclear text area and a simple click on a button in <strong>the</strong> course environment of <strong>the</strong>ir<br />

personal study room opens a dialog. The dialog automatically maintains a pointer to <strong>the</strong> marked unclear section and<br />

lets <strong>the</strong> users write some text. Besides also <strong>the</strong> type of discussion entry can be selected, at <strong>the</strong> moment question,<br />

answer, agree, disagree, remark and hint are supported. Then <strong>the</strong> whole entry with <strong>the</strong> pointer to <strong>the</strong> unclear section<br />

is inserted into <strong>the</strong> discussion <strong>for</strong>um. Besides also an email message is sent to <strong>the</strong> trainer to alert him of <strong>the</strong> new<br />

entry if desired. The trainer <strong>the</strong>n opens <strong>the</strong> <strong>for</strong>um, finds <strong>the</strong> new entry and immediately sees due to <strong>the</strong> special icon<br />

that this is <strong>for</strong> example a question. When opening <strong>the</strong> question <strong>the</strong> trainer obtains <strong>the</strong> question text toge<strong>the</strong>r with <strong>the</strong><br />

automatically generated pointer to <strong>the</strong> unclear section in <strong>the</strong> courseware. Now <strong>the</strong> trainer can answer <strong>the</strong> question in<br />

<strong>the</strong> same way <strong>the</strong> WBT user asked it and <strong>the</strong> answer is inserted into <strong>the</strong> <strong>for</strong>um and automatically interlinked with <strong>the</strong><br />

question. The answer itself can <strong>the</strong>n be subject to new questions or remarks and so <strong>for</strong>th resulting in an offline<br />

discussion. Discussions need not be publicly accessible, WBT users as well as trainers also have <strong>the</strong> possibility to<br />

declare entries private which means that only <strong>the</strong> persons involved in <strong>the</strong> discussion can read <strong>the</strong>m.<br />

Shared <strong>Book</strong>mark Management<br />

Experience with WBT systems has shown that many users search <strong>the</strong> Web <strong>for</strong> additional in<strong>for</strong>mation and store<br />

interesting pages in <strong>the</strong>ir client-side bookmark files. The result is that all <strong>the</strong> users have to do a lot of work to find<br />

partially overlapping material. For this reason GENTLE also provides a facility to maintain bookmarks that are<br />

shared amongst WBT usergroups. Whenever WBT users find an interesting document <strong>the</strong>y can simply click on a<br />

button in <strong>the</strong>ir environment that opens a shared bookmark dialog. In this dialog <strong>the</strong>y can mark <strong>the</strong> usergroup <strong>for</strong><br />

which <strong>the</strong> pointer is interesting and insert <strong>the</strong> URL that <strong>the</strong>y found with some additional description. O<strong>the</strong>r users<br />

being members of this workgroup <strong>the</strong>n find <strong>the</strong> interesting entry <strong>the</strong> next time <strong>the</strong>y look into <strong>the</strong> group document. It<br />

is also possible to install a user agent that automatically in<strong>for</strong>ms <strong>the</strong> group members of new entries in <strong>the</strong> shared<br />

bookmarks via email.<br />

Online Discussion Announcement Management


As has already been discussed in <strong>the</strong> overall system concept arbitrary online discussion tools such as high-level<br />

videoconferencing software or shared whiteboards can be used toge<strong>the</strong>r with <strong>the</strong> GENTLE with loose<br />

synchronization. One possibility to establish an online discussion is to post a message in an announcement <strong>for</strong>um<br />

with a call <strong>for</strong> participation in a conference at a given time.<br />

The online discussion announcement <strong>for</strong>um is managed similarly to <strong>the</strong> offline discussion <strong>for</strong>um. Users can open a<br />

dialog from within <strong>the</strong>ir study room, write a call <strong>for</strong> an online conferencing session and give it a topic and a type.<br />

Besides <strong>the</strong> desired members and usergroups <strong>for</strong> this conferencing session are selected as well as <strong>the</strong> session is<br />

marked to be a public or a private session. This call is <strong>the</strong>n inserted in <strong>the</strong> discussion announcement <strong>for</strong>um readable<br />

only <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> desired group of persons. Besides all conferencing partners are automatically in<strong>for</strong>med of <strong>the</strong> call via<br />

email.<br />

The partners receiving a call <strong>for</strong> discussion <strong>the</strong>n have <strong>the</strong> possibility to agree to this call or <strong>for</strong> example propose a<br />

different time <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> session. This proposal is <strong>the</strong>n also sent to all <strong>the</strong> partners and posted in <strong>the</strong> <strong>for</strong>um. Discussion<br />

<strong>the</strong>n goes on until all participants have agreed.<br />

If <strong>the</strong> session is declared to be a public session <strong>the</strong> final announcement is also made readable <strong>for</strong> everyone while all<br />

previous discussion entries remain private to <strong>the</strong> participants. WBT users who have an agent in <strong>the</strong> system looking<br />

<strong>for</strong> public conferencing sessions on certain topics are <strong>the</strong>n also automatically in<strong>for</strong>med of this event.<br />

Loosely Synchronized Online Collaboration Features<br />

Although all <strong>the</strong> offline features of GENTLE already make it a very powerful WBT plat<strong>for</strong>m <strong>the</strong> concept of loose<br />

synchronization is <strong>the</strong> biggest step towards <strong>the</strong> future of WBT systems. The idea is simple but effective: trainers and<br />

WBT users agree on <strong>the</strong> high-level collaboration tools that <strong>the</strong>y want to use toge<strong>the</strong>r with GENTLE. All users of <strong>the</strong><br />

system have profile entries with <strong>the</strong> tools that <strong>the</strong>y are able and willing to use <strong>for</strong> collaboration, e.g.<br />

videoconferencing systems, whiteboards, etc.<br />

Per<strong>for</strong>ming an online discussion using <strong>the</strong> high-level online collaboration tools is <strong>the</strong>n done in three steps:<br />

• Call <strong>for</strong> online discussion: As has already been described GENTLE manages online discussion<br />

announcements. When posting a call <strong>for</strong> discussion <strong>the</strong> callers are able to select <strong>the</strong> tools that <strong>the</strong>y want to use<br />

and <strong>the</strong> system automatically looks up <strong>the</strong> profiles of <strong>the</strong> participants to find out whe<strong>the</strong>r <strong>the</strong>y all support <strong>the</strong><br />

desired software. If not <strong>the</strong> system returns with a proposal of different possibilities.<br />

The system also looks up <strong>the</strong> loose synchronization mechanism supported by <strong>the</strong> participants and decides<br />

whe<strong>the</strong>r online chat can be used or whe<strong>the</strong>r synchronization has to take place by simple email. All in<strong>for</strong>mation<br />

about <strong>the</strong> tools and <strong>the</strong> synchronization is automatically included in <strong>the</strong> call.<br />

Discussion about <strong>the</strong> call until <strong>the</strong> final agreement is <strong>the</strong>n per<strong>for</strong>med using <strong>the</strong> strategy mentioned in <strong>the</strong><br />

previous section.<br />

• Establishing an online discussion session: At <strong>the</strong> agreed time all participants open <strong>the</strong>ir collaboration tools<br />

and start <strong>the</strong> session. In parallel <strong>the</strong>y also have <strong>the</strong>ir Web browsers open and depending on <strong>the</strong> agreed<br />

synchronization mechanism open <strong>the</strong> automatic email or online chat dialog.<br />

• Synchronization of users during online discussions: During a discussion session ei<strong>the</strong>r <strong>the</strong> automatic email or<br />

<strong>the</strong> online chat dialog are used <strong>for</strong> synchronizing context switches. For example if partners wants to switch to a<br />

different page in <strong>the</strong> Web browser <strong>the</strong>y simply copy <strong>the</strong>ir desired URL into <strong>the</strong> synchronization dialog.<br />

Depending on <strong>the</strong> agreed mechanism this dialog <strong>the</strong>n ei<strong>the</strong>r sends a message to <strong>the</strong> online chat system or<br />

delivers this message via email to all <strong>the</strong> partners in <strong>the</strong> session. As soon as all <strong>the</strong> partners received <strong>the</strong><br />

message <strong>the</strong>y simply navigate to <strong>the</strong> desired location and acknowledge <strong>the</strong> receipt of <strong>the</strong> message in <strong>the</strong><br />

synchronization dialog. Again this acknowledgement is ei<strong>the</strong>r delivered as a chat message to <strong>the</strong> initiator or sent<br />

back as email.


References<br />

[Maglajlic 98] Maglajlic S., Maurer H., Scherbakov N.: Separating Structure and Content: Authoring Educational Web<br />

Applications; <strong>Proceedings</strong> Ed-Media 98, 1998, p 880-884.<br />

[Maurer 96] Maurer H.: Hyperwave: The Next Generation Web Solution; Addison Wesley Pub. Co., 1996.<br />

[Maurer 98] Maurer H.: Using <strong>the</strong> WWW System Hyperwave as <strong>the</strong> Basis of a General Networked Teaching and Learning<br />

Environment; CIT 6, 1998, p 63-72.<br />

[Skillicorn 96] Skillicorn D.: Using Distributed Hypermedia <strong>for</strong> Collaborative Learning in Universities; The Computer Journal,<br />

Vol. 39, No 6, 1996, p 471-482. File translated from TEX by TTH, version 2.01. On 28 Jun <strong>1999</strong>, 14:35.


On-line Support of On-Campus Education:<br />

An Implementation of a Resources-Based Approach<br />

Parviz Doulai<br />

Faculty of In<strong>for</strong>matics<br />

University of Wollongong<br />

Australia<br />

parviz@uow.edu.au<br />

Adopting a Resource-Based Approach to On-Campus Education<br />

As university budgets are under constant pressure and class sizes continue to grow, af<strong>for</strong>dable solutions are<br />

needed to preserve <strong>the</strong> quality of on-campus education. One way to achieve this is to utilize new and emerging<br />

dynamic Web environments in providing classroom support and fostering students learning. The new Web-based<br />

educational technologies provide students with cost-effective choices beyond those normally available in a<br />

centralized environment like a lecture <strong>the</strong>atre.<br />

Web technology is increasingly being used to satisfy <strong>the</strong> requirements of resource-based approaches in distance<br />

education. For on-campus education, <strong>the</strong> potential of Web technology is not being fully realized. The Web and<br />

its associated technologies are capable of supplementing classroom-based teaching and learning strategies by<br />

offering a variety of innovative pedagogical processes. Web technology can meet students’ individual learning<br />

needs and learning styles by offering varied and flexible learning opportunities (Bishop et al. 1997).<br />

Distance education typically employs a resource-based approach to curriculum design. The resource materials in<br />

distance education are designed to facilitate student learning largely independent of real-time contact with<br />

instructors. On-campus education, on <strong>the</strong> o<strong>the</strong>r hand, normally functions in standard teacher-centred classrooms,<br />

and on-campus students generally rely on face-to-face interaction with instructors. Numerous innovations have<br />

been introduced to trans<strong>for</strong>m <strong>the</strong> traditional on-campus education into a more learner-centred environment where<br />

students can discover and construct knowledge with <strong>the</strong> help of introspection and peer interactions. The use of<br />

technology can significantly facilitate <strong>the</strong> application of resource-based approaches in traditional lecture-based<br />

on-campus courses.<br />

This paper illustrates <strong>the</strong> usage of instructional resources that exploit <strong>the</strong> interactive and communication capacity<br />

of modern technology. Incorporation of such resources into curriculum design not only facilitates <strong>the</strong><br />

convergence of on- and off-campus educational programs (Gosper & Rich 1998) but, according to advocates,<br />

can produce o<strong>the</strong>r strategic and educational benefits. This paper also looks at <strong>the</strong> actual students usage of a<br />

sample implementation of a dynamic learning environment and summarizes its students survey results.<br />

Description of <strong>the</strong> Course, Enrolment and Logistics<br />

The course, IACT101: Introduction to In<strong>for</strong>mation and Communication Technology focuses on providing a basic<br />

technical understanding of computers and connectivity. In 1998 about 200 students registered <strong>for</strong> IACT101 of<br />

whom about 190 completed <strong>the</strong> course requirements. The students were from a variety of academic backgrounds.<br />

IACT101 is a 6 credit-point, one semester course. At <strong>the</strong> University of Wollongong, a typical full time student<br />

undertakes 24 credit points per semester. The classes met <strong>for</strong> three hours per week consisting of an hour lecture<br />

and two hours recitation and computer laboratory.<br />

The IACT101 course was <strong>the</strong> University of Wollongong’s first full-featured implementation of a technologyenhanced<br />

on-campus delivery. The World Wide Web Course Tools (WebCT) was used to develop course<br />

resources and deliver <strong>the</strong> resulting learning environment to students. The IACT101 was chosen as <strong>the</strong> pilot<br />

project to demonstrate <strong>the</strong> feasibility and <strong>the</strong> potential benefits and costs of on-line support systems. WebCT is<br />

now <strong>the</strong> standard plat<strong>for</strong>m <strong>for</strong> developing and delivering Web courses at <strong>the</strong> University of Wollongong.<br />

The "IACT101 Learning Environment" is logically organized into six virtual corners whereby <strong>the</strong> students use<br />

<strong>the</strong> Web browser as <strong>the</strong> uni<strong>for</strong>m user interface in accessing <strong>the</strong> course-related in<strong>for</strong>mation and interacting with<br />

<strong>the</strong> system.


• Classroom Corner where students receive lesson contents, tutorial and workshop notes as well as a variety<br />

of course related in<strong>for</strong>mation and announcements.<br />

• Student Lounge that is dedicated to most activities that involve students. These include <strong>the</strong> in<strong>for</strong>mation<br />

about student progress in <strong>the</strong> subject, test and assignment scores and course records. The Student Lounge<br />

also contains a “Student Presentation” area where <strong>the</strong> results of students collaborative projects are viewed.<br />

• Student Communication Corner that offers WebCT built-in bulletin board, private mail and real-time chat<br />

tools (Goldberg, 1997). The tool that was used most extensively by all students was <strong>the</strong> bulletin board. It<br />

served as <strong>the</strong> main <strong>for</strong>um <strong>for</strong> course communication, and provided an effective tool <strong>for</strong> students to<br />

participate in class discussions outside <strong>the</strong> regular lecture and recitation sessions.<br />

• Assessment and Survey Corner houses assessment-related in<strong>for</strong>mation and assessment tasks such as<br />

assignments, on-line quizzes and "Critical Thinking" tasks. The bulletin board gave students a good<br />

plat<strong>for</strong>m to practice <strong>the</strong> task of critical thinking in this subject. A dynamic link was established between<br />

Critical Thinking tasks, weekly face-to-face recitation sessions, <strong>the</strong> bulletin board postings and <strong>the</strong><br />

consequent follow up postings. This dynamic link worked nicely in IACT101 learning environment.<br />

• Additional Resources and Help/Student Manual.<br />

Student Use and Student Tracking In<strong>for</strong>mation<br />

During <strong>the</strong> first eight weeks of <strong>the</strong> operation of IACT101 learning environment, <strong>the</strong> site had:<br />

1. around 8000 visits; approximately one visit per student per working day,<br />

2. over 2000 articles were posted to <strong>the</strong> bulletin board (about half related to <strong>the</strong> subject matter),<br />

3. close to 1200 times <strong>the</strong> timed/on-line quiz environment were used by students, close to 800 on-line<br />

electronic submissions were made (short assignments and Critical Thinking tasks), and<br />

4. 1800 hours of students engagement and interaction with on-line course notes was recorded.<br />

More detailed statistics collected at <strong>the</strong> end of <strong>the</strong> semester (week14) showed a linear increase in student use and<br />

a close to uni<strong>for</strong>m usage distribution across students.<br />

Student Survey<br />

Two on-line questionnaires were administered to obtain in<strong>for</strong>mation regarding student access to <strong>the</strong> course and<br />

student acceptance of, and reaction to, <strong>the</strong> IACT101 learning environment. In<strong>for</strong>mation on <strong>the</strong> effectiveness of<br />

peer interaction and perception of <strong>the</strong> on-line learning environment as a tool to influence students’ learning were<br />

collected and analysed. Some 176 students completed both questionnaires, and a vast majority indicated that <strong>the</strong><br />

Web-based learning environment directly contributed towards <strong>the</strong>ir active learning of <strong>the</strong> subject matter (Survey,<br />

1998). The implementation of <strong>the</strong> on-line support of IACT101 increased <strong>the</strong> class average score by 9% and<br />

increased <strong>the</strong> completion rate by 10% compared to <strong>the</strong> previous year where <strong>the</strong> Web-based learning environment<br />

was not used, but all o<strong>the</strong>r aspects of IACT101 were <strong>the</strong> same.<br />

Conclusion<br />

Providing on-line support <strong>for</strong> classroom-based education has potentially significant educational and<br />

administrative benefits. A resource-based approach provides an effective and af<strong>for</strong>dable mechanism <strong>for</strong><br />

achieving improved quality in traditional on-campus education. In IACT101 case, <strong>the</strong> majority of students<br />

appreciated <strong>the</strong> ef<strong>for</strong>ts of <strong>the</strong> instructor, were excited about learning while interacting with o<strong>the</strong>rs, and expressed<br />

<strong>the</strong> opinion that <strong>the</strong> IACT101 technology-enhanced learning environment directly contributed towards <strong>the</strong>ir<br />

active learning and satisfaction.<br />

References<br />

Bishop, A. S., Greer, J. E., & Cooke, J. E. (1997). The Co-operative Peer Response System: CPR <strong>for</strong> Students. <strong>Proceedings</strong><br />

of <strong>ED</strong>-M<strong>ED</strong>IA 97/<strong>ED</strong>-TELECOM 97, Calgary, Canada, 1997, <strong>Association</strong> <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> Advancement of Computing in Education<br />

(AACE) Charlottesville, VA, 172-178.<br />

Goldberg, M. W. (1997). Communication and Collaboration Tools in WebCT, <strong>Proceedings</strong> of <strong>the</strong> conference Enabling<br />

Network-Based Learning, May 28 - 30, 1997, Espoo, Finland.<br />

Gosper, M. V. & Rich, D. C. (1998). Introducing Flexibility into Educational Programs: The Macquarie University<br />

Experience. <strong>Proceedings</strong> of <strong>ED</strong>-M<strong>ED</strong>IA98/<strong>ED</strong>-TELECOM98, Calgary, Canada, 1997, <strong>Association</strong> <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> Advancement of<br />

Computing in Education (AACE), Charlottesville, VA, 472-478.<br />

Survey (1998). http://edt.uow.edu.au/edtlab/iact101/survey_results/index.html


In-service Teachers Teaching Pre-service Teachers Technology<br />

John H. Durnin<br />

Department of Education and Human Services<br />

Villanova University<br />

USA<br />

jdurnin@email.vill.edu<br />

The proposed project is an initiative through university courses to have graduate in-service teachers, who have learned<br />

<strong>the</strong> use of technology <strong>for</strong> classroom instruction, offer workshops to undergraduate pre-service teachers. The goals of <strong>the</strong><br />

project are two-fold. One is to prepare in-service teachers <strong>for</strong> collegial leadership in using instructional technology<br />

through experience in planning and offering workshops to pre-service teachers, and <strong>the</strong> second is to prepare pre-service<br />

teachers <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> instructional use of technology in <strong>the</strong> classroom.<br />

The specific objectives of <strong>the</strong> project are to develop in pre-service teachers, as well as <strong>the</strong> in-service teachers, <strong>the</strong><br />

competencies:<br />

$ To facilitate student use of multimedia systems in <strong>the</strong>ir subject matter learning<br />

$ To develop instructional material and lessons that involve students in <strong>the</strong> investigation of content areas<br />

through <strong>the</strong> use of technology.<br />

$ To implement <strong>the</strong> WWW as an educational resource <strong>for</strong> both teaching and student learning<br />

$ To develop computer generated verbal and graphic presentations to use with direct instruction<br />

$ To develop and deliver lessons that use <strong>the</strong> interactive capabilities of commercial software, CD ROM, laser<br />

disc, digital versatile disc and video cassette to involve students in <strong>the</strong> subject matter.<br />

$ To assist students in <strong>the</strong>ir applications of technology to communicate about a subject<br />

$ To guide student use of technology <strong>for</strong> individual or group inquiries into academic subjects.<br />

To accomplish <strong>the</strong>se objectives, a multiple sections undergraduate professional development course <strong>for</strong> pre-service<br />

teachers will be given during a 14 week semester. Concurrently, a graduate course on using technology in <strong>the</strong> classroom<br />

will be offered to in-service teachers.<br />

The proposed technologically enhanced undergraduate course will be presented in a recently renovated computer<br />

classroom/laboratory that can accommodate 16 students per class, each on a computer. The computers are networked<br />

new Power MacIntosh G3's. The classroom/laboratory also houses two color printers, a scanner, a laser disc player, a<br />

video cassette recorder, camcorder, a digital versatile disc (DVD) player and CD rewriteable drive. The room will also<br />

serve <strong>the</strong> graduate course <strong>for</strong> in-service teachers.<br />

The graduate course will be offered once a week in early evening. The undergraduate sections will each be offered <strong>for</strong> 2 2<br />

hours once a week on a late afternoon schedule to make <strong>the</strong>m available to <strong>the</strong> graduate students directing <strong>the</strong> workshops. The<br />

graduate students will receive intensive instruction on technology with respect to operating systems, minor maintenance and<br />

troubleshooting, functions of computer networking and printing, word processing, data base, spread sheet, slide show and<br />

presentation software, CD ROM, laser disc, DVD and <strong>the</strong> WWW with regard to classroom teaching. They, in turn, will be<br />

divided into teams to present three 2 2 hour workshops each, under <strong>the</strong> supervision of a university professor, to <strong>the</strong> preservice<br />

teachers. The workshops will be used to instruct <strong>the</strong> pre-service teachers in <strong>the</strong> generic technology competencies<br />

listed previously. In total, <strong>the</strong> pre-service teachers will receive six workshops focusing specifically on <strong>the</strong> use of technology<br />

in <strong>the</strong> classroom directed by <strong>the</strong> in-service teachers during <strong>the</strong> 14 week semester. In this manner <strong>the</strong> pre-service teachers will<br />

be learning and interacting with <strong>the</strong> in-service teachers concerning technology in <strong>the</strong> implementation of <strong>the</strong> above<br />

competencies. Fur<strong>the</strong>rmore, <strong>the</strong> in-service teachers by instructing <strong>the</strong> pre-service teachers will be improving <strong>the</strong>ir own<br />

expertise beyond <strong>the</strong> novice level and demonstrating leadership that could aid <strong>the</strong>m in <strong>the</strong> facilitation of technology among<br />

<strong>the</strong>ir colleagues.<br />

As a requirement of <strong>the</strong> undergraduate course <strong>the</strong> pre-service teachers will be expected to spend, at least, three hours with an<br />

in-service teacher in a secondary or elementary school classroom. The pre-service teacher will be required to develop in<br />

conjunction with <strong>the</strong> in-service teacher a short lesson that can be given to <strong>the</strong> elementary or secondary students. Since all of<br />

<strong>the</strong> schools in <strong>the</strong> participating school district have a computer laboratory, <strong>the</strong> pre-service teacher will develop a lesson using<br />

that facility. Thus, <strong>the</strong> undergraduate students will have an opportunity to apply <strong>the</strong>ir newly acquired technological abilities in


<strong>the</strong> classroom.<br />

The project will be evaluated in several ways. First, a standard instrument <strong>for</strong> evaluating <strong>the</strong> graduate and undergraduate<br />

courses will be applied. However, in addition to this standard evaluation, feedback with respect to specific components of a<br />

course or workshop will be solicited from <strong>the</strong> students. Fur<strong>the</strong>rmore, <strong>the</strong> instructors will use a self evaluation <strong>for</strong>m following<br />

each lesson in order to determine from <strong>the</strong>ir perspective what was effective in <strong>the</strong> lesson and what was not. The in-service<br />

teachers will be required to complete similar self evaluations following each workshop. The views and recommendations of<br />

in-service teachers cooperating with <strong>the</strong> undergraduate students= field experience will also be sought.. These evaluations<br />

should provide, at minimum, indirect evidence with respect to <strong>the</strong> effectiveness of <strong>the</strong> project and its effect upon students in<br />

<strong>the</strong> partnering K-12 classrooms. Part of our estimation of success of <strong>the</strong> project will be evaluated according to <strong>the</strong> feedback<br />

received from <strong>the</strong> pre-service and in-service teachers.<br />

Since all <strong>the</strong> courses are part of <strong>the</strong> academic program, <strong>the</strong> pre-service teachers will be evaluated according to <strong>the</strong><br />

per<strong>for</strong>mance and planning of <strong>the</strong>ir technology related lessons. The undergraduate course is a professional development<br />

course and students are required to plan and present mini lessons. Rubrics that address <strong>the</strong> use of technology have already<br />

been developed <strong>for</strong> a graduate course <strong>for</strong> in-service teachers. These rubrics can easily be adapted <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> evaluation of <strong>the</strong><br />

undergraduate students. In addition with regard to <strong>the</strong> field experience, feedback will be sought with respect to <strong>the</strong> preservice<br />

teachers= technological abilities in a classroom environment. This feedback will be considered in conjunction with<br />

per<strong>for</strong>mance in <strong>the</strong> university classroom.<br />

This project has received initial funding from <strong>the</strong> State of Pennsylvania as a pilot program attempting to facilitate pre-service<br />

and in-service interactions with respect to <strong>the</strong> classroom use of technology. Questions and suggestions with respect to <strong>the</strong><br />

project will be entertained from <strong>the</strong> attendees to this presentation.<br />

Acknowledgements: This project is supported in part by funds from <strong>the</strong> Commonwealth of Pennsylvania’s Link to Learn<br />

Project.


How <strong>the</strong> Construction & Analysis of Digital Movies<br />

Support Theory-Building<br />

Ricki Goldman-Segall, Associate Professor & Director<br />

MERLin (Multimedia Ethnographic Research Laboratory)<br />

Department of Curriculum Studies<br />

University of British Columbia, Canada<br />

http: www.merlin.ubc.ca<br />

<br />

Maggie Beers, Doctoral Candidate<br />

MERLin (Multimedia Ethnographic Research Laboratory)<br />

Department of Language Education<br />

University of British Columbia, Canada<br />

http: www.merlin.ubc.ca<br />

<br />

Suzanne de Castell, Professor<br />

Faculty of Education<br />

Simon Fraser University, Burnaby, Canada<br />

http://www.educ.sfu.ca/gentech/index.htm<br />

<br />

Mary Bryson, Associate Professor<br />

Department of Educational Psychology and Special Education<br />

University of British Columbia, Canada<br />

http://www.educ.sfu.ca/gentech/index.htm<br />

<br />

Brian Reilly, Assistant Professor<br />

Educational Technology Leadership Program<br />

School of Education and Allied Studies<br />

Cali<strong>for</strong>nia State University Hayward<br />

Hayward, CA, USA<br />

http://aeon.csuhayward.edu/~breilly<br />

<br />

Introduction<br />

Ricki Goldman-Segall<br />

We are at a time in <strong>the</strong> development of new tools when we can choose to design digital media authoring<br />

and annotation tools to promote <strong>the</strong> representation of many perspectives and identities. In this panel,<br />

researchers who have used digital media extensively over <strong>the</strong> last decade will address how “participants”<br />

in studies using digital media become collaborators and co-authors of rich-media texts. We will address


how we invite not only <strong>the</strong> participants, but also readers and viewers to partake in <strong>the</strong> construction of <strong>the</strong><br />

story being created. The question we will be tackling in this panel is: Does <strong>the</strong> construction and analysis<br />

of digital movies support <strong>the</strong>ory-building And is that <strong>the</strong>ory-building equitable We will explore this<br />

issue from various perspectives: tools and techniques; gender and culture; creative arts and media<br />

sciences; science and society; language and culture; learning and research methods; epistemology and<br />

ethnography; and, digital data and design teams. We will also discuss <strong>the</strong> <strong>the</strong>oretical perspectives on<br />

methodological issues that deal with how <strong>the</strong> making of media stories becomes a plat<strong>for</strong>m <strong>for</strong> discussing<br />

important issues such as: whose story is being told whose purpose is being presented what's <strong>the</strong> story<br />

which story gets told why do we tell stories in our knowledge making and, what tools do we need to<br />

create <strong>the</strong>se stories<br />

The underlying premise of this panel is that <strong>the</strong> creation of digital movies is a social experience very much<br />

affecting and affected (and sometimes thwarted) by <strong>the</strong> cultures in which <strong>the</strong>y are created. As creators<br />

represent <strong>the</strong>mselves and o<strong>the</strong>rs in <strong>the</strong>ir personal digital artifacts, <strong>the</strong>y contribute to <strong>the</strong> larger cultural<br />

context in which <strong>the</strong>ir work is situated, <strong>the</strong>reby changing <strong>the</strong> nature of <strong>the</strong> learning environment and <strong>the</strong><br />

cultures which constitute <strong>the</strong> community. Electronic media, when used in teaching and learning, thus<br />

involves both students and educators in a reflexive ethnographic experience where <strong>the</strong>y can build,<br />

deconstruct, and reconstruct <strong>the</strong>ir own and each o<strong>the</strong>r’s cultures. By inviting <strong>the</strong> “audience” to participate<br />

in <strong>the</strong>ir interpretation, learners can observe how new views are layered about <strong>the</strong>se media creations,<br />

extending <strong>the</strong> personal cultural story. A plat<strong>for</strong>m <strong>for</strong> multi-loguing is built and new communities of<br />

inquiry are <strong>for</strong>med.<br />

How Teaching & Learning Change Using Media-Rich Texts:<br />

Design Teams Using Ethnographic Methods & Tools<br />

Ricki Goldman-Segall<br />

As chair, moderator, and one of <strong>the</strong> presenters, I will invite <strong>the</strong> audience to think about <strong>the</strong> topic: How<br />

Teaching and Learning Change Using Media-Rich Texts: Design Teams Using Ethnographic Methods &<br />

Tools. This topic was my particular focus of a UBC Teaching & Learning Enhancement grant called<br />

Making Movies, Making Theories: Digital Media Tools <strong>for</strong> Educating Educators to Connect Experiences<br />

to Curriculum written by Goldman-Segall (PI) and Beers (Co-PI), 1998. The study was carried out in a<br />

Curriculum Studies Course called The Digital Media Classroom taught by Goldman-Segall and in a<br />

Modern Language Education course of taught by Beers. In The Digital Media Classroom, students created<br />

digital movies around <strong>the</strong> <strong>the</strong>me, Forests Past, Present, and Future and <strong>the</strong>n had <strong>the</strong> opportunity to<br />

analyze <strong>the</strong>ir constructions using both Constellations and WebConstellations, tools I have created to<br />

layer viewpoints and build not only <strong>the</strong> thick description, but also thick interpretations. Students<br />

connected <strong>the</strong>ir personal experience to <strong>the</strong> course content and critiqued <strong>the</strong> concepts <strong>the</strong>y were studying by<br />

designing cultural artifacts <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> purpose of viewing each o<strong>the</strong>r’s constructions using networked tools to<br />

share, annotate, and analyze <strong>the</strong>ir living narratives in relation to <strong>the</strong> subject being studied in <strong>the</strong><br />

classroom.<br />

One of recent innovations in Web-based media learning environments is that members of emerging online<br />

cultures can make meaning of <strong>the</strong> rich media texts <strong>the</strong>y construct as collaborative design teams. They can<br />

share <strong>the</strong>ir points of viewing and build upon each o<strong>the</strong>r’s thinking. They can construct knowledge toge<strong>the</strong>r<br />

as a community, creating new interpretations. And, <strong>the</strong>y can exhibit digital media artifacts using a range<br />

of media “<strong>for</strong>ms” that call <strong>for</strong> a new method of e-value/ation. Networked digital media tools <strong>for</strong><br />

collaborative investigation offer learners, educators, and researchers <strong>the</strong> opportunity to negotiate<br />

interpretations leading to more inclusive <strong>the</strong>ories of knowledge. Early tools on <strong>the</strong> Web promised this<br />

more inclusive cross-cultural paradigm concerning <strong>the</strong> generation of human knowledge. These new tools<br />

deliver.


Yet, still we ask ourselves: How does this latest technology change our previously-held notions of teaching<br />

and learning, researching and publishing How do we design learning environments to facilitate<br />

innovative plat<strong>for</strong>ms <strong>for</strong> engagement and response within <strong>the</strong>se socially constructed and mediated<br />

communities of inquiry In my presentation, I will describe how learners and educators use tools and<br />

techniques <strong>for</strong> collaborative <strong>the</strong>ory building. These research tools become learning environments—virtual<br />

places where <strong>the</strong>ories can be negotiated and shared as users view data from diverse perspectives. They<br />

become places where learners and educators work as teams to construct <strong>the</strong>ories as <strong>the</strong>y explore more<br />

deeply <strong>the</strong> real and virtual worlds <strong>the</strong>y inhabit<br />

Yet, <strong>the</strong>se new media cannot be embraced without taking into account <strong>the</strong> effect <strong>the</strong>y will have on our<br />

interpretation and construction of culture. By becoming involved in making <strong>the</strong>ir own digital movies,<br />

student and faculty creators may better understand <strong>the</strong> layers of discourse which characterize both <strong>the</strong>ir<br />

own and o<strong>the</strong>rs' cultures and can, in <strong>the</strong> process, participate in an ever evolving cultural discourse, <strong>the</strong>reby<br />

changing <strong>the</strong> nature of <strong>the</strong> didactic learning environment typically inhabiting our academic institutions.<br />

By becoming active participants in <strong>the</strong> research process, students, whom I will describe in this panel, were<br />

better able to examine diverse points of viewing embodied not only within <strong>the</strong> various cultures <strong>the</strong>y are<br />

members but within <strong>the</strong>mselves as a single individual.<br />

Cultural Readings of Digital Texts:<br />

A Media-Based Approach to Foreign Language Teaching & Learning<br />

Maggie Beers<br />

The new British Columbia <strong>for</strong>eign language curriculum <strong>for</strong> grades 5-12 highlights <strong>the</strong> importance of<br />

cultural understanding and positive attitudes <strong>for</strong> students’ success in <strong>the</strong>ir language learning endeavors as<br />

well as in <strong>the</strong>ir ability to assume <strong>the</strong>ir roles as international citizens. In order to effectively integrate <strong>the</strong><br />

notion of culture into <strong>the</strong>ir curriculum, <strong>for</strong>eign language teachers are encouraged to look beyond <strong>the</strong> fields<br />

of linguistics and literature to those of anthropology, sociology, psychology and education and to adopt a<br />

critical pedagogy of intercultural discourse which speaks to <strong>the</strong> multiple voices that comprise an<br />

individual and her culture (Kramsch, C. and von Hoene, L., 1995).<br />

Despite encouragement to use emerging technologies to create innovative learning environments that<br />

enable students to become ethnographers, ra<strong>the</strong>r than ‘tourists’ (Goldman-Segall, 1998, Fischer, 1996),<br />

<strong>for</strong>eign language teachers cite ‘textbook notes’ and ‘au<strong>the</strong>ntic texts’ as <strong>the</strong>ir top resources <strong>for</strong> teaching<br />

culture (Moore, 1996). Yet modern media, with <strong>the</strong>ir capabilities to create “media rich texts” complete<br />

with sound, images and video, create a new, unexplored predicament <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> language teacher and learner<br />

in this new role as ethnographer. Whereas <strong>the</strong> anthropologist traditionally started from a context-andexperience-rich<br />

environment and imagined a ‘text’, <strong>the</strong> language teacher and learner start with a ‘text’<br />

and must imagine a context, drawing from previous experience, knowledge, or stereotypes about <strong>the</strong><br />

<strong>for</strong>eign culture (Teroaka, 1989).<br />

Based on communicative language teaching and constructionist learning models, I’ve implemented a<br />

media-based approach which encourages pre-service and in-service <strong>for</strong>eign language teachers to use <strong>the</strong>ir<br />

personal experiences to create and interpret multi-layered “media rich texts.” Participants use a digital<br />

movie authoring and design tool, CineKit, to make representations of <strong>the</strong>mselves in <strong>the</strong> <strong>for</strong>m of digital<br />

movies and <strong>the</strong>n use WebConstellations to share, annotate and critique <strong>the</strong>ir living works in relation to<br />

<strong>the</strong> subject, (<strong>the</strong> integration of language and culture with modern media), being studied in <strong>the</strong> course.


The aim of this research is to develop <strong>the</strong>ories about how culture and representation affect one’s reading<br />

and interpretation of media texts. An initial pilot study to test this approach was funded by a UBC<br />

Teaching & Learning Enhancement grant: Making Movies, Making Theories: Digital Media Tools <strong>for</strong><br />

Educating Educators to Connect Experiences to Curriculum, written by Goldman-Segall (PI) and Beers<br />

(Co-PI), 1998, and carried out in July/August of 1998 in a Language Education Course I designed and<br />

taught <strong>for</strong> this study: Advanced Studies in Language Education: Integrating Language and Culture with<br />

Modern Media (ML<strong>ED</strong> 480B). The final phase of this research will be completed in <strong>the</strong> same course in<br />

May/June of <strong>1999</strong>.<br />

References<br />

Fischer, G. (1996). Tourist or explorer Reflections on <strong>the</strong> <strong>for</strong>eign language classroom. Foreign Language Annals<br />

29(1), 73-81.<br />

Goldman-Segall, R. (1998). Points of viewing children's thinking: A digital ethnographer's journey. Mahwah, New<br />

Jersey: Lawrence Erlbaum Associates.<br />

Kramsch, C. and von Hoene, L. (1995). The dialogic emergence of difference: Feminist explorations in <strong>for</strong>eign<br />

language learning and teaching. In Stanton, D.C., and Stewart, A.J. Feminisms in <strong>the</strong> academy. Ann Arbor: The<br />

University of Michigan Press, 330-357.<br />

Moore, Z. (1996) Culture: How do teachers teach it In Moore, Z. (Ed.) Foreign language teacher education:<br />

Multiple perspectives. Lanham, Maryland: University Press of America, 269-299.<br />

Teraoka, A.A. (1989). Is culture to us what text is to Anthropology A response to Jeffrey M. Peck’s paper. The<br />

German Quarterly 62 (2), 188-191.<br />

New Research Tools/Gender and Society<br />

Suzanne de Castell & Mary Bryson<br />

What is critical digital ethnography, and why do we need it This is a very important question. For as we<br />

learn to use <strong>the</strong> new research tools digital media provide, we might be <strong>for</strong>given <strong>for</strong> overlooking, in our<br />

warranted enthusiasm <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> ways of seeing <strong>the</strong>y make possible, some dimensions of <strong>the</strong> medium which<br />

can just as easily prevent us from seeing. In Fictions of Feminist Ethnography, Kamala Visweswaren<br />

(1994) speaks of <strong>the</strong> tension between deconstructive practices and realist images: that this is a necessary<br />

and productive tension is a claim we will explore by presenting, as examples, <strong>the</strong> particular uses we have<br />

made of digital "texts" within <strong>the</strong> GenTech research group (see http://www.educ.sfu.ca/gentech/) that we<br />

co-direct.<br />

The GenTech project has, <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> past six years, focused its research ef<strong>for</strong>ts on "girls, tools and schools".<br />

We have argued that access to uses of tools is a gendered per<strong>for</strong>mance enacted through its representation,<br />

and we argue, <strong>the</strong>re<strong>for</strong>e, that research 'stories' ought conscientiously to interfere with any propensity to<br />

represent gender "differences" as natural, fixed or immutable. In this session, we will make use of<br />

GenTech's digital movies about gender and tool use to explore a conception of <strong>the</strong>ory as <strong>the</strong>atre and<br />

digital research as "culture-jamming". (1998)<br />

We have all been trained, through our years of text-based education, to read deconstructively, to question<br />

and challenge and unpack <strong>the</strong> literary and figurative and narratological devices whose evolution and<br />

sophistication is part of our long and well-developed literate tradition. It is in this way that <strong>the</strong>ory can<br />

outstrip practice---even with new tools. We know that we, and perhaps to a lesser extent, our students, are<br />

far less well-equipped to deconstruct visual texts, and <strong>the</strong>re is a substantial body of scholarship from<br />

within screen <strong>the</strong>ory which testifies to our increased vulnerability to being what we might call<br />

"impressionable readers" of filmic and video "texts"(Joyrich, 1995). As one grade 3 student insisted<br />

"When we see it on television, we think its true". We want to build on this simple reminder, an important<br />

caution ---its not just <strong>the</strong> grade threes who "think its true". As filmmaker Trinh T Minh-ha has advised


us, we need to be ever-conscious of <strong>the</strong> way fiction does its best work at <strong>the</strong> very heart of factual<br />

representation.<br />

When we read an account of, <strong>for</strong> example, gender inequity in a science classroom, we are accustomed to<br />

speculating, re-considering, weighing <strong>the</strong> evidence, imagining counter-instances, presuming <strong>the</strong>re is<br />

much more we are NOT being told. But when we view, <strong>for</strong> instance, an eleven year old girl telling us<br />

"Boys and girls have equal access to <strong>the</strong> school computers, only she herself is "just not interested" in<br />

computers, or a high school girl reassuring us that "girls can do anything, I just don't like science", our<br />

critical faculties are more inclined to, as Wittegnstein put it, "go on a holiday". The danger <strong>for</strong> us is that<br />

we risk reproducing, albeit with new research tools, <strong>the</strong> very positivism we imagine ourselves to have left<br />

far behind. And clearly, a proliferation of realist accounts alters that not a whit: all that this produces is a<br />

pluralistic positivism, but positivism it is all <strong>the</strong> same.<br />

As is so often <strong>the</strong> case, we may need to go backwards in order to move ahead, and where we can most<br />

usefully go back to, we suggest, is to <strong>the</strong> medium of <strong>the</strong>atre, and specifically, to <strong>the</strong> activist <strong>the</strong>atre of<br />

Bertold Brecht, to resurrect <strong>for</strong> our use with <strong>the</strong>se new tools, some invaluable, but currently overlooked,<br />

old representational practices. In this presentation, we describe and illustrate <strong>the</strong> "mise-en-scene" of<br />

digital practice, in order to construe <strong>the</strong>ory as <strong>the</strong>atre, and to outline a post-critical per<strong>for</strong>mative praxis of<br />

digital representation.<br />

Creating Interactive Representations of Student Multimedia Work:<br />

Ethnomultimediography<br />

Brian Reilly<br />

Anthropological methods of ethnography, especially those applied to learning contexts (Erickson, 1984;<br />

Florio-Ruane, 1989; Flower, 1989; Lave & Wenger, 1991; Wolcott, 1995) as well as more recent <strong>the</strong>ories<br />

of activity <strong>the</strong>ory as applied to technology use (Nardi, 1996b) emphasize <strong>the</strong> importance of understanding<br />

context as it relates to learning and technology use. Schools and classrooms are communities where<br />

tradition, cultural norms, and social relationships greatly influence what goes on, what gets done, and who<br />

does it. In order to understand and represent <strong>the</strong> particular learning communities I will discuss in my<br />

presentation, I chose to create interactive multimedia representations of <strong>the</strong>se communities and contexts in<br />

an attempt to more faithfully and fully describe and present what went on in <strong>the</strong>m. I use <strong>the</strong> term<br />

“ethnomultimediography” to capture this approach to research and representation.<br />

This type of qualitative research includes elements of participant observation, oral history, ethnography,<br />

and case study, and requires some changes in <strong>the</strong> research process to incorporate multiple media –– print,<br />

video, interactive multimedia –– in <strong>the</strong> final representations. Discussions of multimedia ethnography<br />

(Goldman-Segall, 1995; Goldman-Segall, 1998) have influenced and in<strong>for</strong>med my research methods as<br />

well.<br />

Using video extensively to record classroom observations and interviews changes <strong>the</strong> relationship between<br />

<strong>the</strong> researcher and <strong>the</strong> research participants, in this case, teachers and students. In contexts where students<br />

<strong>the</strong>mselves are multimedia/video producers, using a video camera can be less of an intrusion than it might<br />

be elsewhere, but it is still an intrusion, as student work is not generally documented in this way. One<br />

research tradition, that of subject anonymity, presents a challenge when <strong>the</strong> faces and voices of <strong>the</strong><br />

participants <strong>for</strong>m much of <strong>the</strong> content of <strong>the</strong> multimedia research report, but by making <strong>the</strong> participants<br />

aware of <strong>the</strong> research goals from <strong>the</strong> outset and treating <strong>the</strong>ir words and work with respect can make <strong>the</strong><br />

absence of anonymity a strength ra<strong>the</strong>r than a limitation.<br />

In my presentation, I will briefly show examples of digital video incorporated into multimedia<br />

representations of research on student multimedia work. I will discuss how <strong>the</strong>se representations change


our understanding of <strong>the</strong> learning communities <strong>the</strong>y are drawn from, and how <strong>the</strong> process of creating<br />

<strong>the</strong>m affects <strong>the</strong> researcher and <strong>the</strong> “researched”.<br />

References<br />

Florio-Ruane, S. (1989). Social organization of classes and schools (IP 89-2): National Center <strong>for</strong> Research on<br />

Teacher Learning.<br />

Flower, L. (1989). Studying cognition in context: Introduction to <strong>the</strong> study (Technical Report 21): Center <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong><br />

Study of Writing and Literacy.<br />

Goldman-Segall, R. (1998). Points of viewing children's thinking: A digital ethnographer's journey. Mahwah, New<br />

Jersey: Lawrence Erlbaum Associates.<br />

Goldman-Segall, R. (1995). Configurational validity: A proposal <strong>for</strong> analyzing ethnographic narratives. Journal <strong>for</strong><br />

Educational Multimedia and Hypermedia, 4 (2), 163–182.<br />

Lave, J., & Wenger, E. (1991). Situated learning: Legitimate peripheral participation. Cambridge, MA: Cambridge<br />

University Press.<br />

Wolcott, H. (1995). The art of fieldwork. Walnut Creek: AltaMira Press.<br />

Nardi, B. (1996a). Activity <strong>the</strong>ory and human-computer interaction. In B. Nardi (Ed.), Context and consciousness:<br />

Activity <strong>the</strong>ory and human-computer interaction. Cambridge: MIT Press.


A Reporting Simulation Using Toolbook<br />

Kerry Grant<br />

For a number of reasons, computer simulation of news reporting assignments provides significant<br />

benefits. The computer environment allows beginning students to gain much needed practice in <strong>the</strong> task of<br />

accurate note taking from both face-to-face and telephone interviews, without <strong>the</strong> anxiety induced by <strong>the</strong><br />

need to ask <strong>for</strong> in<strong>for</strong>mation from strangers who may not always be cooperative. Fur<strong>the</strong>rmore, <strong>the</strong> instructor<br />

need not continually depend on <strong>the</strong> goodwill of local sources of news as each new group of students goes<br />

through <strong>the</strong> learning process. “Newsroom” is a work in progress which aims to provide novice newswriters<br />

with a convincing simulation of <strong>the</strong> news ga<strong>the</strong>ring process, from initial assignment to completed story.<br />

The student can ask questions and take notes from filmed responses or from telephone “conversations”<br />

initiated ei<strong>the</strong>r by <strong>the</strong> student or by sources. Interviews can be recorded <strong>for</strong> quote checking when deadline<br />

pressures permit.


Evaluating collaborative telelearning scenarios:<br />

A sociocultural perspective<br />

Frode Guribye & Barbara Wasson<br />

Department of In<strong>for</strong>mation Science<br />

University of Bergen<br />

N-5020 Bergen, NORWAY<br />

Frode.Guribye@ifi.uib.no Barbara.Wasson@ifi.uib.no<br />

Introduction<br />

In this paper we discuss work in progress by describing <strong>the</strong> conceptual framework we are using to identify patterns of<br />

collaboration in collaborative telelearning scenarios within <strong>the</strong> Norwegian project DoCTA [1]. Project DoCTA focuses on<br />

<strong>the</strong> design and use of artefacts in collaborative telelearning scenarios aimed at teacher training. Various scenarios utilising<br />

<strong>the</strong> Internet are used to engage <strong>the</strong> students in collaborative learning activities. An ongoing exploratory study is analysing<br />

four different scenarios.<br />

In <strong>the</strong> first scenario, a pilot study is analysing <strong>the</strong> use of Teamwave Workplace [2] <strong>for</strong> collaborative activities in a graduate<br />

university course [3] at <strong>the</strong> University of Bergen (UiB). The next two scenarios involve European inter-cultural simulations<br />

where <strong>the</strong> goal is to design a textual artefact (such as a treaty or policy statement). In IDEELS [4] teams of Norwegian<br />

students at UiB and Nord-Trøndelag College (HiNT) collaborate with teams in Germany, Spain and France to develop a<br />

treaty. In Demeter [5] Parliament, Norwegian students at Stord/Haugesund College (Stord) collaborate with students from 13<br />

countries to contribute solutions to contemporary problems facing <strong>the</strong> European community. In VisArt, a fourth scenario<br />

being designed, developed and deployed <strong>for</strong> use between Norwegian educational institutions, <strong>the</strong> goal is to design a visual<br />

artefact to be used in teaching a subject of choice. In this scenario, teams will comprise students from <strong>the</strong> three Norwegian<br />

participating educational institutions (UiB, HiNT and Stord).<br />

Collaboration Patterns<br />

From a research perspective, <strong>the</strong> exploratory study being carried out within DoCTA will provide us with insight into <strong>the</strong><br />

processes of collaboration enabling us to identify collaboration patterns and fur<strong>the</strong>r our understanding of how instructors,<br />

students and o<strong>the</strong>r learning facilitators organise <strong>the</strong>ir learning and work.<br />

The community of study includes teachers, learners and facilitators participating in <strong>the</strong> various collaborative telelearning<br />

scenarios. The main research question has been <strong>for</strong>mulated to ask how <strong>the</strong>se students, teachers and facilitators organise <strong>the</strong>ir<br />

learning and work given <strong>the</strong> different scenarios. The four collaborative telelearning scenarios vary with respect to:<br />

• actor characteristics (e.g., within a common community vs. disparate and divergent cultural backgrounds; similar<br />

knowledge and preparation vs. different knowledge and preparation; etc.),<br />

• aspects of <strong>the</strong> learning activity (e.g., text based vs. visually based; well-defined learning tasks and goals vs. illstructured<br />

tasks and goals; etc.),<br />

• <strong>the</strong> kinds of artefacts <strong>the</strong>y have access to (e.g., <strong>the</strong> artefacts provided in <strong>the</strong> various internet environments[6]), and<br />

• <strong>the</strong> kinds of artefacts <strong>the</strong>y are to design (e.g., textual or visual)<br />

Conceptual approach<br />

The underlying conceptual framework adopted in this research is taken from three different, although closely interrelated<br />

approaches, namely: activity <strong>the</strong>ory (Leontev, 1978, Engeström 1987), distributed cognition (Hutchins, 1995), and situated<br />

action (Suchman, 1987, Lave, 1988, Mantovani, 1996). One of <strong>the</strong> goals of this research is to argue that, toge<strong>the</strong>r, <strong>the</strong>se<br />

approaches make up a rich framework <strong>for</strong> describing, evaluating and analysing collaborative telelearning scenarios. All three<br />

approaches underscore <strong>the</strong> need to look at real activities in real situations (Nardi, 1996, our italics), and always, in some<br />

way, include <strong>the</strong> context in studies of human activity.<br />

The rationale <strong>for</strong> combining <strong>the</strong>se three approaches as <strong>the</strong> conceptual foundation of this study, is that <strong>the</strong>y all fall under what<br />

is called a sociocultural perspective (Wertsch, del Río & Alvarez, 1995), that highlights learning and thinking as<br />

phenomenon that can not be studied in isolation. Ra<strong>the</strong>r, <strong>the</strong>y are complex processes situated or distributed in an<br />

[1] http://www.ifi.uib.no/docta/<br />

[3] http://www.ifi.uib.no/staff/barbara/courses/host98.html<br />

[4] http://ftp.uni-bremen.de/wwwgast/fzhb/ideels/public_html/index.html<br />

[5] http://hugin.hsh.no/prosjekt/demeter/index.htm<br />

[6] E.g., in IDEELS <strong>the</strong> artefacts <strong>the</strong>y have access to include <strong>the</strong>ir own email system, Teamwave Workplace, and OPUSi a<br />

web-based conferencing system developed at <strong>the</strong> University of Bremen, Germany.


environment — it is impossible to separate <strong>the</strong>m from <strong>the</strong> context in which <strong>the</strong>y occur. The different approaches each<br />

emphasise slightly different elements of <strong>the</strong> framework that is important to be aware of in <strong>the</strong>se kinds of studies. Situated<br />

action emphasises <strong>the</strong> emergent, contingent nature of human activity, <strong>the</strong> way activity grows directly out of <strong>the</strong><br />

particularities of a given situation (Nardi, 1996). Distributed cognition on <strong>the</strong> o<strong>the</strong>r hand, asserts as a unit of analysis a<br />

cognitive system composed of individuals and <strong>the</strong> artefacts <strong>the</strong>y use (Hutchins, 1991, Nardi, 1996). This approach<br />

underscores <strong>the</strong> distributed nature of cognitive processes, and <strong>the</strong> role that different artefacts play in <strong>the</strong>se processes. Activity<br />

<strong>the</strong>ory also emphasises <strong>the</strong> mediating role of artefacts, but stresses that <strong>the</strong>se artefacts carry with <strong>the</strong>m a particular culture<br />

and history, thus, focuses on <strong>the</strong> institutional and cultural elements involved in <strong>the</strong> learning activity (Kuutti, 1996). Adoption<br />

of <strong>the</strong>se approaches provides a strong and fruitful conceptual framework that in<strong>for</strong>ms <strong>the</strong> evaluation of collaboration patterns<br />

in collaborative telelearning scenarios.<br />

Evaluation approach<br />

The evaluation aims at a naturalistic study of how participants in collaborative telelearning organise <strong>the</strong>ir work and learning<br />

activities. Ethnography (e.g. Hammersley & Atkinson, 1983) influences <strong>the</strong> design of our evaluation approach including <strong>the</strong><br />

choice of data collection (e.g., participant observations, unstructured interviews, video recordings) and analysis techniques<br />

(e.g., discourse analysis, video analysis). This means that <strong>the</strong> evaluation is an iterative process where an ongoing analysis<br />

guides <strong>the</strong> data collection emphasis in successive phases.<br />

In order to collect data about <strong>the</strong> activities that <strong>the</strong> students engage in during <strong>the</strong>ir participation in <strong>the</strong> scenarios, different<br />

methods and techniques will be used. The most important sources of in<strong>for</strong>mation will be derived from observing <strong>the</strong> students<br />

as <strong>the</strong>y collaborate and interviewing <strong>the</strong>m, and also from electronic logging of artefacts used <strong>for</strong> collaborating (e.g., email,<br />

shared whiteboards, chats, to-do-lists) and artefacts designed (e.g., a web page) during <strong>the</strong> collaboration. It is a challenge to<br />

carry out <strong>the</strong> participant observations since a large number of <strong>the</strong> students are geographically distributed over Norway thus<br />

direct observation of all <strong>the</strong> students is unrealistic and too costly. Ra<strong>the</strong>r, an alternative technique consisting of immersing<br />

ourselves in <strong>the</strong> virtual environment in order to observe <strong>the</strong>ir activities will be used. For this reason, <strong>the</strong> electronic data logs<br />

will be an extremely important supplement to <strong>the</strong> “online” and “offline” observations. The data being logged, is not just<br />

statistical data recording who is logged on when, but includes a periodic chronological recording of all artefacts in <strong>the</strong><br />

environment. This means that we can recreate versions of <strong>the</strong> environment to study <strong>the</strong> use of artefacts over time and <strong>the</strong><br />

creation and development of <strong>the</strong> artefacts produced in <strong>the</strong> collaboration process.<br />

Data collected in <strong>the</strong> fall of 1998 has been analysed and used to in<strong>for</strong>m <strong>the</strong> data collection in <strong>the</strong> spring <strong>1999</strong> scenarios. At<br />

<strong>ED</strong>M<strong>ED</strong>IA’99 we will be able to provide a preliminary report on our findings.<br />

References<br />

Engeström, Y (1987) Learning By Expanding: An activity-<strong>the</strong>oretical approach to developmental<br />

research. Helsinki: Orienta-Konsultit Oy<br />

Hammersley, M & Atkinson, P. (1983). Ethnography. Principles in Practice. London : Tavistock<br />

Hutchins, E. (1995) Cognition in <strong>the</strong> Wild. Cambridge, MA: MIT Press.<br />

Hutchins, E. (1991) The social organisation of distributed cognition. In Resnick, L. (Ed.) Perspectives on<br />

Socially Shared Cognition (pp. 238-287). Washington, DC: American Psychological <strong>Association</strong>.<br />

Jonassen, D. & Rohrer-Murphy (<strong>1999</strong>) Activity <strong>the</strong>ory as a framework <strong>for</strong> designing constructivist learning<br />

environments. Educational Technology: Research and Development, 47 (1).<br />

Kuutti, K. (1996) Activity <strong>the</strong>ory as a Potential framework <strong>for</strong> human-computer interaction research.<br />

In Nardi, B. A. (ed.) Context and consciousness: Activity <strong>the</strong>ory and human-computer interaction. Cambridge, MA:<br />

MIT Press<br />

Lave, J. (1998) Cognition in Practice. Cambridge University Press.<br />

Leont’ev, A. N. (1978) Activity, Consciousness, Personality. Englewood Cliffs,NJ: Prentice Hall.<br />

Mantovani, G (1996) New Communication Environments: From Everyday to Virtual. London:<br />

Taylor & Francis Ltd.<br />

Nardi, B. A. (1996) Studying Context: A comparison of activity <strong>the</strong>ory, situated action models<br />

and distributed cognition. In Nardi, B. A. (Ed.) Context and Consciousness: Activity Theory and Human-computer<br />

Interaction. Cambridge, MA: MIT Press<br />

Suchman, L. (1987). Plans and Situated Action. The problems of human-machine<br />

communication. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.<br />

Wertsch, J. V., del Río, P. & Alvarez, A. (1995) Sociocultural studies: history, action and mediation.<br />

In Wertsch, J. V., del Río, P. & Alvarez, A. Sociocultural Studies of Mind. Cambridge University Press.<br />

Acknowledgements<br />

DoCTA is funded by The Norwegian Ministry of Education, Research and Church Affairs (KUF) under <strong>the</strong>ir In<strong>for</strong>mation<br />

Technology in Education (ITU) programme. It is a collaboration between researchers at <strong>the</strong> University of Bergen (UiB),<br />

Stord/Haugesund College (Stord), Nord-Trøndelag College (HiNT) and Telenor Research and Development (Telenor FOU).


Authoring and Maintaining of Educational Applications on The Web<br />

Denis Helic<br />

Institute <strong>for</strong> In<strong>for</strong>mation Processing and Computer Supported New Media (IICM), Graz University of<br />

Technology Graz, Austria<br />

e-mail: dhelic@iicm.edu<br />

Hermann Maurer<br />

Institute <strong>for</strong> In<strong>for</strong>mation Processing and Computer Supported New Media (IICM), Graz University of<br />

Technology Graz, Austria<br />

e-mail: hmaurer@iicm.edu<br />

Nick Scherbakov<br />

Institute <strong>for</strong> In<strong>for</strong>mation Processing and Computer Supported New Media (IICM), Graz University of<br />

Technology Graz, Austria<br />

e-mail: nsherbak@iicm.edu<br />

Abstract: The presented paper clarifies <strong>the</strong> current situation at <strong>the</strong> field of <strong>the</strong> authoring and<br />

maintaining of educational applications on <strong>the</strong> Web. The paper lists well-known problems<br />

concerning <strong>the</strong> design of educational applications in general, as well as specific problems<br />

connected with educational applications meant to be published on <strong>the</strong> Web. Some comparison<br />

of widely used methods <strong>for</strong> authoring and maintaining of educational applications on <strong>the</strong> Web<br />

is, on <strong>the</strong> hand of method's advantages and disadvantages, presented as well. Thus, we<br />

propose a new approach to this specific problematic, that we believe, solves a number of<br />

problems related to <strong>the</strong> <strong>the</strong>me. This new approach to <strong>the</strong> authoring and maintaining of<br />

educational applications on <strong>the</strong> Web is based on <strong>the</strong> concept of hypermedia composites, so<br />

this concept we explain in details.<br />

1. Introduction<br />

An educational application can be seen as a special kind of a database system whose data contains some<br />

educational material. In modern educational applications <strong>the</strong> educational material is always presented using<br />

different types of media, such as text, graphics, animations, video, audio, and so on, i.e. an educational<br />

application is actually a kind of a multimedia database system. Fur<strong>the</strong>r, an educational application has to insure a<br />

unique and non-sequential method of accessing in<strong>for</strong>mation, and that leads us to <strong>the</strong> comprehension of <strong>the</strong><br />

educational application as a special kind of a hypermedia system. The essential feature of a node-link model<br />

hypermedia system are documents nodes ( HTML documents ) and links. Documents can contain text, graphics,<br />

audio, video, animation, and images while links connect nodes related in a certain manner. It is <strong>the</strong> linking<br />

capability which allows <strong>the</strong> non-linear organisation of text. Currently, many organisations consider using<br />

hypermedia as an advanced educational media. Such educational hypermedia databases containing hundreds of<br />

documents are normally referred to as WWW educational applications.<br />

The comprehension and general quality of an educational application in general, and a WWW<br />

educational application in particular, depends on <strong>the</strong> reader's ability to construct a coherent mental representation<br />

of <strong>the</strong> educational in<strong>for</strong>mation. It is <strong>the</strong> author's responsibility to ensure <strong>the</strong> construction of <strong>the</strong> database as a<br />

coherent entity. The construction of a coherent hypermedia databases can be considered to be a design problem.<br />

There are no established guidelines <strong>for</strong> authoring such databases. Going beyond such well-known<br />

recommendations that a hypermedia database should consist of <strong>the</strong> following three components - <strong>the</strong> content<br />

part, <strong>the</strong> organisational part, and <strong>the</strong> presentation part.<br />

Normally, authoring of a WWW educational application is carried out on a local authoring site, where a<br />

big number of HTML documents are created using such an easy to use WYSIWYG authoring environment as<br />

MS Front Page or Netscape Page Composer. After creating a sufficient number of documents <strong>the</strong>y are<br />

interrelated by means of computer navigable links and <strong>the</strong> whole course is uploaded into a Web server where it<br />

becomes available <strong>for</strong> remote access.<br />

While problem of authoring HTML documents got a scrutiny, and <strong>the</strong>re even exists a number of<br />

solutions implemented as so-called HTML Editing Systems, <strong>the</strong> problem of navigating, or more precisely, of<br />

authoring of a convenient navigable structure helping users to construct a coherent mental representation of <strong>the</strong><br />

educational in<strong>for</strong>mation, does not attract much attention.


Actually, when a particular author deals with creating hypermedia links (i.e. with imposing of a<br />

navigable structure on a top of a big number of HTML documents), this task is far from being a trivial one. First<br />

of all, educational applications are considered to be ra<strong>the</strong>r big ones. Fur<strong>the</strong>r <strong>the</strong>y are also heavily structured.<br />

It is interesting to note that HTML authoring software generally do not use HTML tags as an authoring<br />

paradigm. Such authoring systems normally use a publishing logical model, where an author can place objects<br />

on a particular position, cut and paste fragments of arbitrary complexity, etc., At <strong>the</strong> same time, link editing still<br />

follows <strong>the</strong> most primitive node-link paradigm.<br />

Obviously, decreasing of a interrelating complexity of a big number of HTML documents can be done<br />

via <strong>the</strong> usage of some powerful logical linking model ( such as Hyperwave data model or HM-data model ). This<br />

model should provide ano<strong>the</strong>r logical view to hundreds of documents which should be interrelated, and thus<br />

make authoring considerable easier and even error-proven. But if we try to investigate all advantages and<br />

disadvantages when using some new logical data model in <strong>the</strong> authoring of educational applications, we see that<br />

such usage beside advantages, such as: considerably simpler authoring, support <strong>for</strong> referential integrity, to<br />

mention only <strong>the</strong> important ones has also a number of disadvantages. The disadvantages can be classified as<br />

follows: - authors need to learn a new data model, i.e. sometimes it needs a months to know all <strong>the</strong> facilities of a<br />

system supporting a new logical data model - <strong>the</strong> models support only primitive data structuring elements - <strong>the</strong><br />

models do not reflect particular features of an application and still require tedious authoring.<br />

Once, an educational application has been created, an author publishes it on <strong>the</strong> Web, i.e. <strong>the</strong> author<br />

uploads <strong>the</strong> educational application on a Web server. In <strong>the</strong> opposite to <strong>the</strong> authoring of WWW educational<br />

applications, which is done on a local site, <strong>the</strong> maintaining of WWW educational applications is mostly done on<br />

<strong>the</strong> server site, i.e. online. Of course, that in <strong>the</strong> case of some big changes that have to be per<strong>for</strong>med on a WWW<br />

educational application an author can download <strong>the</strong> WWW educational application as a whole, modify it on a<br />

local site and <strong>the</strong>n upload it once more, but that would rarely be <strong>the</strong> case, ra<strong>the</strong>r <strong>the</strong>se changes are small and<br />

consist mostly of deletion or inserting of a small number of documents. But even in this simplest case <strong>the</strong><br />

maintaining of WWW educational applications is connected with big problems. Let us here mention only few of<br />

<strong>the</strong>m. If <strong>the</strong> node-link model has been used to prepare and publish a WWW educational application, i.e. <strong>the</strong><br />

WWW educational application has been uploaded on a standard Web ( HTTP ) server <strong>the</strong> deletion of a document<br />

means also editing of all HTML documents pointing to <strong>the</strong> deleted one. In <strong>the</strong> case of <strong>the</strong> inserting of a HTML<br />

document we have <strong>the</strong> same problem. The usage of ano<strong>the</strong>r, better structured, logical model can solve integrity<br />

and link consistency problems, but it has also earlier mentioned disadvantages.<br />

Thus, we think that a new approach to <strong>the</strong> authoring and maintaining of educational applications on <strong>the</strong><br />

Web should be introduced. We propose <strong>the</strong> concept of a hypermedia composites, that we believe solve a number<br />

of problems mentioned be<strong>for</strong>e.<br />

Hypermedia composites should be seen as a higher level of hypermedia authoring. The hypermedia<br />

composite represents a collection of multimedia documents and/or o<strong>the</strong>r hypermedia composites. It has some<br />

internal navigational structure, that can be defined. The visualisation of a hypermedia composite can also be<br />

defined in desirable way. The hypermedia composite can be so organised that it full fills all needed aspects of a<br />

particular educational application. The data model which is <strong>the</strong> concept of hypermedia composites based upon<br />

could be classified as <strong>the</strong> semantic data model.<br />

The semantic data models introduce purpose-oriented data structure types suitable <strong>for</strong> a particular<br />

application. These semantic data types with its navigational structure and its visualisation mechanism, as well<br />

with <strong>the</strong> data modification operations are defined using a well defined Data Definition Language ( DDL ) and<br />

Data Modification Language ( DML ) and are produced by <strong>the</strong> data administrator on <strong>the</strong> demand of an author. In<br />

this way an author can concentrate on <strong>the</strong> production of comprehend and convenient educational applications, so<br />

he can see <strong>the</strong> authoring process as in <strong>the</strong> first hand a design and not as a technical problem.<br />

Each hypermedia composite can be mapped to a widely used hypermedia logical data model, in this<br />

way it could be uploaded on a Web server, and what is very important an inverse map can be per<strong>for</strong>med, so <strong>the</strong><br />

maintaining of a hypermedia composite, from an author point of view, does not differ from <strong>the</strong> authoring.<br />

2. Hypermedia Composite<br />

The hypermedia composite is a basic concept of what we called Hypermedia Composite Data Model.<br />

The Hypermedia Composite Data Model insures higher level of authoring and maintaining of educational<br />

applications on <strong>the</strong> Web. As object-oriented programming languages insure higher level of data abstraction <strong>the</strong>n<br />

<strong>the</strong> procedural programming languages do, so <strong>the</strong> Hypermedia Composite Data Model gives us <strong>the</strong> possibility to<br />

define many different "classes" of educational applications, that will best match with <strong>the</strong> requirements of a<br />

particular application. Each "class" of educational applications has <strong>the</strong> predefined navigational structure and <strong>the</strong><br />

visualisation paradigm. An author's task is to choose <strong>the</strong> best "class" of educational applications <strong>for</strong> his particular<br />

needs, <strong>the</strong>n to construct a number of instances of this educational application class and fill it with HTML


documents. It is a task of a data administrator to produce "classes" of educational applications on specific<br />

demand of an author.<br />

As we mentioned be<strong>for</strong>e <strong>the</strong> hypermedia composite is <strong>the</strong> main construct of <strong>the</strong> proposed model. Here<br />

we distinguish between two terms: <strong>the</strong> hypermedia composite unit ( HC unit ) and <strong>the</strong> hypermedia composite<br />

type ( HC type ). An HC unit represents a collection of HTML documents and/or o<strong>the</strong>r HC units, which are<br />

called members hence<strong>for</strong>th. Here we can draw a line of equivalency between an HC unit and an educational<br />

application, because an HC unit in <strong>the</strong> Hypermedia Composite Data Model is an educational application.<br />

An HC unit can be treated in two ways. One way is <strong>the</strong> manipulation of <strong>the</strong> HC unit, i.e. an author can create a<br />

new HC unit, insert members into it, delete already existing members, save ( publish onto a Web server) <strong>the</strong> HC<br />

unit, and so on.<br />

The second way to treat an HC unit is to access it on <strong>the</strong> Web and to browse its content. This means that<br />

each HC unit, additionally, encapsulates a special navigational paradigm, i.e. computer-navigable links between<br />

members of <strong>the</strong> HC unit. As can be expected of a hypermedia system, whenever an user accesses such HC unit<br />

with an ordinary Web browser, it is visualised in a <strong>for</strong>m of interrelated HTML pages. The concept can be<br />

explained with a simple example ( Figure 1 ).<br />

Figure 1: Hypermedia Composite Unit = Educational Application on <strong>the</strong> Web<br />

Consider a hypermedia system that contains course modules. A set of nodes presenting in<strong>for</strong>mation on a<br />

certain topic, can be joined toge<strong>the</strong>r to <strong>for</strong>m a conceptual group - an HC unit "Course with a given name". Thus<br />

<strong>the</strong> HC unit in question would contain HTML documents ( members ) - "title page", "abstract", "referential<br />

material", etc. Moreover, it might contain even o<strong>the</strong>r HC units presenting chapters units.<br />

We can now generalise a number of HC units having <strong>the</strong> same navigational structure to a concept of <strong>the</strong><br />

hypermedia composite type. A hypermedia composite type ( HC type ) is a meta definition of a specific linking<br />

structure which is automatically supported by all instances, i.e. HC units, of this type. It can be seen as an<br />

abstract data type and in <strong>the</strong> analogy to <strong>the</strong> programming languages as a class of objects. In this way we consider<br />

any HC unit as an instance of a particular HC type. Here we can say that an HC unit represents a class of similar<br />

educational applications, i.e. it is a template <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> creation and manipulation of educational applications.<br />

Thus we can say that a HC type automatically impose a particular navigable structure on <strong>the</strong> top of<br />

collection of existing HTML pages r o<strong>the</strong>r HC units defined as members of a HC unit. For example we can<br />

define an HC type "Course" ( Figure 2 ).<br />

Figure 2: Hypermedia Composite Type = Class of Educational Applications


Any instance of this type is an HC unit consisting of HTML documents ( or o<strong>the</strong>r HC units ) labelled as:<br />

"Content", "Abstract", "Chapters" or "References". The term "labelled" deserves an additional discussion since it<br />

is very important concept of HC types.<br />

In fact, members of an HC unit play essentially different roles when such unit is accessed or browsed by<br />

users. In our particular case, users might expect that: - <strong>the</strong> document "Content" is shown and provide references<br />

to all "Chapters" whenever <strong>the</strong>y access <strong>the</strong> course; - any "Chapter" is provided with references to <strong>the</strong> "next" and<br />

"prior" "Chapters"; - "Chapters" are automatically provided with a number of "References" <strong>for</strong> fur<strong>the</strong>r diting, etc.<br />

These "labels" are used by <strong>the</strong> mapping mechanism in order to get <strong>the</strong> proper visualisation of an HC<br />

unit when it is accessed or browsed, For example if an HC unit is to be mapped onto <strong>the</strong> Hyperwave logical data<br />

model, most probably "labels" will be mapped into <strong>the</strong> attributes of a Hyperwave object, so <strong>the</strong>y can be later<br />

interpreted in <strong>the</strong> proper way. More on this topic in <strong>the</strong> following chapters let us now go back to <strong>the</strong> concept of<br />

HC types.<br />

Practically speaking, we can perceive an HC type as a special template consisting of a number of cells.<br />

Each cell represent a member ( a set of members ) having identical properties. Similarly an HC unit might be<br />

seen as an HC type template filled with existing HTML documents and/or o<strong>the</strong>r existing HC units.<br />

Thus, from an author point of view, <strong>the</strong>re is a number of predefined templates ( HC types ) where <strong>the</strong><br />

author can simply insert existing pages or o<strong>the</strong>r HC units to define sophisticated navigable structure. Of course if<br />

an author has in <strong>the</strong> mind a special linking structure that has not been defined yet, he can ask a WBT<br />

administrator to create an HC type, i.e. an HC type template that comprises wished linking structure.<br />

In <strong>the</strong> following chapter we present an implementation of <strong>the</strong> proposed model which is a running<br />

project on <strong>the</strong> Institute <strong>for</strong> In<strong>for</strong>mation Processing and Computer Supported New Media, called <strong>the</strong> Structure<br />

Editor.<br />

3. Structure Editor Architecture and Components<br />

The Structure Editor is a system implementing proposed Hypermedia Composite Data Model. The<br />

system is used <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> authoring and maintaining educational applications on <strong>the</strong> Web. It treats educational<br />

applications as HC units which can be created, manipulated, uploaded onto a Web server, maintained on <strong>the</strong><br />

server and so on. It also provides a data administrator with <strong>the</strong> tools <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> definition of HC types, i.e. templates<br />

<strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> creation of different educational applications. Let us now look closely on <strong>the</strong> architecture of Structure<br />

Editor and its components.<br />

The Structure Editor consists of <strong>the</strong> following functional components ( see Figure 3 ):<br />

Figure 3: Structure Editor Components<br />

• Visual Data Definition Tool ( VDDT ) provides a convenient way <strong>for</strong> defining HC types, i.e. templates <strong>for</strong><br />

different educational applications. The definition of HC types means <strong>the</strong> definition of topology of templates,<br />

functionality and properties of individual cells, a specific linking structure which is inherited by all instances<br />

of this type, i.e. by all educational applications produced with this template.<br />

• Visual Data Manipulation Tool ( VDMT ) provides a convenient way <strong>for</strong> automatic generation of a<br />

navigational structure of an educational application by means of inserting/removing elements into/from HC<br />

type template, saving such units on a Web browser ( it could be a standard Web server or a Hyperwave<br />

server, i.e. <strong>the</strong> mapping mechanism will upload an educational application in <strong>the</strong> proper way ) or on a local<br />

drive and fur<strong>the</strong>r editing, maintaining of <strong>the</strong> existing HC units, i.e. educational applications.


• Server Site Script/Remote Applet are special programs which visualise a particular educational application<br />

as a collection of interrelated HTML documents.<br />

The Visual Data Definition Tool is a stand-alone Java application working with a special HCT file<br />

containing <strong>the</strong> definition of a HC type. It can create new and edit existing HCT file residing on a local drive.<br />

The Visual Data Manipulation Tool is a stand-alone Java application working with an existing HCT<br />

file, HTML pages and existing HC units, i.e. educational applications. It can create new and edit existing<br />

educational applications residing on a Web server or on a local drive. The main way of authoring and<br />

maintaining such educational applications is dragging and dropping existing HTML documents, MM elements<br />

and/or HC units onto a selected template. HTML documents can be created with an arbitrary o<strong>the</strong>r editing<br />

system and must be in a valid HTML <strong>for</strong>mat. Additionally, <strong>the</strong> structure editor provides a possibility to generate<br />

valid HTML documents on <strong>the</strong> fly using so-called Macros defined as a part of <strong>the</strong> HC type definition.<br />

The VDMT allows to combine pages and existing educational applications into a new educational<br />

application by means of <strong>the</strong> following operations:<br />

• drag and drop objects into a template cell<br />

• delete an object from a template cell<br />

• change a relative position within a template cell<br />

• set up particular member attributes ( see Figure 4 )<br />

Figure 4: Working with <strong>the</strong> VDMT<br />

A newly created educational application can be stored, i.e. mapped on a Hyperwave server, a standard<br />

HTTP Web server or on a local drive. Storing an educational application to a particular hypermedia system<br />

means providing it with some additional attributes specific to <strong>the</strong> chosen system. For example if an educational<br />

application is stored on a Hyperwave server, it is stored as a Hyperwave collection having a number of additional<br />

attributes which are automatically assigned by <strong>the</strong> VDMT. Members of <strong>the</strong> HC unit are defined as members of<br />

<strong>the</strong> corresponding Hyperwave collection and also automatically provided with specific set of attributes.<br />

An educational application can be also stored on a local drive or on an ordinary Web server as a directory in a<br />

file system containing a number of additional attribute files which are automatically generated by <strong>the</strong> VDMT.<br />

Members of <strong>the</strong> HC unit are also put into <strong>the</strong> corresponding folder along with automatically generated attribute<br />

files and a special navigational applets interpreting <strong>the</strong> attribute files.<br />

As stated earlier user's Web browsers ( like Netscape or Microsoft InternetExplorer ) do not access<br />

directly an educational application. Instead, in order to obtain data, <strong>the</strong> browser communicates with a special<br />

Sever Site Script ( if <strong>the</strong> educational application resides on a Hyperwave server ) or with a special Java applet ( if<br />

<strong>the</strong> educational application resides on a standard HTTP Web server or on a local drive ).


Figure 5: Saving an Educational Application on a Hyperwave Server<br />

In o<strong>the</strong>r words, whenever an user accesses such educational application with an ordinary Web browser a<br />

special software component is run to visualise <strong>the</strong> unit in <strong>the</strong> <strong>for</strong>m of interrelated HTML pages. The HCT file<br />

containing a description of <strong>the</strong> generic link structure and attributes attached to <strong>the</strong> educational application's<br />

members are essentially used to control such visualisation ( see Figure 6 ).<br />

Figure 6: Accessing an Educational Application<br />

4. Conclusion<br />

Here, we would like to conclude that <strong>the</strong> proposed combination of Hypermedia Composite data model with<br />

Hyperwave data model in order to decrease ef<strong>for</strong>t <strong>for</strong> authoring and maintaining educational applications <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong><br />

Web has much bigger possibilities <strong>the</strong>n <strong>the</strong> described use. It can be very useful <strong>for</strong> different kinds of hypermedia<br />

systems. The power of this concept comes from <strong>the</strong> highly structured hypermedia composites that can be created<br />

with Hypermedia Composite data model. Of course that Hypermedia Composite data model has to be mapped<br />

onto a logical data model to show all its possibilities so we believe that its use should not only depend on<br />

Hyperwave data model, but ra<strong>the</strong>r it should try to use o<strong>the</strong>r powerful data models, such as XML. XML<br />

technology allows <strong>the</strong> author to define <strong>the</strong> constructs, i.e. <strong>the</strong> structure of hypermedia database, as well as <strong>the</strong><br />

navigational and visualisation paradigm. Hypermedia Composite data model on <strong>the</strong> o<strong>the</strong>r hand allows <strong>the</strong> author<br />

to automatically and rapidly create predefined structures.<br />

5. References<br />

1. Hermann Maurer (1996), Hyperwave – The Next Generation Web Solution, Addison-Wesley<br />

2. Denis Helic, Seid Maglajlic, Nick Sherbakov (<strong>1999</strong>), Educational Materials on The Web: Data Modelling<br />

Approach, MIPRO 99<br />

3. D. Freismuth, K. Schmaranz, B. Zwantschko (1998), Telematic Plat<strong>for</strong>m <strong>for</strong> Patient Oriented Services, JUCS,<br />

vol. 11, 1998<br />

4. Microsoft Online XML Workshop (1998), http://www.microsoft.com/xml, Microsoft Corp. Homepage


Webfuse: an Integrated, Eclectic Web Authoring Tool<br />

David Jones<br />

Faculty of In<strong>for</strong>matics and Communication<br />

Central Queensland University<br />

Australia<br />

d.jones@cqu.edu.au<br />

Introduction<br />

Webfuse is an authoring tool <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> World-Wide Web designed and constructed at Central Queensland<br />

University to aid in <strong>the</strong> development of Web-based learning (Jones and Buchanan, 1996). Webfuse has been used in<br />

<strong>the</strong> construction and maintenance of numerous websites <strong>for</strong> online learning and commercial purposes<br />

(http://www.broncos.com.au/). It is currently <strong>the</strong> primary web authoring plat<strong>for</strong>m <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> Faculty of In<strong>for</strong>matics and<br />

Communication of Central Queensland University and is used by almost 100 staff to maintain a Web site with over<br />

150 units and over 100,000 separate web pages.<br />

A University developing a system <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> support of online learning is not new with systems such as<br />

WebCT (http://www.webct.com/webct) having similar origins. In fact, a number of Webfuse's characteristics are<br />

similar to <strong>the</strong>se o<strong>the</strong>r systems. While this paper briefly describes <strong>the</strong>se familiar characteristics it concentrates on <strong>the</strong><br />

features of Webfuse which differ from similar tools. In particular it will examine how Webfuse draws on <strong>the</strong> lessons<br />

ga<strong>the</strong>red from <strong>the</strong> fields of hypermedia and operating systems to arrive at a structure which attempts to ease <strong>the</strong><br />

authoring bottleneck while providing <strong>the</strong> extensibility and adaptability required to keep up with <strong>the</strong> Web.<br />

The Familiar Characteristics of Webfuse<br />

Three familiar characteristics of Webfuse include: being server-based, offering server and client plat<strong>for</strong>m<br />

indpendence and providing <strong>the</strong> standard functionality required of a Web-based learning system. A Web-browser is<br />

<strong>the</strong> only authoring tool required to use Webfuse. The browser provides <strong>the</strong> interface between <strong>the</strong> user and <strong>the</strong><br />

collection of CGI scripts and o<strong>the</strong>r software residing on a Web server that provide all of Webfuse's functionality.<br />

Why Webfuse is Different:<br />

The major differences between Webfuse and o<strong>the</strong>r systems are <strong>the</strong> use of hypermedia templates and an<br />

eclectic and integrated structure. The following section describes <strong>the</strong> importance of <strong>the</strong>se differences.<br />

Web authoring is usually carried out without a defined process, lacks suitable tool support, does little to<br />

separate content, structure and appearance (Coda et al, 1998), makes limited reuse of previous work (Rossi et al,<br />

1997) and requires better group access mechanisms and online editing tools (Andrews, 1996). The difficulty of<br />

authoring on <strong>the</strong> Web often leads to <strong>the</strong> management of content <strong>for</strong> a web site being assigned to one person who<br />

becomes <strong>the</strong> bottleneck <strong>for</strong> maintenance (Thimbleby, 1997). This can be a major problem in online learning where<br />

simple, rapid and cheap maintenance of a site is essential <strong>for</strong> its on-going usefulness.<br />

Hypermedia templates (Catlin and Garret, 1991) are an approach to simplifying <strong>the</strong> authoring process while<br />

still ensuring <strong>the</strong> application of good in<strong>for</strong>mation design principles. Hypermedia templates enable content experts to<br />

be responsible <strong>for</strong> maintaining Websites and thus increases ownership, decreases costs and addresses <strong>the</strong> authoring<br />

bottleneck problem. Hypermedia templates also aid in reuse which is a strategic tool <strong>for</strong> reducing <strong>the</strong> cost and<br />

improving <strong>the</strong> quality of hypermedia design and development (Nanard, Nanard and Kahn, 1998).<br />

It was recognised from <strong>the</strong> start of <strong>the</strong> Webfuse project that it would not be possible <strong>for</strong> a small collection<br />

of part-time individuals to build and maintain a Web authoring tool. Not only would <strong>the</strong> amount of work required to<br />

initially construct a useful system be onerous but a much larger task would be to continue upgrading <strong>the</strong> system in<br />

response to changing requirements and changes in <strong>the</strong> Web.


To address this problem Webfuse draws on <strong>the</strong> micro-kernel architecture approach used in many modern<br />

operating systems. The advantages of <strong>the</strong> micro-kernel approach include a more modular system structure and a<br />

system which is more flexible and tailorable (Liedtke, 1995).<br />

The Webfuse "kernel" is a collection of abstractions and services including au<strong>the</strong>ntication, access control,<br />

HTML validation, presentation and data storage. These abstractions and services are drawn upon by a collection of<br />

hypermedia templates and o<strong>the</strong>r higher level services which are used by authors to develop web sites.<br />

At any time a new hypermedia template can be written to provide Webfuse with added functionality. New<br />

templates generally wrap around new software or technology (e.g. a Java based chat room, a Web-based mailing list<br />

manager etc) as it becomes available. It is significantly easier to create a new hypermedia template than to create <strong>the</strong><br />

software from scratch.<br />

Usually <strong>the</strong> use of a large collection of software created by different people would increase <strong>the</strong> authoring<br />

complexity due to <strong>the</strong> large amount of variety and duplication in user interfaces. Webfuse addresses this problem via<br />

<strong>the</strong> Webfuse "kernel" which provides a single common administrative interface used by all hypermedia templates.<br />

The "kernel" integrates <strong>the</strong> eclectic templates behind a common interface.<br />

All of <strong>the</strong> existing Webfuse hypermedia templates are written around ei<strong>the</strong>r existing open source software<br />

(e.g. MHonarc, Ewgie, WebBBS) or applications written specifically <strong>for</strong> use at CQU (e.g. an assignment submission<br />

tied to CQU's student database system). The hypermedia template approach allows <strong>the</strong> quick integration of most<br />

Web-based software into a common management framework. The eclectic and integrated approach has been<br />

particularly useful in allowing Webfuse to draw on <strong>the</strong> large collection of open source software <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> Web. This<br />

ability to use almost any open source software has fur<strong>the</strong>r increased <strong>the</strong> ability of Webfuse to adapt to changes and<br />

provide additional functionality.<br />

Conclusions<br />

The creation and management of Websites is a difficult task which can suffer from a bottleneck as<br />

authoring responsibility is restricted to a few individuals. Hypermedia templates are an approach which allow<br />

content experts to become responsible <strong>for</strong> creating and managing websites. Webfuse uses hypermedia templates to<br />

ease <strong>the</strong> authoring bottleneck. Hypermedia templates, in conjunction with a collection of support services, also<br />

enable Webfuse to have an integrated and eclectic structure which enables it to adapt quickly to changes in<br />

requirements and <strong>the</strong> Web.<br />

References<br />

Andrews, K. (1996). Applying hypermedia research to <strong>the</strong> World Wide Web, Workshop on Hypermedia Research and <strong>the</strong> World<br />

Wide Web, Hypertext'96 Conference, Washington, [http://www.iccm.edu/apphrweb].<br />

Catlin, K.S. and Garret, L.N. (1991). Hypermedia Templates: An Authors Tool, <strong>Proceedings</strong> of Hypertext'91, ACM, 147-160.<br />

Coda, F., Ghezzi, C., Vigna, G. and Garzotto, F. (1998). Towards a Software Engineering Approach to Web Site Development,<br />

<strong>Proceedings</strong> of <strong>the</strong> 9th International Workshop on Software Specification and Design, Isobe, Japan<br />

Jones, D. and Buchanan, R. (1996). The Design of an Integrated Online Learning Environment. Making New Connections.<br />

<strong>Proceedings</strong> of ASCILITE'96. Christie, A., James, P. and Vaughan, B. (eds), pp 331-345<br />

Liedtke, J. (1995). On Micro-Kernel Construction. Operating Systems Review. 29(5), pp 237-250.<br />

Nanard, M., Nanard, J. and Kahn, P. (1998). Pushing reuse in hypermedia design: golden rules, design patterns and constructive<br />

templates, <strong>Proceedings</strong> of <strong>the</strong> 9th ACM Conference on Hypertext and Hypermedia, ACM Press, 11-20.<br />

Rossi, G., Schwabe, D. and Garrido, A. (1997). Design reuse in hypermedia applications development, <strong>Proceedings</strong> of <strong>the</strong> 8th<br />

ACM conference on Hypertext, ACM Press, 57-66.<br />

Thimbleby, H. (1997). Distributed Web Authoring, <strong>Proceedings</strong> of WebNet'97, <strong>Association</strong> <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> Advancement of Computing<br />

in Education, 1056-1083.


Cognitive Tools and <strong>the</strong>ir Design Implications <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> Interactive Hypermedia<br />

Instructional Program: HIV/AIDS Prevention Education <strong>for</strong> Women of Color<br />

Hea<strong>the</strong>r A. Katz, Doctoral Candidate: Department of Curriculum and Instruction, University of Texas at Austin,<br />

USA, hakatz@mail.utexas.edu<br />

1. Overview<br />

The purpose of this interactive hypermedia instructional program (HIV and AIDS Prevention Education <strong>for</strong><br />

Women of Color) is to provide women of color HIV and AIDS facts and <strong>the</strong> skills to protect against contracting<br />

HIV. Both <strong>the</strong> research of (Park and Hannafin 93) and (Park 95) serve as <strong>the</strong> <strong>the</strong>oretical framework <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong><br />

development of <strong>the</strong> program, which mirrors Park and Hannafin's twenty guidelines <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> design of interactive<br />

multimedia. Additionally, Park's research was applied to <strong>the</strong> development of <strong>the</strong> program's cognitive tools—<strong>the</strong><br />

function of <strong>the</strong> individual cognitive tools in <strong>the</strong> hypermedia program were designed to be analogous to <strong>the</strong><br />

function of specific self-regulated learning strategies (SRLS). Additionally, both <strong>the</strong> interface design and<br />

content are tailored <strong>for</strong> African and Latina American women (e.g., culturally appropriate graphics, video, and<br />

language) and <strong>the</strong>ir unique circumstances surrounding HIV and AIDS. Literature, audio, and video acquired<br />

from <strong>the</strong> United States' Centers <strong>for</strong> Disease Control HIV and AIDS prevention initiative were used to develop<br />

<strong>the</strong> instructional content. Macromedia Authorware was used to develop <strong>the</strong> interactive hypermedia<br />

instructional program.<br />

2. Theoretical Background<br />

Several empirical studies have reported (a) significant gains in learner per<strong>for</strong>mance (Borsook &<br />

Higginbotham-Wheat 92, Crosby & Stelovsky 95, Frey & Simonson 93); (b) increased course completion rate<br />

(Hardiman & Williams 90); (c) decreased demand on teaching time (Higgins & Boone 92); and (d) a positive<br />

attitude toward hypermedia instruction (Janda 92). Thus, when hypermedia is grounded in research and<br />

integrated with instruction it has <strong>the</strong> following five potentials: (1) provides rich and realistic contexts <strong>for</strong><br />

multichannel learning; (2) Ability to access in<strong>for</strong>mation non-linearly; (3) focuses learner attention on <strong>the</strong><br />

relationship of facts and multiple perspectives of in<strong>for</strong>mation; (4) encourages active, student-centered learning;<br />

and (5) promotes collaborative learning (Ambrose 91, Nelson & Palumbo 92, Yang & Moore 95-6).<br />

Using <strong>the</strong> a<strong>for</strong>ementioned hypermedia characteristics, <strong>the</strong> HIV/AIDS Prevention Education <strong>for</strong> Woman of<br />

Color program provides <strong>the</strong> opportunity to immerse oneself in <strong>the</strong> program's content via a multifaceted learning<br />

environment. It incorporates text, graphics, video, sound, animation, and linkage between nodes of<br />

in<strong>for</strong>mation. However, <strong>the</strong> development of effective hypermedia instruction must be based on <strong>the</strong>oretical and<br />

empirical research.<br />

The proceeding explains how this interactive hypermedia program is grounded in research. First, are two<br />

examples of how this interactive hypermedia program integrates <strong>the</strong> research of (Park & Hannafin 93) and <strong>the</strong><br />

implications <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> design of interactive multimedia:<br />

1. "The program's cognitive tools (bookmark, find, glossary, help, notepad, and program map) exemplify<br />

<strong>the</strong> guideline to "embed structural aids to facilitate selection, organization, and integration."<br />

2. "The program's instructional modules and sub-modules support both "layering of in<strong>for</strong>mation to<br />

accommodate multiple levels of complexity and accommodate differences," and <strong>the</strong> "organization of<br />

lesson segments into internally consistent idea units" (p.68).<br />

The following exemplifies how learning strategy research was applied to <strong>the</strong> design of <strong>the</strong> cognitive tools<br />

and discusses <strong>the</strong>ir analogous relationship. SRLS represent actions and processes that learners implement<br />

during achievement situations. Such actions and processes are "directed at acquiring in<strong>for</strong>mation or skill that<br />

involve agency, purpose, and instrumentality perceptions by learners. SRLS include organizing and<br />

trans<strong>for</strong>ming in<strong>for</strong>mation, self-consequating, seeking in<strong>for</strong>mation, and rehearsing or using memory aids"<br />

(Zimmerman & Martinez-Pons 88, p.329). Similar to SRLS within traditional learning environments are<br />

cognitive tools (e.g., bookmark, find, glossary, help, notepad, and program map) within interactive hypermedia<br />

learning environments.


Cognitive tools can act as structural aids to assist learners in managing new in<strong>for</strong>mation. Research has<br />

reported that cognitive tool use during computer-assisted instruction can assist learners to construct knowledge<br />

and support cognitive processes, such as memory and monitoring one's learning experience, and allow learners<br />

to engage in o<strong>the</strong>rwise unattainable cognitive activities (Lajoie 93). Hence, <strong>the</strong> function of cognitive tools<br />

within hypermedia environments is analogous to <strong>the</strong> function of SRLS within traditional learning<br />

environments—<strong>the</strong>y assist learners to acquire, process, and comprehend in<strong>for</strong>mation.<br />

The cognitive tools that are available in this program (i.e., bookmark, find, glossary, help, notepad, and<br />

program map) are mirrored after <strong>the</strong> functions of select effective SRLS. The notepad can be used <strong>for</strong><br />

summarization and note taking, and <strong>the</strong> program map serves as an advance organizer—three strongly effective<br />

strategies. For example, one activity requires <strong>the</strong> learner to construct a “virtual” poster that represents her<br />

attitudes and beliefs concerning each module topic at <strong>the</strong> onset of each respective module instruction. This task<br />

requires <strong>the</strong> learner to use <strong>the</strong> notepad to ga<strong>the</strong>r/organize her thoughts concerning <strong>the</strong> respective module topic.<br />

Upon completion of each module, <strong>the</strong> learner is asked to reassess her poster and notes, referencing in<strong>for</strong>mation<br />

from <strong>the</strong> modules that she has completed. Then, she is given <strong>the</strong> opportunity <strong>for</strong> additions to or subtractions<br />

from her poster—a chance to redesign <strong>the</strong> poster/reorganize her thoughts.<br />

Additionally, <strong>the</strong> program map (overview of modules and sub-modules) acts as an advance organizer with<br />

pop-up in<strong>for</strong>mation that tells <strong>the</strong> learner what to expect in each module. The advance organizer also reminds<br />

users what modules and sub modules <strong>the</strong>y have completed, and which ones <strong>the</strong>y have not visited. This can help<br />

students to integrate new material into <strong>the</strong>ir existing cognitive structure.<br />

3. Conclusion<br />

In sum, hypermedia programs that embed cognitive tools grounded in research can provide learners with<br />

actions and processes to prevent in<strong>for</strong>mation decay. Such assistance can complement cognitive processes and<br />

reduce <strong>the</strong> complexity of <strong>the</strong> in<strong>for</strong>mation-processing task (Park & Hannafin 93). The interactive hypermedia<br />

instructional program HIV and AIDS Prevention Education <strong>for</strong> Women of Color provides: (a) empirically and<br />

<strong>the</strong>oretically grounded cognitive tools to ensure effective learning within hypermedia environments; and (b)<br />

women of color an opportunity gain a wealth of knowledge from a culturally tailored instructional environment.<br />

4. References<br />

Abrams, A., & Streit, L. (1986). Effectiveness of interactive video in teaching basic photography. T.H.E. Journal,<br />

14(2), 92-96.<br />

Borsook, T. K., & Higginbotham-Wheat, N. (1992). A psychology of hypermedia: A conceptual framework <strong>for</strong> R & D.<br />

Paper presented at <strong>the</strong> Annual Meeting of <strong>the</strong> <strong>Association</strong> <strong>for</strong> Educational Communications and Technology, Washington,<br />

D.C.<br />

Crosby, M. E., & Stelovsky, J. (1995). From multimedia instruction to multimedia evaluation. Journal of Educational<br />

Multimedia and Hypermedia, 4(2/3), 147-162.<br />

Frey, D., & Simonson, M. (1993). Assessment of cognitive style to examine students' use of hypermedia within historic<br />

costume. Home Economics Research Journal, 21(4), 403-421.<br />

Hardiman, B., & Williams, R. (1990). Teaching developmental ma<strong>the</strong>matics: The interactive video approach. T.H.E.<br />

Journal, 17, 154-159.<br />

Higgins, K., & Boone, R. (1992). Hypermedia computer study guides: Adapting a Canadian history text. Social<br />

Education, 56(3), 154-159.<br />

Janda, K. (1992). Multimedia in political science: Sobering lessons from a teaching experiment. Journal of Educational<br />

Multimedia and Hypermedia, 1(341-354).<br />

Jones, L. L., & Smith, S. G. (1989). Lights, camera, reactions! The interactive videodisc: A tool <strong>for</strong> teaching chemistry.<br />

T.H.E. Journal, 16, 78-85.<br />

Lajoie, S. P. (1993). Computer environments as cognitive tools <strong>for</strong> enhancing learning. In S. P. Lajoie & S. J. Derry<br />

(Eds.), Computers as Cognitive Tools (pp. 261-288). Hillsdale, NJ: Lawrence Erlbaum.<br />

Nelson, W. A., & Palumbo, D. B. (1992). Learning, instruction, and hypermedia. Journal of Educational Multimedia<br />

and Hypermedia, 1(4), 445-464.<br />

Park, I., & Hannafin, M. J. (1993). Empirically-based guidelines <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> design of interactive multimedia. Educational<br />

Technology, Research, and Development, 41(3), 63-85.<br />

Park, S. (1995). Implications of learning strategy research <strong>for</strong> designing computer-assisted instruction. Journal of<br />

Research on Computing in Education, 27(4), 435-456.<br />

Yang, C.-S., & Moore, D. M. (1995-6). Designing hypermedia systems <strong>for</strong> instruction. Journal of Educational<br />

Technology Systems, 24(1), 3-30.


Tutee’s Reflective Thinking of Tutor’s Response Produces Monitoring<br />

Michiko Kayashima<br />

Department of Art<br />

Tamagawa University, Japan<br />

kayasima@lit.tamagawa.ac.jp<br />

Toshio Okamoto<br />

The Graduate School of In<strong>for</strong>mation Systems<br />

University of Electro-Communications, Japan<br />

okamoto@ai.is.uec.ac.jp<br />

Abstract: This study proposes two elements that were encountered during analysis of<br />

cross-age tutoring investigations. The first is that both learners’ questions and tutors’<br />

advice is representative of <strong>the</strong>ir externalized metacognitive experiences. The second is<br />

<strong>the</strong> manner in which interaction between learners and tutors develops <strong>the</strong> learner’s<br />

monitoring abilities. If learners notice differences in meaning in <strong>the</strong> responses tutors<br />

give to learners’ questioning and per<strong>for</strong>m conscious cognition of <strong>the</strong> tutor’s externalized<br />

metacognitive experiences, <strong>the</strong> learner’s reflective thinking caused by <strong>the</strong> tutor’s<br />

responses produces <strong>the</strong> learner's monitoring as affected by <strong>the</strong> tutor’s criterion.<br />

Introduction<br />

Recently <strong>the</strong> view of learning has changed from <strong>the</strong> “transference of knowledge” to<br />

“constructing knowledge through interaction with <strong>the</strong> external world including o<strong>the</strong>rs”. Traditionally<br />

teachers have been about <strong>the</strong> task of transferring <strong>the</strong>ir knowledge. The important concern <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> teacher<br />

was <strong>the</strong> organization of knowledge so those learners could learn effectively. However, <strong>the</strong> new view of<br />

learning considers that learners construct knowledge by <strong>the</strong>ir own processes through evaluation and<br />

improvement of <strong>the</strong>ir own knowledge. Concurrently <strong>the</strong>y are learning how to learn as well.<br />

Under <strong>the</strong> new view of learning, many researchers focus on <strong>the</strong> role of o<strong>the</strong>rs in <strong>the</strong> external<br />

world. They have tried to practice collaborative learning. Collaborative learning is defined as learners<br />

working on a task toge<strong>the</strong>r. However it is yet unclear whe<strong>the</strong>r collaboration improves learning. There is<br />

some research supporting <strong>the</strong> view that low achievers progressively become passive while collaborating<br />

with high achievers (Mulyran 1992).<br />

A number of researchers in cognitive science have proposed reasons as to why collaborative<br />

learning is more efficient than learning alone. The aim of <strong>the</strong> early studies of collaborative learning was to<br />

determine <strong>the</strong> conditions under which collaborative learning is efficient. Experiments were conducted to<br />

answer <strong>the</strong> question: “Under what conditions is collaborative learning efficient” ra<strong>the</strong>r than “Which<br />

interactions occur under which conditions" or "What kind of effects do <strong>the</strong>se interactions cause” They<br />

have considered conditions such as <strong>the</strong> composition of <strong>the</strong> group, <strong>the</strong> features of <strong>the</strong> task, <strong>the</strong> context of<br />

collaboration and so on. However <strong>the</strong>se conditions were very complicated and inter-connected. Thus it<br />

was difficult <strong>for</strong> researchers to identify <strong>the</strong> relationship between <strong>the</strong> conditions and <strong>the</strong> effects.<br />

Consequently <strong>the</strong> study of collaborative learning has shifted in focus to <strong>the</strong> relationship between <strong>the</strong><br />

process of collaboration itself and <strong>the</strong> learning results.<br />

Our focus is on <strong>the</strong> latter. We envisage how and why interaction in <strong>the</strong> collaborative process<br />

progresses participants’ metacognitive experience on <strong>the</strong> assumption that collaboration develops<br />

participants’ metacognitive experience. This term, metacognitive experience, is based on Nelson and<br />

Narens metacognitive system model of monitoring and control.<br />

Nelson and Narens proposed a metacognitive system model in which <strong>the</strong>y split <strong>the</strong> cognitive<br />

process into two or more specifically interrelated levels. The most simple metacognitive system model<br />

consists of two interrelated levels; <strong>the</strong> meta-level and <strong>the</strong> object-level. Fur<strong>the</strong>rmore, <strong>the</strong> metacognitive<br />

system model has a kind of dominance relationship, which is defined by <strong>the</strong> direction of <strong>the</strong> flow of<br />

in<strong>for</strong>mation; monitoring and control. Monitoring occurs when <strong>the</strong> meta-level is in<strong>for</strong>med by <strong>the</strong> objectlevel;<br />

control occurs when <strong>the</strong> meta-level modifies <strong>the</strong> object-level (Nelson & Narens 1994).


In this study, we propose <strong>the</strong> following two points which were found through analysis of crossage<br />

tutoring. First we propose that learners’ questions and <strong>the</strong> tutors’ responses are representative of <strong>the</strong>ir<br />

metacognitive experience. Second we propose in <strong>the</strong> process of cross-age tutoring that tutors cause <strong>the</strong><br />

learners’ metacognitive experience to progress.<br />

Section 2 describes <strong>the</strong> cross-age tutoring practices and representative dialogs. Section 3<br />

illustrates <strong>the</strong> relationship between learners' questions and tutors’ suggestions and <strong>the</strong>ir metacognitive<br />

experience. Section 4 delineates <strong>the</strong> process of <strong>the</strong> cross-age tutoring that tutors cause <strong>the</strong> learners’<br />

metacognitive experience to progress.<br />

Cross-age tutoring practice and dialog<br />

First, let us make a distinction between collaboration and cooperation. We cite <strong>the</strong> following<br />

definition by Roschelle and Teasley (Roschelle & Teasley, 1994).<br />

“Collaboration is a coordinated, synchronous activity that is <strong>the</strong> result of a continued attempt to<br />

construct and maintain a shared conception of a problem. Cooperation is accomplished by <strong>the</strong> division<br />

of labor among participants, as an activity where each person is responsible <strong>for</strong> a portion of <strong>the</strong> problem<br />

solving.”<br />

We designed a cross-age tutoring situation <strong>for</strong> use on a computer network between <strong>the</strong><br />

Department of Engineering and <strong>the</strong> Department of Art at Tamagawa University. The 6 senior students<br />

in <strong>the</strong> Department of Engineering tutored <strong>the</strong> 34 first year students in <strong>the</strong> Department of Art. The first<br />

year students had no particular level of computer literacy.<br />

Two tasks were assigned. The first task was to learn new terms that are encountered in<br />

computer science. As examples:<br />

1. RAM: random access memory,<br />

2. ROM, read only memory, and so on.<br />

The second task was <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> first year students to create Web Pages to explain <strong>the</strong>ir interpretation of <strong>the</strong><br />

terms encountered in computer science. Requesting this explanation of terms allowed <strong>the</strong> students to<br />

engage in fur<strong>the</strong>ring constructive knowledge.<br />

This "class" term was <strong>for</strong> six weeks. In <strong>the</strong> first task, most students did not understand <strong>the</strong> terms<br />

encountered. Additionally most students were unable to explain <strong>the</strong> terms as assigned in <strong>the</strong> second task.<br />

They required fur<strong>the</strong>r help from senior students in <strong>the</strong> Department of Engineering using Bulletin Board<br />

Services [BBS]. Senior students tutored <strong>the</strong>m through <strong>the</strong> BBS. By using <strong>the</strong> BBS <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong>ir<br />

communications all students were able to have access to all questions and suggestions. The tutors were not<br />

given any specific instructions about how to do <strong>the</strong>ir teaching. They were only told to help <strong>the</strong> first year<br />

students.<br />

The content of <strong>the</strong> interactions was recorded on <strong>the</strong> BBS. Following we will show some examples of<br />

natural discourse indicating how knowledge was constructed in cross-age tutoring.<br />

Questions that request in<strong>for</strong>mation<br />

All university students asked questions that request in<strong>for</strong>mation such as “What is a modem” in<br />

<strong>the</strong> first lesson.<br />

Question 1:<br />

Although we have researched SCSI, we do not understand it. Please explain it to us simply.<br />

Question 2:<br />

Hi, it is hot today. How are you doing I have researched about floppy disks. However, I have little<br />

knowledge. Please help me. Please explain about floppy disks in words that I can understand.<br />

Question 3:<br />

Let us know about CD-ROMs in simple terms.


Most students were sure someone would answer <strong>the</strong>ir questions and could copy those answers.<br />

Criticism of questions that request in<strong>for</strong>mation<br />

In answer to <strong>the</strong>se questions that requested in<strong>for</strong>mation, one tutor gave <strong>the</strong> following severe<br />

criticism. The tutor was aware of who <strong>the</strong> learner was who asked <strong>the</strong> question requesting in<strong>for</strong>mation on<br />

BBS. In his interview, he criticized her <strong>for</strong> not trying to answer <strong>the</strong> question herself. She wanted help too<br />

quickly.<br />

Criticism 1:<br />

Do it yourself. Have you looked it up in books or dictionaries You should ask questions only after<br />

you’ve done some research and make your question more specific. Don’t ask such vague questions.<br />

Explanation on questions that request in<strong>for</strong>mation<br />

Ano<strong>the</strong>r tutor gave a detailed explanation of over three pages.<br />

Explanation 1:<br />

I took note of <strong>the</strong> severe criticism you received. Concerning SCSI, it means Small Computer Systems<br />

Interface. That is <strong>the</strong> interface’s standard connection between <strong>the</strong> computer and different devices.<br />

After writing this explanation, this tutor became aware of many questions that requested<br />

in<strong>for</strong>mation on <strong>the</strong> BBS. And he remembered that he had requested in<strong>for</strong>mation two years prior. Thus he<br />

thought he should advise learners on how to ask more specific questions. Then he and <strong>the</strong> o<strong>the</strong>r tutors began<br />

to give <strong>the</strong> learners <strong>the</strong>ir advice.<br />

Advice on questions that request in<strong>for</strong>mation<br />

Advice 1:<br />

I guess you are confused about how to ask <strong>for</strong> help. When I was a junior student I asked questions like<br />

yours...You should make clearer <strong>the</strong> things you are uncertain of when you ask somebody <strong>for</strong> help. Even<br />

if you ask “Let me know about SCSI”, we can not explain it all. It is too vague.<br />

Advice 2:<br />

Hi, you know about CPUs don’t you I don’t know <strong>for</strong> certain what you know about CPUs. I had no<br />

computer literacy ei<strong>the</strong>r when I was a junior. I know that you asked, “What is a CPU” However you<br />

should make clear <strong>the</strong> things you don't know when you ask somebody <strong>for</strong> help. There are a lot of<br />

magazines about computer literacy and <strong>the</strong>y explain things in simpler terms than many books do. Thus<br />

<strong>the</strong>re are explanations about CPUs in magazines. Please read <strong>the</strong>m. If you have questions after reading<br />

<strong>the</strong>m, I can help you.<br />

Advice 3:<br />

I guess you need to have some fundamental knowledge and to search <strong>for</strong> one thing at a time. You should<br />

make clear <strong>the</strong> things you don't know when you ask somebody <strong>for</strong> help. If you make <strong>the</strong> uncertain things<br />

clear you will be successful and will enjoy learning. This is my advice as a senior.<br />

Questions that confirm interpretation<br />

In response to this advice, questions that requested in<strong>for</strong>mation were trans<strong>for</strong>med into questions<br />

that confirmed interpretation. Questions that confirm interpretation are questions that learners ask in order<br />

to confirm <strong>the</strong>ir own comprehension.<br />

Question 4:<br />

I suppose that all in<strong>for</strong>mation is represented as one or zero. If so, is hiragana or katakana 1<br />

one or zero<br />

represented as<br />

Question 5:<br />

I have researched and come to an understanding of <strong>the</strong> term “Hard Disk”. “Hard Disk” is ÖLet us know<br />

1 Hiragana and katakana are Japanese phonetic alphabets.


more in<strong>for</strong>mation about it, <strong>for</strong> example, <strong>the</strong> merits or <strong>the</strong> demerits and so on.<br />

Questions, <strong>the</strong> response and <strong>the</strong> metacognition<br />

Useful metacognitive experiences may be engendered by communication loosely and broadly<br />

defined. Metacognitive experience may be engendered by paraphrasing, finding examples, or asking<br />

questions about what we have tried to comprehend in order to find out how correctly and fully we have<br />

comprehended it (Flavell 1981). These actions are communicative attempts to talk to ourselves or to<br />

o<strong>the</strong>rs. There<strong>for</strong>e <strong>the</strong> learners’ questions and tutors’ responses are related to <strong>the</strong>ir metacognitive experience<br />

(Kayashima 1998).<br />

Additionally, Artzt & Armour-Thomas have claimed <strong>the</strong> difficulty in problem solving may lie in<br />

a student’s inability to actively monitor and subsequently regulate <strong>the</strong> cognitive process engaged in during<br />

problem solving (Artzt & Armour-Thomas 1992). They reported that <strong>the</strong> group that did not solve <strong>the</strong><br />

problem consisted of <strong>the</strong> members who had <strong>the</strong> lowest percentage of episodes at <strong>the</strong> metacognitive level<br />

and highest percentage of episodes at <strong>the</strong> cognitive level. Based on Flavell’s idea mentioned above, we<br />

could rephrase <strong>the</strong>ir results as follows: <strong>the</strong> communication between <strong>the</strong> members, who belonged to <strong>the</strong><br />

group that did not solve <strong>the</strong> problem, could not engender <strong>the</strong>ir metacognitive experiences.<br />

On <strong>the</strong> contrary, <strong>the</strong> communication between <strong>the</strong> members, who belonged to <strong>the</strong> group that<br />

solved <strong>the</strong> problem, could engender <strong>the</strong>ir metacognitive experiences. Their metacognitive experiences<br />

affected <strong>the</strong>ir cognitive objectives and <strong>the</strong>ir cognitive actions; thus <strong>the</strong>y were able to solve <strong>the</strong> problem.<br />

Hence, we try to analyze <strong>the</strong> learners’ questionings and <strong>the</strong> tutors’ responses from <strong>the</strong> viewpoint<br />

of <strong>the</strong>ir metacognitive experience in order to verify how <strong>the</strong> interactions between learners and tutors<br />

develop <strong>the</strong>ir metacognitive experiences.<br />

Questions represent learners’ immediate antecedent action of questionings<br />

We categorized learners’ questions into “questions that request in<strong>for</strong>mation” and “questions that<br />

confirm interpretation”. Questions that request in<strong>for</strong>mation are those that ask o<strong>the</strong>rs to state <strong>the</strong>ir<br />

knowledge in a way that <strong>the</strong> questioner can comprehend ef<strong>for</strong>tlessly. For example, “Let us know about..."<br />

These types of questions asked tutors to explain “simply” or “so I can comprehend ef<strong>for</strong>tlessly”. These<br />

show that learners were aware that <strong>the</strong>y did not have some basic necessary knowledge. In o<strong>the</strong>r words,<br />

<strong>the</strong>se questions imply that <strong>the</strong> immediate antecedent of <strong>the</strong>se questionings could be metacognitive<br />

experience: monitoring, and in particular, awareness.<br />

However, <strong>the</strong> response of <strong>the</strong> tutors to questions that requested in<strong>for</strong>mation caused, in some<br />

cases a trans<strong>for</strong>mation of <strong>the</strong> questions into ones that desired to confirm interpretation. These types of tutor<br />

responses were characterized by criticisms upon learners’ cognitive actions and subsequent suggestions<br />

about <strong>the</strong>se same cognitive actions. This trans<strong>for</strong>mation implies that learners’ predictors of <strong>the</strong> state of<br />

<strong>the</strong>ir understanding trans<strong>for</strong>med from ignorant noncomprehension into a degree of comprehension, though<br />

somewhat untrustworthy, that evidenced growth of constructive knowledge. This is evident because <strong>the</strong><br />

questions that confirm interpretation are questions that learners ask in order to confirm <strong>the</strong>ir own state of<br />

understanding. For example, one of <strong>the</strong> students in <strong>the</strong> study, who engaged in learning about <strong>the</strong> binary<br />

system, asked <strong>the</strong> following: “I suppose that all in<strong>for</strong>mation is represented as one or zero. If so, is hiragana<br />

or katakana represented as one or zero” The latter questions imply that learners attempted to seek out<br />

criterion that referenced evidence of <strong>the</strong>ir comprehension. That is, although <strong>the</strong> questioners monitored <strong>the</strong><br />

state of <strong>the</strong>ir understanding, <strong>the</strong>y could not evaluate <strong>the</strong> trustworthiness. There<strong>for</strong>e <strong>the</strong> immediate<br />

antecedent of <strong>the</strong>se questionings could be also metacognitive experience, i.e. monitoring.<br />

In <strong>the</strong> above-mentioned questions, <strong>the</strong> immediate antecedent is monitoring. However, as far as<br />

<strong>the</strong> criterion referenced evidence of cognitive progress is concerned, <strong>the</strong> <strong>for</strong>mer monitoring is different<br />

from <strong>the</strong> latter monitoring at a certain level. The <strong>for</strong>mer monitoring is evidenced by <strong>the</strong> learner<br />

per<strong>for</strong>ming monitoring functions without <strong>the</strong> criterion-referenced evidence. The learner attempting to<br />

monitor with criterion-referenced evidence characterizes <strong>the</strong> latter monitoring. There<strong>for</strong>e <strong>the</strong> latter is at a<br />

higher level than <strong>the</strong> <strong>for</strong>mer. Hence, <strong>the</strong> latter learner might develop his metacognitive experience.<br />

Tutors’ response and <strong>the</strong>ir metacognition<br />

We have tried to analyze questions that requested in<strong>for</strong>mation and <strong>the</strong> responses of <strong>the</strong><br />

tutors. Let us recall <strong>the</strong> tutors’ responses to <strong>the</strong>se questions. These responses were criticisms on<br />

learners’ cognitive activities and suggestions <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> learners’ future cognitive activities. The criticism


of, <strong>for</strong> example “Do it yourself. Have you looked it up in books or dictionaries” implies that <strong>the</strong><br />

tutor has monitored <strong>the</strong> learner’s cognitive actions through his question and criticized <strong>the</strong> learner’s<br />

insufficient cognitive action. Moreover <strong>the</strong> suggestions, <strong>for</strong> example “you should make things you are<br />

uncertain of clearer”, shows how <strong>the</strong> learner should regulate his cognitive actions.<br />

Consequently, tutors’ responses are <strong>the</strong>ir metacognitive experiences to which learners’ cognitive<br />

actions provided input or which can exert influence on learners’ cognitive actions. As learners<br />

develop a conscious cognition of <strong>the</strong> tutors’ responses, <strong>the</strong>se responses can be exhibited in <strong>the</strong><br />

learners’ externalized metacognitive experiences.<br />

Communication and <strong>the</strong> development of metacognition<br />

We now consider how <strong>the</strong> communication between learners and tutors develops learners’<br />

metacognitive experiences.<br />

Although learners asked questions which depended on tutors to supplement <strong>the</strong>ir cognitive<br />

actions, <strong>the</strong> tutors didn’t comply. This shows that <strong>the</strong> meaning which learners gave <strong>the</strong>ir questions is<br />

different from <strong>the</strong> meaning tutors gave. Thus learners noticed <strong>the</strong> difference in meaning which tutors gave<br />

and <strong>the</strong>y reinterpreted discourse events; i.e. <strong>the</strong>ir questionings (Fox 1987). This reinterpretation would<br />

cause ei<strong>the</strong>r reflective thinking or monitoring.<br />

We must make <strong>the</strong> distinction clear between reflective thinking and monitoring be<strong>for</strong>e<br />

describing <strong>the</strong> process of developing learners’ metacognitive experiences. We can distinguish reflective<br />

thinking from monitoring as “criterion-referenced”. Reflective thinking is to think backward carefully<br />

about one’s cognitive actions in <strong>the</strong> past. However monitoring is to evaluate one’s cognitive actions with<br />

one’s criterion-reference. Thus monitoring is a meta-level action, but reflective thinking is not.<br />

We believe that criterion-referencing is <strong>the</strong> discerning factor by which reflective thinking turns into<br />

monitoring. To developing monitoring abilities means <strong>the</strong> development of a new criterion-reference. If a<br />

tutor’s response has impacted a learner’s reflective thinking through <strong>the</strong> conscious cognition of <strong>the</strong> tutor’s<br />

criterion-referencing, <strong>the</strong> learner’s reflective thinking could be <strong>the</strong> cause of his monitoring. If so, he would<br />

monitor using <strong>the</strong> tutor’s criterion. During this process of monitoring utilizing <strong>the</strong> tutor’s criterion, a<br />

learner gradually internalizes it as his own criterion. Then <strong>the</strong> student is able to do monitoring by himself.<br />

This process is <strong>the</strong> identical to Vygotsky’s <strong>the</strong>ory (Vygotsky, 1978).<br />

“Every function in <strong>the</strong> child’s development appears twice: first, on <strong>the</strong> social level, and later on <strong>the</strong><br />

individual level; first, between people (inter-psychological) and inside <strong>the</strong> child (intra-psychological)”.<br />

Conclusion<br />

We have proposed two elements in this paper. The first is that <strong>the</strong> learners’ questions represent <strong>the</strong>ir<br />

immediate antecedent cognitive actions and <strong>the</strong> tutors’ responses represent <strong>the</strong>ir externalized<br />

metacognitive activities to which learners’ cognitive actions provided input or which can exert<br />

influence on learners’ cognitive actions. The second is how <strong>the</strong> communication between learners and<br />

tutors develops learners’ monitoring. If learners notice <strong>the</strong> difference in meaning engendered in <strong>the</strong><br />

tutor's response to <strong>the</strong>ir questioning, and <strong>the</strong>y engage in conscious cognition of <strong>the</strong> tutors’ externalized<br />

metacognitive experiences, <strong>the</strong> learner’s reflective thinking elicited by <strong>the</strong> tutor’s responses produces<br />

monitoring by <strong>the</strong> learner utilizing <strong>the</strong> tutor’s criterion.<br />

These two points are based on only two kinds of questions and answers. Although <strong>the</strong>re are many<br />

additional kinds of questions, we are quite certain that most of <strong>the</strong> learners who do not develop <strong>the</strong>ir<br />

monitoring abilities ask <strong>the</strong>se two types of questions.<br />

References<br />

Artzt, A. F. and Amour-Thomas, E. (1992). Development of a Cognitive-Metacognitive Framework <strong>for</strong> Protocol<br />

Analysis of Ma<strong>the</strong>matical Problem Solving in Small Groups, Cognition and Instruction, 9(2), 137-175.<br />

Flavell, J. H. (1981). Cognitive Monitoring. In: W. P. Dickson (Ed.), Children’s Oral Communication Skills, 35-60.<br />

Fox, B. A. (1987). Interactional Reconstruction in real-time language Processing. Cognitive Science 11, 365-387.<br />

Kayashima, M. (1998). Evaluating Collaborative Learning using BBS - focusing on questions of learners. <strong>Proceedings</strong><br />

of <strong>ED</strong>-M<strong>ED</strong>IA&<strong>ED</strong>-TELECOM, 1998, <strong>Association</strong> <strong>for</strong> Advancement of Computing in Education,


Charlottesville, VA., 691-696.<br />

Mulyran, C. M. (1992). Student passivity during cooperative small group in ma<strong>the</strong>matics. Journal of Educational<br />

Research, 10, 151-177.<br />

Nelson, T. O. and Narens, L. (1994). Why Investigate Metacognition In: J. Metcalfe and A. P. Shimamura (Eds.)<br />

Metacognition (pp. 1-25) MIT Press.<br />

Roschelle, J. & Teasley, S. D. (1994) The construction of shared knowledge in collaborative problem solving In:<br />

C.O’Malley (ed.) Computer Supported Collaborative Learning,(pp. 69-97) NATO ASI series Vol. F-128,<br />

Springer-Verlag, Berlin.<br />

Vygotsky, L. A. (1978) Mind in Society: The Development of Higher Psychology Processes. Cambridge, MA: Harvard<br />

University Press.


COMPUTER M<strong>ED</strong>IAT<strong>ED</strong> COURSEWARE<br />

DEVELOPMENT AND THE ACADEMIC CULTURE<br />

Koppi, A.J., Chaloupka, M.J. & Llewellyn, R.<br />

New Technologies in Teaching and Learning, Carslaw F07, University of Sydney,<br />

NSW 2006, Australia<br />

Email: tony@nettl.usyd.edu.au<br />

Abstract<br />

Tertiary teachers are generally creative individuals, critical thinkers and experts in a<br />

particular field. Whilst working collegially, academics usually maintain an objective<br />

distance from <strong>the</strong> work of <strong>the</strong>ir peers. Tertiary institutions also tend to differentiate<br />

<strong>the</strong>mselves from o<strong>the</strong>r institutions and define <strong>the</strong>ir own special niche in <strong>the</strong> market<br />

place. These attitudes are concerned with establishing uniqueness and <strong>the</strong>y contribute<br />

to an academic culture that pervades <strong>the</strong> education system from <strong>the</strong> individual<br />

academic through to <strong>the</strong> institutional level.<br />

This culture rewards <strong>the</strong> teacher (or group of teachers) <strong>for</strong> designing unique courses.<br />

In Australia in particular, this personal course development is accepted practice to <strong>the</strong><br />

extent that cross-institutional <strong>for</strong>mal evaluation and comparison of courses does not<br />

generally occur. An academic will not normally adopt ano<strong>the</strong>r academic’s course<br />

without personalising it. Academics make courses that are based upon personal<br />

experience and beliefs. These features of <strong>the</strong> academic culture may be characterised as<br />

idiosyncratic.<br />

Consistent with <strong>the</strong> cultural practices, and public sector funding, individual<br />

academics, or small groups of academics, put toge<strong>the</strong>r (idiosyncratic) courses and<br />

computer aided learning packages. Consistent with <strong>the</strong> cultural practices, few o<strong>the</strong>r<br />

academics in <strong>the</strong> same discipline at o<strong>the</strong>r institutions adopted <strong>the</strong>se inflexible courses.<br />

In keeping with <strong>the</strong> culture, an academic will utilise parts of <strong>the</strong> work of o<strong>the</strong>r<br />

individuals, e.g., in assembling a course, a teacher will weave toge<strong>the</strong>r a unique fabric<br />

of personal experience and selections from published works – a chapter from here and<br />

a journal reference from <strong>the</strong>re etc. Utilising a programme that cannot be teased apart<br />

or modified has little place in this culture. It is not flexible.<br />

The conclusion is that <strong>the</strong> uptake of learning programmes by <strong>the</strong> teacher and<br />

institution will only occur if <strong>the</strong> programmes are consistent with <strong>the</strong> academic culture<br />

and are customisable. In keeping with <strong>the</strong> academic culture described, a recent<br />

development in Australia, <strong>the</strong> National Teaching and Learning Database (NTLD)<br />

project is designed to provide access to learning materials. The database comprises a<br />

centralised index of remote resources. These resources are held in o<strong>the</strong>r databases at<br />

<strong>the</strong> various contributing members’ locations. Developers of learning materials submit<br />

a URL of <strong>the</strong> location of those learning materials. The primary resource (i.e., teaching<br />

and learning material) may ei<strong>the</strong>r be held in <strong>the</strong> database(s) that is owned by <strong>the</strong><br />

creators of <strong>the</strong> material or be submitted directly to <strong>the</strong> central database. In ei<strong>the</strong>r case,


ownership is retained by <strong>the</strong> institution that developed <strong>the</strong> original material. The<br />

NTLD is a distributed database (at many locations) which academics can search and<br />

obtain teaching and learning materials to be customised, assembled and utilised as<br />

appropriate to <strong>the</strong> individual or institution style.<br />

Key benefits of <strong>the</strong> NTLD are a “one-stop” shop <strong>for</strong> teaching and learning resources<br />

that can be deployed or re-deployed using different educational methodologies, e.g.,<br />

resource-based, problem-based, or constructivist models.<br />

The aim of this paper is to seek to understand and describe <strong>the</strong> academic culture in<br />

order to be able to develop computer-mediated courseware that will be utilised by <strong>the</strong><br />

individuals working within this culture.<br />

1. INTRODUCTION<br />

The academic culture has a range of attributes that lie between several continua of<br />

extremes. Collegiality at one end, and individuality at <strong>the</strong> o<strong>the</strong>r, describe one such<br />

continuum. The system rewards <strong>the</strong> behaviour that characterises both ends of this<br />

continuum, <strong>for</strong> example, collaboration in research is rewarded as is <strong>the</strong> demonstration<br />

of individual creativity. Individual per<strong>for</strong>mance is particularly prised and sought after<br />

and is accompanied by such questions as “but how much of it was really his/her own<br />

work” This individualistic end of <strong>the</strong> continuum can lead to idiosyncrasy as<br />

academics seek to distinguish <strong>the</strong>mselves from <strong>the</strong>ir colleagues. This idiosyncrasy can<br />

also pervade course development to <strong>the</strong> extent that individual teachers make courses<br />

unique to <strong>the</strong>mselves. In fact, it is probably true to say that no two individuals will<br />

teach <strong>the</strong> “same” course in <strong>the</strong> same way. Each individual will seek to personalise <strong>the</strong><br />

course in keeping with his/her own experience, beliefs and values. This also applies to<br />

computer mediated courseware development.<br />

If individual academics can be labelled as idiosyncratic, institutions also attempt to<br />

distinguish <strong>the</strong>mselves from each o<strong>the</strong>r. Thus, part of <strong>the</strong> academic culture can be<br />

characterised by individuality or idiosyncrasy at more than one level, including<br />

departments and faculties which seek to distinguish <strong>the</strong>mselves.<br />

Ano<strong>the</strong>r continuum may be described by <strong>the</strong> extremes of conservatism and<br />

innovation. From <strong>the</strong> teaching point of view, <strong>the</strong> conservative extreme of <strong>the</strong><br />

continuum may be concerned with maintaining <strong>the</strong> face-to-face didactic environment<br />

and one of many innovation extremes may be concerned with computer-based, online,<br />

distributed teaching and learning environments. It is probably reasonable to say<br />

that parts of both extremes are relevant and appropriate at certain times <strong>for</strong> certain<br />

purposes. Computer mediated courseware development belongs mainly at <strong>the</strong><br />

innovation end of this particular continuum. The conservative extreme tends to resist<br />

technological innovation (Hesketh et al., 1996; Craw<strong>for</strong>d and Craw<strong>for</strong>d, 1997).<br />

2. COMPUTER M<strong>ED</strong>IAT<strong>ED</strong> COURSEWARE<br />

Computer mediated courseware (CMC) has probably as many meanings and<br />

applications as <strong>the</strong>re are people thinking about it. Broadly, CMC has enabled a kind of


learning which lies along a continuum of complete freedom at one end to prescriptive<br />

learning at <strong>the</strong> o<strong>the</strong>r end. From <strong>the</strong> student’s point of view, at <strong>the</strong> one extreme, this<br />

freedom represents many things: to learn whatever, whenever and wherever; to access<br />

in<strong>for</strong>mation and communicate conveniently at a global scale; to make one’s own<br />

destiny by personalising and pursuing one’s own knowledge interests; to not follow<br />

someone else’s prescribed learning; and <strong>the</strong> ability to access continuing education<br />

while in <strong>the</strong> work<strong>for</strong>ce. This might sit more com<strong>for</strong>tably in <strong>the</strong> constructivist<br />

philosophy where learners take responsibility <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong>ir own knowledge. At <strong>the</strong> o<strong>the</strong>r<br />

extreme, CMC is prescriptive and didactic and learning is characterised by memory<br />

work and repetition. In real life, learning takes place along <strong>the</strong> whole of this<br />

continuum, even within <strong>the</strong> same discipline.<br />

From <strong>the</strong> teacher’s point of view, <strong>the</strong> provision of CMC may be in response to student<br />

freedoms (or at least <strong>the</strong> desires <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> realisation of <strong>the</strong>se freedoms) but is also<br />

constrained by <strong>the</strong> rewards, values and aspirations of <strong>the</strong> academic culture to which<br />

most teachers probably subscribe. In many institutions, <strong>the</strong>se constraints are<br />

fundamentally determined by <strong>the</strong> need to enrol students and provide <strong>the</strong>m with<br />

structured learning programs that can be assessed.<br />

3. THE ACADEMIC CULTURE AND COMPUTER<br />

M<strong>ED</strong>IAT<strong>ED</strong> COURSEWARE<br />

An aspect of <strong>the</strong> academic culture includes <strong>the</strong> continuum of teacher/student<br />

dependency. At one extreme, <strong>the</strong> culture is teacher-centred and creates student<br />

dependency. At <strong>the</strong> o<strong>the</strong>r end, students are autonomous independent learners. This<br />

could result in a tension between flexibility and providing learning on demand, on <strong>the</strong><br />

one hand, and control over what <strong>the</strong> student is learning on <strong>the</strong> o<strong>the</strong>r. Whatever, a goal<br />

of most teachers is to encourage students to take responsibility <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong>ir own learning.<br />

There would appear to be a fundamental paradox between a rigorous academic culture<br />

and flexibility. This tension is great where <strong>the</strong> academic culture has <strong>the</strong> teacher as <strong>the</strong><br />

central figure (teachers set <strong>the</strong> curriculum and design <strong>the</strong> courses) whereas<br />

independent learning empowers <strong>the</strong> students (<strong>the</strong> students choose <strong>the</strong> learning<br />

materials and set <strong>the</strong> goals). A position somewhere between <strong>the</strong>se extremes is <strong>the</strong><br />

likely compromise where <strong>the</strong> teachers largely design <strong>the</strong> CMC yet <strong>the</strong> students have<br />

greater freedom in access and time of learning.<br />

Thus, it seems that in <strong>the</strong> design of CMC, <strong>the</strong> prevailing academic culture is biased<br />

towards <strong>the</strong> end of <strong>the</strong> continuum where <strong>the</strong> teacher describes <strong>the</strong> path <strong>the</strong> student is<br />

expected to follow.<br />

Ano<strong>the</strong>r continuum that is part of <strong>the</strong> academic culture may be described as <strong>the</strong> spatial<br />

one. At one extreme, students attend all courses on campus, and at <strong>the</strong> o<strong>the</strong>r extreme,<br />

all courses are mediated in distance mode ei<strong>the</strong>r by paper or electronic means or both.<br />

The spatial positioning is determined to some extent by <strong>the</strong> major goals of <strong>the</strong><br />

institution. The academic culture is not just manifest by teaching and learning but also<br />

by <strong>the</strong> o<strong>the</strong>r major activity that occupies universities, that is, discipline-based<br />

research. In many (not all) disciplines, research is spatially dependent (e.g. laboratory<br />

based research), that is, <strong>the</strong> academic staff and students have to be in a particular<br />

location (at least some of <strong>the</strong> time) to do <strong>the</strong> research. If research of that nature is a


priority, it is in <strong>the</strong> interests of universities to foster spatial dependence in order to<br />

bring <strong>the</strong> students to <strong>the</strong> campus. In that case, <strong>the</strong>re may well be a motivation amongst<br />

research academics to use CMC <strong>for</strong> on-campus activities.<br />

4. SETTING COURSES<br />

In a traditional setting, courses are set according to a combination of interests at<br />

several levels: <strong>the</strong> level of <strong>the</strong> institution through to <strong>the</strong> individual. The individual<br />

level is probably <strong>the</strong> one with <strong>the</strong> most influence on <strong>the</strong> type of course, content and<br />

method of interaction. Personal desires also play a large part. Most academics<br />

personalise a course and do not adopt one in its entirety without changing it to suit<br />

<strong>the</strong>m. That course is developed from a combination of personal experience and<br />

external resources assembled to support <strong>the</strong> personal experience and beliefs of <strong>the</strong><br />

academic. Generally <strong>the</strong> content is assembled as a result of a mix-and-match approach<br />

(a book chapter here; journal paper <strong>the</strong>re etc) which results in an individual, if not<br />

idiosyncratic, course. How that subject is taught depends on a combination of <strong>the</strong><br />

content, teaching and assessment methods. (It is well known that <strong>the</strong> assessment<br />

methods (usually time-honoured) often drive <strong>the</strong> learning.) Different institutions<br />

teaching <strong>the</strong> same subject may have variations in content and teaching and assessment<br />

methods producing a more-or-less similar course. Against this backdrop, <strong>the</strong>re are<br />

major implications <strong>for</strong> CMC developments. The driving <strong>for</strong>ce of individual creativity<br />

in <strong>the</strong> setting of courses is a major factor in how CMC courses will be is developed.<br />

Within <strong>the</strong> context of universities, many learning technology developments are not<br />

used or taken up beyond <strong>the</strong> person or group responsible <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> innovation (Scott et<br />

al., 1997; Alexander et al., 1998). Dearing (1997) has suggested that <strong>the</strong> slow uptake<br />

of computer aided learning (CAL) packages is because of poor IT skills amongst<br />

academic staff. This may be true but we can also ask if <strong>the</strong>re would be a great increase<br />

in <strong>the</strong> use of CAL packages if <strong>the</strong> IT literacy were very good amongst all academic<br />

staff We believe that <strong>the</strong> answer would be negative because <strong>the</strong> academic culture that<br />

promotes individuality and idiosyncrasy would be unchanged simply by increasing IT<br />

literacy skills. Academics and institutions would still want to develop CMC in <strong>the</strong>ir<br />

own way and would not adopt o<strong>the</strong>r people’s programmes that cannot be customised.<br />

The design, development and widespread utilisation of CMC programmes has to be<br />

compliant with <strong>the</strong> academic culture. As argued above, this compliance means that<br />

digital teaching and learning materials have to have certain qualities consistent with<br />

<strong>the</strong> way academics work. One of <strong>the</strong> primary qualities is that <strong>the</strong>y have to be<br />

customisable (Jones et al., 1997) and capable of being personalised. In addition,<br />

CMC programmes must be capable of being changed and combined with o<strong>the</strong>r digital<br />

and non-digital course components. The ability to mix-and-match learning materials<br />

to support <strong>the</strong> teacher’s experience and consequent course construction is essential.<br />

For <strong>the</strong>se reasons, learning materials should be small and object-oriented (Chaloupka<br />

and Koppi, 1998).<br />

It is likely that <strong>the</strong> kind of technology that will be utilised and adapted by teachers is<br />

that which supports traditional teaching practices. One fundamental practice is that of<br />

delivering in<strong>for</strong>mation as a lecture which has its place at one end of <strong>the</strong><br />

didactic/interactive continuum. Delivering in<strong>for</strong>mation via <strong>the</strong> web is consistent with


this practice and is an alternative (or an addition) that is readily accepted by teacher<br />

and student alike.<br />

The means of providing teachers with ready access to digital learning materials <strong>for</strong><br />

assembling courses in accordance with many aspects of <strong>the</strong> academic culture is<br />

provided by <strong>the</strong> National Teaching and Learning Database in Australia. The database<br />

is distributed throughout <strong>the</strong> continent and consists of small reusable digital learning<br />

materials (held at a variety of institutions) that can be pulled and assembled into CMC<br />

according to <strong>the</strong> individual academic’s way of working. The learning materials range<br />

from simple image objects to more complex vignette objects. Chaloupka and Koppi<br />

(1998) defined Vignettes as small, first-principle, first-person, heuristic activities<br />

(components) from which courses can be constructed by utilising <strong>the</strong> NTLD.<br />

Chaloupka and Koppi (1998) note that:<br />

This vignette approach to development allows academics to construct<br />

courses in much <strong>the</strong> same way that is traditionally acceptable. It also<br />

allows <strong>the</strong> vignette to be used in a number of situations and applied across<br />

disciplines. Thus <strong>the</strong> program development is a horizontal developmental<br />

process as opposed to vertical development process which is discipline<br />

based as represented by <strong>the</strong> monolithic development approach. Because<br />

vignettes are single-issue first principal activities that can be readily<br />

modified, <strong>the</strong>y can be shared between disciplines. For instance, pH is<br />

taught in a variety of disciplines including medicine, biology, agriculture<br />

and chemistry.<br />

The NTLD can be used to construct CMC simply by using <strong>the</strong> NTLD search function<br />

to locate appropriate teaching and learning resources located on a contributing<br />

database associated with <strong>the</strong> NTLD. Some of <strong>the</strong>se resources (considered to be<br />

objects) could be images, discussions, vignettes, reference materials, assessments and<br />

teaching guides and o<strong>the</strong>r teaching resources. These objects can be assembled into a<br />

cohesive learning environment or activity as defined by <strong>the</strong> CMC criteria. The<br />

functionality of this working model is based upon <strong>the</strong> characteristics and idiosyncratic<br />

nature of <strong>the</strong> academic culture.<br />

5. CONCLUSION<br />

Many aspects of <strong>the</strong> academic culture encourage individuality and idiosyncrasy and<br />

<strong>the</strong>se affect <strong>the</strong> way teachers make courses. For <strong>the</strong> benefit of student learning,<br />

teachers make courses to suit <strong>the</strong>mselves and generally do not adopt whole courses<br />

made by o<strong>the</strong>rs, and that includes computer mediated courseware packages that<br />

cannot be customised.<br />

Computer mediated courseware development requires that <strong>the</strong> course components are<br />

easy to locate, obtain and assemble into integrated packages. A national distributed<br />

database of learning objects contributes to <strong>the</strong> resources required <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong>se purposes.<br />

The goal of <strong>the</strong> NTLD project is to be useful by providing a service to academic<br />

course developers. The usefulness of <strong>the</strong> NTLD is predicated upon <strong>the</strong> strengths and


limitations of <strong>the</strong> prevailing complex academic culture that this paper has sought to<br />

understand and describe.<br />

6. REFERENCES<br />

Alexander, S, McKenzie, J. and Geissinger, H. (1998) An evaluation of in<strong>for</strong>mation<br />

technology projects <strong>for</strong> university learning. Commonwealth of Australia.<br />

Chaloupka, M.J. and Koppi, A.J. (1998) A vignette model <strong>for</strong> distributed teaching and<br />

learning. <strong>Association</strong> <strong>for</strong> Learning Technology, 6, 21-49.<br />

Craw<strong>for</strong>d, K and Craw<strong>for</strong>d, S. (1997) Agency, Technology and Vision: The Dynamics<br />

of Learning. Novae Research Group, University of Sydney, Sydney.<br />

Dearing, R. et al. (1997) Higher Education in <strong>the</strong> Learning Society: Report of <strong>the</strong><br />

National Committee of Inquiry into Higher Education. London: HMSO and<br />

NCIHE Publications.<br />

Hesketh, B., Gosper, M., Andrews, J. and Sabaz, M. (1996) Computer-mediated<br />

Communication in University Teaching. DEETYA. Australian Government<br />

Publishing Service, Canberra.<br />

Jones, P., Jacobs, G. & Brown, S. (1997) Learning styles and CAL design: a model<br />

<strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> future. Active Learning 7, December, pp 9-13.<br />

Scott, B., Ryan, S., Patel, D. (1997) Embedding TLTP and o<strong>the</strong>r resource based<br />

learning materials into <strong>the</strong> curriculum. Virtual Campus Real Learning,<br />

<strong>Association</strong> <strong>for</strong> Learning Technology Conference, University of Wolverhampton,<br />

Tel<strong>for</strong>d, Shropshire, UK, September 15–17. Conference <strong>Proceedings</strong>, pp. 68–69.


Development of a Collaborative Learning System<br />

based on NHK's Educational TV Program<br />

Haruo Kurokami<br />

Faculty of Education<br />

Kanazawa University<br />

kurokami@mbc.sphere.ne.jp<br />

Tatsuya Horita<br />

Faculty of Education<br />

Toyama University<br />

horita@edc.toyama-u.ac.jp<br />

Yuhei Yamauchi<br />

Faculty of Humanities<br />

Ibaraki University<br />

yamauchi@mito.ipc.ibaraki.ac.jp<br />

1. Introduction<br />

There have been a number of attempts to make collaborative learning situations <strong>for</strong> elementary school children using<br />

<strong>the</strong> Internet. While <strong>the</strong>re has been some success, effective collaborative learning depends on <strong>the</strong> sharing of a<br />

common problem or issue (Kurokami et al., 1996, 1997). Because of <strong>the</strong> vast quantity and variety of in<strong>for</strong>mation<br />

available <strong>for</strong> each learner, <strong>the</strong> Internet alone cannot provide <strong>the</strong> focus necessary <strong>for</strong> effective collaborative learning.<br />

NHK, <strong>the</strong> largest broadcasting company in Japan, televises a variety of educational programs including, "Tatta<br />

Hitotsu-no Chikyu; The Only One Earth." This series, targeting fifth and sixth graders, focuses on environmental<br />

<strong>the</strong>mes such as <strong>the</strong> destruction of <strong>the</strong> environment, environmental recovery, recycling systems, and what children<br />

can do in <strong>the</strong>ir daily lives to help <strong>the</strong> environment. This nationally broadcast program provides a common learning<br />

source <strong>for</strong> distant learners. Children from geographically distant locations, can watch <strong>the</strong> same program, <strong>for</strong>m ideas<br />

and opinions from <strong>the</strong>ir local perspectives and exchange in<strong>for</strong>mation with each o<strong>the</strong>r.<br />

2. Outline of Collaborative Learning System<br />

We have developed a collaborative learning system named <strong>the</strong> "The Only One Earth Club"<br />

(http://plan2.mbc.ntt.co.jp/~club/) based on <strong>the</strong> "The Only One Earth" series. The system is divided into two<br />

collaborative modes: "Club Diary" and "Is <strong>the</strong> Earth All Right" The <strong>for</strong>mer allows easy communication among<br />

individual participants; while <strong>the</strong> latter provides <strong>the</strong> opportunity <strong>for</strong> in-depth communication among three or four<br />

classes.<br />

Club Diary: "The Only One Earth" series has 20 programs yearly. Each program is broadcasted six times over two<br />

weeks. Participants are invited to exchange <strong>the</strong>ir opinions and ideas on BBS (Fig.1). After watching <strong>the</strong> program,<br />

participants think about and study <strong>the</strong> story's <strong>the</strong>me. They can send ideas or opinions to BBS through <strong>the</strong> "Club<br />

Diary." Our staff members, who are in-service teachers, can respond to <strong>the</strong> students opinions by choosing a<br />

character from a character pool and sending a message. These comments encourage participants to learn and<br />

communicate with each o<strong>the</strong>r.<br />

Is The Earth All Right: On this mode, a few classes make a group and collaborate with each o<strong>the</strong>r by web site and a<br />

video conference system. Web sites are made on our system so that it is possible to make comments to o<strong>the</strong>r classes<br />

via <strong>the</strong>ir web sites. Fig.2 is an example of a class's web site. The Web window is divided into two frames. One is <strong>for</strong><br />

class web sites and <strong>the</strong> o<strong>the</strong>r is <strong>for</strong> comments from co-learners. Each class learns about <strong>the</strong> environment from its<br />

unique perspective and make its own web pages. The pages are used to present each class's research findings and to


exchange in<strong>for</strong>mation with o<strong>the</strong>r classes. Participants who want to comment on a page he/she has read can change<br />

modes to <strong>the</strong> "comment mode" by clicking a button located at <strong>the</strong> bottom of <strong>the</strong> window.<br />

3. Conclusions<br />

At <strong>the</strong> end of this school year over 240 children and 65 classes had participated in "Club Diary," while 15 classes are<br />

participating in "Is The Earth All Right." 15 classes are grouped by <strong>the</strong>mes of learning. The <strong>the</strong>mes are "Rice<br />

Plant", "Water", "Garbage," "Atmosphere" and "Sea Turtle". Analysis of <strong>the</strong> "Club Diary" logs indicate that<br />

children, participating in <strong>the</strong> system, created multimedia documents, including still photographs, communicated with<br />

each o<strong>the</strong>r via BBS and began thinking about environmental issues in connection with <strong>the</strong>ir own daily life. The<br />

system's success is illustrated by an interaction between classes participating in "Is The Earth All Right" Questions<br />

were raised around <strong>the</strong> use of agricultural chemicals. One class, located in a rural area, agreed with <strong>the</strong> use of<br />

chemicals, while <strong>the</strong> ano<strong>the</strong>r class, located in <strong>the</strong> city, insisted that chemical use must be stopped. The children<br />

engaged in a heated debate via a video conference. Later, after interviewing farmers and consumers,. <strong>the</strong> students<br />

exchanged <strong>the</strong>ir findings through <strong>the</strong>ir web sites and both sides were better able to understand <strong>the</strong> opinions and<br />

objections of <strong>the</strong> o<strong>the</strong>r.<br />

It is difficult to quantify <strong>the</strong>se types of learning activities; however, <strong>the</strong> above examples clearly demonstrate that this<br />

collaborative learning system, based on NHK's educational program, can encourage new types of learning.<br />

References<br />

Kurokami, H., Iguchi, I., Yamauchi, Y., Horita, T., & Kuroda, T. (1997) Relationship between Network and TV programs <strong>for</strong><br />

school children. Educational TV Programs and Educational Software in Multimedia Era, A Report <strong>for</strong> NHK<br />

Kurokami, H., Horita, T., Yamauchi, Y., & Kuroda, T. (1998) Development of network communicating system to activate TV<br />

centered learning, Educational TV Programs and Educational Software in Multimedia Era, A Report <strong>for</strong> NHK


DATABASE-DRIVEN WEB APPLICATIONS FOR TEACHING & LEARNING<br />

1. Introduction<br />

Daniel Y. Lee<br />

Department of Economics & Coordinator, <strong>the</strong> Virtual University<br />

Shippensburg University<br />

Shippensburg, PA 17257 USA<br />

DYL@ship.edu<br />

Although many instructors now utilize <strong>the</strong> Web to supplement <strong>the</strong>ir courses, <strong>the</strong> Web pages <strong>the</strong>y create are<br />

mostly “static” in nature. These HTML documents are written and <strong>the</strong>n posted onto <strong>the</strong> Web server, where <strong>the</strong>y sit until<br />

requested by a browser. Materials on <strong>the</strong>se documents are outdated overtime until <strong>the</strong> Web developer revises <strong>the</strong>m one<br />

page at a time, which requires considerable time and ef<strong>for</strong>t, especially as Web pages multiply. In <strong>the</strong> long run, a better<br />

strategy to maintain a Web site is to use “dynamic” pages linked to databases. These Web pages are "dynamic" in <strong>the</strong><br />

sense that <strong>the</strong>y are created “on <strong>the</strong> fly.” They don’t exist until a browser makes <strong>the</strong> request. Upon <strong>the</strong> in<strong>for</strong>mation user’s<br />

request, <strong>the</strong> database inserts <strong>the</strong> requested in<strong>for</strong>mation into pre<strong>for</strong>matted HTML templates. If <strong>the</strong> in<strong>for</strong>mation in <strong>the</strong><br />

database is updated, <strong>the</strong> Web page will display <strong>the</strong> new in<strong>for</strong>mation <strong>the</strong> next time it is requested by <strong>the</strong> user. The purpose<br />

of this paper is to provide an overview of how educational Web sites can be more easily administered, modified, and<br />

customized by using Web-database connectivity.<br />

2. Developing Database-Driven Web<br />

2.1 Advantages of using database-driven Web<br />

Web browsers provide a Graphical User Interface (GUI) that can be used to access many things, including a<br />

database. Unlike <strong>the</strong> traditional database management systems, <strong>the</strong> user would not have to configure and learn to program<br />

database client software. Instead, using a Web browser's built-in <strong>for</strong>ms capability, users can access a database by simply<br />

filling in <strong>the</strong> data <strong>the</strong>y want and pressing a button. The returned data can <strong>the</strong>n be presented in an easily readable <strong>for</strong>mat.<br />

Fur<strong>the</strong>rmore, <strong>the</strong> Web's cross-plat<strong>for</strong>m support allows users on many different types of computers or plat<strong>for</strong>ms (Windows,<br />

Mac, Unix) to access a database from anywhere in <strong>the</strong> world. In<strong>for</strong>mation can be disseminated with a minimum of time<br />

and ef<strong>for</strong>t, without having to solve compatibility problems (Lee and Liu, 1998).<br />

There are several advantages of using database-driven Web development over <strong>the</strong> conventional “static”<br />

Web pages. First of all, Web pages can be created “on <strong>the</strong> fly” by querying current in<strong>for</strong>mation stored in <strong>the</strong><br />

database. New and fresh in<strong>for</strong>mation can be presented to <strong>the</strong> user at each visit. This technology also makes it easier<br />

to administer, modify, update, and customize a Web site. In addition, users can tap into vast existing databases<br />

including many legacy systems through Web-database interaction. This allows <strong>for</strong> cross plat<strong>for</strong>m access without<br />

requiring custom client applications. Fur<strong>the</strong>rmore, database-driven Web makes it possible such useful functions as<br />

maintaining user state, i.e., user’s preferences and o<strong>the</strong>r user-specific in<strong>for</strong>mation can be stored between visits <strong>for</strong><br />

various uses. In addition to <strong>the</strong>se benefits, database-driven Web renders particular advantages to educational Web<br />

sites. Databases are “an excellent way to manage <strong>the</strong> media components of a Web site … instructional Web sites<br />

comprise huge numbers of media objects and multiple of content creators; databases make managing this<br />

in<strong>for</strong>mation and longer-term maintenance issues easier to address” (Ashenfelter 1998).<br />

2.2 Mechanism of database-driven Web<br />

Typically, <strong>the</strong> Web server delivers a block of text written in <strong>the</strong> HTML to <strong>the</strong> browser, which parses <strong>the</strong> HTML<br />

and may request additional content, such as graphical data. The model works well <strong>for</strong> static data, but what about live data<br />

For example, how would a Web server deliver content that it generates based on user input One answer is to use a CGI<br />

(Common Gateway Interface) script to handle <strong>the</strong> database queries. CGI scripts are programs that let Web servers<br />

execute o<strong>the</strong>r programs and incorporate <strong>the</strong>ir output into HTML documents. The Web server executes a CGI<br />

program as a separate process to fulfill a user's request, which can be as simple as a Web page hit counter or as complex as<br />

a database query. Because a CGI program is external to <strong>the</strong> Web server, it can be written in virtually any language,


whe<strong>the</strong>r compiled or interpreted. Some Web servers provide libraries and interpreters <strong>for</strong> Java and Visual Basic <strong>for</strong> use by<br />

CGI programs.<br />

While CGI programs can handle basic Web-database connectivity functions, programming requires a steep<br />

learning curve. CGI programming is also subject to such limitations as input data validations and weak security. Recently<br />

various “middleware” products have been developed to minimize <strong>the</strong> CGI programming time and additional features of<br />

Web-database connectivity, including superior security, input data validation, e-mail protocol, etc. Middleware is a<br />

general term <strong>for</strong> any programming that serves to glue toge<strong>the</strong>r or enhance two separate programs. Users now can<br />

create Web-database applications by using a fourth generation language middleware products such as Cold Fusion or<br />

Active Server Pages.<br />

Database-driven Web publishing involves three major components: <strong>the</strong> Web <strong>for</strong>ms, CGI or middleware,<br />

and database system. The mechanisms <strong>for</strong> Web-database interaction are shown schematically in Figure 1. There<br />

are four major stages in this interaction. First, <strong>the</strong> user fills <strong>the</strong> Web <strong>for</strong>m using <strong>the</strong> browser, requesting pertinent<br />

in<strong>for</strong>mation. The browser submits <strong>the</strong> request to <strong>the</strong> Web server. Second, <strong>the</strong> server invokes middleware or CGI<br />

scripts, accessing and querying <strong>the</strong> database. Third, <strong>the</strong> middleware or CGI retrieves or produces a HTML<br />

document. Finally, <strong>the</strong> Web server sends <strong>the</strong> result to <strong>the</strong> browser <strong>for</strong> display. CGI script or middleware makes it<br />

possible <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> operations such as opening and updating appropriate database tables to link <strong>for</strong>m objects to a<br />

database structure specified in <strong>the</strong> database design. The Web server and database server can be hosted in a single<br />

computer or two separate machines connected through <strong>the</strong> Internet.<br />

2.3 Design of a database-driven Web<br />

To design an effective database-driven Web, three major design activities must be per<strong>for</strong>med, including<br />

Web <strong>for</strong>m design, database development and CGI or middleware programming. Web <strong>for</strong>ms are necessary as a user<br />

interface <strong>for</strong> a database-driven Web. The in<strong>for</strong>mation user can send a request to a database by submitting it via<br />

Web <strong>for</strong>m. A relational database is composed of rows (<strong>for</strong> records) and columns (<strong>for</strong> fields) in table <strong>for</strong>mat.<br />

Compared with a flat file structure, database approach has <strong>the</strong> advantages of minimal data redundancy,<br />

in<strong>for</strong>mation sharing, and data consistency. Finally, some programming is required to connect <strong>the</strong> Web <strong>for</strong>ms and<br />

databases. For example, Active Server Pages utilize extensively Visual Basic programming knowledge. Visual<br />

InterDev utilizes more user-friendly graphical interface. Cold Fusion eliminates some of <strong>the</strong> complex CGI coding<br />

by combining standard HTML with a server-side markup language called <strong>the</strong> Cold Fusion Markup Language<br />

(CFML). For example, <strong>the</strong> CFML tag can replace many lines of CGI programming codes. In<br />

addition, Cold Fusion supports such advanced features as security integration, dynamic Java <strong>for</strong>ms, data entry<br />

valuation, e-mail integration, Lightweight Directory Access Protocol (LDAP) support, and advanced SQL<br />

(Structural Query Language).


3. Conclusion<br />

Static Web documents are cumbersome and time-consuming to maintain. Whenever part of <strong>the</strong> contents is<br />

changed, <strong>the</strong> Web pages need to be updated. While dynamic Web development may require greater up-front costs, <strong>the</strong>se<br />

database-driven Web pages will minimize <strong>the</strong> cost of providing up-to-date materials to <strong>the</strong> in<strong>for</strong>mation user in <strong>the</strong> long<br />

run. Instructors can simplify <strong>the</strong> means of adding and updating materials on <strong>the</strong> Web by connecting <strong>the</strong>ir Web pages to<br />

databases. Carefully designed database-driven course Web sites can significantly enhance student-teacher interactions<br />

without taxing heavily on <strong>the</strong> instructors' valuable time and ef<strong>for</strong>t.<br />

REFERENCES<br />

Ashenfelter, J. P. (1998). Using Databases <strong>for</strong> Dynamic Web Sites: Techniques. Ed-Media & Ed-Telecom 98: <strong>Proceedings</strong> of <strong>the</strong> 10 th<br />

World Conference on Ed-Media and Ed-Telecom. <strong>Association</strong> <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> Advancement of Computing in Education. 1606-1608.<br />

Dwight, J., & Erwin, M. (1996). Special Edition Using CGI. Indianapolis: Que Corp.<br />

Lazar, Z. P., & Holfelder, P. (1997). Web Database Connectivity with Scripting Languages. World Wide Web Journal, 2(2).<br />

Lazar, Z. P. (1997). Web-Database Connectivity. Dr. Dobb's Sourcebook, 22(15).<br />

Lee, D. Y., & Liu, C. (1998). Building a Dynamic Web-Database Interface <strong>for</strong> Business Curriculum. Ed-Media & Ed-Telecom 98:<br />

<strong>Proceedings</strong> of <strong>the</strong> 10 th World Conference on Ed-Media and Ed-Telecom. <strong>Association</strong> <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> Advancement of Computing in<br />

Education, 842-847.<br />

Swank, M., & Kittel, D. (1996). World Wide Web Database Developer’s Guide. Indianopolis: Sams.net.


A web site system <strong>for</strong> instructors to manage collaborative learning<br />

Chen-Chung Liu, Gwo-Dong Chen, Kuo-Liang Ou, Baw-Jhiune Liu, Chih-Kai Chang<br />

Institute of Computer Science and In<strong>for</strong>mation Engineering<br />

National Central University, Taiwan<br />

{christia, chen, klou, bjliu, kant_c}@db.csie.ncu.edu.tw<br />

Abstract: As <strong>the</strong> World Wide Web (<strong>the</strong> Web) become popular, increasing number of<br />

distance learning systems are built on <strong>the</strong> Web. Yet, Instructors must onerously write<br />

complex programs to manage students’ learning behavior in a web based collaborative<br />

learning system. In addition, <strong>the</strong> instructor should prevent a learner from reading prohibited<br />

material, e.g. reading o<strong>the</strong>r groups’ work result be<strong>for</strong>e deadline. There<strong>for</strong>e, this investigation<br />

devises a web site system that allows instructors to regulate desired collaborative learning<br />

models. According to <strong>the</strong> regulated learning model, an instructor support system is also<br />

devised to automatically monitor <strong>the</strong> learning activities, control <strong>the</strong> learning actions, and<br />

generate notification in<strong>for</strong>mation to guide learners to learn concepts in an intended<br />

collaborative manner. Consequently, an instructor can easily and quickly construct a web<br />

based collaborative learning system that supports a desired collaborative learning model.<br />

Introduction<br />

Collaborative learning style (Monaghan and Clement 1995) is widely used in conventional<br />

classrooms. The learning style is also applied to promote <strong>the</strong> learning effect on <strong>the</strong> Web. Especially, a student<br />

in a distance learning system can not talk and learn with o<strong>the</strong>r students face to face. The students may feel<br />

lonely and abandon <strong>the</strong> courses without peers encouragement and pressure. In <strong>the</strong> collaborative learning style,<br />

learners are divided into groups and interact with each o<strong>the</strong>r to achieve common learning goals. Many <strong>for</strong>mats<br />

of group interaction such as group project and discussion are used to promote <strong>the</strong> interdependency(Thousand<br />

et al. 1994) among a learning group. Okamoto(Okamoto 1994) emphasized that <strong>the</strong> interaction among group<br />

members such as discussion and collaboration promotes learners’ understanding and confirmation. Besides,<br />

owing to achieving a common goal of <strong>the</strong> team, members of a group are more willing to help each o<strong>the</strong>r and to<br />

response question of o<strong>the</strong>r members quickly. However, to allow students <strong>for</strong> learning concepts in a desired<br />

collaborative manner, <strong>the</strong> instructors must made great ef<strong>for</strong>ts to manage student’s learning behavior in a<br />

learning environment.<br />

Our laboratory is cooperating with National Open University (NOU) and Institute <strong>for</strong> In<strong>for</strong>mation<br />

Industry (III) to offer web-based courses. In general, a web-based course in NOU and III has a primary<br />

instructor to set and monitor <strong>the</strong> learning goals. At <strong>the</strong> same time, three assistant instructors have to regulate<br />

collaborative learning models and develop a web-based collaborative learning system (CLS) to allow students<br />

<strong>for</strong> learning concept in a desired collaborative manner. Different assistant instructors usually adapt different<br />

collaborative learning models, e.g. group projects, group discussions, group debates and quizzes, etc. In <strong>the</strong><br />

running of <strong>the</strong>se courses, students suggest to offer a private discussion <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong>ir group. Students also do not<br />

want <strong>the</strong>ir individual learning in<strong>for</strong>mation such as <strong>the</strong> instructor’s commend or homework to be read by<br />

o<strong>the</strong>rs. In addition, <strong>the</strong> instructors found that it is necessary to assign each student a role and to define<br />

responsibility and capability of a role. Thus, <strong>the</strong> groups are easier to learn collaboratively according to <strong>the</strong>ir<br />

role and responsibilities. At <strong>the</strong> same time, instructors are easier to guide and monitor <strong>the</strong> groups. To satisfy<br />

<strong>the</strong>se requirements, an instructor must write many programs onerously to manage different collaborative<br />

learning activities. There<strong>for</strong>e, instructors need facilities to manage students’ learning behavior in a web-based<br />

CLS.<br />

Current web servers un<strong>for</strong>tunately do not support directly required facilities <strong>for</strong> constructing a CLS.<br />

According to <strong>the</strong> existing collaborative learning models, e.g. Team game tournament (TGT), and Jigsaw<br />

(Slavin 1994, Stallings and Stipek 1986, Stallings and Stipek 1986), and our experiences (Chang and Chen


1997), basic requirements <strong>for</strong> supporting collaborative learning on Web include facilities <strong>for</strong> (1) regulating<br />

collaborative learning model (2) controlling <strong>the</strong> learning actions, and (3) notifying participants to guide<br />

learners to interact with o<strong>the</strong>rs according to <strong>the</strong> defined learning model. We explain each requirement and<br />

why current web servers, e.g. Microsoft IIS and Netscape web server, can not support it in <strong>the</strong> following<br />

collaborative learning scenario.<br />

Team game tournament (TGT)(Slavin 1994) is recognized as an effective learning model in<br />

conventional classrooms. The TGT model first evaluates learners’ learning status and <strong>the</strong>n divides <strong>the</strong>se<br />

learners into heterogeneous groups according to evaluating results. After studying a subject, learners of a<br />

group join proper team games with <strong>the</strong> members of o<strong>the</strong>r groups to win points <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong>ir own groups. An<br />

illustrative TGT scenario, as depicted in figure 1, is given here to clarify <strong>the</strong> tasks of instructors. First, learners<br />

join a quiz activity after <strong>the</strong>y finish an assigned reading activity. According to <strong>the</strong> portfolio in <strong>the</strong> quiz,<br />

instructors divide <strong>the</strong> learners into several groups. Then, <strong>the</strong> learners are assigned to suitable team games to<br />

win point <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong>ir groups. Finally, learners of a group discuss collaboratively to clarify <strong>the</strong>ir misconceptions in<br />

team games.<br />

Figure 1: The scenario of <strong>the</strong> illustrative example<br />

To support <strong>the</strong> TGT scenario on <strong>the</strong> Web, an instructor must do <strong>the</strong> following tasks. First, <strong>the</strong>re are<br />

three roles involved in <strong>the</strong> quiz activity, i.e. student, teacher, and teaching assistant (TA). The instructor must<br />

initially assign each learner and o<strong>the</strong>r participant an appropriate role in <strong>the</strong> quiz activity. In addition, <strong>the</strong><br />

instructor must regulate <strong>the</strong> capability and responsibility of each role. For instance, <strong>the</strong> teacher role should set<br />

quiz paper to start <strong>the</strong> quiz activity. Then, each student role should submit his/her answer in one day. Since<br />

existing web server do not distinguish users’ roles, capabilities, and responsibilities, instructors can not<br />

regulate desired learning activity on <strong>the</strong> Web based on group, role, and status. This issue is referred as<br />

learning model regulation problem.<br />

Second, after <strong>the</strong> instructor regulate a collaborative learning model, each role has certain capability to<br />

per<strong>for</strong>m some actions. For example, in <strong>the</strong> quiz activity, a student role can read <strong>the</strong> quiz paper and submit<br />

his/her answer. He/she can also read <strong>the</strong> correct answer posted by a TA. However, until <strong>the</strong> student submits<br />

his/her answer, he/she can not read <strong>the</strong> correct answer. In addition, some learning material can be access only<br />

by a specific learner or participant. For example, <strong>the</strong> revised answer of a student’s answer can be read only by<br />

this student. O<strong>the</strong>r student can not read <strong>the</strong> revised answer. There<strong>for</strong>e, <strong>the</strong> instructor must prevent learners<br />

from per<strong>for</strong>ming prohibited actions. We refer this issue as learning action control problem.<br />

Finally, each role has responsibility to per<strong>for</strong>m some actions according to <strong>the</strong> regulated collaborative<br />

learning model. For example, an instructor may regulate that <strong>the</strong> TA role in a discussion activity has to initiate<br />

a topic <strong>for</strong> discussion. Then, <strong>the</strong> moderator role has to raise issues of <strong>the</strong> topic in two days. The student roles<br />

must post <strong>the</strong>ir arguments to an issue in two days. Finally, <strong>the</strong> TA should conclude <strong>the</strong> discussion. There<strong>for</strong>e,<br />

<strong>the</strong> instructor has to notify appropriate learner to per<strong>for</strong>m proper actions in learning activities. The first thing


is to monitor <strong>the</strong> status of learners. Then, when <strong>the</strong> learner log in <strong>the</strong> system, <strong>the</strong> system should present<br />

appropriate in<strong>for</strong>mation and tell him/her what to do according to his/her status and <strong>the</strong> defined learning<br />

model. However, current web servers are passive and stateless in nature. They present <strong>the</strong> same in<strong>for</strong>mation<br />

<strong>for</strong> each user. These servers will not notify a user when some event or condition happens. This issue is referred<br />

as guidance and notification problem.<br />

To sum up, in current situation, <strong>the</strong> instructors, web server managers, or learning system development<br />

team should write many programs to build a web based collaborative learning system <strong>for</strong> each desired learning<br />

model. The instructors need an easy-to-use facility tool by which <strong>the</strong>y can easily regulate desired collaborative<br />

learning models. An instructor support system is also necessary to automatically manage learners’ learning<br />

behavior, i.e. control student’ learning action and generate notification in<strong>for</strong>mation.<br />

The Activity regulation tool<br />

To allow instructors <strong>for</strong> regulating intended learning models, an activity regulation tool is supported<br />

in <strong>the</strong> web site system. An instructor initially organizes a learning group and assigns roles in <strong>the</strong> group. The<br />

learning group is <strong>the</strong>n put in a learning activity. A participant of a certain role has responsibility to per<strong>for</strong>m<br />

some actions. The participants of different roles have also different capacities on per<strong>for</strong>ming actions.<br />

There<strong>for</strong>e, to facilitate instructors in regulating desired learning models, <strong>the</strong> activity regulation tool must allow<br />

an instructor <strong>for</strong> specifying <strong>the</strong> following in<strong>for</strong>mation: (1) learning groups that per<strong>for</strong>m <strong>the</strong> activity, (2) roles<br />

involved in <strong>the</strong> activity, (3) role assignment <strong>for</strong> organizing <strong>the</strong> activity, (4) actions that a role can per<strong>for</strong>m in<br />

<strong>the</strong> activity, (5) capabilities of each participating role, and (6) responsibilities of each participating role.<br />

An illustrative quiz learning activity is given in figure 2. To clearly explain <strong>the</strong> idea, an in<strong>for</strong>mal<br />

notation is used. The team games and discussion activities in <strong>the</strong> TGT scenario can be also regulated in a<br />

similar manner.<br />

------------------------------------------------------- Quiz Activity ------------------------------------------------------------<br />

---<br />

Participants:<br />

s 1, s 2,, ta 1 , t 1<br />

Roles:<br />

Student, Teacher, TA , All<br />

Role assignment:<br />

Participants s 1, s 2 play Student role.<br />

Participant ta 1 plays TA role.<br />

Participant t 1 plays Teacher role.<br />

Actions: read quiz paper, read correct answer, read student’s answer, read revised answer,<br />

set quiz paper, announce correct answer, submit answer, revise student’s answer<br />

Capabilities Grants:<br />

G1: All roles (Student, TA, Teacher) can read quiz paper.<br />

G2: Teacher roles can read correct answer.<br />

G3: TA roles can read correct answer.<br />

G4: A student role can read correct answer. But he/she can not read correct answer until he/she has Submit his/her<br />

answer.<br />

G5: TA roles can read student’s answers.<br />

G6: Teacher roles can read student’s answers.<br />

G7: A Student roles can read a student’s answer if he/she is <strong>the</strong> author of <strong>the</strong> answer.<br />

G8: Teacher roles can read revised answer.<br />

G9: TA roles can read revised answer.<br />

G10: A Student role can read revised answer if <strong>the</strong> revised answer is <strong>for</strong> his/her submitted answer.<br />

G11: Teacher roles can set quiz paper.<br />

G12: TA roles can announce correct answer.<br />

G13: A student can submit his/her answer. But he/she can not submit his/her answer one day after Teacher role set<br />

<strong>the</strong> quiz paper.<br />

G14: TA roles can revise student’s answer.


Responsibilities:<br />

R1: If a teacher role sets quiz paper, <strong>the</strong>n all student roles must submit <strong>the</strong>ir answer in one day.<br />

R2: If a student role submits his/her answer, <strong>the</strong>n a TA role must revise <strong>the</strong> answer in two days.<br />

R3: If a TA role revise a student’s answer, <strong>the</strong>n <strong>the</strong> student role must read <strong>the</strong> revised answer in two days.<br />

R4: If a teacher role set a quiz paper, <strong>the</strong>n a TA role must announce correct answer in two days.<br />

Figure 2: Quiz activity<br />

Figure 3: Web interface of activity regulation tool<br />

The activity regulation tool interface is illustrated in figure 3. To organize <strong>the</strong> learning groups, <strong>the</strong><br />

instructor can include a set of <strong>the</strong> participants in <strong>the</strong> activity regulation tool. For instance, <strong>the</strong> quiz activity in<br />

figure 2 includes four participants in a learning group to per<strong>for</strong>m <strong>the</strong> quiz activity. Fur<strong>the</strong>rmore, <strong>the</strong> roles and<br />

role assignment allows instructors to organize <strong>the</strong> activity. For instance, an instructor can specify that a quiz<br />

activity involves Student, Teacher, and Teaching Assistant (TA) and assign each participant in <strong>the</strong> learning<br />

group to play appropriate roles. In addition, <strong>the</strong> activity model also contains a set of actions that participants<br />

can per<strong>for</strong>m in <strong>the</strong> learning activity. As illustrated in figure 3, instructors can organize activities by <strong>the</strong><br />

provided activity regulation tool.<br />

In addition, to specify <strong>the</strong> capability of each participating role, <strong>the</strong> activity regulation tool allows<br />

instructors to specify a set of capability grants. The capability grants indicate whe<strong>the</strong>r a participating role can<br />

per<strong>for</strong>m an action at a moment in a learning activity. There are four cases when a participating role per<strong>for</strong>ms<br />

an action. (1) Statically accessible: A participating role can always per<strong>for</strong>m an action. For example, a student<br />

can always read quiz paper as given in G1 in figure 2. (2) Statically inaccessible: A participating role can not<br />

per<strong>for</strong>m an action. For example, a student can not revise o<strong>the</strong>r students’ answer. In this case, <strong>the</strong>re is no<br />

capability grand in <strong>the</strong> activity model. (3) Privately accessible: An action can only be per<strong>for</strong>med by a particular<br />

participating role. An example is that a student can only read <strong>the</strong> revised answer of his/her answer. O<strong>the</strong>r<br />

students are not allowed to read <strong>the</strong> revised answer. Hence, <strong>the</strong> access grant G10 is set in <strong>the</strong> quiz activity. (4)<br />

Temporally accessible: A participating role can per<strong>for</strong>m an action only at some moment during <strong>the</strong> activity.<br />

For instance, a student can not read <strong>the</strong> correct answer until he/she has submitted his/her answer as regulated<br />

in G4. Ano<strong>the</strong>r example is that a student can not submit his/her answer one day after <strong>the</strong> teacher set <strong>the</strong> quiz<br />

paper (G13). To specify <strong>the</strong>se temporal properties, a temporal concept is required.<br />

Many temporal <strong>for</strong>malisms such as temporal logic, timed temporal logic and metric temporal logic<br />

(MTL)(Alur and Henzinger 1997) are available to specify <strong>the</strong> temporal property. For instance, <strong>the</strong> capability<br />

grant G4 in figure 2 regulates that a student role can not read correct answer until he/she has Submitted<br />

his/her answer. This capability grant can be expressed in MTL as not ReadCorrectAnswer Until Submit. And


<strong>the</strong> capability grant G13 as Not SetQuizPaper and Eventually >1day Submit to express that no learners submits<br />

his/her answer one day after <strong>the</strong> teacher set <strong>the</strong> quiz paper.<br />

To regulate <strong>the</strong> responsibility of each participating role, <strong>the</strong> activity regulation tool contains a set of<br />

interaction rules. The interaction rules specify what a participating role should do when/after o<strong>the</strong>r<br />

participating role per<strong>for</strong>med some actions. For instance, <strong>the</strong> R1 in quiz activity regulates that if a teacher role<br />

sets quiz paper, <strong>the</strong>n eventually all student roles must submit <strong>the</strong>ir answer in one day. In this aspect, we use<br />

also MTL to specify such interaction rules. For instance, <strong>the</strong> interaction rule R1 can be regulated in MTL as If<br />

SetQuizPaper <strong>the</strong>n Eventually


notification module must notify all students to submit quiz answer. Since we can not expect that learners stay<br />

on <strong>the</strong> collaborative learning system all <strong>the</strong> times, immediate notification to per<strong>for</strong>m action is not necessary.<br />

There<strong>for</strong>e, <strong>the</strong> notification can use <strong>the</strong> action history, as illustrated in figure 4, to generate notification<br />

in<strong>for</strong>mation once a learner log in <strong>the</strong> collaborative learning system.<br />

Requirement Instructor’s Tasks Facilities<br />

regulation of<br />

learning model<br />

Control of learning<br />

action<br />

Notification and<br />

guidance<br />

Organizing learning group,<br />

Assigning roles,<br />

Regulating each role’s capability,<br />

Regulating each role’s responsibility<br />

Monitoring learners’ action,<br />

Checking <strong>the</strong> accessibility of actions, and<br />

Present learning material<br />

Monitoring learners’ action,<br />

notify learners<br />

Activity regulation tool with learning<br />

group, role assignment and MTL <strong>for</strong><br />

specifying capability and responsibility<br />

Instructor support system <strong>for</strong> checking of<br />

<strong>the</strong> learning actions, and dynamically<br />

generating HTML file<br />

Instructor support system <strong>for</strong> generation<br />

of notification<br />

Table 1. Summary of requirement, instructors’ task and supported facilities<br />

We provide facility <strong>for</strong> instructors to regulate intended collaborative learning model, control learning actions,<br />

and generate notification in<strong>for</strong>mation. Table 1 summarizes <strong>the</strong> requirements, <strong>the</strong> instructor’s tasks to enact<br />

collaborative learning on <strong>the</strong> Web, and <strong>the</strong> facilities provided in this investigation.<br />

Conclusion<br />

The creation of learning environments that renders learning more active is initiating challenges <strong>for</strong><br />

research on learning (Barfurth 1995). The idea of <strong>the</strong> investigation comes from different instructors may desire<br />

different collaborative learning models to promote learning effect in distance learning environments. The<br />

architecture of <strong>the</strong> devised learning web site system fulfills <strong>the</strong> ideal to relieve instructors’ tasks in supporting<br />

desired collaborative learning models on <strong>the</strong> Web. Instructors can regulate desired learning model by <strong>the</strong> use<br />

of devised activity regulation tool, regardless of writing complex programs. The instructor support system<br />

automates <strong>the</strong> guidance and control of learners’ learning actions. Instructors may consequently support desired<br />

collaborative learning model on <strong>the</strong> Web easily and quickly.<br />

References<br />

Alur R. and Henzinger T. A.(1997), Real-time logics: complexity and expressiveness, In<strong>for</strong>mation and<br />

Computation, 104, pp.35-77, 1997.<br />

Barfurth M. A.(1995), Understanding <strong>the</strong> collaborative learning process in a technology rich environment: <strong>the</strong><br />

case of children disagreements. Proc. of Computer Support <strong>for</strong> Collaborative Learning, pp. 8-13, 1995.<br />

Chang C. K. and Chen G. D.(1997), Constructing collaborative learning activities <strong>for</strong> distance CAL systems.<br />

Journal of Computer Assisted Learning, Vol.13, pp.2-15, 1997.<br />

Monaghan J. M. and Clement J.(1995), Use of collaborative computer simulation activities to facilitate relative<br />

motion learning, Proc. First International Conf. on Computer Support <strong>for</strong> Collaborative Learning,<br />

Bloomington, Indiana, pp.242-246, October 1995.<br />

Okamoto T. (1994), The current situations and future directions of intelligent CAI research/development,<br />

IEICE Trans. Inf. & Syst., vol.E77D, no.1, pp.9-18 , January 1994.


Slavin R.(1994), Small group method, in M. Dunkin(Ed.), The international encyclopedia of teaching and<br />

teacher education, pp. 237-243, Elms<strong>for</strong>d, NY:Pergamon Press, 1986.<br />

Stallings J. and Stipek D.(1986), Research on early childhood and elementary school teaching programs, in M.<br />

Wittrock (Ed.), Handbook of research on teaching, pp. 727-753, New York:Macmillan, 1986.<br />

Thousand J. S., Villa R. A. and Nevin A. I.(1994), Creativity and collaborative learning, Paul H. Publishing<br />

Co., Baltimore, Maryland, 1994.


Scaffolding : Applications to learning in technology supported environments<br />

Ca<strong>the</strong>rine McLoughlin<br />

Edith Cowan University<br />

Western Australia<br />

Abstract<br />

Scaffolding is a <strong>for</strong>m of temporary support offered to a learner to assist in <strong>the</strong> process of becoming a<br />

skilled practitioner. Traditionally, <strong>the</strong> most common <strong>for</strong>m of learning has been an apprenticeship,<br />

where a novice learns through active participation in a task, initially only peripherally, and <strong>the</strong>n<br />

assuming more control and ownership. Originating in <strong>the</strong> socio-cultural perspective of Vygotskyan<br />

<strong>the</strong>ory and developed by later <strong>the</strong>orists, <strong>the</strong> concept of scaffolding has been extended by practical<br />

applications in technology-based environments. As <strong>the</strong> World Wide Web becomes increasingly<br />

integrated into <strong>the</strong> delivery of learning experiences at primary, tertiary and secondary levels, <strong>the</strong><br />

concept of scaffolding needs to be redefined because it is not readily translated into contexts where<br />

<strong>the</strong> teacher is not present, as in on-line environments. This calls <strong>for</strong> a reconsideration of <strong>the</strong> nature of<br />

scaffolding and <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> alignment of <strong>the</strong>ory with practice.<br />

Introduction: Foundations of scaffolding<br />

The term ‘scaffolding’ is increasingly used to describe certain kinds of support which learners receive in <strong>the</strong>ir<br />

interaction with experts, teachers and mentors as <strong>the</strong>y develop new skills, concepts or levels of understanding.<br />

The term scaffolding was originally coined by Bruner, Wood & Ross (1976) as a metaphor to describe <strong>the</strong><br />

effective intervention by a peer, adult or competent person in <strong>the</strong> learning of ano<strong>the</strong>r person. Bruner explicitly<br />

relates <strong>the</strong> term scaffolding to Vygotsky’s concept of “<strong>the</strong> zone of proximal development”, that is <strong>the</strong> actual<br />

developmental level of <strong>the</strong> learner compared with <strong>the</strong> level of potential development that can occur with<br />

guidance or collaboration with a more competent person. In technology supported learning environments, <strong>the</strong><br />

metaphor of scaffolding is appealing in principle, yet elusive and problematic. The appeal of <strong>the</strong> concept lies in<br />

<strong>the</strong> fact that it directs attention to <strong>the</strong> role of <strong>the</strong> instructor or teacher in <strong>the</strong> learning process, and does so in a<br />

way which emphasises that good teaching is necessarily responsive to <strong>the</strong> state of understanding achieved by<br />

particular learners. In earlier research <strong>the</strong>re<strong>for</strong>e, scaffolded instruction was conceived as a joint interaction in<br />

which <strong>the</strong> teacher and <strong>the</strong> learner share <strong>the</strong> responsibility <strong>for</strong> learning (Vygotsky, 1978; Wood, Bruner & Ross,<br />

1976). In environments mediated by technology, scaffolding can be provided by a tutor or intelligent agent so<br />

that learners attain new skills, concepts and knowledge.<br />

Theoretical perspectives on scaffolding: Past and present<br />

It is important to trace <strong>the</strong> early origins of research on scaffolding in order to appreciate its complexity. The<br />

socio-cultural approach emanating from <strong>the</strong> work of Vygotsky has had a major influence on <strong>the</strong> development of<br />

scaffolded instruction and apprenticeship models of learning (Vygotsky, 1978; Wood & Wood, 1976; Rogoff &<br />

Lave, 1984; Collins, Brown & Newman, 1989). Much of this work emphasises <strong>the</strong> role of social interaction as<br />

a cultural amplifier to extend children’s cognitive processes, with an adult or expert o<strong>the</strong>r introducing learners<br />

to <strong>the</strong> conceptual tools available in society. For cognition to be analysed, culture and context are <strong>the</strong><br />

fundamental units of consideration, as human development is seen to be located and immersed in social<br />

practices. This perspective resists <strong>the</strong> separation of <strong>the</strong> individual from society and <strong>the</strong> daily environment, and<br />

perceives meaningful activity as embedded in au<strong>the</strong>ntic socially-created situations. This perspective has had<br />

profound and far-reaching influences on how current practitioners design learning environments (eg, Jarvela,<br />

1995; Roschelle & Teasley, 1995). Cognitive change can be effected through processes of social interaction in<br />

which ideas are articulated, shared, revised, modified and adopted because of <strong>the</strong>ir relevance to <strong>the</strong> cultural<br />

context (Roschelle, Levine & Teasley, 1991; Newman, Griffin & Cole, 1989). Learners progress through <strong>the</strong><br />

ZPD by attempting successive approximations of <strong>the</strong> learning task, assisted by peers, more able o<strong>the</strong>rs or with a


tutor. Support offered in <strong>the</strong> <strong>for</strong>m of dialogue, discussion and demonstration has been found to be effective in<br />

enabling cognitive change (Lave, 1991; Palincsar, 1986).<br />

The mechanisms <strong>for</strong> assisting learner cognition through <strong>the</strong> ZPD have been extended greatly by technology<br />

applications. Originally, <strong>the</strong> teachers role was conceived as providing scaffolded assistance through modelling,<br />

contingency management, cognitive structuring and feedback (Tharp & Gallimore, 1988). Through modelling,<br />

tasks, skills and concepts can be demonstrated while retaining complexity and au<strong>the</strong>nticity, so that learners can<br />

become engaged in <strong>the</strong> acquisition of new skills. Contingency management is concerned with recognising and<br />

rewarding learner actions, while feedback enables students to compare <strong>the</strong>mselves to o<strong>the</strong>rs. In cognitive<br />

structuring, learners are assisted to organise <strong>the</strong>ir own experiences following <strong>the</strong> provision of explanations, or<br />

meta-level strategies to enable students to organise <strong>the</strong>ir own thinking. Later, <strong>the</strong>se mechanisms are<br />

internalised and become metacognitive strategies <strong>for</strong> students to regulate <strong>the</strong>irs own learning. In addition,<br />

verbal scaffolds such as instructing, questioning and cognitive structuring enable students to organise <strong>the</strong>ir own<br />

activities by suggesting meta strategies that students can acquire so that teacher support becomes “ ... a heard,<br />

regulating voice, a gradually internalised voices that <strong>the</strong>n becomes <strong>the</strong> pupil’s self-regulating ‘still small’<br />

instructor.” (Tharp & Gallimore, 1988: 57).<br />

Evolving research on scaffolding<br />

Some similarities and differences emerge when we compare recent work on scaffolding with earlier research<br />

conducted in <strong>the</strong> 1980’s. For example, much of <strong>the</strong> work of <strong>the</strong> Cognition & Technology Group at Vanderbilt<br />

(CTGV) has emphasised <strong>the</strong> notion of anchoring instruction in everyday au<strong>the</strong>ntic contexts (CTGV, 1993;<br />

1996). However a major difference is that earlier work (Tharp & Gallimore, 1998; Rogoff & Lave, 1984;<br />

Newman, Griffin & Cole, 1989; Wood, Bruner & Ross;1976; Palincsar, 1986) was conducted in face-to face<br />

classrooms, where <strong>for</strong>ms of verbal interaction were <strong>the</strong> most common <strong>for</strong>ms of scaffolding. Teachers and<br />

learners occupied <strong>the</strong> same space, and engaged in learning processes in <strong>the</strong> social context of a conventional<br />

classroom, with its prescribed rules, roles and expectations. This often limited scaffolding to teacher initiated<br />

discourse. For example, in many traditional classrooms, questioning has been shown to be a <strong>for</strong>m of social<br />

control (Edwards & Westgate, 1994). Many of <strong>the</strong>se social constraints are not present in <strong>the</strong> virtual classrooms<br />

or in contexts where learning is asynchronous. In addition, <strong>the</strong> nature of scaffolding in such face-to-face<br />

classrooms was assumed to be asymmetric in that <strong>the</strong> teacher was regarded as <strong>the</strong> expert, and <strong>the</strong> student <strong>the</strong><br />

novice. Recent advances in communications technology and in pedagogy envisage an active, participatory role<br />

<strong>for</strong> students, as initiators and co-participant in self-regulating learning process (Brown & Campione, 1994).<br />

A consideration of more recent work in technology-supported environments illustrates how <strong>the</strong> concept of<br />

scaffolding has expanded to include many news <strong>for</strong>ms of support, increased responsibility <strong>for</strong> students and a<br />

fading of <strong>the</strong> directive of assymetrical aspect of earlier work on scaffolding. While Vygotskyan <strong>the</strong>ory provides<br />

<strong>the</strong> <strong>the</strong>oretical anchoring needed by making an explicit connection between social interaction and cognitive<br />

development, o<strong>the</strong>r <strong>for</strong>ms of support can be provided by technology thus enabling learners to engage in<br />

cognitive change and skills advancement.<br />

Supporting learning through WWW-based course supports<br />

As <strong>the</strong> World Wide Web becomes increasingly integrated into <strong>the</strong> delivery of learning experiences at primary,<br />

tertiary and secondary levels, <strong>the</strong> concept of scaffolding needs to be redefined because it is not readily translated<br />

into contexts where <strong>the</strong> teacher is not present, as in on-line environments. This calls <strong>for</strong> a reconsideration of<br />

<strong>the</strong> nature of scaffolding and <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> alignment of <strong>the</strong>ory with practice (Collis, 1997; 1998). As yet, research<br />

focusing on <strong>the</strong> nature of scaffolds and <strong>the</strong>ir functions in specific contexts of learning is limited. Through <strong>the</strong><br />

provision of examples from a range of contexts where technology is used to mediate <strong>the</strong> teaching transaction, it<br />

is possible to show that <strong>the</strong> notion of scaffolding offers a way of conceptualising <strong>the</strong> process of effective<br />

learning by:<br />

• reducing <strong>the</strong> scope <strong>for</strong> failure in <strong>the</strong> task that <strong>the</strong> learner is attempting;<br />

• enabling learners to accomplish a task that <strong>the</strong>y would not be able to achieve on <strong>the</strong>ir own;


• bringing learners closer to a state of independent competence.<br />

As technology extends learning beyond <strong>the</strong> classroom to learning communities, so must roles and concepts of<br />

learning and teaching be reconsidered (Collis, 1998). In learning from <strong>the</strong> WWW, distributed groups of<br />

learners can be supported in <strong>the</strong> learning process by different technological functionalities which support<br />

dialogue and interaction (Table 1). With its great potential <strong>for</strong> collaborative learning, particular <strong>for</strong>ms of<br />

scaffolding are needed to provide models, examples and support <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> processes of active learning<br />

characterised by:<br />

• self-responsibility <strong>for</strong> thinking and learning,<br />

• awareness of social responsibility;<br />

• thinking and acting scientific processes;<br />

• relating group process and product with professional practice.<br />

.<br />

Collaborative work can be supported by developing WWW functionalities to support, or scaffold group<br />

processes and cognition. Collis (1997) has ‘re-engineered’ academic courses and developed a number of ‘tools’<br />

to enable group work, sharing of resources, ideas and so that processes and products are integrated. Through a<br />

shared work-space environment, students can access texts, documents and o<strong>the</strong>r resources, add resources and<br />

interacting with o<strong>the</strong>rs through conferencing facilities. Table 1 displays a number of scaffolding solutions<br />

using WWW tools to enable cognitive outcomes and processes that underpin successful learning. In <strong>the</strong> left<br />

column, a list of scaffolds af<strong>for</strong>ded by WWW tools is provided.<br />

Cognitive goal WWW Tool Scaffolding af<strong>for</strong>ded by<br />

tools<br />

Reflection<br />

Group dialogue<br />

Collaboration<br />

Metacognitive awareness<br />

Questioning<br />

Self-regulated learning<br />

Group problem solving<br />

social interaction<br />

Self-responsibility<br />

Email<br />

Bulletin boards<br />

Frequently asked question<br />

space(FAQ)(<br />

Hyperlinked access to course<br />

resources<br />

Groupware & databases<br />

Threaded computer conferences<br />

• Group messaging<br />

• Discussion <strong>for</strong>ums<br />

• Guided reflection<br />

• Support <strong>for</strong> questioning<br />

• Collaborative problem<br />

solving<br />

• Reflection on peer<br />

contributions<br />

• Shared resources<br />

• On line mentors<br />

• Management of group<br />

processes<br />

Table 1: Examples of scaffolds af<strong>for</strong>ded by WWW functionalities<br />

Some examples of key indicators of effective scaffolding in Web-based environments include:<br />

• <strong>the</strong> provision of learning resources to help students solve <strong>the</strong>ir own problems and share <strong>the</strong>m with o<strong>the</strong>rs;<br />

• offering multiple channels of communication should enable conversation, exchange of ideas and<br />

discussion;<br />

• provision of support <strong>for</strong> collaborative tasks and development of higher order cognition.<br />

It is advocated that <strong>the</strong>se scaffolding features are built into <strong>the</strong> design of Web-based courseware, since its<br />

activities tend to be less structured that face-to-face instruction, utilising principled design processes (Collis,<br />

1997).<br />

A range of technological approaches to enable scaffolded learning


Apart from utilising <strong>the</strong> functionalities of <strong>the</strong> WWW to support learning, recent research in technology<br />

mediated environments presents an array of possibilities and perspectives on scaffolding. By investigating <strong>the</strong>se<br />

applications it is possible to compare and extrapolate common features and propose principles <strong>for</strong> future<br />

research. Four examples of scaffolded instructional using hypermedia provide contrasting scenarios <strong>for</strong> recent<br />

interpretations of scaffolded instruction.<br />

Computer supported-intentional learning environments (CSILES)<br />

This approach, conceived by Scardamalia & Bereiter (1989;1992;1993) provides a powerful collaborative<br />

medium based on anchored design and discourse space, in which students can negotiate and construct new<br />

understandings. In <strong>the</strong> environment, <strong>the</strong> teacher’s role is trans<strong>for</strong>med from that of manager to facilitator of<br />

student collaborative processes. A CSILE is an experimental computer system which can mediate shared<br />

spaces <strong>for</strong> collaborative knowledge building. The basis <strong>for</strong> this is a shared communal database, which gives<br />

students a common space to create and communicate <strong>the</strong> ideas and representations that emerge from<br />

individually and group work. In addition to supporting social interactions needed <strong>for</strong> shared understanding, it<br />

provides facilities required <strong>for</strong> reaching reciprocal understanding, and facilities <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> shared product to be<br />

expanded, altered, clarified, elaborated and manipulate <strong>for</strong> new meanings to emerge. A shared database of text<br />

notes and graphics notes allows learners to access and collaborate on <strong>the</strong> creation of knowledge objects.<br />

CSILES have inspired fur<strong>the</strong>r work and have provided a supportive medium <strong>for</strong> a number of projects<br />

(Cognition and Technology Group at Vanderbilt, 1993).<br />

Intelligent tutoring systems (ITS)<br />

In an intelligent tutoring system, learners are guided through a learning processes and provided with a<br />

structures and sequences of task to assist <strong>the</strong>m. Well known examples can be seen in <strong>the</strong> work of Andersen et<br />

al (Anderson, Boyle, Carbett & Lewis, 1990; Anderson, Boyle & Reiser, 1985) is which students are taught to<br />

solve algebra word problems, develop programs and generate geometry proofs. By reducing <strong>the</strong> complexity of<br />

<strong>the</strong> task and providing cognitive structuring, an ITS cam scaffold learning. In an intelligent tutoring system, a<br />

learner’s progress is charted against an expert model of <strong>the</strong> process, which <strong>the</strong> student is expected to model.<br />

Intelligent tutoring systems have be criticised <strong>for</strong> lack of au<strong>the</strong>nticity in <strong>the</strong> learning task, and <strong>for</strong> creating<br />

tasks where students do not have to engage in real life problem solving (Gudzial & Kehoe, 1998). In ITS<br />

environments, collaboration in learning is less essential than in o<strong>the</strong>r apprenticeship settings.<br />

Goal-based scenarios (GBS)<br />

Goal-based scenarios are learning setting where students have to engage in an au<strong>the</strong>ntic setting where <strong>the</strong>y are<br />

presented with a goal to achieve. The objective is <strong>for</strong> students to acquire and develop <strong>the</strong> requisite process skills<br />

and conceptual knowledge to attain <strong>the</strong> goal (Schank, 1992). Students are provided with technology-based<br />

resources to achieve <strong>the</strong>se goals, and <strong>the</strong>ir per<strong>for</strong>mance is compared to that of successful model of <strong>the</strong> process.<br />

If a learner cannot achieve <strong>the</strong> goal, scaffolding is provided in <strong>the</strong> <strong>for</strong>m of process in<strong>for</strong>mation which gives<br />

corrective feedback in story <strong>for</strong>m to help <strong>the</strong> learner to address <strong>the</strong> problem. In a GBS students interact with<br />

agents embedded in a system, ra<strong>the</strong>r than with socially-based collaborators or peers. BGS are never<strong>the</strong>less<br />

unable to provide feedback or support <strong>for</strong> complex abstract processes where <strong>the</strong>re is no single solution.<br />

Design support environments (DSE’s)<br />

Design support environments are aimed at supporting students through a <strong>for</strong>m of software realised scaffolding<br />

tailored to assist students engaged in design of software or instruction. In DSE’s <strong>the</strong> environment is simplified<br />

by providing a large number of cases, coaching students in <strong>the</strong> design process and fading <strong>the</strong> scaffolding<br />

(Gudzial, 1998). Instead of providing students with problems, <strong>the</strong>y simply scaffold <strong>the</strong> design process. A<br />

fur<strong>the</strong>r feature of some DSE’s is that <strong>the</strong>y provide adaptive scaffolds, where students can choose or turn off<br />

various scaffolds that are not required, <strong>the</strong>reby fading support.<br />

Conclusion


Examples of each of <strong>the</strong>se <strong>for</strong>ms of technology based scaffolding can be found in <strong>the</strong> literature cited and each<br />

offers a unique perspective on apprenticeship <strong>for</strong>ms of learning, and with <strong>the</strong> original conception of learning in<br />

<strong>the</strong> zone of proximal development (Collins , Brown & Newman, 1989). While each <strong>for</strong>m of scaffolding<br />

provides support, each differs in <strong>the</strong> level of social support, collaboration with peers and type of feedback<br />

offered. Few provide <strong>the</strong> au<strong>the</strong>nticity that a real apprenticeship offers. Never<strong>the</strong>less, by creating and<br />

evaluating scaffolding with technology, researchers are now developing more principled <strong>for</strong>ms of instructional<br />

design to guide <strong>the</strong> process.<br />

References<br />

Anderson, J. R., Boyle, C. F., Corbett, A. T., & Lewis, M. W. (1990). Cognitive modelling intelligent tutoring<br />

systems. Artificial Intelligence, 42, 7-49.<br />

Anderson, J. R., Boyle, C. F., & Reiser, B. J. (1985). Intelligent tutoring systems. Science, 228, 465-462.<br />

Brown, A. L., & Campione, J. C. (1994). Guided discovery in a community of learners. In K. McGilly (Eds.),<br />

Classroom lessons: Integrating cognitive <strong>the</strong>ory Cambridge, Mass.: MIT Press.<br />

Collins, A., Brown, J. S., & Newman, S. E. (1989). Cognitive apprenticeship: Teaching <strong>the</strong> crafts of reading,<br />

writing and ma<strong>the</strong>matics. In L. B. Resnick (Eds.), Knowing, Learning and Instruction: Essays in Honour of<br />

Robert Glaser (pp. 453-494). Hillsdale, New Jersey: Lawrence Erlbaum.<br />

Collis, B. (1997). Supporting project-based collaborative learning via World Wide Web environment. In B.<br />

Khan (Eds.), Web-based instruction (pp. 213-221). Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Educational Technology<br />

Publications.<br />

Collis, B. (1998). New didactics <strong>for</strong> university instruction: Why and how. Computers and eduction, 31(4), 373-<br />

395.<br />

(CTGV) Cognition and Technology Group at Vanderbilt (1996). Designing learning environments that support<br />

thinking: The Jasper series as a case study. In T. M. Duffy, J. Lowyck, & D. H. Jonassen (Eds.). Designing<br />

environments <strong>for</strong> constructive learning Berlin: Springer-Verlag.<br />

(CTGV) Cognition and Technology Group at Vanderbilt(1993). Anchored instruction and situated cognition<br />

revisited. Educational Technology, 33(3), 52-70.<br />

Edwards, A. D., & Westgate, D. (1994). Investigating classroom talk (Revised and extended second edition<br />

ed.). London: The Falmer Press.<br />

Guizal, M., & Kehoe, C. (1998). Apprenticeship-based learning environments: A principled approach to<br />

providing software-realised scaffolding through hypermedia. Journal of Interactive Learning Research, 9(4),<br />

289-336.<br />

Hmelo, C. E., Guizal, M., & Turns, J. (1998). Computer-support <strong>for</strong> collaborative learning: Learning to support<br />

collaborative engagement. Journal of Interactive Learning Research, 9(2), 107-129.<br />

Lave, J. (1991). Situating learning in communities of practice. In L. B. Resnick, J. Levine, & S. Teasley (Eds.),<br />

Perspectives on socially shared cognition (pp. 63-82). Washington, D.C.: American Psychological <strong>Association</strong>.<br />

Newman, D., Griffin, P., & Cole, M. (1989). The construction zone: Working <strong>for</strong> cognitive change in school.<br />

Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.<br />

Palincsar, A. S. (1986). The role of dialogue in scaffolded instruction. Educational Psychologist, 21(1,2), 71-<br />

98.<br />

Rogoff, B. (1990). Apprenticeship in thinking: Cognitive development in social context. New York: Ox<strong>for</strong>d<br />

University Press.


Rogoff, B., & Lave, J. (Ed.). (1984). Everyday cognition: its development in a social context. Cambridge,<br />

Mass, & London: Harvard University Press.<br />

Roschelle, J., & Teasley, S. D. (1995). The construction of shared knowledge in collaborative problem solving.<br />

In C. O'Malley (Eds.), Computer Supported Collaborative Learning (pp. 69-100). Berlin: Springer Verlag.<br />

Scardamalia, M., & Bereiter, C. (1992). An architecture <strong>for</strong> collaborative knowledge building. In E. D. Corte,<br />

M. C. LInn,H. Mandl, & L. Verschaffel (Eds.), Computer-based learning environments and problem solving<br />

(pp. 41-66). Berlin: Springer-Verlag.<br />

Scardamalia, M., & Bereiter, C. (1994). Computer support <strong>for</strong> knowledge-building communities. Journal of <strong>the</strong><br />

Learning Sciences, 3(3), 265-283.<br />

Scardamalia, M., Bereiter, C., R.McLean, & Woodruff, J. (1989). Computer-supported intentional learning<br />

environments. Journal of Educational Computing Research, 5(1), 51-68.<br />

Schank, R. C., Fano, A., Bell, B., & Jona, M. (1994). The design of goal-based scenarios. Journal of <strong>the</strong><br />

Learning Sciences, 3(4), 305-346.<br />

Tharp, R. G., & Gallimore, R. (1988). Rousing minds to life. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.<br />

Tiessen, E., & Ward, D. R. (1997). Collaboration by design: Context, structure and medium. Journal of<br />

Interactive Learning Research, 8(2), 175-197.<br />

Vygotsky, L. (1978). Mind in society: <strong>the</strong> development of higher psychological processes. Cambridge MA:<br />

Harvard University Press. (Original material published in 1930, 1933 and 1935).<br />

Wood, D. (1991). Aspects of teaching and learning. In M. Richards & P. Light (Eds.), Children of Social<br />

Worlds (pp. 191-212). Cambridge: Polity Press.<br />

Wood, D., Bruner, J. S., & Ross, G. (1976). The role of tutoring in problem solving. Journal of child<br />

psychology and psychiatry, 17(2), 89-100.<br />

Wood, D., & Wood, H. (1996). Vygotsky, tutoring and learning. Ox<strong>for</strong>d Review of Education, 22(1), 5-10.


High-tech Learning Environments <strong>for</strong> Low-tech Classrooms<br />

Jeff Morrow<br />

Lead Designer, Web-based Integrated Science Environment Project<br />

Graduate School of Education, University of Cali<strong>for</strong>nia at Berkeley, USA<br />

jmorrow@alum.mit.edu<br />

James D. Slotta<br />

Director, Web-based Integrated Science Environment Project<br />

Graduate School of Education, University of Cali<strong>for</strong>nia at Berkeley, USA<br />

slotta@socrates.berkeley.edu<br />

As increasing numbers of classrooms throughout <strong>the</strong> United States and <strong>the</strong> world become Internet-ready,<br />

educational content providers must be aware of <strong>the</strong> particular technological issues faced in <strong>the</strong>se classrooms.<br />

In many cases, <strong>the</strong> result of recent upgrades is a well-connected classroom full of low- to mid-range<br />

computers. However, many content providers appear to be proceeding under <strong>the</strong> assumption that with good<br />

connectivity comes good client-side technology. In our own work developing Internet-based learning<br />

environments, we have come face to face with this conundrum. For example, one urban middle school<br />

excitedly approached our project, not long after <strong>the</strong>ir Net Day celebration, to announce that <strong>the</strong>y were fully<br />

wired, connected, and ready to use our curriculum. Un<strong>for</strong>tunately, when we arrived to consult <strong>the</strong>m on<br />

implementing our approaches, we were greeted by a roomful of computers with insufficient memory to run<br />

<strong>the</strong> latest Internet browsers! In addition, increases in classroom Internet capacity have often been outstripped<br />

by even greater increases in Internet demands resulting from modern Web site design. Heavy use of graphics<br />

and Java within Web pages can render <strong>the</strong> Internet capacity of some classrooms obsolete be<strong>for</strong>e students even<br />

have a chance to go online. This presentation will address five important problems with <strong>the</strong> assumptions made<br />

by educational content providers: <strong>the</strong> problems of graphics, Java, data processing, bandwidth, and scalability.<br />

It will <strong>the</strong>n review our own case history in <strong>the</strong> Web-based Integrated Science Environment (WISE) Project,<br />

reviewing our adopted solutions to <strong>the</strong>se real problems. The presentation will evaluate <strong>the</strong> effectiveness of our<br />

solutions and how we revised <strong>the</strong>m over <strong>the</strong> course of our first year of development.<br />

What is WISE<br />

The Web-based Integrated Science Environment, or WISE, is an NSF-funded research project whose goal is<br />

to harness <strong>the</strong> wealth of existing Internet resources, <strong>the</strong> power of Internet technology, and <strong>the</strong> insight of prior<br />

educational research in designing new technology and curriculum <strong>for</strong> integrated science. Based on prior<br />

research in <strong>the</strong> Knowledge Integration Environment (Bell, Davis and Linn, 1995; Slotta and Linn, in press),<br />

WISE curriculum provides students with knowledge integration activities where <strong>the</strong>y critique existing<br />

materials drawn from <strong>the</strong> Web, create designs, and compare <strong>the</strong>ories of controversial science topics. Our<br />

project incorporates existing Internet materials to bring exciting new science activities to middle and high<br />

school classrooms in accordance with an established pedagogical framework of Scaffolded Knowledge<br />

Integration (Linn, 1992). WISE technology is completely Web-based, meaning that its interface runs<br />

completely within <strong>the</strong> Web browser. The decision to serve all our functionality from a central server was<br />

made in response to <strong>the</strong> issues encountered in previous versions of our technology that included some clientside<br />

software, resulting in many unanticipated problems.<br />

The Problem of Graphics - The ability to transmit and display graphical content is one of <strong>the</strong> most<br />

fundamental strengths of <strong>the</strong> World Wide Web. However, as anyone with a 14.4 kilobits-per-second modem<br />

can tell you, overeager use of graphics can quickly frustrate even <strong>the</strong> most patient Web user. In an average<br />

Web page download, graphical content accounts <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> vast majority of total download time. Thus, content<br />

providers must deliberately plan graphical content in a way that provides <strong>the</strong> desired look and feel while<br />

minimizing data traffic.<br />

The Problem of Java - The Internet is replete with in<strong>for</strong>mation about Java ranging from serious<br />

technological discussion to pure marketing hype. Although Java's promises of easy development and crossplat<strong>for</strong>m<br />

support are becoming more realistic, educational content providers must be aware that <strong>the</strong> use of


Java can significantly increase <strong>the</strong> minimum system requirements <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong>ir sites. In most cases, <strong>the</strong> use of Java<br />

will increase <strong>the</strong> minimum system requirements <strong>for</strong> acceptable per<strong>for</strong>mance even if <strong>the</strong> <strong>the</strong>oretical minimum<br />

system requirements remain <strong>the</strong> same.<br />

The Problem of Data Processing - Internet content providers of all types are quickly realizing that a major<br />

hurdle to overcome is <strong>the</strong> selection of methods <strong>for</strong> organizing, storing and retrieving large amounts of data.<br />

Relational databases such as Oracle, Sybase, MySQL, and Microsoft SQL have become <strong>the</strong> rage among<br />

content providers due to <strong>the</strong>ir flexibility and speed in dealing with arbitrarily large and diversely organized<br />

data sets. The choice of a database engine, however, results in additional constraints and choices to be made.<br />

Specifically, content providers must create mechanisms <strong>for</strong> client communication with <strong>the</strong> database. Many<br />

sites choose a CGI-based approach, but this is often insufficient. The major drawback of CGI programs is that<br />

each client request involving a CGI causes a new program to be launched and run on <strong>the</strong> server. Even if <strong>the</strong><br />

CGI programs <strong>the</strong>mselves are small and fast, <strong>the</strong> overhead involved in launching <strong>the</strong>m is quite high.<br />

The Problem of Bandwidth - Bandwidth is a measure of how much data can be transferred over <strong>the</strong> path that<br />

exists between a server and a client. The problem of bandwidth is related to both data processing and<br />

graphical content. However, whereas control of data and graphics resides primarily with <strong>the</strong> content provider,<br />

control of bandwidth does not. Un<strong>for</strong>tunately, <strong>the</strong> nature of <strong>the</strong> Web is such that insufficient client-side<br />

connectivity can reflect poorly on <strong>the</strong> content provider, even if no server-side bottlenecks exist.<br />

The Problem of Scalability - A scalable system is one that can handle higher traffic by straight<strong>for</strong>ward<br />

means such as purchasing new or additional hardware ra<strong>the</strong>r than more complicated means such as major<br />

software redesign. This is one of <strong>the</strong> <strong>for</strong>emost concerns of all Internet content providers, especially since <strong>the</strong><br />

number of users approaching <strong>the</strong> Internet is increasing at a phenomenal rate.<br />

These issues have been at <strong>the</strong> <strong>for</strong>efront of many technological decisions we have made in <strong>the</strong> design of our<br />

Web-based Integrated Science Environment. Our experiences have shown that if classroom bandwidth is<br />

sufficient, <strong>the</strong> end users' experiences can be positive even on classroom machines that are five years old or<br />

older. Our presentation will discuss how this has been achieved in <strong>the</strong> WISE Project, focusing on <strong>the</strong> five<br />

problem areas mentioned above. The presentation will also show that with proper server-side preparation, it is<br />

possible to balance desired functionality against technological limitations <strong>for</strong> a very wide range of client<br />

machines. Finally, it will touch upon <strong>the</strong> necessary trade-offs between server-side per<strong>for</strong>mance and cost. The<br />

purpose of this presentation is not only to share our experiences in implementing a high-tech learning<br />

environment, but also to invite discourse among o<strong>the</strong>rs who have had similar experiences.<br />

References<br />

Bell, P., Davis, E. A., & Linn, M. C. (1995). The knowledge integration environment: Theory and design.<br />

<strong>Proceedings</strong> of <strong>the</strong> Computer Supported Collaborative Learning Conference (CSCL '95: Bloomington, IN),<br />

(pp. 14-21). Hillsdale, NJ: Lawrence Erlbaum Associates.<br />

Linn, M. C. (1992). The Computer as Learning Partner: Can Computer Tools Teach Science In K.<br />

Sheingold, L. G. Roberts, and S. M. Malcolm (Eds.),Technology <strong>for</strong> and Learning. Washington, DC:<br />

American <strong>Association</strong> <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> Advancement of Science.<br />

Slotta, J. D. & Linn, M. C. (in press). How do students make sense of Internet resources in <strong>the</strong> science<br />

classroom In Jacobson, M. J. & Kozma, R. (Ed.), Learning <strong>the</strong> Sciences of <strong>the</strong> 21st Century. Hilldale, NJ:<br />

Lawrence Erlbaum & Associates.<br />

Acknowledgements<br />

The WISE Project is funded through NSF Grant #REC 98-05420.


Re-engineering <strong>the</strong> MBA<br />

Using Virtual Seminars<br />

Drew Parker Vivian Rossner-Merrill Rob McTavish<br />

Faculty of Business Administration LohnLab <strong>for</strong> Teaching Technologies LohnLab <strong>for</strong> Teaching Technologies<br />

parker@sfu.ca rossner@sfu.ca mctavis@sfu.ca<br />

Simon Fraser University<br />

Burnaby, British Columbia, Canada<br />

Introduction and Overview:<br />

Universities are increasingly subscribing to <strong>the</strong> notion of executive education, lifelong learning, and program profitability<br />

largely as a result of decreased public funding and greater public demands <strong>for</strong> accountability. At <strong>the</strong> same time, novel<br />

technologies are starting to prove effective <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> delivery of remote full or part-time programs. Schools are now starting to<br />

offer unique programs that are quickly becoming global through novel delivery methods. Strategic alliances have been<br />

<strong>for</strong>med and new technologies employed and <strong>the</strong> resulting increased competition between educational institutions underscores<br />

<strong>the</strong> necessity to re-engineer existing programs to meet learning needs that may span a lifetime. The purpose of this paper is to<br />

present a case exemplar describing how one university re-engineered its MBA program. Our challenge was to design a single<br />

set of courses that would serve <strong>the</strong> different needs of both students and working professionals. The goal was to develop high<br />

quality and sustainable courses and program options to be offered in a highly competitive educational market place that<br />

reflects <strong>the</strong> criteria of excellence required by <strong>the</strong> University.<br />

Why Re-engineer <strong>the</strong> MBA<br />

The North American MBA market has changed dramatically in <strong>the</strong> past several years. Overall enrollments are dropping<br />

(Canadian Business), while product offerings continue to expand. Student educational demands are also expanding<br />

concomitant with new developments in educational uses of technology. Thus needs <strong>for</strong> enhanced communication among<br />

dispersed individuals and novel applications of technology led us to explore uses of computer mediated telecommunications<br />

in ways to ensure that our Business programs remain competitive with established programs available in Canada. (See, <strong>for</strong><br />

example, http://www.athabascau.ca or http://info.queensu.ca/index.html.) Thus a necessary part of re-engineering <strong>the</strong> MBA<br />

discussed here included developing high quality, sustainable courses that incorporate a range of flexible study options suited<br />

to <strong>the</strong> virtual learning environment.<br />

The concept of re-engineering has a simple premise: to look at underlying processes and consider how In<strong>for</strong>mation<br />

Technology can support a redesigned methodology. It has come to mean change in almost any <strong>for</strong>m, but continues to reflect<br />

changed business processes. The MBA degree is a suitable candidate <strong>for</strong> re-engineering today due to increased pressure <strong>for</strong><br />

shortened delivery times, remote locations access, and <strong>the</strong> need to remain competitive by meeting <strong>the</strong> variable knowledge<br />

needs of students in different workplace situations. These include management development seminars, executive diploma<br />

programs, focussed Masters programs, like a Master of Technology, and specialized Master's programs designed <strong>for</strong> target<br />

client groups like nurses, physicians, dentists, agriculturists, financiers, or entrepreneurs. To design programs that allow <strong>for</strong><br />

incorporation of <strong>the</strong> range of desirable options, one must study a particular program's underlying processes, including target<br />

clientele, timing, method of delivery, and desirability of change. Making programs available while students remain in <strong>the</strong><br />

workplace precludes disruption of workflow, salary and benefits, and reduction in required residence time <strong>for</strong> students. O<strong>the</strong>r<br />

advantages include considerable cost reduction <strong>for</strong> corporate sponsored study, allowances <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> reusability of course<br />

materials <strong>for</strong> in-house professional training and upgrading of personnel.<br />

Modularizing <strong>the</strong> Business Program:<br />

University graduates who move into a management role often look to executive programs to upgrade <strong>the</strong>ir management<br />

acumen. Our starting point, <strong>the</strong>re<strong>for</strong>e, was to target working professionals who ei<strong>the</strong>r do not have business backgrounds, or if<br />

<strong>the</strong>y do <strong>the</strong>ir knowledge is outdated, who are in situations where <strong>the</strong> need <strong>for</strong> education or training in one or more business<br />

areas is highly desirable. A second targeted group comprised students who typically have recently graduated from an<br />

undergraduate program and are looking to ei<strong>the</strong>r extend <strong>the</strong>ir business education to graduate school or to acquire business<br />

education in addition to ano<strong>the</strong>r discipline, such as computing science or engineering science. To better accommodate <strong>the</strong><br />

range of prospective students’ needs, we developed a series of integrated modules that toge<strong>the</strong>r make up a Graduate Diploma<br />

Program in Business Administration (GDBA).


The modules are designed <strong>for</strong> a variety of applications:<br />

• in whole, <strong>the</strong>y offer a specialized graduate diploma,<br />

• in whole, <strong>the</strong>y provide a “pre-MBA” qualifying program <strong>for</strong> students wishing to prepare <strong>for</strong> advanced studies in an MBA or Executive<br />

MBA program,<br />

• in standalone <strong>for</strong>mats, <strong>the</strong>y may be used singly or <strong>for</strong> cross-disciplinary incorporation into o<strong>the</strong>r related or complementary courses or<br />

programs,<br />

• as a packaged grouping, <strong>the</strong>y may be selected <strong>for</strong> professional development or specific training or upgrading needs,<br />

• in packaged or standalone <strong>for</strong>mats, <strong>the</strong>y can be reassembled <strong>for</strong> overseas or national delivery.<br />

Program Description and Design:<br />

Graduates of this program are expected to have acquired a fundamental mastery of core topics in Business Administration,<br />

and have proven ability to work strategically in teams, and to present and defend complex material. Professional development<br />

courses, on <strong>the</strong> o<strong>the</strong>r hand, are available on a fee <strong>for</strong> purchase basis and may or may not include on-line or in-person<br />

instruction. Modules to be used <strong>for</strong> adaptation to cross-disciplinary areas are available on request. The modules, singly or<br />

combined in a program, are suitable <strong>for</strong> students studying in cohorts or on <strong>the</strong>ir own. Students complete a total of eight half<br />

courses plus a project at a minimum, and must make up a series of qualifying courses if <strong>the</strong>ir background doesn't include<br />

coursework in a particular area, namely Management Science and In<strong>for</strong>mation Systems, Accounting, Finance, Marketing or<br />

Human Resource Management.<br />

The overall program goal was to design courses that would be offered entirely over <strong>the</strong> Internet. In most cases, students are<br />

expected to meet only in <strong>the</strong>ir respective virtual seminars. All students are required to participate in on-line group<br />

conferencing and to have, or have access to, <strong>the</strong> necessary computing equipment. Because students meet instructors and study<br />

in asynchronous and synchronous learning environments, <strong>the</strong>y will be able to work independently of time and place-based<br />

constraints. The LohnLab <strong>for</strong> Teaching Technologies group assisted with all phases of <strong>the</strong> planning including selection of<br />

technologies appropriate <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> program and <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> design and delivery of courses. Their instructional design expertise<br />

provided guidance in using principles of instruction drawn from empirically viable models of instruction and learning that<br />

were used to organize <strong>the</strong> desktop interface and in<strong>for</strong>m <strong>the</strong> processes of teaching and learning.<br />

Instructional design features focused on optimizing teaching and learning practices that pertain to <strong>the</strong> virtual seminar setting<br />

but are flexible enough to vary with <strong>the</strong> goals and objectives of <strong>the</strong> different course modules in <strong>the</strong> program. Design features<br />

focus on providing a tightly structured course architecture and carefully laid out processes and procedures <strong>for</strong> students to<br />

follow. Once <strong>the</strong>se parameters were designed we <strong>the</strong>n concentrated on implementing teaching and learning methods that<br />

maximize opportunities <strong>for</strong> collaborative online group activities, tasks, and assignments and foster lively discussion and<br />

debate of pertinent issues. Optional strategic learning practices were also embedded in course design. These were specifically<br />

intended to provide mature, returning students with study tips and aids <strong>the</strong>y may find helpful after prolonged absence from<br />

study. For most courses <strong>the</strong> instructors presence was initially quite directive but moved into more of a facilitative role once<br />

students were active in <strong>the</strong> learning process, both singly and in groups, and seen to be taking a good deal of responsibility <strong>for</strong><br />

<strong>the</strong>ir own learning. Examples of course design features will be presented and discussed in terms of <strong>the</strong>ir suitability <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong><br />

content concerned and contribution toward enhancement of instruction and learning processes and outcomes.<br />

Benchmarks <strong>for</strong> Early Success:<br />

Although <strong>the</strong> material to be covered is established curriculum, <strong>the</strong> <strong>for</strong>m of delivery is radically different from <strong>the</strong> status quo.<br />

In this case, we designed a program specifically <strong>for</strong> non-resident students designed to be offered through <strong>the</strong> computer<br />

mediated medium of instruction using tools provided through <strong>the</strong> Internet. Because of <strong>the</strong> experimental nature of <strong>the</strong> program<br />

<strong>the</strong>re are a number of key risk areas where we needed to have demonstrated successes:<br />

• student acceptance as indicated by enrolment figures, establishing wait lists and course and program completion rates<br />

• faculty buy-in. In order <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> program to succeed, good faculty must be convinced of <strong>the</strong> value of experimenting with new mediums of<br />

instruction and course delivery<br />

• institutional commitment to completion of <strong>the</strong> course cycle<br />

• The success of courses and of <strong>the</strong> program must be demonstrable. This includes metrics of student per<strong>for</strong>mance, evaluation of <strong>the</strong><br />

program, acceptance of incoming students and acceptance by employers wanting training and upgrading opportunities <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong>ir employees.<br />

The program is currently in process and students have completed <strong>the</strong> first half of <strong>the</strong>ir coursework. Benchmark outcomes to<br />

date are available and will be discussed in our session. In<strong>for</strong>mation on <strong>the</strong> success of course design features and strategic<br />

learning practices, however, will not be available until <strong>the</strong> completion of <strong>the</strong> first cycle.


Hezinet: Interactive (Adaptive) Education Through Activities<br />

Tomás A. Pérez, Koro Gabiola, Julián Gutiérrez, Ricardo López, Amaia González, Jose Ángel Carro<br />

Dept. of Computer Languages and Systems<br />

University of <strong>the</strong> Basque Country UPV-EHU<br />

Spain<br />

{tomas, jibgacok, gutierrez, jibloprr, jibgogoa, jibcamej}@si.ehu.es<br />

Abstract: Most language learning systems and in general all educational systems accessible<br />

via WWW, lack in individualizing <strong>the</strong> course <strong>for</strong> each student. Adaptive Hypermedia<br />

Systems can offer solutions by controlling <strong>the</strong> student progress throughout <strong>the</strong> course.<br />

Besides, <strong>the</strong>y can provide multimedia interface to students. This paper introduces HE-<br />

ZINET, a project whose goal has been to develop by <strong>the</strong> end of 1998 a commercial product<br />

based on <strong>the</strong> AHS approach <strong>for</strong> learning Basque language. As far as we know, this<br />

product will be <strong>the</strong> first with <strong>the</strong>se characteristics in <strong>the</strong> market.<br />

Introduction and Context: Adaptive Hypermedia Systems <strong>for</strong> Language Teaching<br />

The World Wide Web (WWW) began in 1989 as a mean of transporting research and ideas effectively<br />

(Berners & Cailliau, 1989). In few years, <strong>the</strong> widespread use of <strong>the</strong> WWW has converted it in a very<br />

appropriate medium <strong>for</strong> sharing all kind of in<strong>for</strong>mation. One of <strong>the</strong> uses of <strong>the</strong> WWW is distance learning.<br />

The ideal course would be intelligent and adaptive to <strong>the</strong> user.<br />

Based our experience, currently computer systems <strong>for</strong> language-learning do not adapt to <strong>the</strong>ir students.<br />

The systems we have evaluated do not take into account which concepts <strong>the</strong> student has not been<br />

able to acquire. As Professor Alfred Bork said, "<strong>the</strong>y are alike traditional books badly designed, adorned<br />

with hypertext functionality" (Sáez-Vacas, 1998). For instance, (Kargu-Heldring, 1996) describes an Adaptive<br />

Hypermedia System (AHS) <strong>for</strong> learning Estonian by means of an interactive hypermedia environment.<br />

However, this system does not take into account <strong>the</strong> student model to help understand <strong>the</strong> in<strong>for</strong>mation it<br />

provides. (Johansson, 1998) introduces IKITS, an Intelligent Tutoring System (ITS) that teaches Chinese<br />

individually. System developers say that individuality can be seen when <strong>the</strong> students get tips from <strong>the</strong> system<br />

depending on <strong>the</strong> results of <strong>the</strong>ir interactions. These tips are independent of <strong>the</strong> concepts he has understood<br />

or not. AHSs constitute a new approach <strong>for</strong> educational systems (Urban-Lurain, 1997). Usually,<br />

AHSs combine ITS and Educational Hypermedia Systems (Pérez, Gutiérrez & Lopistéguy, 1995). Because<br />

of this, <strong>the</strong>y get <strong>the</strong> advantages of both to achieve <strong>the</strong> adaptation to <strong>the</strong> student.<br />

The Basque language is spoken in <strong>the</strong> Basque Country, which is situated on <strong>the</strong> North of Spain<br />

and on <strong>the</strong> SouthWest of France. It is not a curiosity of <strong>the</strong> past, but a living language, and <strong>the</strong>re<strong>for</strong>e, plenty<br />

of future. The majority of grown-up population is not Basque-literate, that is why exist centers <strong>for</strong> Basque<br />

learning: <strong>the</strong> so-called "Euskaltegiak". The learning of this language is divided into several levels being <strong>the</strong><br />

last <strong>the</strong> one called EGA ("Euskarako Gaitasun Agiria" or "Basque language Certificate"), which assess a<br />

level of proficiency in written and spoken Basque.<br />

We have built Hezinet-EGA, a language-learning system on <strong>the</strong> web, as a solution <strong>for</strong> people<br />

willing to learn Basque that are not able to assist to <strong>the</strong> Euskaltegiak. With <strong>the</strong> system, <strong>the</strong> students can<br />

learn via Internet at <strong>the</strong>ir own place and pace. A course lasts about 100 hours. The courses to learn Basque<br />

from scratch last 500 hours (10 terms, 50 hours each). EGA-Hezinet cover <strong>the</strong> last two terms. Later on <strong>the</strong><br />

system will be completed to cover <strong>the</strong> o<strong>the</strong>r four courses.<br />

Hezinet-EGA is user-adaptive. The adaptation can be seen in several ways. First of all, since <strong>the</strong><br />

system uses WWW <strong>the</strong> system can be used with any web browser available. Second, <strong>the</strong> system stores in<strong>for</strong>mation<br />

about <strong>the</strong> different students and presents diverse course material according to it. For example, <strong>the</strong><br />

students are categorized into two stereotypes: analytic and Multimedia. Depending on <strong>the</strong>se categories <strong>the</strong><br />

system will present activities ei<strong>the</strong>r full of attractiveness and needing more interaction (multimedia) or<br />

simpler activities visually less attractive using basically text (analytic). Third, <strong>the</strong> system also prepares


adapted tests to assess <strong>the</strong> student acquisition of knowledge. The test, usually does not contain items used<br />

be<strong>for</strong>e and <strong>the</strong> items are about content that <strong>the</strong> student has already seen. Of course, <strong>the</strong> items can also include<br />

<strong>the</strong> characteristic of multimedia and analytic previously commented. Fourth, It creates new activities<br />

to make <strong>the</strong> students keep working on those concepts that <strong>the</strong>y have not acquired (looking at <strong>the</strong> results of a<br />

test). Fifth, <strong>the</strong> system provides a book of Basque grammar (hyperized) whose presentation adapts to <strong>the</strong><br />

student travel throughout <strong>the</strong> knowledge.<br />

The system is not totally valid without <strong>the</strong> help of a human teacher. The teacher can complement<br />

and assure <strong>the</strong> correct per<strong>for</strong>mance of <strong>the</strong> system. He or she can supervise <strong>the</strong> activities <strong>the</strong> student is<br />

working on and add (in most cases) or delete (rarely) activities to make <strong>the</strong> system adapt better to <strong>the</strong> student.<br />

It is supposed that <strong>the</strong>se decisions are taken after some contact with <strong>the</strong> students or any o<strong>the</strong>r interaction<br />

apart from <strong>the</strong> system. Besides, in language-learning <strong>the</strong>re is a lack in working or assessing essays.<br />

There are some aspects, such as <strong>the</strong> writing style, that have not been solved yet and where <strong>the</strong> help of a<br />

human teacher can be very helpful.<br />

Of course, <strong>the</strong> users may adapt <strong>the</strong>ir interaction with <strong>the</strong> system asking <strong>for</strong> optional activities<br />

stressing on ei<strong>the</strong>r <strong>the</strong> same concepts or concepts related to <strong>the</strong> concepts that an activity covers. Once <strong>the</strong><br />

students have completed an activity, <strong>the</strong>y may notice that <strong>the</strong>y need fur<strong>the</strong>r work on <strong>the</strong> contents it is<br />

stressing.<br />

This paper describes EGA-Hezinet, an AHS <strong>for</strong> education. Next section will describe <strong>the</strong> structure<br />

of <strong>the</strong> pedagogical domain as pedagogues organized it. Then, a brief guide of <strong>the</strong> activities is given. Activities<br />

are <strong>the</strong> method that <strong>the</strong> system provides to let <strong>the</strong> student learn within a constructivist approach. After<br />

that, <strong>the</strong> architecture of <strong>the</strong> system is explained. Eventually, some conclusions are given.<br />

The Structure of <strong>the</strong> Pedagogical Domain<br />

The pedadogues in Basque language defined <strong>the</strong> structure of <strong>the</strong> pedagogical domain. They designated<br />

content (concept) as <strong>the</strong> basic unit (Fig. 1). Some of <strong>the</strong>m are key concepts. The pedagogues create<br />

activities according to <strong>the</strong>se units. Contents are grouped into work areas and families. So far, <strong>the</strong>re are 10<br />

working areas, namely: declination, verb, syntax, vocabulary, suffix, orthography, connectors, written expression,<br />

speech comprehension, and reading comprehension. These work areas and families give <strong>the</strong> system<br />

some knowledge to recommend <strong>the</strong> student to practice certain activities related in some way to one<br />

concrete activity. The system offers activities related to <strong>the</strong> family of <strong>the</strong> main content of an activity or to<br />

<strong>the</strong> group.<br />

Figure 1: A graphical representation of <strong>the</strong> structure of <strong>the</strong> Pedagogical Domain


The system manages basically courses. A course is structured in layers. A layer contains a group<br />

of concepts pedagogically structured by <strong>the</strong> experts that must be presented to <strong>the</strong> student and that must be<br />

evaluated after seen it. Layers in a course get progressively more complicated. Each layer contains several<br />

sessions. A session is equivalent to a class at <strong>the</strong> school (1-hour). The system stores <strong>the</strong> analytic and <strong>the</strong><br />

multimedia version of a session (Fig. 2). A session contains a series of activities that <strong>the</strong> student has to<br />

make. Each session contains three parts: a presentation, activities and an evaluation to test whe<strong>the</strong>r <strong>the</strong> student<br />

has understood <strong>the</strong> contents <strong>for</strong> what <strong>the</strong> session was designed.<br />

Figure 2: A session <strong>for</strong> analytic (left) and multimedia (right) students<br />

Teaching With Activities<br />

An activity is an interactive exercise to be done by a student. It is <strong>the</strong> smallest piece of work that<br />

<strong>the</strong> system manages. It usually involves some abilities to work on listening, reading, and writing…). We<br />

have defined 20 different types of activities, on which <strong>the</strong> user can work during a session. They include (1)<br />

Highlight mistakes in a text where <strong>the</strong> students read a text and have to highlight <strong>the</strong> words with mistakes<br />

such <strong>the</strong> one depicted in (Fig. 2). There is also a progress cue, which shows <strong>the</strong> percentage of <strong>the</strong> exercise<br />

already completed. (2) Multiple choice exercise that consists of several questions based on a multimedia<br />

document (just text, a video clip, sound…) <strong>the</strong> students have to look through previously. The student has to<br />

choose <strong>the</strong> correct response to a question from a group of selected answers previously given. (3) True-false<br />

exercise, which is a variant of <strong>the</strong> previous type of activity. In this case, <strong>the</strong> students have only two possible<br />

answers to choose: true and false. (4) Free answer exercise. In this case, <strong>the</strong> questions about <strong>the</strong> document<br />

have no predefined answers. The student has to write a complete answer. (5) Ordering exercise where <strong>the</strong><br />

student has to choose <strong>the</strong> right order of all of several elements offered in a random order to get a coherent<br />

result. Currently, <strong>the</strong> elements we work with are words, sentences, paragraphs and images, such as in (Fig.<br />

2) right. (6) Matching elements, where <strong>the</strong> student has to find <strong>for</strong> each element in a list a matching element<br />

in ano<strong>the</strong>r list. At <strong>the</strong> moment we working on object names and <strong>the</strong>ir pictures, words and <strong>the</strong>ir definitions,<br />

words and one of <strong>the</strong>ir synonyms, words and one of <strong>the</strong>ir antonyms. (7) Fill in blanks. The student receives<br />

a text with some blanks to be filled in. The exercise may optionally provide a cue with a list of words to be<br />

used. (8) Translation exercise where <strong>the</strong> student has to translate a column with short sentences or alternatively<br />

words. There is ano<strong>the</strong>r column to fill in with <strong>the</strong> corresponding translation of <strong>the</strong> element offered.<br />

(9) Translation of documents. This exercise presents a text ei<strong>the</strong>r in Spanish or Basque and <strong>the</strong> student has<br />

to translate it to <strong>the</strong> o<strong>the</strong>r language. (10) Fill in speech balloons of comic strips. The system shows a comic<br />

strip and <strong>the</strong> student has to fill in <strong>the</strong> balloons in <strong>the</strong> strip to build up a story. (11) Sum up exercises. Starting<br />

from a multimedia document, <strong>the</strong> student has to write an essay summarizing its ideas. (12) Compositions<br />

or essays. The student has to develop an essay about a briefly exposed subject (usually a sentence<br />

with four or five ideas to start organizing <strong>the</strong> result).


Architecture of HEZINET<br />

The system has six main modules, namely, <strong>the</strong> Interface, <strong>the</strong> Auditor, <strong>the</strong> Course, <strong>the</strong> Student<br />

Model, <strong>the</strong> Intelligent Module, <strong>the</strong> Human Teacher Module and <strong>the</strong> Communication Module. In (Fig. 3) a<br />

view of <strong>the</strong> interaction between <strong>the</strong>se modules is provided. There are two well-differentiated parts: <strong>the</strong> hypermedia<br />

and <strong>the</strong> adaptive part. The Interface module controls <strong>the</strong> hypermedia part. The o<strong>the</strong>r modules<br />

<strong>for</strong>m <strong>the</strong> adaptive part, which is <strong>the</strong> one that is in charge of decision making and storing <strong>the</strong> evolution of <strong>the</strong><br />

student evolution with <strong>the</strong> system. The modules have been implemented using Java, Orbixweb and SQL<br />

Server.<br />

Figure 3: General architecture of HEZINET<br />

The interface module consists of a series of screens developed specially <strong>for</strong> each part of <strong>the</strong> system.<br />

The screen design has been taken seriously so that <strong>the</strong> student motivation gets promoted and he does<br />

not get bored, as stated in (Landow, 1997) "if <strong>the</strong> user gets lost or bored, <strong>the</strong> system is bound to fail". The<br />

screens contain very intuitive buttons and are very easy to use (Baker, 1993): "<strong>the</strong> interface should be<br />

structured such that <strong>the</strong> student is learning <strong>the</strong> subject domain, not <strong>the</strong> program interface". The Interface<br />

interacts directly with <strong>the</strong> student. It obtains user reactions and sends relevant ones to <strong>the</strong> Auditor. The latter<br />

processes that in<strong>for</strong>mation and returns back to <strong>the</strong> <strong>for</strong>mer new data to be displayed. The interface has<br />

been divided into five functional spaces (Fig. 4). Area 1 contains buttons offering functionality always<br />

available during <strong>the</strong> student interaction with <strong>the</strong> system. It basically contains contextual help <strong>for</strong> new users;<br />

a grammar book; a dictionary; tools to contact a human teacher or to talk with o<strong>the</strong>r students working with<br />

<strong>the</strong> system at that moment; and a tool to review <strong>the</strong> steps followed previously. Area 2 contains buttons that<br />

will not always be active. Some of <strong>the</strong>m depend on <strong>the</strong> type of activity <strong>the</strong> student works on. Area 3 is a<br />

navigation area that offers <strong>the</strong> possibility to go back through previous steps of navigation. Area 4 is only<br />

in<strong>for</strong>mative and provides in<strong>for</strong>mation about <strong>the</strong> task being done by <strong>the</strong> student and <strong>the</strong> location in <strong>the</strong> hypermedia<br />

where is <strong>the</strong> user. Finally, area 5 is <strong>the</strong> workspace. It shows <strong>the</strong> activities and provides places to<br />

write or construct answers to questions.<br />

Figure 4: The interface is divided into five functional areas


The Course module manages all <strong>the</strong> didactic material provided by <strong>the</strong> pedagogue experts. It contains<br />

all in<strong>for</strong>mation about <strong>the</strong> pedagogical domains explained in <strong>the</strong> previous section. The Auditor module<br />

distributes <strong>the</strong> requests to <strong>the</strong> o<strong>the</strong>r modules. It has been designed using <strong>the</strong> pattern facade (Gamma, Helm,<br />

Johnson & Ulissides, 1995). It transmits <strong>the</strong> interactions considered relevant by <strong>the</strong> interface.<br />

The Student Model module stores general characteristics as <strong>the</strong> login, password…. It also records<br />

<strong>the</strong> student profile (multimedia, analytic) and <strong>the</strong> per<strong>for</strong>mance along <strong>the</strong> sessions with <strong>the</strong> system such as<br />

concepts acquired, failed, etc. Some of <strong>the</strong>se characteristics are ga<strong>the</strong>red at <strong>the</strong> beginning of <strong>the</strong> course in a<br />

general test carried out ei<strong>the</strong>r by <strong>the</strong> system or by a specific exam.<br />

The Intelligent module consults <strong>the</strong> Student model and makes intelligent decisions based on heuristically<br />

defined tasks taken from Artificial Intelligence. It also compiles tests to evaluate sessions using<br />

techniques borrowed from Item Response Theory (Weiss & Yoes, 1990) and Computer Adaptive Testing<br />

(Hambleton, Zaal & Pieters). Besides, it requests data update in <strong>the</strong> student model as a result of certain operations<br />

made by <strong>the</strong> student such as recording <strong>the</strong> results of a test, or navigation from a node to ano<strong>the</strong>r in<br />

<strong>the</strong> hypermedia.<br />

The Teacher module provides tools to manage <strong>the</strong> behavior of <strong>the</strong> system to adapt better to <strong>the</strong><br />

students. With it teachers can supervise <strong>the</strong> learning and behavior of <strong>the</strong>ir students. They are able to access<br />

<strong>the</strong> Student Model and examine its contents. Consult which activities, sessions, layers, courses have been<br />

seen and which concepts have been passed and failed. This module also provides tools to build teacherdefined<br />

sessions made up from activities existing in <strong>the</strong> system (by now). These sessions have <strong>the</strong> same<br />

characteristics and treatment as <strong>the</strong> sessions compiled by <strong>the</strong> system autonomously. This system also provides<br />

functionality to retrieve and assess those activities that <strong>the</strong> system is not able to evaluate autonomously.<br />

Finally, <strong>the</strong>re is a Communication Module that allows distribution among several machines of <strong>the</strong><br />

previously commented modules. It is implemented using CORBA (Urban-Lurain, 1997) programming environment.<br />

Conclusions<br />

EGA-Hezinet is <strong>the</strong> AHS built as a result of <strong>the</strong> project Hezinet. It demonstrates that AHS can be<br />

built on <strong>the</strong> web even when <strong>the</strong> domain is large and complicated such as in this case <strong>the</strong> learning of a language.<br />

The key techniques of this success relied on <strong>the</strong> experience of <strong>the</strong> project participants. Aurten Bai<br />

gave a coherent and usable structure to <strong>the</strong> domain. The group of Hypermedia and Multimedia (GHM) of<br />

<strong>the</strong> University of <strong>the</strong> Basque Country add to <strong>the</strong> system <strong>the</strong>ir background with some research prototypes of<br />

AHS, such as HyperTutor (Pérez, Lopistéguy, Gutiérrez & Usandizaga, 1995) or WebTutor (Pérez & Gutiérrez,<br />

1996).<br />

The interface of EGA-Hezinet is plenty of functionality and offers great variety of activities. This<br />

has been achieve thanks to <strong>the</strong> ef<strong>for</strong>t of Ibermática in <strong>the</strong> implementation and <strong>the</strong> design of up to 20 different<br />

types of activities made by pedagogues of Aurten Bai. Also <strong>the</strong> ef<strong>for</strong>ts of adaptation included in <strong>the</strong><br />

system added by <strong>the</strong> GHM. The system has included currently some activities specially created by wellknown<br />

Basque writers to encourage <strong>the</strong> students with some motivating narrations. And multimedia is<br />

achieved adding animations, presentations and virtual tours through <strong>the</strong> Basque country using Macromedia<br />

Director.<br />

EGA-Hezinet is not ano<strong>the</strong>r prototype. It is a commercial product obtained from research work<br />

developed by <strong>the</strong> GHM. The system is going to be published soon, after it passes its evaluation period with<br />

students of a high school. Our goal is to use this experience to develop o<strong>the</strong>r systems in o<strong>the</strong>r areas. The<br />

group has already contacted o<strong>the</strong>r possible partners interested in include <strong>the</strong>ir domain in such an interactive<br />

system.<br />

References<br />

Baker, N.C. (1993). Intelligent Tutoring Frameworks <strong>for</strong> Engineering. In In<strong>for</strong>mation Technology <strong>for</strong> Civil and Structural<br />

Engineers, <strong>Proceedings</strong> of The Third International Conference in <strong>the</strong> Appli-cation of Artifical Intelligence to Civil<br />

and Structural Engineering. B.H.V. Topping and A.I. Khan Editors, Civil-Comp Press. 295-300.


Berners-Lee, T. & R. Cailliau, (1989). Proposal <strong>for</strong> a hypertext project.<br />

http://www.w3.org/pub/WWW/Proposal.html<br />

Gamma, E., Helm, R., Johnson, R. & Ulissides, J. (1995). Design patterns. Addison Wesley Congman Inc. 185-193.<br />

Hambleton, R. K.; J. N. Zaal & J. P. M. Pieters (1990). Computerized Adaptive Testing: Theory, Applications & Standards.<br />

In Hambleton, R. K., J. N. Zaal (Eds). Advances in educational and psychological testing. Kluwer Academic<br />

Publishers: Norwell, Massachusetts (USA).<br />

Johansson Kokkinakis, S. (1998) An intelligent Tutor System <strong>for</strong> Chinese.<br />

http://svenska.gu.se/~svesj/IKITS/IKITSeng.html<br />

Kargu-Heldring, E. (1996). Estonian Language Learning in Interactive Hypermedia Environment. <strong>Proceedings</strong> of <strong>the</strong><br />

Conference Hypermedia in Tallinn, Tallinn.<br />

Landow, G.P. (1997). What can educational hypertext do What can you do with hypertext in education <br />

http://www.stg.brown.edu/projects/hypertext/landow/vp/educate.html<br />

Object Management Group. (1998). <strong>Book</strong>marks <strong>for</strong> CORBA.<br />

http://www.omg.org/news/corbkmk.htm<br />

Pérez, T. A. & Gutiérrez J. (1996). WebTutor. Un sistema Hipermedia Adaptativo para la educación en WWW. Actas<br />

del V Congreso Iberoamericano de Inteligencia Artificial, IBERAMIA'96. Cholula, Puebla, MÉXICO.<br />

Perez, T. A., Gutiérrez, J. & Lopistéguy, P.(1995). An Adaptive Hypermedia System. Artificial Intelligence in Education,<br />

AI<strong>ED</strong>'95. AACE: Charlottesville, EE.UU.<br />

Pérez, T. A., Lopistéguy P.,. Gutiérrez J. & Usandizaga I. (1995). HyperTutor: From Hypermedia to Intelligent Adaptive<br />

Hypermedia. Educational Multimedia and Hypermedia, <strong>ED</strong>-M<strong>ED</strong>IA'95. AACE: Charlottesville, EE.UU.<br />

Sáez-Vacas, F. (1998). La duración creadora. PC Week magazine. September.<br />

Urban-Lurain, M. (1997). Intelligent Tutoring Systems: A Historic Review in <strong>the</strong> Context of <strong>the</strong> Develop-ment of Artificial<br />

Intelligence and Educational Psychology.<br />

http://web.cps.msu.edu/~urban/ITS.htm<br />

Weiss, D. J. & M. E Yoes. (1990). Item Response Theory. In Hambleton, R. K., J. N. Zaal (Eds). Advances in educational<br />

and psychological testing. Kluwer Academic Publishers: Norwell, Massachusetts (USA).<br />

Acknowledgements<br />

HEZINET project has been carried out with <strong>the</strong> economic support of Gobierno Vasco-Eusko Jaularitza (Government<br />

of <strong>the</strong> Basque Country). It has been a joint project of a software company (Ibermática), a prestigious regional<br />

newspaper (El Diario Vasco), a cultural foundation whose aim is to spread Basque knowledge (Aurten Bai), a secondary<br />

school from <strong>the</strong> environment (Ekintza ikastola) and <strong>the</strong> Hypermedia and Multimedia research group of <strong>the</strong> University<br />

of <strong>the</strong> Basque Country.<br />

We would like to acknowledge Iñaki Mokoroa and Koldo Lopetegi (Ibermática), Andoni Unzalu (Aurten<br />

Bai), Santiago Ipiñazar (El Diario Vasco) and Koldo Pérez (Ekintza ikastola) to join <strong>the</strong>ir ef<strong>for</strong>t to build this product.


A telematics learning environment on <strong>the</strong> European Parliament:<br />

<strong>the</strong> ParlEuNet system<br />

Alberto Reggiori, Clive Best, Per Loekkemyhr, Dirk-Willem van Gulik<br />

alberto.reggiori@jrc.it, clive.best@jrc.it, per.loekkemyhr@jrc.it, dirk.vangulik@jrc.it<br />

JRC - Joint Research Centre of <strong>the</strong> European Communities<br />

ISIS - Institute <strong>for</strong> Systems, In<strong>for</strong>matics and Safety<br />

STA - Software Technologies and Automation Unit<br />

TP 270, 21020 - Ispra (VA), Italy<br />

Abstract - The ParlEuNet (European Parliament Network) under development at <strong>the</strong> JRC is a Web<br />

based in<strong>for</strong>mation system that will provide a multimedia educational plat<strong>for</strong>m <strong>for</strong> 10 secondary<br />

schools across Europe. Schools, teachers and pupils will use <strong>the</strong> system to teach to, learn about and<br />

prepare collaborative projects on <strong>the</strong> European Parliament. State of <strong>the</strong> art Internet technology<br />

toge<strong>the</strong>r with a set of pedagogical models will be employed to give live access to a highly dynamic<br />

multimedia database and promote a student-centred problem based learning. Web servers,<br />

browsers, digital certification, Java/JavaScript, URN and metadata technologies will allow an easy<br />

and transparent access to a set of resources. The pilot experiment under development will have to<br />

provide a validation plat<strong>for</strong>m to propose useful, transferable models on learning in a telematics<br />

environment <strong>for</strong> generalisation in a maximum number of European schools.<br />

1. Introduction<br />

The World Wide Web (WWW) has shown to be a really good means of distribution and communication of<br />

multimedia content worldwide. On-line databases, data catalogues, advertisement services, data dictionaries and<br />

searching tools are commonly used within in<strong>for</strong>mation communities today. Access to data and in<strong>for</strong>mation has been<br />

made easy and straight<strong>for</strong>ward. JRC ISIS has developed several dynamic Web based in<strong>for</strong>mation system. These<br />

systems allow users to register and to submit and update in<strong>for</strong>mation and data to a closely integrated database. The<br />

European Wide Services Exchange (http://ewse.ceo.org) developed <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> Centre <strong>for</strong> Earth Observation has been<br />

very successful and is now used regularly by Europe’s community of remote sensing specialits. O<strong>the</strong>r systems are<br />

<strong>the</strong> G7 Environment and Natural Resource Monitoring (http://ceo.gelos.org) and <strong>the</strong> CEOS In<strong>for</strong>mation Locator<br />

System (http://cils.ceo.org). This last system has servers worldwide and allows <strong>for</strong> metadata synchronisation<br />

between servers. A feature of <strong>the</strong> EWSE is that each user has personal Web space where <strong>the</strong>y can customise and<br />

update documents, images etc. This type of server is characterised by a "self populating database" whose content is<br />

defined by <strong>the</strong> users of <strong>the</strong> system.<br />

The ParlEuNet (European Parliament Network) is <strong>the</strong> first European initiative to permit secondary school students to<br />

use state of <strong>the</strong> art networks and multimedia resources to learn about and do collaborative projects on <strong>the</strong> European<br />

Parliament. Internet connections, videoconferencing and a website containing a well-structured dynamic multimedia<br />

database of educationally relevant materials will be used by students to access in<strong>for</strong>mation on <strong>the</strong> European<br />

Parliament, create <strong>the</strong>ir own projects, and exchange in<strong>for</strong>mation and views with members of Parliament and students<br />

in o<strong>the</strong>r countries. The students' work will gradually supplement <strong>the</strong> website with educational modules and resources<br />

which can be used by o<strong>the</strong>r students. The ParlEuNet system is under development at <strong>the</strong> JRC site and aims to<br />

provide a first prototype system by September 1998.<br />

The objective of this document is to give a general idea of <strong>the</strong> ParlEuNet system showing its component parts, its<br />

possible uses and describe <strong>the</strong> basic techniques that will be used to implement it.<br />

2. General description


The ParlEuNet system will provide a multimedia database on <strong>the</strong> Internert to be accessed by 10 schools across<br />

Europe. The <strong>the</strong>me of <strong>the</strong> database will be <strong>the</strong> history, institutions and functions of <strong>the</strong> European Parliament. The<br />

system will handle two types of in<strong>for</strong>mation : reference material and dynamic educational material. The <strong>for</strong>mer<br />

concerns in<strong>for</strong>mation and description of <strong>the</strong> European Parliament, <strong>the</strong> European Union and <strong>the</strong> Institutions of <strong>the</strong><br />

EU; this will provide <strong>the</strong> basic set of data chunks which students and teachers can access and derive in<strong>for</strong>mation.<br />

The dynamic education material contains <strong>the</strong> structured work defined by teachers (course work, assignments) and by<br />

pupils (projects, documents).<br />

Figure 1 - Overview of <strong>the</strong> ParlEuNet system<br />

The <strong>ED</strong>UCASE software under development by Arboth Learning Technologies NV will be used to store and<br />

retrieve all <strong>the</strong> reference material. Whereas <strong>the</strong> full dynamic educational content will be handled through a Web<br />

multimedia database. The <strong>ED</strong>UCASE software is currently a PC based system supporting teachers and learners. It<br />

consists of two tools. The first allows educators to enter course material into an MS-ACCESS database and to define<br />

structured course material using an editing tool. The second, Edubrowser allows learners to access <strong>the</strong> course<br />

material in an interactive fashion. The student can select different views of <strong>the</strong> material - through scenarios and<br />

through linked structures. The material is <strong>for</strong>matted in HTML and is supported by helpers such AVI video players.<br />

The system runs on a standalone PC and all <strong>the</strong> software tools are written in Visual Basic. <strong>ED</strong>UCASE was<br />

developed under a previous EU funded project and is now being applied <strong>for</strong> technical education and training by<br />

several industries and companies. The <strong>ED</strong>UCASE software will be interfaced to <strong>the</strong> ParlEuNet system ei<strong>the</strong>r using<br />

<strong>the</strong> ODBC protocol and/or a Web server accessable by users thorugh a Web browser.<br />

The ParlEuNet system software will be tailored <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> needs of students and teachers to exploit <strong>the</strong> new technology<br />

available to <strong>the</strong>m through <strong>the</strong> Internet. The system will allow individual students to prepare and submit material<br />

visible by <strong>the</strong> teacher and/or o<strong>the</strong>r students. Groups of students will be able to prepare joint project work.<br />

Communications between schools, between students and remote collaboration on project work <strong>for</strong> students from<br />

different schools will be possbile using <strong>the</strong> system. ParlEuNet aims to provide a transparent and integrated interface<br />

to <strong>the</strong> overall material. Students will be directed towards <strong>ED</strong>UCASE <strong>for</strong> reference material about <strong>the</strong> Parliament and<br />

to <strong>the</strong> dynamic system <strong>for</strong> authoring and structuring project material. At <strong>the</strong> same time, users can access <strong>the</strong> Internet<br />

at large <strong>for</strong> acquiring additional data and material and insert into <strong>the</strong>ir work.<br />

A tree view of available resources will be displayed into <strong>the</strong> entry page of each user, giving a easy to understand and<br />

straight<strong>for</strong>ward way to navigate through databases. Any object within <strong>the</strong> <strong>ED</strong>UCASE system can be incorporated<br />

into student created material held within <strong>the</strong> dynamic database.


There will be a unique identification system to retrieve resources stored within <strong>the</strong> system. Both systems must<br />

support three languages : English, French and German. Users will have <strong>the</strong> freedom to feed data and search<br />

keywords in different languages. Each user of <strong>the</strong> system will be identified uniquely, giving <strong>the</strong>m a persistent profile<br />

<strong>for</strong> long term and transient (session) in<strong>for</strong>mation. Each user will have <strong>the</strong>ir own private area where <strong>the</strong>y can upload<br />

and store data. Students and teachers will be able to interact with databases and construct and structure <strong>the</strong>ir work as<br />

HTML pages. A simple content editor will be developed to help users to fulfill this task. A hierachical structure of<br />

all data will be assured to give <strong>the</strong> possibility to school directors, teachers and <strong>the</strong> database manager to administer<br />

objects of a specific subpart of <strong>the</strong> system. Teachers will be able to delete or modify as well as insert resources into<br />

pupils private space. Each school and class will have <strong>the</strong>ir Web page where identity cards and in<strong>for</strong>mation of all<br />

members are collected toge<strong>the</strong>r automatically. The system will allow to build collaborative project pages between<br />

schools, between members of a particular school or pupils of a specific class. There will be a teacher or student that<br />

will own a project or assignment. An internal message system will be set up to allow student-to-student iteraction. It<br />

will be possible to set up a group work Web space to which a number of users can contribute. A bulletin board<br />

facility will be available to students to post a message or a question and get back an answer by somebody else. A<br />

logging system will be built into <strong>the</strong> server to allow educationalists to analyse <strong>the</strong> reaction of students to <strong>the</strong> system.<br />

The logging will register <strong>the</strong> accesses to items and <strong>the</strong> choices and constructs made by <strong>the</strong> students.<br />

Downloading of large multimedia files over <strong>the</strong> Internet can be a serious problem. There<strong>for</strong>e a caching system will<br />

be set up. There will be a CD-ROM issued regularly containg update from <strong>the</strong> database of video clips, sound files,<br />

VRML models etc. The system will automatically identify which data to load from <strong>the</strong> client CD-ROM and which<br />

o<strong>the</strong>r to load over <strong>the</strong> Internet. There must be an educationalist interface to allow researchers to analyse <strong>the</strong> activities<br />

of <strong>the</strong> students giving a full access to all parts of <strong>the</strong> database.<br />

Possible scenarios<br />

Based on <strong>the</strong> description given above a set of sample use cases of <strong>the</strong> system will be described here.<br />

Populating <strong>the</strong> reference database<br />

This scenario concerns <strong>the</strong> definition and insertion of <strong>the</strong> reference material of <strong>the</strong> European Parliament<br />

within <strong>the</strong> <strong>ED</strong>UCASE system.<br />

1. The reference database is populated using <strong>the</strong> existing editing and data entry tools provided with<br />

<strong>the</strong> software.<br />

2. A researcher identifies a number of documents, images, video clips and speeches, which cover <strong>the</strong><br />

historical development of <strong>the</strong> Parliament.<br />

3. All <strong>the</strong> inserted material is classified into course material, case studies and a set of learning<br />

goals/path is defined.<br />

4. All <strong>the</strong> documents are digitised and converted to HTML and <strong>the</strong> images are converted to JPEG.<br />

Populating <strong>the</strong> dynamic database<br />

This scenario describes how a user can register into <strong>the</strong> system, insert data, create projects and set<br />

assignments.<br />

1. The user accesses <strong>the</strong> Web server and get registered in. Each user receives a unique digital<br />

signature (like a credit CARD ID) that will be used to identify <strong>the</strong>m in future.<br />

2. Each registered user has a personal Web space and a personal profile where <strong>the</strong>y can submit<br />

reports, research and personal details.<br />

3. Students are grouped into classes. Classes are grouped into teacher groups. Teachers are grouped<br />

into schools. Schools are grouped into divisions etc. Each group of users has a Web page<br />

including all members’ ID cards.<br />

4. A teacher submits assignments <strong>for</strong> members of <strong>the</strong> class. Each pupil create a set of documents (or<br />

projects) <strong>for</strong> that assignment.<br />

Student assignment work<br />

This scenario describes a simple use of <strong>the</strong> system to define a collection of resources and publish it.<br />

1. A teacher or a user organise <strong>the</strong> assignment work and/or <strong>the</strong> project work.<br />

2. Students research <strong>for</strong> in<strong>for</strong>mation in <strong>the</strong> reference <strong>ED</strong>UCASE database or directly on <strong>the</strong> Internet.<br />

They include and collate <strong>the</strong>ir contribution (results) into a report document.


3. Students use a dedicated HTML content editor to structure, <strong>for</strong>mat and organize <strong>the</strong>ir resources.<br />

They publish <strong>the</strong> document to <strong>the</strong> dynamic database.<br />

4. Teachers receive a notification after each student contribution.<br />

5. All <strong>the</strong> project or assignment work is structured into a document collection.<br />

Inter School work<br />

This use case describes a path of interaction and collaboration between users.<br />

1. A head teacher or educationalist set up a user group composed by members of a different classes,<br />

different schools and perhaps different districts<br />

2. The head user set up <strong>the</strong> access rights to <strong>the</strong> group project page.<br />

3. Each member contributes to <strong>the</strong> project submitting <strong>the</strong>ir own contents.<br />

Educationalist research<br />

This scenarios outline how a researcher can analyse and monitor <strong>the</strong> progress and effectiveness of <strong>the</strong><br />

system.<br />

1. The logging system will contain in<strong>for</strong>mation about chioce material and decisions made by<br />

students.<br />

2. A educationalist has read access to all elements of <strong>the</strong> database and can view any assignment and<br />

report submitted across all users.<br />

3. The educationalist calls up an analysis tool to produce a report of activity within a certain project<br />

or <strong>for</strong> acertain student.<br />

Registering new schools<br />

The last use case describe a possible way to expand <strong>the</strong> ParlEuNet system to o<strong>the</strong>r schools.<br />

1. The ParlEuNet will be publicly visible, but no write or access will be possible to individual class<br />

work of students. Only school and class Web pages will be visible.<br />

2. A new school may apply to be registered on <strong>the</strong> system. When agreed by <strong>the</strong> administrators, <strong>the</strong>y<br />

can be included in <strong>the</strong> network.<br />

3. The new school Web space will be automatically created when <strong>the</strong>y register in <strong>the</strong> first time.<br />

3. Technical description<br />

The following section will depict <strong>the</strong> system architecture as is under development at <strong>the</strong> JRC.<br />

The ParlEuNet system will be built using a four tier layered architecture. A modern Web browser on <strong>the</strong> client side,<br />

a Web server on <strong>the</strong> server side backed by <strong>the</strong> applications/tools and <strong>the</strong> underlaying data holding. There will be a<br />

level of indirection into <strong>the</strong> data holding splitting up <strong>the</strong> database into two parts : <strong>the</strong> entity object model and <strong>the</strong> flat<br />

data storage (see Figure 2).<br />

The entity object model contains <strong>the</strong> links, references and metadata which constitute <strong>the</strong> virtual worlds which make<br />

up <strong>the</strong> users environments. Whereas <strong>the</strong> flat data storage contains <strong>the</strong> physical images, sound and video clips, <strong>the</strong><br />

reference material (<strong>ED</strong>UCASE) and text files. The neat separation between logical and physical resources will allow<br />

to mirror part of <strong>the</strong> system on CD-ROM or onto a Web site close to <strong>the</strong> target schools (Intranet).<br />

The actual model of <strong>the</strong> World Wide Web does not address issues like user identification, session management,<br />

persistence and data description. The ParlEuNet system will try to solve those problems using an enhanced Web<br />

server integrating modules to handle user identification, session tracking, user profile persistence and metadata<br />

handling. This implies that a complete personalized and persistent environment will be automatically available prior<br />

to invoking <strong>the</strong> ParlEuNet application components.<br />

To identify uniquely a user on <strong>the</strong> system a digital certificate and/or a basic au<strong>the</strong>ntication will be used. This<br />

solution will be almost invisible to <strong>the</strong> user. A separate session module, built into <strong>the</strong> Web server will manage and<br />

track individual user sessions (i.e. a user having multiple sessions opened, or logged in on more than one machine).<br />

Using <strong>the</strong> identity, <strong>the</strong> authorisation and session in<strong>for</strong>mation a private profile database, session database and Web<br />

accessible directory will be made available to <strong>the</strong> application being invoked.<br />

The general architecture shown in Figure 2 emphasizes how <strong>the</strong> system has been defined according to application<br />

specificity. A rigorous distinction between User Interface (UI) components and applications, entity object model and<br />

flat data storage has been made. The reason <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> first distinction is to make functional decomposition easier and


allow a fast prototyping of <strong>the</strong> user interaction. This functional separation will allow to deploy and store part of <strong>the</strong><br />

server applications near <strong>the</strong> user Web browser and tighten <strong>the</strong> bandwidth requirements.<br />

Figure 2 - The ParlEuNet system architecture<br />

The distinction between <strong>the</strong> entity object model and <strong>the</strong> flat data storage is twofold. First, it allows references to <strong>the</strong><br />

<strong>ED</strong>UCASE database directly from projects and assignments. Secondly, through a set of CD-ROM backups will be<br />

possible to move part of <strong>the</strong> physical entities on <strong>the</strong> client side (in particular those elements which are too<br />

cumbersome to transfer or which are often used). In this way, users will be still able to modify elements referred to<br />

on <strong>the</strong> CD-ROM, but such a modification would imply that <strong>the</strong> data will be loaded from <strong>the</strong> remote data storage<br />

again until <strong>the</strong> next backup is burned and dispatched. Using <strong>the</strong> Uni<strong>for</strong>m Resource Names (URN) technology will be<br />

possible to federate and independently manage <strong>the</strong>se entities. A URN consists of a persistent URL with an extra<br />

level of indirection behind it. Federated URNs will allow <strong>for</strong> an arbitrary number of depositories with little or no<br />

interconnections or shared management. The URN resolution to a URL will be done automatically when necessary.<br />

The entity object model contains effectively a object relation model of various resources owned by pupils, teachers<br />

and managers, such documents, projects and assignments. To communicate such in<strong>for</strong>mation structure between<br />

client and server applications a metadata strategy is needed. This should allow to serialize <strong>the</strong> data model and pass it<br />

<strong>for</strong>e and back between <strong>the</strong> Web server and <strong>the</strong> Web browser. At <strong>the</strong> JRC, it is under investigation <strong>the</strong> use of <strong>the</strong> new<br />

Web metadata technologies like <strong>the</strong> Extensible Markup Language (XML) and <strong>the</strong> Resource Description Framework<br />

(RDF) to fulfill this crucial task.<br />

4. System prototyping<br />

A series of prototypes of <strong>the</strong> ParlEuNet system are under development at <strong>the</strong> JRC. These aim to provide a basic<br />

framework on which <strong>the</strong> final system will be built.<br />

The actual prototypes are implemented using Apache (version 1.2 or higher) as Web server running on a FreeBSD<br />

UNIX machine, PERL5 as programming language on <strong>the</strong> server side and HTML/Java/Javascript to provide <strong>the</strong> UI<br />

on <strong>the</strong> client side. The system has been tested using Netscape 3.0 and/or Netscape Communicator 4.0 as well as MS-<br />

IE 3.0-4.0. The Apache software has been customized to include a session module, a digital certification module and<br />

many o<strong>the</strong>rs.


The prototype under development is available at <strong>the</strong> following address : https://pen.jrc.it<br />

5. What to espect from <strong>the</strong> ParlEuNet<br />

A first prototype version of <strong>the</strong> system must be ready by January <strong>1999</strong>. Based on <strong>the</strong> first prototype <strong>the</strong> final system<br />

will be defined and implemented.<br />

A variety of collaborative activities will be planned in <strong>the</strong> experimentation phase. ParlEuNet will experiment with<br />

pedagogical models that promote student-centred problem based learning aiming at <strong>the</strong> design of guidelines <strong>for</strong><br />

working in telematics learning environments. Training workshops will be conducted to integrate <strong>the</strong> telematics<br />

learning environment into classroom practice, get feedback on content, <strong>the</strong> appropriateness of <strong>the</strong> media involved.<br />

Following <strong>the</strong> experimentation, <strong>the</strong> results will be analysed. In addition to educational publications, a practical guide<br />

will be produced to disseminate <strong>the</strong> results to o<strong>the</strong>r European schools to generalise <strong>the</strong> results from <strong>the</strong> pilot<br />

experiment. A hands-on workshop in <strong>the</strong> European Parliament will be organised <strong>for</strong> policymakers and<br />

Parliamentarians. Workshops will be organised on a national level by parents' associations as well as <strong>the</strong> distribution<br />

of a project video and major on-line hyperlinking with European educational projects.<br />

6. References<br />

CEO Briefing Document, CEO/115/95, http://www.ceo.org/CEO_briefpap.html<br />

CEO Enabling Services, CEO/166/1995, CEOS , http://gds.esrin.esa.it:80/05EC3ADD/Cceos-about<br />

EWSE, http://ewse.ceo.org<br />

G7 Environment and Natural Resource Monitoring, http://ceo.gelos.org<br />

CEOS In<strong>for</strong>mation Locator System, http://cils.ceo.org<br />

ParlEuNet, http://parleunet.jrc.it<br />

WWW, http://www.w3.org<br />

HTTP, Berners-Lee, T., The Hypertext Transfer Protocol, World Wide Web Consortium, Work in Progress,<br />

http://www.w3.org/hypertext/WWW/Protocols/Overview.html<br />

Hypertext Transfer Protocol -- HTTP/1.0, Internet draft of <strong>the</strong> HTTP Working Group of <strong>the</strong> IETF,<br />

http://www.w4.org/pub/WWW/Protocols/HTTP1.0/draft-ietf-http-spec.html<br />

URL, Berners-Lee, T., Fielding, R. and Nielsen, H.F., Hypertext Transfer Protocol-HTTP/1.0, March 1995<br />

IETF, http://www.ietf.org/<br />

URNs, K. Sollins, L. Masinter, Functional Requirements <strong>for</strong> Uni<strong>for</strong>m Resource Names, RFC 1737<br />

EWSE Design Document, Clive Best, European Wide Service Exchange Design Document, CEO/125/95<br />

Perl, Larry Wall and Randal L. Schwartz, Programming Perl, O'Reilly & Associates, Inc, ISBN 0-937175-64-1<br />

Apache, David Robinson, Apache - An HTTP Server, Reference Manual, The Apache Group 1995,<br />

http://www.apache.org/


Synchronised Slides ’n Sounds On-line<br />

John Rosbottom<br />

Department of In<strong>for</strong>mation Systems<br />

University of Portsmouth<br />

Locksway Road, Portsmouth, PO4 8JF, UK<br />

john.rosbottom@port.ac.uk<br />

Introduction<br />

Synchronised Slides ‘n Sounds On-line (SSSO) is an integrated multimedia/hypermedia system that<br />

provides a distinctive new medium <strong>for</strong> teaching and learning. Students use <strong>the</strong> world wide web to<br />

connect to an audio lecture illustrated by visual slides. Students can move backwards and <strong>for</strong>wards<br />

through <strong>the</strong> lecture while <strong>the</strong> slides and <strong>the</strong> talk remain tightly synchronised.<br />

The cornerstones of student learning in <strong>the</strong> late twentieth century are <strong>the</strong> lecture, <strong>the</strong> tutorial, <strong>the</strong><br />

practical case study and <strong>the</strong> book. One of <strong>the</strong> most important aspects of <strong>the</strong>se ways to learn is that <strong>the</strong>y<br />

are all to some extent highly flexible and may be adapted to a variety of students in a variety of<br />

situations. These approaches to learning work in a wide variety of subject areas to a wide range of<br />

student competences. The influence of <strong>the</strong> computer as a learning aid, ra<strong>the</strong>r than as an administrative<br />

aid to learning, is significantly less than <strong>the</strong> mainstays of <strong>the</strong> lecture delivered in a face to face lecture<br />

<strong>the</strong>atre, <strong>the</strong> tutorial or seminar delivered in a small group environment, and <strong>the</strong> book. However SSSO<br />

has something of <strong>the</strong> versatility of <strong>the</strong>se more traditional learning methods.<br />

Pedagogy<br />

The approach to education that we are currently developing seeks to maintain a highly flexible<br />

approach to learning by utilising a wide variety of resources and methods. To this extent it is much <strong>the</strong><br />

same as any standard late twentieth century university course. However whenever it is appropriate to<br />

do so, activities are migrated to a multimedia/hypermedia environment delivered on <strong>the</strong> world wide<br />

web. The key criterion in implementing this system is that of identifying <strong>the</strong> most appropriate way to<br />

deliver resources and facilitate learning. What we are developing is a robust “mixed economy” of<br />

learning. We believe <strong>the</strong> lecture is over-used. Some (but not all) of what is done in lectures can be<br />

done better by <strong>the</strong> equivalent lecture delivered as an asynchronous multimedia lecture on <strong>the</strong> world<br />

wide web.<br />

There is an ideal of <strong>the</strong> lecture which is <strong>the</strong> Socratic model, or perhaps <strong>the</strong> Oxbridge model, in which<br />

students are inculcated into a field of knowledge and understanding by gifted, charismatic individuals<br />

able to inspire <strong>the</strong>ir students with a love of <strong>the</strong> subject and a thirst <strong>for</strong> learning more. On this ideal<br />

model lectures are conducted in a face to face environment where students can interrogate <strong>the</strong> lecturer<br />

who is sufficiently sensitive to construct responses at a level appropriate to <strong>the</strong> students’ current level<br />

of understanding. The lecturer is able to perceive <strong>the</strong> needs of <strong>the</strong> audience and explains <strong>the</strong> subject in<br />

such a way that <strong>the</strong>y can relate <strong>the</strong>ir new understanding to what <strong>the</strong>y already know. The reality in<br />

modern Higher Education is that only a minority of lectures correspond to this ideal. Large student<br />

numbers from widely heterogeneous backgrounds, and shorter teaching hours conspire to reduce many<br />

lectures to a much more routine affair in which <strong>the</strong> lecturer addresses some slides and answers some<br />

questions. There may be insufficient time <strong>for</strong> every question to be asked. Such a lecture pitched at <strong>the</strong><br />

“average student” in an audience of perhaps 150 students is likely to be beyond <strong>the</strong> comprehension of<br />

some, and obvious to o<strong>the</strong>rs - both of <strong>the</strong>se extremes learn little from <strong>the</strong> lecture. Part of <strong>the</strong> aim of our<br />

current work is to be able to raise <strong>the</strong> standard of face to face lectures to that of <strong>the</strong> ideal outlined<br />

above. Our approach to achieving this is to make <strong>the</strong>se face to face lectures much more of a “special<br />

event” than <strong>the</strong> routine, same-time-same-place-every-week lecture. To achieve this elevation of<br />

standards many of <strong>the</strong>se routine lectures can be beneficially delivered as a streamed audio file with<br />

synchronised slides illustrating <strong>the</strong> talk and an extended set of frequently asked questions associated<br />

with <strong>the</strong> discussion of <strong>the</strong> lecture. These SSSO lectures are just one of a rich set of features which


make an hypermedia educational environment that in many respects reflects <strong>the</strong> richness and variety of<br />

provision found in standard University learning.<br />

Distance Learning<br />

Can our environment be used <strong>for</strong> distance learning The answer is “Yes and No”. The learner is an<br />

intrinsic part of successful distance learning. Traditionally what distinguishes successful distance<br />

learners is an extraordinarily high level of motivation to learn, a resourcefulness in developing<br />

appropriate learning skills, and a very high ability to manage <strong>the</strong>ir own learning. It would be a mistake<br />

to suppose that all “standard” University students exhibit <strong>the</strong>se qualities to <strong>the</strong> same degree as<br />

successful distance learners. So <strong>the</strong> traditional distance learner will rejoice in <strong>the</strong> web based learning<br />

environment as a supplement to <strong>the</strong> traditional distance learning resources of books and correspondence<br />

with tutors; many will accept web-based resources as a substitute <strong>for</strong> traditional distance learning tools.<br />

What though of <strong>the</strong> standard full-time students We are wary of diminishing <strong>the</strong> richness of <strong>the</strong>ir<br />

environment in case <strong>the</strong>re is an adverse effect on student progress and success. So we do not wish to<br />

eliminate <strong>the</strong> face to face lecture, we want to make it better. Unlike some face to face lectures<br />

everything in our SSSO lectures is legible. The slides are clear on <strong>the</strong> computer screen, <strong>the</strong> digitised<br />

voice played though <strong>the</strong> sound card is clear. Crucially, and unlike in face to face lectures, <strong>the</strong><br />

individual student controls <strong>the</strong> pace of events. Students might rewind <strong>the</strong> lecture in order to replay<br />

something important. They might pause to check in a book something that was said. They might<br />

pause <strong>the</strong> lecture in mid-sentence in order to construct a mail message. Such e-mailed questions do<br />

<strong>the</strong>mselves become a valuable resource as “frequently asked questions” visible to all.<br />

Technology<br />

The system uses RealPlayer to play streamed compressed audio. We have experimented with two<br />

approaches to <strong>the</strong> creation of SSSO files. The first utilises Real software to embed slide-change events<br />

into a Real-encoded audio file. The second technology uses Synchronised Multimedia Integration<br />

Language (SMIL) to display slides at predetermined points in <strong>the</strong> audio file. This open standard<br />

language makes it easy to “play toge<strong>the</strong>r” a variety of media. The first technology is very simple <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong><br />

user and can be played through a standard web server using http protocol. The second, SMIL based,<br />

technology requires <strong>the</strong> use of RealServer to deliver <strong>the</strong> files to a Netscape browser (Internet Explorer<br />

includes an Active-X plug-in that makes <strong>the</strong> RealServer unnecessary but we have followed <strong>the</strong> more<br />

general route). Using <strong>the</strong> SMIL solution <strong>the</strong> student-interface is more functional but also more<br />

complicated. For example students can select any slide and play <strong>the</strong> lecture from <strong>the</strong> start of <strong>the</strong> slide<br />

(like playing a track on a music CD). The simpler interface of <strong>the</strong> first method requires <strong>the</strong> user to<br />

move a slider to <strong>the</strong> approximate start of <strong>the</strong> desired slide.<br />

Conclusion<br />

Our experience with SSSO has been limited to just a few trials, but feedback from students has been<br />

encouragingly positive. Observations of students using <strong>the</strong> system shows that <strong>the</strong>y do pause <strong>the</strong><br />

presentation and replay sections. A telling comment from one student is: “I like <strong>the</strong> on-line lecture<br />

because I am in control.” We expected <strong>the</strong> quality of student lecture notes to improve as <strong>the</strong>y can take<br />

as much time as needed, however one student commented “I didn’t bo<strong>the</strong>r to make any notes because I<br />

knew I could play <strong>the</strong> lecture again.” So like most educational media SSSO may be susceptible to<br />

misuse! Next year we plan to use <strong>the</strong> method as a substitute <strong>for</strong> some of our standard lectures, so<br />

students will experience a high quality distance learning regime as a small part of <strong>the</strong>ir course. To<br />

view a sample SSSO lecture that discusses fur<strong>the</strong>r <strong>the</strong> contents of this paper please see<br />

http://www.dis.port.ac.uk/~johnr/lal2/start.htm


Higher Education: Infected with a Millenarian Bug<br />

Dr Yoni Ryan<br />

Teaching and Learning Support Services Department<br />

Queensland University of Technology<br />

Brisbane, Australia<br />

y.ryan@qut.edu.au<br />

Suellen Tapsall<br />

School of Media Communication and Culture<br />

Murdoch University<br />

Perth, Western Australia<br />

stapsall@central.murdoch.edu.au<br />

Abstract: This paper reports on an extensive survey of <strong>the</strong> opinions and intentions of major media and<br />

telecommunications CEOs and higher education administrators regarding <strong>the</strong> potential <strong>for</strong> ‘a global university’. It<br />

argues that a crisis of confidence engulfs public sector education systems, which may only be resolved through a<br />

thorough knowledge of <strong>the</strong> private companies involved in education delivery, and a renewed focus on <strong>the</strong> core<br />

business of higher education.<br />

Five years ago a millenarian virus hit <strong>the</strong> academic world. Not <strong>the</strong> Y2K bug, but an<br />

apocalyptic vision of a global university dominated by media companies and telecommunications<br />

entities. The virus was orally and aurally transmitted and spread quickly through <strong>the</strong> Vice Chancellors<br />

and Directors of well-established and prestigious universities, fuelled by respected academic leaders<br />

such as Barry Munitz of Cali<strong>for</strong>nia State University, who <strong>for</strong>esaw a conglomerate of Microsoft, AT&T<br />

and IBM offering <strong>the</strong> Governor of Cali<strong>for</strong>nia a cheaper, more efficient public education system. In<br />

Australia, <strong>the</strong> virus was spread by Alan Gilbert, University of Melbourne Vice-Chancellor, an<br />

academic not noted <strong>for</strong> alarmist statements. Subsequently, <strong>the</strong> Australian federal education department<br />

tendered <strong>for</strong> a reality check of <strong>the</strong> global university. Queensland University of Technology won <strong>the</strong><br />

contract in its Media and Journalism department.<br />

This paper reports on <strong>the</strong> potential scenarios our team devised on <strong>the</strong> basis of investigations<br />

and interviews with many of <strong>the</strong> key players in <strong>the</strong> corporate and academic world. They represent our<br />

analysis, within <strong>the</strong> context of <strong>the</strong> investigation’s focus on convergence with global media networks, of<br />

<strong>the</strong> potential <strong>for</strong> new types of worldwide universities ei<strong>the</strong>r in existence or likely to emerge within <strong>the</strong><br />

next ten years. We conclude <strong>the</strong> paper with an update in terms of <strong>the</strong> likelihood of <strong>the</strong> scenarios a year<br />

later, and a few suggestions <strong>for</strong> inoculating our present universities from <strong>the</strong> effects of <strong>the</strong> virus, which<br />

we believe is more a crisis of confidence within public education than a threat from <strong>the</strong> corporate<br />

world. The scenarios are not mutually exclusive: several may develop concurrently, and combinations<br />

may appear.<br />

Scenario 1: Harvard-Murdoch U<br />

A globally branded university partners a global media network such as News Corporation and<br />

offers a high-quality prestigious degree. The alliance brings toge<strong>the</strong>r partners of equal strengths in <strong>the</strong>ir<br />

core areas. It provides access to a pre-existing and substantial marketplace, an understanding of <strong>the</strong><br />

strengths and weaknesses of <strong>the</strong> medium of delivery and a means of carriage that is highly developed<br />

and robust. The means of delivery is presumably broadcast (satellite or cable) or <strong>the</strong> Internet. Programs<br />

are globally available in <strong>the</strong> home and workplace.<br />

This is one scenario ‘often presented to faculty at institutions o<strong>the</strong>r than Harvard as <strong>the</strong><br />

frightening future’ (Reeves, UGA). It is also a scenario that seems to be strongly identified with<br />

American institutions and media networks.<br />

Any offerings by a globally branded institution should be highly attractive. The global<br />

recognition of <strong>the</strong> institutional name would overcome some of <strong>the</strong> inherent difficulties of local


accreditation or standing in countries o<strong>the</strong>r than America and Britain. The likely focus would be at <strong>the</strong><br />

professional postgraduate level. James O’Donnell, Vice-Provost <strong>for</strong> In<strong>for</strong>mation Systems and<br />

Computing at <strong>the</strong> University of Pennsylvania, has said that undergraduate distance-learning programs<br />

would be more difficult to justify at Ivy League prices: “At Penn and similar private institutions, <strong>the</strong><br />

one thing <strong>the</strong>y sell is that <strong>the</strong> people sitting next to you are smart people. Universities haven’t yet<br />

figured out how to recruit a comparatively talented pool over <strong>the</strong> Internet.” (Chronicle of Higher<br />

Education, 20 June 1997:A23)<br />

Significant questions surround <strong>the</strong> notions of such an alliance. Why should ei<strong>the</strong>r partner<br />

participate High-end institutions owe a significant part of <strong>the</strong>ir success to <strong>the</strong>ir elitist branding. Would<br />

such an institution even want to mass-produce its degrees Zastrocky (Gartner Group) says “Harvard<br />

can’t just mass produce. They have <strong>the</strong> means, but it would undermine <strong>the</strong>ir own prestige”.<br />

Finally, what of <strong>the</strong> global media networks Would <strong>the</strong>y get involved in such an alliance<br />

Henkin (NTG, News Corporation) says one immediate problem that springs to mind is that of<br />

exclusivity. “If you’re a distributor, you want to be open to multiple providers but an institution is more<br />

likely to want to be <strong>the</strong> major or sole provider with perhaps some second-tier institutions underneath as<br />

part of <strong>the</strong> service.” It would also need to be economically viable. “For <strong>the</strong> private sector to get<br />

involved <strong>the</strong>y would have to see this as lucrative endeavour. If it’s not a bottom-line profit-making<br />

business <strong>the</strong>n it won’t happen” (Pease, International University).<br />

Scenario 2: The Big Mac-Disney-Real Thing U<br />

“McDonald’s U … They recruit you, guarantee you a part-time job, you drop into a Bachelor’s degree<br />

and are given a job at <strong>the</strong> end. I see problems with competing with that.” (Miller, GATE)<br />

One or more corporations partner a global media network and offer education and training on<br />

a global scale. These corporations are hugely successful at <strong>the</strong>ir core businesses and already are<br />

committed to providing training <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong>ir own employees. Many have <strong>the</strong>ir own media networks and/or<br />

infrastructures, guaranteeing <strong>the</strong>m access to <strong>the</strong> technology and means of delivery at minimal cost, at<br />

<strong>the</strong> same time capitalising on <strong>the</strong>ir core business. Once again, <strong>the</strong> means of delivery is likely to be<br />

satellite, cable or <strong>the</strong> Internet, with a stronger focus on online media due to <strong>the</strong> ubiquity of <strong>the</strong><br />

workplace desktop computer and established levels of connectivity. Most of <strong>the</strong> organisations are<br />

multinationals, providing an automatic physical and student base across <strong>the</strong> globe.<br />

If one accepts that <strong>the</strong> core business of Disney and McDonald’s is as much marketing and<br />

customer satisfaction as developing entertainment products or making hamburgers, <strong>the</strong>n this<br />

combination carries significant market attraction. Fur<strong>the</strong>r, we would argue that some disciplines,<br />

including business, are more attractive to new providers and appear to convert more easily to different<br />

models of delivery. For example, programs originating from <strong>the</strong> computing and telecommunications<br />

companies—IBM, Microsoft and Motorola, to name but a few—would prove attractive to <strong>the</strong> market<br />

due to <strong>the</strong> demand <strong>for</strong> technology-related learning.<br />

It would seem obvious that this scenario has potential in <strong>the</strong> most commercially and<br />

economically viable parts of <strong>the</strong> sector. Corporate providers have <strong>the</strong> infrastructure and financial<br />

means, toge<strong>the</strong>r with <strong>the</strong> ‘branding’ in terms of ‘real-world’ experience to be attractive options <strong>for</strong> a<br />

student cohort concerned primarily with employment-related issues.<br />

The major corporate providers were quick to dismiss notions that this scenario had potential.<br />

Most said <strong>the</strong>y were only in <strong>the</strong> business of industry-specific education because traditional institutions<br />

were not meeting <strong>the</strong>ir needs. IBM spends more than $400 million annually on corporate training to<br />

IBM staff and Verville says that while <strong>the</strong>re may be some small examples of this type of alliance<br />

around: “it’s not going to be a major thrust. Increasingly corporations around <strong>the</strong> world are focussing<br />

on core competencies, on core business. Generally, it’s something <strong>the</strong>y do because <strong>the</strong>y have to.<br />

They’ll only do it if <strong>the</strong>y get better returns on <strong>the</strong>ir investment than <strong>the</strong>y get from making hamburgers.”<br />

O<strong>the</strong>r questions surround <strong>the</strong> portability of a degree from IBM or Disney and levels of<br />

acceptance by competing employers. “In general, lots of companies have tried to provide training <strong>for</strong><br />

<strong>the</strong>ir own employees because tertiary institutions are unwilling to do that. Most of us would prefer to<br />

go to a tertiary institution where <strong>the</strong> degree or certificate is portable. Does a certification of<br />

management from IBM work I’d ra<strong>the</strong>r pay <strong>for</strong> an employee to do a degree from Stan<strong>for</strong>d, MIT or<br />

Harvard” (Geoghegan, IBM).


Scenario 3: Virtual U<br />

Although <strong>the</strong> term ‘virtual’ tends to be equated <strong>the</strong> with Internet and World Wide Web<br />

offerings, <strong>the</strong> virtual university could operate via a range of communication and in<strong>for</strong>mation<br />

technologies. However, this scenario envisages <strong>the</strong> Virtual U as heavily dependent on <strong>the</strong> Internet and,<br />

to a lesser extent, on satellite and cable, as <strong>the</strong> primary means of delivery. Carriage may be linked to<br />

one specific global media network (eg. Microsoft, IBM) but is more likely to involve a combination of<br />

media organisations (eg. McGraw Hill) and media infrastructure (eg. <strong>the</strong> Internet), although Farrington<br />

(1997: 67) calls this ‘<strong>the</strong> CNN model’.<br />

The ubiquity of communication and in<strong>for</strong>mation technologies (CITs) suggests that <strong>the</strong> Virtual<br />

U is, at <strong>the</strong> very least, a probable future contender in <strong>the</strong> education sector. In fact, several variations are<br />

already under development. To succeed, <strong>the</strong> Virtual U first needs to overcome some of <strong>the</strong><br />

negativities—at institutional, faculty, student and industry level—that in <strong>the</strong> past have been related to<br />

distance education. It requires robust communication networks and technology infrastructures. Quality<br />

of content and delivery materials must be guaranteed. There must also be strong support and feedback<br />

structures <strong>for</strong> students and lecturers. Finally, a feasible Virtual U requires off-campus solutions to<br />

resource access issues (eg. digital libraries and multimedia data banks). Pease (International<br />

University) says totally off-campus initiatives have to ensure <strong>the</strong>y deliver what students expect from a<br />

university. “We stopped using <strong>the</strong> Virtual U as a name. It used to conjure up a negative image—that<br />

it’s not a real university.” Pedagogical issues are also problematic <strong>for</strong> critics of <strong>the</strong> Virtual U scenario.<br />

Fur<strong>the</strong>rmore, <strong>the</strong>re is little concrete evidence to indicate student demand or support <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> Virtual U.<br />

Scenario 4: The Open University<br />

A large centralised education production and distribution agent, utilising a ‘Fordist’, ie.<br />

industrial model team development process, sets its sights on a mass global market in order to produce<br />

economies of scale, with some reliance on mass broadcasting media, and local student support centres<br />

to provide both tutorial and counselling service. This model is not reliant on a specific medium or<br />

media organisation, although both may play a significant role in <strong>the</strong> provision of education. Course<br />

content may be delivered by a variety of technologies and be augmented by face-to-face tutoring. This<br />

model differs from World U (Scenario 7) in that it does not source from multiple providers, uses ‘LCD<br />

(Lowest Common Denominator) media’ (print and broadcast TV/radio) plus local complementary<br />

classes, and has an established reputation <strong>for</strong> good quality education. It represents <strong>the</strong> general concept<br />

of <strong>the</strong> UK Open University model. It appears to be transplantable—<strong>the</strong> HKOU, and more recently <strong>the</strong><br />

Singapore Institute of Management, were established with UKOU materials and processes, local tutors,<br />

and local case studies, and WGU is now completing a partnership agreement with UKOU.<br />

Campion and Renner (1992) <strong>for</strong>eshadowed <strong>the</strong> expansion of UKOU to become a<br />

multinational centralised provider, in <strong>the</strong>ir term, ‘a neo-Fordist model’ based on ‘techno-economic<br />

paradigms’ (1992:18), but <strong>the</strong>y warn that a highly differentiated market would militate against this<br />

model, since it is predicated on a mass market. Because of <strong>the</strong> recognised strong educational base,<br />

accreditation is less of a problem than, <strong>for</strong> example, in <strong>the</strong> World U model.<br />

The UKOU model may require an increasing move to pre-recorded video <strong>for</strong> audiovisual<br />

material, a move to (expensive) dedicated cable/satellite programming, or to <strong>the</strong> Internet. Both <strong>the</strong><br />

latter choices would diminish a potential international audience and reduce <strong>the</strong> economy of scale on<br />

which <strong>the</strong> Open University model is predicated, and also subvert <strong>the</strong> ‘openness’ on which <strong>the</strong><br />

institution has prided itself.<br />

A more fundamental barrier is a widespread recognition that partnerships and collaborative<br />

development, ra<strong>the</strong>r than <strong>the</strong> centralised curriculum/production/dispatch, are more appropriate and<br />

practical in <strong>the</strong> coming century. For Daniel (1996:49) <strong>the</strong> OU model faces a dire choice: a ‘low frills’<br />

approach, which offers a cost advantage or appeal to a niche market via differentiation of ‘product’. He<br />

argues this is an ei<strong>the</strong>r/or choice.<br />

Scenario 5: Super Corridor Model


A government designates a certain area to become a ‘super corridor’ <strong>for</strong> media and<br />

communications networks and infrastructures. The proposal brings toge<strong>the</strong>r CITs with government<br />

policy, integrating technology into all aspects of <strong>the</strong> economy, including education and training.<br />

This scenario is geographically bound, usually sub-national, and is generally related to<br />

establishing robust, maintainable and high-capacity infrastructures <strong>for</strong> CITs. Educational institutions<br />

participate in <strong>the</strong> model at <strong>the</strong> direction of <strong>the</strong> nation state. This scenario was emerging in some Asian<br />

countries, notably Malaysia, Singapore and Korea. To succeed, <strong>the</strong> super corridor scenario requires a<br />

government that is philosophically and financially committed to <strong>the</strong> concept, with <strong>the</strong> power to compel<br />

major cultural institutions, corporations, industries and individuals to participate. This would not<br />

appear to be a viable option <strong>for</strong> countries that rely more on cooperation than coercion, or a ‘noninterventionist’<br />

approach (Hong Kong) vs ‘a fa<strong>the</strong>rly approach’ (Malaysia) (Yuen, HKOU).<br />

Scenario 6: Western Governors University<br />

Politicians, educational providers (private and public), industry and communications and<br />

media networks band toge<strong>the</strong>r in a coordinated ef<strong>for</strong>t to make education available to students in a<br />

defined regional area. This scenario is based on <strong>the</strong> model of <strong>the</strong> Western Governors University<br />

(WGU) as a brokering agency.<br />

It is reliant on strong CIT infrastructures and may involve one or more media networks such<br />

as AT&T in a technical support role. The participating educational institutions provide content that is<br />

<strong>the</strong>n delivered using various media. A feature is competency-based assessment, allowing students to<br />

capitalise on ‘real-world learning’ and pre-existing skills and abilities. All elements of <strong>the</strong> program<br />

have been disaggregated, with fees <strong>for</strong> each component of service, including pre-enrolment<br />

competency assessment. The system operates as a distinct entity, separated from <strong>the</strong> individual state<br />

education authorities. Like <strong>the</strong> super corridor model, <strong>the</strong> WGU scenario relies on initial government<br />

support. On <strong>the</strong> o<strong>the</strong>r hand, it can also be described as a cooperative model, as <strong>the</strong>re is no compulsion<br />

<strong>for</strong> states, institutions, students or corporations to participate.<br />

One of <strong>the</strong> major problems with <strong>the</strong> concept is its non-coercive nature. Why should<br />

institutions or states participate in a model of educational delivery which means <strong>the</strong>y will have to share<br />

<strong>the</strong> proceeds of any student enrolments, while requiring institutional reorganisation and change For<br />

example, Microsoft had ‘talks early on’, but declined to participate in <strong>the</strong> project (Richards, Microsoft).<br />

There were many sceptical responses from interviewees. Bacsich (Sheffield Hallam) said some<br />

universities have tried this approach in Europe “and failed. Consortium models are good fun <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong><br />

academics involved but <strong>the</strong>y’re not relevant”. There remain problems of accreditation, relevance to<br />

market demand and institutional credibility. Government support would be essential.<br />

Scenario 7: World U<br />

A central agency is established to broker units and courses sourced from a range of countries.<br />

This scenario, like several o<strong>the</strong>rs, involves new and traditional providers, delivering content and<br />

interacting with students via several modes, including print-based, broadcast and Internet. The<br />

brokering agency ‘World U’ would grant <strong>the</strong> degrees.<br />

World U would make substantial use of multiple media. Some suggest that this is <strong>the</strong> answer<br />

to problems with international demands <strong>for</strong> portable, accredited programs and that <strong>the</strong> elements<br />

required to establish World U already exist. Zastrocky (Gartner Group) says it is similar to James<br />

Miller’s attempts to establish a University of <strong>the</strong> World. “His model is building a co-operative venture<br />

globally. He’s out to equate Zaire and Harvard. He’s had lots of interest from <strong>the</strong> developing countries<br />

−but not <strong>the</strong> developed nations. The best thing is to look at regional models.”<br />

Seah Chiong Tian (SIM) says World U has <strong>the</strong> potential to provide ‘<strong>the</strong> best of <strong>the</strong> best’ to<br />

students through its global sourcing of courses, but notes <strong>the</strong> difficulties in coordinating such an<br />

offering, and in guaranteeing quality control and standardisation across <strong>the</strong> program. Questions of<br />

accreditation, articulation, language, accessibility, ownership, intellectual property and copyright<br />

would have to be dealt with be<strong>for</strong>e this scenario could advance.<br />

Scenario 8: Free Market U


Any organisation able to provide solutions to perceived educational needs does so, in<br />

whatever way it chooses. Whe<strong>the</strong>r industry, a commercial or public entity or government, <strong>the</strong><br />

organisation can compete in <strong>the</strong> education sector, using <strong>the</strong> method of delivery and technology that it<br />

chooses. Public and private providers, corporations and o<strong>the</strong>rs exist side-by-side, delivering multiple,<br />

diverse education and training programs. The market (students, employers, industry) decides whe<strong>the</strong>r a<br />

program is successful and how much <strong>the</strong> degree is worth. Communication networks have as much right<br />

to participate as any o<strong>the</strong>r organisation, but may be in a stronger position to compete due to <strong>the</strong>ir<br />

established expertise and strengths with regard to CITs.<br />

European, Asian and Australian interviewees were quick to identify <strong>the</strong> problems as centred<br />

on accreditation issues, lack of quality control and existing numbers of universities. “(The) real danger<br />

is Everybody U…aimed at <strong>the</strong> bottom end” of <strong>the</strong> market (Calvert, Virtual U). Asian respondents were,<br />

with <strong>the</strong> exception of those in South Korea, opposed to a ‘free market’ or ‘anything goes’ approach to<br />

<strong>the</strong> establishment of new universities. Several interviewees suggested a free market scenario would<br />

place more pressure on universities to work with industry and to address <strong>the</strong> needs of <strong>the</strong> vocational<br />

sector, but <strong>the</strong>y <strong>for</strong>ecast difficulties. “This would be a high risk response. Current accreditation<br />

procedures are valued by employers” (O’Neil, News Corporation, Australia).<br />

“But that’s <strong>the</strong> model we (America) already have” (West, Cal State). American interviewees<br />

have few problems envisaging such a scenario. It is not surprising that many of <strong>the</strong> new models of<br />

education provision have <strong>the</strong>ir genesis in <strong>the</strong> United States, as <strong>the</strong> American educational structure is<br />

probably <strong>the</strong> closest in <strong>the</strong> world to a free market model.<br />

Scenario 9: Traditional with Intensifying Change<br />

Traditional campus-based institutions offer a significant portion of <strong>the</strong>ir course content using<br />

flexible delivery methods. They intensify use of CITs to support <strong>the</strong> teaching and learning processes in<br />

a sophisticated teaching program. Some degree of on-campus and face-to-face teaching is preserved;<br />

<strong>the</strong> actual amount varies according to <strong>the</strong> individual institution.<br />

The quality of institutional offerings using flexible delivery varies. Some providers seize on<br />

<strong>the</strong> technology as a means to cut costs and teach more students <strong>for</strong> less outlay and buy in commercial<br />

packages of ‘courseware’. Their infrastructural support is inadequate and online support functions<br />

(including administration and library resources) are patchy. These institutions are not well-regarded in<br />

<strong>the</strong> marketplace. O<strong>the</strong>r providers, including some traditional face-to-face institutions, are in more<br />

demand than ever. They have invested considerably in infrastructure, development and support<br />

networks, after carefully investigating and working through issues related to student and faculty needs<br />

and expectations. They make appropriate use of technology to deliver some aspects of <strong>the</strong> program, and<br />

have effective online library and administration facilities. On-campus and face-to-face sessions are<br />

valued and used to provide a quality teaching and learning experience. These institutions have effective<br />

and efficient partnerships with media organisations, which may or may not be global media networks.<br />

This scenario operates along a continuum, with significant differences between traditional oncampus<br />

institutions at one end, and progressive multi-campus institutions at <strong>the</strong> o<strong>the</strong>r. Such<br />

institutions, like Cal State, would have <strong>the</strong> potential to operate as global campuses, but this potential<br />

may not be realised because of <strong>the</strong> missions of <strong>the</strong> institutions—many of which have a local, regional<br />

or state focus.<br />

The scenarios in 1998<br />

When we completed our report in 1997, Australia was already aware of <strong>the</strong> imminent collapse<br />

of <strong>the</strong> Malaysian economy. The ‘Super Corridor’ was being scaled back, and Malaysian universities<br />

were struggling to accommodate <strong>the</strong> students <strong>for</strong>ced to return to <strong>the</strong>ir home country after <strong>the</strong>ir<br />

scholarships were withdrawn. That scenario has been blighted by economic realities.<br />

Realities have also hit home <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> supporters of WGU, which finally opened on September 3<br />

this year. After several weeks, despite 10,000 hits on <strong>the</strong> site, only 100 students had registered in its<br />

three courses, reportedly because of computer problems in processing applications, and continuing<br />

problems with accreditation (Net News 17/9/1998). Its sponsoring governments have now agreed to<br />

provide aid programs to entice students to enrol (HES, October 7, 1998 p. 29).<br />

Such facts do not seem to have had a significant impact on <strong>the</strong> rhetoric still heralding a higher<br />

education global market now available <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> taking, and <strong>the</strong> likelihood that global media networks


will be involved – ei<strong>the</strong>r in partnership with globally-branded providers (Scenario 1), through <strong>the</strong><br />

advent of totally virtual programs (Scenario 4) or as providers of <strong>the</strong> infrastructure <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> world<br />

brokering systems (Scenario 7). While <strong>the</strong>se three options continue to excite attention, <strong>the</strong>re have been<br />

few advances in <strong>the</strong>ir development.<br />

In contrast, <strong>the</strong> Big Mac-Disney-Real Thing U scenario appears to be growing in likelihood –<br />

as stand-alone or hybrid options. Traditional providers appear to be responding to <strong>the</strong> perceived threats<br />

of corporate universities by extending <strong>the</strong>ir alliances with business and industry, and accommodating<br />

demands <strong>for</strong> customised learning solutions (eg Regis University, Deakin). Western governments seem<br />

particularly drawn to this scenario as an alternative to public funding programs.<br />

Finally, <strong>the</strong> millenarian bug – and <strong>the</strong> panic it has caused – has not been eradicated, although<br />

<strong>the</strong> symptoms have changed somewhat. Ultimately, Intensifying Change U is <strong>the</strong> scenario most likely<br />

to characterise <strong>the</strong> future direction of higher education around <strong>the</strong> world. Some institutions will<br />

investigate ‘quack’ remedies, like ‘off-<strong>the</strong>-shelf’ pre-packaged solutions: <strong>the</strong> ‘U-Tel’ model – ‘Not $1<br />

million, not $500,000; not even $100,000. Delivery of your new ‘online degree program’ guaranteed in<br />

60 days or less – but wait, <strong>the</strong>re’s more! You don’t even have to change your courses or redesign, we<br />

do it all <strong>for</strong> you.’<br />

This bug, too, is likely to be insidious in its ability to mutate and replicate in unexpected and<br />

un<strong>for</strong>seen directions. Those institutions which survive this difficult period – and emerge stronger than<br />

be<strong>for</strong>e – are likely to be those which take preventative measures:<br />

• Differentiate between reality and rhetoric<br />

• Consult stakeholders, including students, staff, community, industry, government<br />

• Avoid ‘quick-fix’ or ‘miracle’ cures from ‘silicon snake oil’ salespeople<br />

• Keep <strong>the</strong>ir insurance up to date…where that insurance is quality teaching, quality content,<br />

meeting client needs, delivering a program that is in demand, attending to <strong>the</strong> ‘health’ of <strong>the</strong>ir<br />

institutions (including professional development of staff, conscious determination of <strong>the</strong>ir<br />

unique mission and intelligent and strategic development of infrastructure).<br />

The future shape of educational provision may resemble, at least in part, some of <strong>the</strong> scenarios<br />

discussed in this paper. More simply, it might be reduced to three sorts of ‘campuses’:<br />

• A residential college community where—<strong>for</strong> a summer or <strong>for</strong> four years—students study and<br />

receive guidance, support, evaluation, and motivation<br />

• A global electronic campus that students can enter via a computer, ‘commuting’ from home,<br />

dormitory room, or community centre<br />

• Continuing education and training provided at <strong>the</strong> workplace by employers and community<br />

organisations (Rossman, quoted in Oblinger and Rush 1997:13).<br />

References<br />

Campion, M. & Renner, W. (1992) ‘The supposed demise of Fordism: Implications <strong>for</strong> distance education and<br />

higher education’, Distance Education 13(1), 7-28.<br />

Daniel, J. (1996) Mega-universities and <strong>the</strong> knowledge media. London: Kogan Page.<br />

Farrington, G. (1997) ‘Higher education in <strong>the</strong> in<strong>for</strong>mation age’. In D. Oblinger & S. Rush (Eds) The Learning<br />

Revolution ( pp. 69-71). Bolton MA: Anker.<br />

Oblinger, D. & Rush, S. (1997) ‘The learning revolution’, in D. Oblinger & S. Rush (Eds) The Learning<br />

Revolution (pp. 2-19). Bolton MA: Anker.<br />

Acknowledgements<br />

The original study on which this paper is based was funded under <strong>the</strong> Evaluations and Investigations<br />

Program of <strong>the</strong> Department of Employment, Education and Youth Affairs, Canberra, in 1997-98.<br />

Quotes are taken from Interviews conducted in mid-1997. Affiliations were correct at <strong>the</strong> time of <strong>the</strong><br />

interview. The following people are quoted here: Bacsich, P. Sheffield Hallam University; Calvert, T. Virtual U;<br />

Chiong Tian, S. Singapore Institute of Management; Geoghegan, W. IBM; Henkin, M. News Technology Group,<br />

News Corp; Man Chan, J. Chinese University of Hong Kong; Miller. B. GATE; O’Neil, H. News Corp Australia;<br />

Pease, P. International University; Reeves, T. University of Georgia; Richards, T. Microsoft; Verville, A-L. IBM;<br />

West, T. Cali<strong>for</strong>nia State University; Yuen, K-S. Hong Kong Open University; Zastrocky, M. Gartner Group.


Media <strong>for</strong> biology - on CD-ROM and Online<br />

Uwe Sander<br />

Institute <strong>for</strong> Scientific Film<br />

Germany<br />

The German Institute of Scientific Film (IWF) is a scientific-media service provider. The IWF's service is primarily<br />

intended to serve <strong>the</strong> research and educational communities. It now presents an interactive program, offering a<br />

unique and rich multimedia experience: The Cell I - Life from Light an Air. It focuses on <strong>the</strong> cell - <strong>the</strong> basic<br />

structural unit of living matter. The smallest morphological unit in any organism. So complex, that it cannot be<br />

represented with <strong>the</strong> medium of <strong>the</strong> classic textbook, but only with state of <strong>the</strong> art multimedia. In <strong>the</strong> CD-ROM, you<br />

can study living cells, use a virtual microscope, come into a virtual laboratory, per<strong>for</strong>m <strong>the</strong> key experiments in<br />

biology, search <strong>for</strong> missing molecules, fly through cells and explore Virtual Reality in <strong>the</strong> microcosm. Our website<br />

cells.de offers science news, evaluated links to o<strong>the</strong>r internet resources and access to <strong>the</strong> world's largest library of<br />

cell-biological videos.


Streaming 7000 films...<br />

Uwe Sander<br />

Institute <strong>for</strong> Scientific Film<br />

Germany<br />

How to create a unique source <strong>for</strong> educational media in <strong>the</strong> internet<br />

The German Institute <strong>for</strong> Scientific Film (IWF) is a major european non profit producer of scientific videos. It's<br />

archives contain about 7000 films, videos, laserdiscs and CD-ROMs. These media are unique, but difficult to access<br />

outside of Germany. They may be a source <strong>for</strong> education in most fields of science, including biology and o<strong>the</strong>r<br />

natural sciences, cultural anthropology and medicine. In 1998, IWF started to publish its videos and o<strong>the</strong>r media in<br />

<strong>the</strong> internet. The end of this year, about 500 media are expected to be online, including videos, Virtual Reality<br />

(QuickTime VR and VRML) and interactive modules (Shockwave, Java).<br />

To fulfill this task, a lot of different issues had to be addressed, including legal, technical and scientific aspects. In<br />

<strong>the</strong> presentation, focus will be laid on technical issues. Avid systems have been used to digitize and optimize videos.<br />

QuickTime 3.0 and Real Video has been used to render preview quality of media. For higher bandwidth, we provide<br />

MPEG 1. A presentation of <strong>the</strong> website www.cells.de, containing about 50 videos and o<strong>the</strong>r media, will show <strong>the</strong><br />

first implementation of this educational source.


Enriching Drawing: A Three Year Project To Develop A Computer Based Learning<br />

Package In Drawing<br />

Robin Shaw<br />

University of Glasgow<br />

Scotland<br />

Until <strong>the</strong> latest round of funding, United Kingdom Higher Education (UKHE) through <strong>the</strong> Teaching and Learning<br />

Technology Programme (TLTP) despite an overall budget of around £75 million, has not made any sizable<br />

investment in learning technology <strong>for</strong> art and design. Art schools have always been in <strong>the</strong> <strong>for</strong>efront of <strong>the</strong> use of<br />

computers as tools. In design, in layout, in <strong>the</strong> manipulation of images, and in <strong>the</strong> creation of art, lecturers and<br />

students have possibly <strong>for</strong>med <strong>the</strong> most expert group of computer users and <strong>the</strong>ir needs have driven some of <strong>the</strong><br />

most innovative packages.<br />

However <strong>the</strong>re has always existed a healthy scepticism as to whe<strong>the</strong>r computers have anything to contribute to<br />

teaching and learning in art schools. This is not surprising. Apart from <strong>the</strong> provision of ready access to resources<br />

through <strong>the</strong> internet, learning technology has been dependent on pedagogic situations where new skills or concepts<br />

had to be acquired by <strong>the</strong> student and where <strong>the</strong> class as a whole would move ahead in expertise which would be<br />

tested by <strong>the</strong> examination. The computer is ideal <strong>for</strong> a situation where, <strong>for</strong> example, <strong>the</strong> student has to learn <strong>the</strong><br />

basics of a scientific discipline. In<strong>for</strong>mation can be given, processes can be simulated and at each stage of <strong>the</strong><br />

package <strong>the</strong> student can discover whe<strong>the</strong>r <strong>the</strong>y are understanding <strong>the</strong> material. 1 Questions can be posed and often<br />

quite sophisticated feedback given to <strong>the</strong> student. Contrast that with <strong>the</strong> situation in art. In art <strong>the</strong>re are few<br />

certainties. The emphasis is less on facts, <strong>the</strong> needs of <strong>the</strong> student are individual and <strong>the</strong> assessment of <strong>the</strong> student<br />

is through a piece of work demonstrating creativity and <strong>the</strong> development of ideas.<br />

Now with a grant from TLTP of £300,000 and matching funds to give a budget of around £800,000 a consortium<br />

of art schools and universities led by <strong>the</strong> London Institute is engaged on a three year project to create interactive<br />

multimedia learning packages on drawing. Drawing is central to all that is produced within <strong>the</strong> broadest spectrum<br />

of art and design. It is <strong>the</strong> core around which <strong>the</strong> conceptual and intellectual development of students takes place.<br />

Drawing allows individuals to learn to look, to record what <strong>the</strong>y see, and is used to develop thought and ideas <strong>for</strong><br />

artwork and <strong>for</strong> design, in both two and three dimensions.<br />

In 1995-96 almost 5% of students in UKHE were in art and design. If related subjects with a clear interest in<br />

drawing such as architecture, and engineering and technology, are included <strong>the</strong> total rose to almost 16% 2 . This<br />

growth in numbers has created problems which <strong>the</strong> package seeks to address.<br />

The approach adopted by <strong>the</strong> London Institute and its partners in <strong>the</strong> Falmouth College of Art, Ravensbourne<br />

College of Design and Communication and <strong>the</strong> Universities of Ulster and Brighton is intended to create materials<br />

which give full respect to <strong>the</strong> richness of <strong>the</strong> subject. The packages will come at drawing from many different<br />

angles and controversy will be welcomed ra<strong>the</strong>r than shunned. In addition to a thorough treatment of <strong>the</strong> basic<br />

skills such as drawing on paper, drawing with <strong>the</strong> computer and draughting, <strong>the</strong> programs will explore <strong>the</strong><br />

historical development of our understanding of spatial representation from <strong>the</strong> origins of perspective, through<br />

drawing machines to 3D and computer graphics. In all <strong>the</strong> work <strong>the</strong> importance of how to see, how to interpret<br />

1<br />

Doughty, G et al, Using Learning Technologies: Interim Conclusions from <strong>the</strong> TILT Project, Shaw, R. (ed) University of<br />

Glasgow (March 1995) 27-33<br />

2<br />

1 Students in Higher Education 1995-96 HESA July 1997


and how to innovate will be paramount and due weight will be given to <strong>the</strong> <strong>the</strong>oretical, philosophical and<br />

contextual elements. Considerable use will be made of video to show practitioners at work and discussing <strong>the</strong>ir<br />

particular approach to drawing.<br />

The project got underway in June 1998 and <strong>the</strong> initial period has been spent in blocking out <strong>the</strong> areas of drawing<br />

we wish to address and researching our pedagogical approach. The second phase of <strong>the</strong> project was to write<br />

detailed descriptions of <strong>the</strong> planned modules focusing on <strong>the</strong> aims and objectives of <strong>the</strong> module and how <strong>the</strong><br />

content was to be presented and made interactive. From <strong>the</strong> module descriptions we are now moving on to<br />

storyboarding and developing using Authoware.<br />

There is a considerable body of evidence that in order <strong>for</strong> learning to take place effectively on <strong>the</strong> computer, <strong>the</strong><br />

user has to be involved in tasks where decisions have to be made. 3 The learning should be active and consequently<br />

<strong>the</strong>re is a continual pressure to find ways of engaging <strong>the</strong> student. While assessment within <strong>the</strong> field of drawing is<br />

difficult, we are convinced that <strong>the</strong> student will gain by reviewing what has been learned and by receiving sensitive<br />

feedback on progress, so we are exploring ways in which this can be possible.<br />

In a project of this nature it is vital to expose ideas to <strong>the</strong> widest audience be<strong>for</strong>e committing <strong>the</strong>m to development<br />

and we have been disseminating in<strong>for</strong>mation about <strong>the</strong> project to art colleges and o<strong>the</strong>r institutions with an interest<br />

in drawing. To date, staff from more than seventy institutions in <strong>the</strong> UK and <strong>the</strong> USA have expressed an interest<br />

and we are allowing <strong>the</strong>m access to our deliberations. We are eager <strong>for</strong> as wide a participation as possible and<br />

interested faculty can sign up to <strong>the</strong> list from our website at http://tltp.linst.ac.uk/.<br />

The finished package will be distributed on a number of interlinked plat<strong>for</strong>m-independent CD-ROMs and we are<br />

also investigating <strong>the</strong> suitability of DVD since that medium allows <strong>the</strong> packaging of <strong>the</strong> product on one disk with a<br />

more than adequate space <strong>for</strong> high quality graphics. The finished product will be available to UKHE at <strong>the</strong><br />

beginning of 2001 though beta versions will be widely distributed <strong>for</strong> testing well be<strong>for</strong>e that date. As <strong>the</strong> project<br />

progresses, prototype modules will be trialled in <strong>the</strong> classroom situation, both in <strong>the</strong> consortium partners and also<br />

in a number of o<strong>the</strong>r interested institutions. From <strong>the</strong> evaluation of <strong>the</strong>se prototypes, which will be carried out by<br />

<strong>the</strong> University of Glasgow, we will make changes to incorporate what we learn from student and staff use. The<br />

results of <strong>the</strong>se evaluations will be widely disseminated. The project intends that <strong>the</strong> package will be made<br />

available outside of <strong>the</strong> United Kingdom though its primary audience is first year degree students in that country.<br />

Since <strong>the</strong> project is probably <strong>the</strong> largest investment ever in learning technology in art it poses a considerable<br />

challenge. Its aims are ambitious and wide ranging and while it in no way seeks to supplant <strong>the</strong> traditional<br />

relationship between staff and student, it intends to make a significant contribution to <strong>the</strong> richness of <strong>the</strong> learning<br />

environment in <strong>the</strong> area of drawing. It will do this by producing products which will emphasis <strong>the</strong> development of<br />

observation, skill and accuracy and <strong>the</strong> understanding of <strong>for</strong>m and space. Though <strong>the</strong> package will encourage <strong>the</strong><br />

use of <strong>the</strong> computer <strong>for</strong> drawing, <strong>the</strong> focus of <strong>the</strong> materials will remain on traditional drawing tools. However it<br />

will certainly promote <strong>the</strong> new approaches to drawing which are made possible through technology, and will aim<br />

to improve <strong>the</strong> ability to utilise software applications <strong>for</strong> three-dimensional modeling and to enhance <strong>the</strong> teaching<br />

of <strong>for</strong>mal drawing systems such as projection and perspective. When completed it will be a valuable resource <strong>for</strong><br />

use in <strong>the</strong> classroom and <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> independent student.<br />

The proposed presentation will demonstrate examples of <strong>the</strong> development to date deal with project management<br />

issues and invite discussion and participation from interested faculty.<br />

3<br />

Davies M., and Crow<strong>the</strong>r D., 'The Benefits of using multimedia in higher education: myths and realities', Active Learning 3<br />

(December 1995) 4-5 Ox<strong>for</strong>d


Design of Web-based Learning Environments: Integrating curriculum,<br />

technology, and professional development approaches<br />

James D. Slotta and Marcia C. Linn<br />

Graduate School of Education, University of Cali<strong>for</strong>nia at Berkeley<br />

4523 Tolman Hall<br />

Berkeley, CA 94720-1670<br />

slotta@socrates.berkeley.edu<br />

Philip Bell<br />

College of Education<br />

University of Washington<br />

322 Miller Hall Box 353600<br />

Seattle, WA 98195<br />

pbell@u.washington.edu<br />

Panel Topic Summary<br />

An increasing number of learning environments are successfully engaging students in au<strong>the</strong>ntic inquiry while also<br />

promoting meaningful learning about central concepts in a discipline. These ef<strong>for</strong>ts are characterized by some<br />

common characteristics:<br />

• Computer-based activities are embedded in curriculum sequences, so computers become a learning partner,<br />

ra<strong>the</strong>r than a medium <strong>for</strong> direct instruction or a generic tool<br />

• Instructional frameworks in<strong>for</strong>m <strong>the</strong> design process and provide a connection back to our <strong>the</strong>oretical<br />

understanding of learning<br />

• Innovations are designed and refined through multiple iterations by collaborating design partnerships that<br />

include teachers, educational researchers, technologists, and domain experts (e.g., scientists)<br />

• Professional development <strong>for</strong> teachers emerges as an integral component of research and development work.<br />

This involves new technologies and materials, and typically <strong>the</strong> creation of dedicated "on-line communities."<br />

Over <strong>the</strong> past fourteen years, our own research program has focused on promoting middle and high school students'<br />

integrated understanding of science through <strong>the</strong> use of carefully designed and technology-rich curriculum (Linn,<br />

1995). This ef<strong>for</strong>t has resulted in a framework <strong>for</strong> designing instruction called Scaffolded Knowledge Integration<br />

(SKI), as well as several computer-based learning environments, including:<br />

• The Computer as Learning Partner Project (CLP) ><br />

• The Knowledge Integration Environment (KIE) ><br />

• The Web-based Integrated Science Environment (WISE) <br />

The software and curriculum used within <strong>the</strong>se learning environments has included on-line lab-books to support<br />

reflection during experimentation, electronic coaches and guidance to offer conceptual hints, Internet-based<br />

discussion tools to help students exchange ideas, on-line design libraries to support <strong>the</strong> sharing of design resources,<br />

computer-based argument editors to enrich discussions during classroom debate activities, and any number of<br />

different interface designs which provided procedural scaffolding to students as <strong>the</strong>y progressed through <strong>the</strong>se online<br />

activities. Throughout this extensive history, <strong>the</strong> elaboration and refinement of our instructional framework has<br />

been an enduring focus and product of <strong>the</strong> work. With every new semester in <strong>the</strong> classroom, we have continued to<br />

refine this framework, toge<strong>the</strong>r with our understanding of how to design effective curriculum activities, and our<br />

knowledge of how to support teachers who wish to adopt our curriculum and technology.<br />

This panel examines <strong>the</strong> principles of this framework, describes how <strong>the</strong>y are being applied to design new <strong>for</strong>mats<br />

<strong>for</strong> Web-based instruction in science, and explains how <strong>the</strong> framework can promote professional development <strong>for</strong><br />

both pre-service and in-service teachers. Technology can be used catalyze a shift toward new instructional practices<br />

in classrooms, but not without careful attention to issues of curriculum, assessment, and learning.


Toward a framework <strong>for</strong> instruction with technology<br />

Marcia C. Linn, University of Cali<strong>for</strong>nia at Berkeley<br />

Based on over a decade of research in <strong>the</strong> Computer as Learning Partner project, The Scaffolded<br />

Knowledge Integration (SKI) framework guides <strong>the</strong> design of effective, technology rich learning environments<br />

(Linn, 1995; Linn & Hsi, in press). My research targets scientific understanding, with particular focus on preparing<br />

students to become lifelong science learners in a complex, changing world. In this panel, I describe how <strong>the</strong><br />

Scaffolded Knowledge Integration framework can guide decisions made by instructional designers. This process has<br />

succeeded in our Computer as Learning Partner Project and Knowledge Integration Environment Project (Bell,<br />

Davis and Linn (in press), and is currently guiding our work in two new projects: The Web-based Integrated Science<br />

Environment (WISE) and Science Controversies On-line: Partnerships in Education (SCOPE).<br />

An effective framework <strong>for</strong> instructional design should respond to a wide range of questions: How can we<br />

help students gain lifelong learning skills What kinds of guidance do students need in order to best succeed in <strong>the</strong><br />

activities we design How do we capitalize on <strong>the</strong> social aspects of classrooms too often ignored by instruction An<br />

instructional framework should integrate <strong>the</strong> findings from abstract <strong>the</strong>ories and detailed experiments into principles<br />

that can effectively guide <strong>the</strong> design of learning technologies and curriculum.<br />

I define knowledge integration as <strong>the</strong> dynamic process of connecting, distinguishing, organizing, and<br />

structuring models of a particular scientific phenomenon. I use <strong>the</strong> term "model" loosely to refer to patterns,<br />

templates, views, ideas, <strong>the</strong>ories, and visualizations. In general, learners bring multiple models of <strong>the</strong> phenomenon<br />

to any intellectual situation and regularly revise and reconnect <strong>the</strong>ir ideas. For example, if one wishes to instruct<br />

students in <strong>the</strong> area of heat and temperature, a quick review of <strong>the</strong> vocabulary around <strong>the</strong>se concepts suggest a broad<br />

range of models available to students. Students may believe that heat and temperature are interchangeable, based on<br />

verbal <strong>for</strong>mulations such as "turn up <strong>the</strong> heat" and "turn up <strong>the</strong> temperature." Or <strong>the</strong>y may distinguish heat from<br />

temperature, <strong>for</strong> example, remarking that temperature refers to all of <strong>the</strong> possible degrees on <strong>the</strong> <strong>the</strong>rmometer<br />

whereas heat refers to <strong>the</strong> degrees near <strong>the</strong> top of <strong>the</strong> <strong>the</strong>rmometer.<br />

In general, students bring a multitude of models to any situation and engage in a dynamic process of<br />

selecting among <strong>the</strong>m to deal with particular problems or social interactions. Ra<strong>the</strong>r than viewing multiple models as<br />

a problem, we see this as an opportunity <strong>for</strong> students to gain a rich understanding of <strong>the</strong> learning process and of <strong>the</strong><br />

distinction between scientific and everyday problem solving. The Scaffolded Knowledge Integration framework<br />

helps designers create materials that invite students to develop a deeper, more connected understanding of scientific<br />

phenomena. This view of students as “seeking connections” and instruction as “fostering knowledge integration”<br />

stands in contrast to <strong>the</strong> conventional model of learners as receiving in<strong>for</strong>mation and of instruction as providing<br />

in<strong>for</strong>mation. To design <strong>for</strong> knowledge integration, we articulate four major tenets of our framework:<br />

Making Science Accessible: To enable students to connect new ideas to <strong>the</strong>ir existing knowledge, we must<br />

assess <strong>the</strong>ir baseline understanding and design materials that connect to this knowledge. Effective instruction<br />

provides opportunities <strong>for</strong> students to evaluate scientific evidence according to <strong>the</strong>ir own understanding, to articulate<br />

<strong>the</strong>ir own <strong>the</strong>ories and explanations, and participate actively in principled design. This might involve using models<br />

of phenomena that are more accessible to students than <strong>the</strong> normative scientific models (Linn & Songer, 1991).<br />

Making Thinking Visible: To model <strong>the</strong> process of knowledge integration teachers and software can<br />

illustrate <strong>the</strong> wrong paths and confusions typical of scientific reasoning. To design instruction, we also need to help<br />

students make <strong>the</strong>ir own thinking visible (e.g., Collins, Brown and Holum, 1991; Linn and Songer, 1991; Slotta and<br />

Linn, in press).<br />

Promoting Lifelong Science Learning: To prepare students <strong>for</strong> autonomous, lifelong science learning we<br />

start with small but independent student activities that require sustained reasoning. To make such projects au<strong>the</strong>ntic,<br />

we draw on students existing knowledge and incorporate scientific evidence that students find personally relevant.<br />

In our Computer as Learning Partner project, we found that electronic coaches could helps students use such<br />

evidence productively. Electronic coaches, carefully designed, can be just as effective and more efficient than some<br />

<strong>for</strong>ms of human coaching.<br />

Providing Social Supports <strong>for</strong> Learning: Science learning is rarely per<strong>for</strong>med in isolation from ones peers;<br />

ra<strong>the</strong>r, peer exchange is often vital to learning. (e.g., Brown and Campione, 1990; Vygotsky, 1987). Science projects<br />

should be designed to foster collaborative work, both because this will be an important skill <strong>for</strong> students throughout<br />

<strong>the</strong>ir lives, and also because it is an efficient means of learning how o<strong>the</strong>rs connect ideas. Designing an effective<br />

social context <strong>for</strong> learning involves guiding <strong>the</strong> process of social interaction. Hearing ideas in <strong>the</strong> words of peers,<br />

validating each o<strong>the</strong>rs' ideas, and asking questions of peers can all foster links and connections among ideas when<br />

carefully designed.


Science Controversies On-Line: Designing Web-based Learning<br />

Environments around “Science in <strong>the</strong> Making”<br />

Philip Bell, University of Washington<br />

Exploring <strong>the</strong> Role of Controversy in <strong>the</strong> Science Curriculum: The SCOPE Project<br />

In our schools, <strong>the</strong> current curriculum in science is more decreed than designed and <strong>the</strong>se decreed curriculum<br />

materials rarely if ever discuss current or historical controversies in science. Most scientists spend <strong>the</strong>ir time<br />

working at <strong>the</strong> <strong>for</strong>efront of knowledge where controversy is <strong>the</strong> rule (Latour, 1998), but students rarely glimpse this<br />

aspect of science (Driver, Leach, Millar & Scott, 1996). Instead, well-meaning individuals create goals, texts, and<br />

assessments that are never subjected to <strong>the</strong> process of principled design and neglect important aspects of “science in<br />

<strong>the</strong> making.” While scientists proceed along <strong>the</strong> lines of controversy, school science tends toward didactic<br />

presentation of known facts, leading students to develop incorrect ideas about <strong>the</strong> nature of science content and<br />

scientific process. Students can profit from activities that focus on current scientific controversies, evidence, and<br />

scientific arguments. They can observe scientists who debate different hypo<strong>the</strong>ses or contribute different<br />

perspectives, and create <strong>the</strong>ir own scientific arguments through carefully supported learning activities.<br />

Web-based learning environments can be designed to support students in this process. The Science<br />

Controversies On-Line: Partnerships in Education (SCOPE) Project is developing controversy communities of<br />

scientists and science learners, focusing on controversies that concern leading research scientists and also connect to<br />

interests of citizens, such as <strong>the</strong> prediction of earthquakes or <strong>the</strong> control of malaria.<br />

A Prototype SCOPE Community on De<strong>for</strong>med Frogs<br />

Consider <strong>the</strong> following example. Over <strong>the</strong> past few years an apparent increase in physical de<strong>for</strong>mities among frog<br />

populations has been observed in parts of this country. The de<strong>for</strong>med frog controversy represents a complex,<br />

multidisciplinary problem involving environmental, genetic, and chemical arguments. We have been involved in an<br />

multidisciplinary partnership—between classroom teachers, integrative biologists, educational researchers, and<br />

computer scientists—focused on building a Web-based curriculum project (using <strong>the</strong> WISE learning environment<br />

shown below) that allows students to explore this controversy and communicate with scientists about <strong>the</strong> topic.<br />

Since it is a current scientific controversy, <strong>the</strong> project allowed seventh-grade students in an urban middle school not<br />

only to learn about a cutting-edge science topic but also to experience central aspects of <strong>the</strong> scientific process itself.<br />

We have documented large shifts in students’ images of science: exploring an au<strong>the</strong>ntic scientific controversy in<br />

process allows students to develop a dynamic understanding of <strong>the</strong> process of scientific progress while also<br />

developing a more integrated understanding of <strong>the</strong> science content. The design principles we are developing based<br />

on our research on students’ cognition will guide <strong>the</strong> development of new learning environments on numerous<br />

scientific controversies in a way that makes <strong>the</strong>m accessible to students and citizens alike.<br />

The De<strong>for</strong>med Frog Web-based Curriculum Sequence (http://scope.educ.washington.edu/frogs/)


A knowledge integration approach to professional development:<br />

Enabling teachers to succeed in adopting new practices<br />

Jim Slotta, University of Cali<strong>for</strong>nia at Berkeley<br />

The Web-based Integrated Science Environment provides science teachers with powerful new tools and approaches<br />

to bring knowledge integration activities into <strong>the</strong>ir classrooms. However, even when presented with a well-designed<br />

technology like WISE, teachers require significant levels of support to adopt new pedagogical concepts and<br />

methods. For example, teachers need to understand that technology is not an end in itself, and that <strong>the</strong> Internet must<br />

be used carefully to promote learning. Also, despite advances in our development of pedagogical approaches that<br />

promote conceptual change (see Linn, 1992, Slotta and Chi, 1997), <strong>the</strong> majority of middle school and high school<br />

science teachers still employ more traditional approaches to teaching science. (Poole and Page, 1996) Thus, teacher<br />

professional development has emerged as an essential component of our research in <strong>the</strong> WISE project. In order to<br />

support teachers with powerful instructional technologies, we must help <strong>the</strong>m gain new understandings about<br />

effective curriculum activities and classroom practices.<br />

This challenge has provided us with <strong>the</strong> incentive and opportunity to research effective approaches to<br />

professional development that empower teachers with new ideas and approaches. We designed an on-line<br />

community to help teachers learn about <strong>the</strong> WISE pedagogy and technology as <strong>the</strong>y prepared to use it in <strong>the</strong>ir own<br />

classrooms. This community was designed as a self-sustaining professional development resource <strong>for</strong> its members,<br />

who continue <strong>the</strong>ir interactions during and after <strong>the</strong> school year. It has also served as a research tool, enabling us to<br />

understand teachers' initial ideas about using <strong>the</strong> Internet in <strong>the</strong>ir classrooms, as well as <strong>the</strong> effectiveness of our<br />

materials and approaches. Our professional development curriculum is delivered via <strong>the</strong> Internet, by means of this<br />

WISE on-line community, and consists of <strong>the</strong> following three components:<br />

(1) The WISE Teacher NetCourse that scaffolds teachers as <strong>the</strong>y gain understanding of our pedagogical<br />

framework, known as Scaffolded Knowledge Integration. The NetCourse is delivered in <strong>the</strong> <strong>for</strong>m of a WISE<br />

Curriculum Project (Figure 1) where teachers learn about our technology and approaches by actually using it.<br />

(2) Teachers join <strong>the</strong> WISE On-line Community where <strong>the</strong>y receive feedback and support from o<strong>the</strong>r teachers as<br />

well as from WISE on-line mentors. The community supports electronic discussions (Figure 2) to help<br />

teachers in <strong>the</strong>ir own process of knowledge integration, as <strong>the</strong>y explore new ideas about professional practice.<br />

We have applied our framework of scaffolded knowledge integration in designing <strong>the</strong> materials <strong>for</strong> this<br />

community – seeking to connect to all teachers’ ideas and support <strong>the</strong>ir creation of personal understanding<br />

(3) WISE Project Forums have been developed to help teachers succeed in using specific WISE Curriculum<br />

Projects in <strong>the</strong>ir classroom. Each Project Forum includes a wide array of specific supports to help teachers<br />

succeed. For <strong>the</strong> WISE De<strong>for</strong>med Frogs Project, shown in Figure 2, we provide links to a demo of <strong>the</strong><br />

curriculum, explicit lesson plans and example student work, electronic discussions about how to help students<br />

succeed with <strong>the</strong> project, and <strong>the</strong> WISE classroom management tools (e.g., <strong>for</strong> assessment and student work).<br />

Figure 1. WISE Teacher NetCourse<br />

Figue 2. On-line discussions within <strong>the</strong> community


Issues In The Design, Development And Implementation Of An<br />

Alternative Delivery Format Master's Degree In Instructional<br />

Technology<br />

Michael Szabo, Ph.D., Forum Organizer, University of Alberta<br />

mike.szab@ualberta.ca<br />

Craig Montgomerie, Ph.D., University of Alberta<br />

craig.montgomerie@ualberta.ca<br />

David Mappin, Ph.D., University of Alberta<br />

david.mappin@ualberta.ca<br />

Annette Fuchs, M.Ed., University of Alberta<br />

<br />

Edmonton, AB Canada<br />

Overview<br />

The purpose of this <strong>for</strong>um is to describe <strong>the</strong> process, issues and some solutions encountered in<br />

converting a university-based Masters Degree in Instructional Technology to an alternate delivery <strong>for</strong>mat<br />

(ADF). Beginning in 1994, courses in this degree program have been converted to one or more ADFs. By<br />

<strong>the</strong> summer of <strong>1999</strong>, <strong>the</strong> core courses in <strong>the</strong> program will be available in ADF <strong>for</strong>mat and have been piloted<br />

at least once.<br />

The team involved in <strong>the</strong> conversion has wrestled with numerous issues that will be discussed during<br />

<strong>the</strong> <strong>for</strong>um. Some of <strong>the</strong> issues are:<br />

• What are ADFs and which are useful <strong>for</strong> our purpose<br />

• To what extent should <strong>the</strong> entirety of <strong>the</strong> courses be placed in ADF<br />

• How do we deal with conveying expert's knowledge via ADF<br />

• How do students obtain access to <strong>the</strong> resources needed to complete <strong>the</strong> courses<br />

• What data should be tracked and how will it be tracked<br />

• What issues arise from building a non-conventional degree in a conventional, research-oriented<br />

university<br />

• What is <strong>the</strong> reaction of students, who are by and large majoring in instructional technology<br />

• How does one build an infrastructure to promote ADF courses and degrees<br />

• What is <strong>the</strong> role of face to face (F2F) instruction in ADF<br />

• What is <strong>the</strong> return on investment on course development <strong>for</strong> ADF<br />

• What skills are crucial to successful development What is <strong>the</strong> role of a design team<br />

It is expected that o<strong>the</strong>rs at <strong>ED</strong>M<strong>ED</strong>IA 99 are grappling with similar issues and would appreciate<br />

hearing how one institution deals with <strong>the</strong>m, discussing <strong>the</strong>ir particular situation with respect to ADFs,<br />

providing feedback to <strong>the</strong> <strong>for</strong>um leaders and networking with o<strong>the</strong>rs at <strong>the</strong> conference about <strong>the</strong>se issues.<br />

Background<br />

The University of Alberta has been a leader in <strong>the</strong> field of Computer-Based Instruction since it acquired an<br />

IBM 1500 System in <strong>the</strong> middle 1960s. The leadership continued when <strong>the</strong> 1500 system was replaced by a<br />

PLATO system, later to be replaced by micros, videodisc, CDs, LANs, WANs, <strong>the</strong> Internet and most<br />

recently <strong>the</strong> WWW. Many of <strong>the</strong> faculty members who participated in <strong>the</strong>se early systems now <strong>for</strong>m <strong>the</strong><br />

core of <strong>the</strong> graduate program in Instructional Technology (IT).<br />

Throughout that period, extensive research and development on many phases of CBI were carried out.<br />

This work could not have been done without <strong>the</strong> extensive participation of graduate students, many of<br />

whom have continued and excelled in <strong>the</strong> field (e.g., Donald Tapscott, M.Ed. 1978; Greg Kearsley, Ph.D.<br />

1978). In<strong>for</strong>mal masters and doctoral degree programs arose within <strong>the</strong> Department of Educational<br />

Psychology to accommodate <strong>the</strong>se students.


In 1978, <strong>the</strong> University <strong>for</strong>malized its Masters degree in Instructional Technology by officially<br />

establishing it within <strong>the</strong> Faculty of Education. Due to a number of factors, such as budgets, changes in<br />

organizational structure, and individual personalities, a '<strong>for</strong>mal' Ph.D. program was not initiated until 1998<br />

with <strong>the</strong> admission of four doctoral students into <strong>the</strong> Basic Area of Educational Psychology.<br />

Events in <strong>the</strong> past several years have provided impetus to explore ADFs <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> Masters degree. These<br />

include a recent mandate by <strong>the</strong> provincial government to increase access <strong>for</strong> our programs to more<br />

students, both on and off campus, increased levels of funding, and a growing recognition by <strong>the</strong><br />

administration of <strong>the</strong> potential of ADF.<br />

A Brief History of ADF in <strong>the</strong> Department of Educational Psychology<br />

Statistics<br />

While <strong>the</strong> course in introductory statistics is not a specific IT course per se, it is a required research course.<br />

Historically, <strong>the</strong> course was originally developed in <strong>the</strong> early 1960s <strong>for</strong> delivery on <strong>the</strong> IBM 1500 system.<br />

Budget cuts in <strong>the</strong> early 1990s suggested a reduction in courses across <strong>the</strong> Faculty, including <strong>the</strong> statistics<br />

courses. The complete 3 credit graduate course was resurrected, polished, updated, and reconstructed using<br />

Authorware. It is delivered via CD-ROM with a unique twist. All student data tracking is done via <strong>the</strong><br />

WWW, meaning of course that delivery can take place anywhere in <strong>the</strong> world. There is even a facility to<br />

update <strong>the</strong> user with any modules that have been changed since <strong>the</strong> CD was shipped.<br />

Introduction to WWW<br />

Around 1996, and ef<strong>for</strong>t was made by Professor Montgomerie and graduate student to develop a course<br />

whose content is <strong>the</strong> Internet and <strong>the</strong> WWW and to deliver <strong>the</strong> course on <strong>the</strong> WWW. This course 'broke <strong>the</strong><br />

ice' and encouraged o<strong>the</strong>rs to participate. At <strong>the</strong> same time, <strong>the</strong> Faculty decided to follow <strong>the</strong><br />

recommendation to bring <strong>the</strong> main IT players toge<strong>the</strong>r in <strong>the</strong> same office area, regardless of home<br />

departmental affiliation.<br />

Additional Key Developments<br />

In 1997, a <strong>for</strong>mal reconfiguration of <strong>the</strong> Masters program was undertaken. In 1997, work began on<br />

developing <strong>the</strong> course on <strong>ED</strong>IT 571, Introduction to Educational Technology and Communication <strong>for</strong> webbased<br />

delivery, which we call Web-Based Instruction (WBI). This course, as well as two undergraduate<br />

courses in IT were funded in part by <strong>the</strong> University and in part by a special funding mechanism established<br />

by <strong>the</strong> provincial government to stimulate increased access to education on <strong>the</strong> part of <strong>the</strong> citizens of <strong>the</strong><br />

province.<br />

In 1998, partial funding was received to create three more core courses in <strong>the</strong> Masters in IT program;<br />

<strong>ED</strong>IT 568, 572 and 573. These courses have been developed and piloted at least once at <strong>the</strong> time of this<br />

writing.<br />

Issues Considered Along <strong>the</strong> Way<br />

This <strong>for</strong>um will provide insight into some of <strong>the</strong> issues listed below along with opportunity <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> audience<br />

to discuss and network.<br />

What are ADFs and which are useful <strong>for</strong> our purpose<br />

There are numerous applications and variations of <strong>the</strong> term ADFs. In general, we mean any instructional<br />

alternative to conventional lecture-seminar <strong>for</strong>mat. In contrast, distributed education means delivery to<br />

both on and off-campus students. Should <strong>the</strong> course <strong>for</strong>mats be different <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong>se two groups Given that<br />

<strong>the</strong> Masters degree uses <strong>the</strong> content of IT, both <strong>the</strong> content and <strong>the</strong> methodology need to be discussed,<br />

demonstrated and practiced.<br />

To what extent should <strong>the</strong> entirety of <strong>the</strong> courses be placed in ADF<br />

What is gained and what is lost by moving entire courses to ADF What is <strong>the</strong> role of F2F in <strong>the</strong> delivery<br />

of instruction Given that <strong>the</strong>re will be an on-campus group as well as an off-campus group, how should<br />

any differences in opportunities be resolved Should all learning activities be placed in ADF, <strong>for</strong> example,<br />

does <strong>the</strong> technology allow <strong>for</strong> effective dialogue and debate<br />

2


How do we deal with conveying expert's knowledge via ADF<br />

A particular problem we face is that most of our IT faculty have lived through <strong>the</strong> days of CBI and have a<br />

wealth of experience and scars to show <strong>for</strong> it. Can we convey that experience in ADF Conveying<br />

experience is important but not <strong>the</strong> only factor. Focussing on early approaches to Computer Based<br />

Instruction, <strong>for</strong> example, can detract from <strong>the</strong> differences and emphasis in <strong>the</strong> new work on computer based<br />

learning environments, constructivism, situated learning, and so <strong>for</strong>th. Fur<strong>the</strong>rmore, what design should be<br />

chosen There is <strong>the</strong> issue of student choice over knowledge of essential content, as judged by <strong>the</strong><br />

connisseur professor. How are <strong>the</strong> disagreements within <strong>the</strong> group about what essential content should be<br />

handled<br />

How do students obtain access to <strong>the</strong> resources needed to complete <strong>the</strong> courses<br />

A course which requires only reading material has a slight advantage over IT courses, which require that<br />

students have access to some of <strong>the</strong> latest, most powerful and expensive hardware and software, such as<br />

Authorware, NT Servers, and so <strong>for</strong>th. How is this equipment to be provided in ADF This raises issues<br />

related to <strong>the</strong> choice of technologies, such as WWW, synchronous audio or videoconferencing, mailed CD-<br />

ROMS, videotape, and fax.<br />

What data should be tracked and how will it be tracked<br />

Per<strong>for</strong>mance and communication data can be delivered easily on <strong>the</strong> WWW but systems to track and make<br />

use of that data are still somewhat primitive and difficult or time-consuming to construct in terms of<br />

programming, database access, and so <strong>for</strong>th. What should be tracked is an interesting question particularly<br />

if assignments are made where assessment by judgements made on analysis and writing are deemed<br />

important.<br />

What issues arise from building a non-conventional degree in a conventional, research-oriented<br />

university<br />

Promotion, tenure, and <strong>the</strong> occasional deafening lack of interest are but many of <strong>the</strong> issues to be faced in<br />

this category. As members of <strong>the</strong> Education Faculty, we are privileged that our research and course<br />

development activities can coincide. What has been <strong>the</strong> experience of some of our colleagues and what<br />

changes seem to be in <strong>the</strong> future<br />

What is <strong>the</strong> reaction of students, who are by and large majoring in instructional technology<br />

Student involvement in building ADF-courses and <strong>the</strong>ir reaction are always important issues. They are<br />

particularly crucial when <strong>the</strong> students are studying IT as opposed to studying o<strong>the</strong>r content domains using<br />

IT.<br />

How does one build an infrastructure to promote ADF courses and degrees<br />

ADF courses imply a certain infrastructure to develop and maintain. These include not only hardware,<br />

software and telecommunications, but support, encouragement, and active participation by administration.<br />

There is also <strong>the</strong> issue of providing an example to o<strong>the</strong>r departments and faculties, such as Adult and<br />

Higher Education, Library, and <strong>the</strong> creation of a generic M.Ed. program.<br />

What is <strong>the</strong> role of face to face (F2F) instruction in ADF<br />

Is F2F instruction required in all situations Where can it be optimized and where can it be dispensed<br />

with Is <strong>the</strong>re a body of evidence that argues <strong>for</strong> or against effectiveness, efficiency and optimality of<br />

learning with or without F2F Does it take more work to teach a course with significant group and<br />

Computer Mediated Communication components A related issue is <strong>the</strong> conflict with <strong>the</strong> potential of ADF<br />

and <strong>the</strong> mental models held by many current university instructors. Communication difficulties tend to be<br />

amplified and take longer to resolve, particularly where asynchronous communication is involved. This<br />

may be a trade off <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> inability of an instructor to address individual questions in a large class of more<br />

than 25 students.<br />

What is <strong>the</strong> return on investment on course development <strong>for</strong> ADF<br />

Most educational institutions view ADF as a cost, and an add-on cost at that, without considering ei<strong>the</strong>r <strong>the</strong><br />

return on <strong>the</strong> investment or <strong>the</strong> cost of not implementing ADF. There are often to erroneous cost<br />

3


comparisons to conventional instruction where not all <strong>the</strong> costs are considered or calculated properly. The<br />

presenters will provide data on development in one of <strong>the</strong> current courses in <strong>the</strong> M.Ed.<br />

What skills are crucial to successful development What is <strong>the</strong> role of a design team<br />

A sampling of skills would include instructional design, experience with ADF in its wide ranging <strong>for</strong>mats,<br />

knowledge of strengths and weaknesses of interactive instructional media, project management, evaluation,<br />

content and political astuteness. Large scale ef<strong>for</strong>ts require a team of individuals who can execute <strong>the</strong>se<br />

skills and solve disagreements without resorting to fist fights!<br />

O<strong>the</strong>r issues<br />

How do students learn <strong>the</strong> needed skills <strong>for</strong> ADF which <strong>the</strong>y do not possess How does one handle <strong>the</strong><br />

purchase and distribution of books, software and o<strong>the</strong>r learning resources What minimum system<br />

configuration is required and what are <strong>the</strong> implications <strong>for</strong> course design How good is good enough<br />

related to costs of development What is <strong>the</strong> price of effectiveness over efficiency How does one resolve<br />

myriad infrastructure issues when implementing ADF in an institution which has been designed <strong>for</strong> on<br />

campus and F-2-F learning What are some of <strong>the</strong> issues in moving to global deliver, such as<br />

telecommunications, acceptance of <strong>for</strong>eign credentials <strong>for</strong> admission and differences in culture, language<br />

and educational systems<br />

Forum Presenters<br />

The <strong>for</strong>um organizer, Professor Michael Szabo, has been centrally involved in ADFs since 1970 and<br />

designed <strong>the</strong> original Masters degree in IT at <strong>the</strong> University of Alberta. Discussants include Professor<br />

Craig Montgomerie, Professor of Educational Psychology and Policy Studies, Professor David Mappin,<br />

Professor of Educational Psychology and Policy Studies. Michael, David and Craig have been involved in<br />

<strong>the</strong> field of IT since <strong>the</strong> 1960s'; have authored hundreds of papers and articles in <strong>the</strong> field; directed major<br />

CBI research, development and evaluation projects; worked on mainframe, mini and micro CBI systems;<br />

and consulted internationally. Annette Fuchs, Research Assistant has been involved in <strong>the</strong> development<br />

and validation of many of <strong>the</strong> courses. She completed <strong>the</strong> Masters in IT in 1998 and is now pursuing <strong>the</strong><br />

Ph.D. degree.<br />

Relevant Links<br />

The courses under discussion can be examined through this link:<br />

http://www.quasar.ualberta.ca/IT/<br />

A short list of publications by members of <strong>the</strong> <strong>for</strong>um can be examined at:<br />

http://www.quasar.ualberta.ca/IT/research/<br />

4


Support offered User Per<strong>for</strong>mance Speed, Memory, Ef<strong>for</strong>t, and Com<strong>for</strong>t by<br />

Package Features<br />

Jennifer D.E. Thomas, Ph.D., Associate Professor<br />

Pace University, 1 Pace Plaza, N.Y., N.Y. 10038<br />

Email: jthomas@pace.edu<br />

It is suggested that ease of use of a package may be evaluated as a function of <strong>the</strong> support which design and<br />

assistance features offer user per<strong>for</strong>mance speed, memory, ef<strong>for</strong>t and com<strong>for</strong>t. Features provided in software which<br />

are believed to alleviate <strong>the</strong> human shortcoming of limited memory capacity include databases, macros, menu<br />

structures, mnemonics, icons and templates. Macros, commands to bypass menu structures and shallow menus are<br />

all features designed to minimize <strong>the</strong> user's ef<strong>for</strong>t. Shallow menu structures and commands have been found to be<br />

faster than deep structures as have menus redesigned according to frequency of use. Use of natural language<br />

systems may or may not require <strong>the</strong> same amount of time to use and yet be considered more com<strong>for</strong>table than o<strong>the</strong>r<br />

interaction methods. Text size and placement, use of figures, graphics, color, sound, highlighting, etc. are all<br />

features which contribute to <strong>the</strong> appeal of <strong>the</strong> package. Also, conceptual models provided by <strong>the</strong> system or<br />

developed by <strong>the</strong> user have also been found beneficial to <strong>the</strong> user. A package will be easier to use and learn when<br />

support of <strong>the</strong>se factors by packaage features is greater. In this paper, <strong>the</strong> support <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong>se factors are examined in<br />

<strong>the</strong> Human Factors and Learning literatures, relative to specific package design and assistance features.<br />

Page 1 of


Multimedia Cases in Teacher Education: Towards a Constructivist<br />

Learning Environment<br />

Ellen van den Berg<br />

University of Twente<br />

P.O. Box 217<br />

7500 AE Enschede<br />

The Ne<strong>the</strong>rlands<br />

berg@edte.utwente.nl<br />

Introduction<br />

This paper is about <strong>the</strong> integration of multimedia cases in elementary science teacher education.<br />

These cases have been developed within <strong>the</strong> framework of <strong>the</strong> MUST-project (MUltimedia in Science &<br />

Technology). The MUST-project is a joint venture on behalf of three Teacher Education Colleges, <strong>the</strong> National<br />

Institute <strong>for</strong> Curriculum Development and <strong>the</strong> University of Twente in <strong>the</strong> Ne<strong>the</strong>rlands. The project aims at<br />

developing multimedia cases <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> professional development of prospective teachers in elementary science<br />

and technology education. In <strong>the</strong> first project year two working prototypes on CD-ROM were developed.<br />

During this year <strong>the</strong> MUST-team became increasingly aware of <strong>the</strong> significance of <strong>the</strong> implementation of<br />

multimedia cases in teacher education programs. This paper ends with <strong>the</strong> notion of flexibility-in-use that in<br />

our opinion is a promising way to reconcile <strong>the</strong> voice of <strong>the</strong>ory and <strong>the</strong> voice of practice.<br />

Multimedia cases and a constructivist learning environment<br />

In this section <strong>the</strong> design of <strong>the</strong> MUST multimedia cases are described according to principles <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong><br />

design of constructivist learning environments (cf. Honebein, 1995). This description is not limited to <strong>the</strong><br />

cases <strong>the</strong>mselves, but, if appropriate, also <strong>the</strong> broader scope of teacher education programs is taken into<br />

account.<br />

Embed learning in a realistic and relevant context<br />

Non-scripted edited video of (an) elementary science lesson(s) <strong>for</strong>ms <strong>the</strong> core of every MUST-case.<br />

These video clips are both a realistic and relevant context <strong>for</strong> prospective teachers. The clips are edited in a<br />

way that <strong>the</strong>y provide ample opportunity <strong>for</strong> practising analysis and contemplate action (cf. Merseth, 1996).<br />

So, <strong>the</strong>y are not meant to follow uncritically. On <strong>the</strong> contrary <strong>the</strong>y intend to stimulate reflective thought and<br />

communication. These activities are also supported by assignments in which prospective teachers are<br />

encouraged to analyse <strong>the</strong> video from different perspectives and use <strong>the</strong>se knowledge constructions in planning<br />

and implementing elementary science lessons <strong>the</strong>mselves.<br />

Different perspectives and multiple modes of representation<br />

The MUST CD-ROMS include comments on <strong>the</strong> lesson by <strong>the</strong> video-teacher, experts, and prospective<br />

teachers. So, students are provided with experiences from different perspectives. However, <strong>the</strong>re is some<br />

controversy among specialists in case-based instruction about whe<strong>the</strong>r or not to include experts’ comments into<br />

a case. For instance, Merseth (1996) thinks those comments may inhibit <strong>the</strong> construction of knowledge by<br />

novices. When novices have read what "experts" say about <strong>the</strong> case, <strong>the</strong>y may tend to abandon or suspend <strong>the</strong>ir


own beliefs in favor of <strong>the</strong> "delivered wisdom" (p. 733). On <strong>the</strong> o<strong>the</strong>r hand, Shulman (1992) argues that, <strong>for</strong><br />

example, experts’ comments provide additional perspectives or lenses through which to view <strong>the</strong> events of <strong>the</strong><br />

case. So, <strong>the</strong>y add complexity and richness that gloss ra<strong>the</strong>r than simplifying or trivializing <strong>the</strong> events (p. 12).<br />

In <strong>the</strong> MUST-project <strong>the</strong> use of multiple modes of representation has been applied in different ways. Firstly,<br />

<strong>the</strong> earlier mentioned edited non-scripted videotapes and audio comments on <strong>the</strong> video represent science<br />

lessons in elementary classrooms in different modes. Moreover, o<strong>the</strong>r modes of representation are depicted by<br />

all kinds of textual in<strong>for</strong>mation.<br />

Ownership an voice in <strong>the</strong> learning process<br />

A third design principle is to warrant ownership and voice in <strong>the</strong> learning process by prospective<br />

teachers. This implies that <strong>the</strong>y are encouraged to reflect on <strong>the</strong>ir knowledge construction processes and take<br />

responsibility <strong>for</strong> setting learning goals and pursue learning processes. In <strong>the</strong> design of <strong>the</strong> CD-ROMS of <strong>the</strong><br />

MUST cases this principle has been applied by constructing an open non-linear interface. A second, and more<br />

important, way to account <strong>for</strong> this design principle is to <strong>for</strong>mulate assignments that have an open character and<br />

stimulate <strong>the</strong> users to reflect on <strong>the</strong>ir learning processes.<br />

The voice of practise: teacher educators<br />

Especially <strong>the</strong> four teacher educators in <strong>the</strong> MUST-team refer repeatedly to <strong>the</strong> issue, that students are<br />

not familiar with working in a constructivist learning environment. The teacher educators question how much<br />

responsibility <strong>the</strong>ir students may handle. Moreover, <strong>the</strong>y are worried about <strong>the</strong>ir role both in terms of <strong>the</strong>ir<br />

responsibility and in terms of practical implications. The <strong>for</strong>mer point may be illustrated by a remark of one of<br />

<strong>the</strong> teacher educators: she stated that it is her responsibility to do her utmost that students will reach <strong>the</strong><br />

predefined learning objectives, so she wants to implement one of <strong>the</strong> multimedia cases in a ra<strong>the</strong>r traditional<br />

setting. This setting consists of a science method course, which is assessed by a uni<strong>for</strong>m test <strong>for</strong> all students.<br />

The latter point consists of concerns of teacher educators to assign all different types of more open assignments,<br />

such as portfolios. Or as one of <strong>the</strong>m <strong>for</strong>mulated it: For time reasons it is simply impossible <strong>for</strong> me to grade all<br />

<strong>the</strong>se assignments.<br />

Conclusions: towards flexibility-in-use<br />

In this paper a dilemma is sketched between <strong>the</strong> ideal of multimedia cases in a constructivist learning<br />

environment and <strong>the</strong> reality of teachers and students in teacher education programs. In order to overcome this<br />

dilemma, <strong>the</strong> MUST project introduced <strong>the</strong> notion of flexibility-in-use. This notion implies that, especially,<br />

teacher educators have a considerable freedom in <strong>the</strong> way <strong>the</strong>y want to use <strong>the</strong> multimedia cases, because from<br />

an implementation perspective it is nei<strong>the</strong>r possible nor desirable to impose a change in practice on teacher<br />

educators. By doing so, we take <strong>the</strong> warning of Louden and Wallace (1994) seriously. They warn re<strong>for</strong>mers<br />

not to fall into <strong>the</strong> trap of <strong>the</strong> constructivist paradox. This means that re<strong>for</strong>mers press teachers to make <strong>the</strong><br />

trans<strong>for</strong>mation from conventional to constructivist practise in a single step. We opt <strong>for</strong> a more realistic re<strong>for</strong>m<br />

agenda in which learning to teach with multimedia cases is perceived as a process of gradual re<strong>for</strong>mation and<br />

elaboration of teacher educators' established patterns of teaching.<br />

References<br />

Honebein, P.C. (1996). Seven goals <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> design of constructivist learning environments. In B.G. Wilson<br />

(Ed.), Constructivist learning environments (pp. 11-24). Englewood Cliffs: Educational Technology<br />

Publications.


Merseth, K.K. (1996). Cases and case methods in teacher education. In J. Sikula (Ed.), Handbook of research<br />

on teacher education (pp. 722-746). New York: Macmillan.


Building Online learning Communities <strong>for</strong> Teaching and<br />

Learning,which integrate Online Multi Media.<br />

Tony van der Kuyl<br />

University of Edinburgh<br />

Scotland<br />

James O'Brien<br />

University of Edinburgh<br />

Scotland<br />

Introduction<br />

Those who teach must espouse and exemplify in all <strong>the</strong>ir activities those values which will underpin professional<br />

life, given International, National and local technology initiatives(see Appendix 1 <strong>for</strong> Scottish initiatives) which in<br />

<strong>the</strong> next 36 months will rapidly develop <strong>the</strong> role of ICT in all areas of <strong>the</strong> profession and learning and teaching, it is<br />

essential that <strong>the</strong> teachers and <strong>the</strong>ir institutions develop strategies which begin to build on-line staff and student<br />

learning communities. These initiatives will enhance <strong>the</strong> quality of teaching and learning in class and lecture rooms,<br />

and provide a teaching environment where many of <strong>the</strong> new competencies required by new millenia educators in <strong>the</strong><br />

use of ICT can be exemplified through <strong>the</strong>ir own teaching and learning process.


Using Multimedia to support mentors<br />

Simon Walker<br />

University of Greenwich<br />

United Kingdom<br />

Abstract: This paper reports on <strong>the</strong> development of a new system <strong>for</strong> training mentors of student<br />

teachers in Post Compulsory Education & Training (PCET) by a team of educational practitioners<br />

at <strong>the</strong> University of Greenwich with little previous experience in multimedia development. It's<br />

rationale is discussed in <strong>the</strong> light of <strong>the</strong> difficulties of providing training and support. A solution is<br />

proposed with regard to Dearing's National Committee of Inquiry (1997) into Higher Education in<br />

<strong>the</strong> UK, which states that, in cases where o<strong>the</strong>r methods have failed, improvements in motivation<br />

and understanding may occur through <strong>the</strong> use of new technology. The system combines <strong>the</strong><br />

development of an Interactive Multimedia Learning Environment (IMLE) with an On-Line campus.<br />

The prototype is discussed and issues of design heuristics are raised.<br />

Context<br />

The Post Graduate Certificate of Education programme <strong>for</strong> pre-service full-time students is taught jointly by staff at<br />

<strong>the</strong> University of Greenwich and by staff in <strong>the</strong>ir own institutions throughout <strong>the</strong> student teacher's work experience.<br />

The programme is delivered over a single academic year. Between 250 - 350 students each year are taken on and are<br />

trained to be teachers in a variety of academic and vocational subjects. Each student teacher is supported by a<br />

subject mentor in a range of culturally and geographically diverse PCET institutions. The mentor has two basic<br />

generic tasks encompassing a range of subsidiary roles that need to be per<strong>for</strong>med. Firstly, <strong>the</strong> mentor organises<br />

appropriate teaching experiences and secondly, <strong>the</strong> mentor supports <strong>the</strong> student teacher's professional development<br />

in teaching <strong>the</strong>ir subject areas. The mentor's ability to respond to <strong>the</strong> student teacher's professional development<br />

hinges on <strong>the</strong>ir own understanding of <strong>the</strong> relationship between <strong>the</strong> knowledge, skills and processes of mentoring and<br />

<strong>the</strong> support provided by <strong>the</strong> University <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong>m in this role.<br />

Following research conducted by questionnaire with 10 university tutors and 117 student teachers, a number of<br />

factors were identified as affecting <strong>the</strong> quality of mentor training.<br />

(a) Diminishing resources resulted in a lack of time <strong>for</strong> any sustained level of support <strong>for</strong> training <strong>the</strong> mentors.<br />

(b) The difficulty of arranging F2F meetings because of issues of physical distance and/or clashes with timetables.<br />

Research was also conducted with 36 subject mentors to confirm <strong>the</strong> acceptability and content of using an ITC<br />

system <strong>for</strong> supporting <strong>the</strong>m in this role.<br />

A proposal to develop interactive multimedia using hybrid CD ROM technology was supported jointly by <strong>the</strong><br />

School of PCET and Academic Development Group at <strong>the</strong> University of Greenwich. It was seen as a possible<br />

solution to <strong>the</strong> above problems <strong>for</strong> a number of reasons:<br />

• interactive multimedia environments may extend <strong>the</strong> setting and amplify opportunities <strong>for</strong> learning in a dynamic<br />

way<br />

• CD-ROM technology is relatively inexpensive and allows <strong>the</strong> storage of large amounts of (non-editable)<br />

interactive support material<br />

• by using <strong>the</strong> potential of hybrid CD-ROM, <strong>the</strong> integration of web browsers with embedded links makes<br />

communication with an On-Line Campus with dedicated sites <strong>for</strong> supporting mentors possible.<br />

Design heuristics<br />

Learning how to develop and produce interactive multimedia involved a significant learning curve. For many of us,<br />

<strong>the</strong> greatest educational technological development over <strong>the</strong> last fifty years has been <strong>the</strong> Overhead Projector. Unless


we are able, as educationalists, to harness <strong>the</strong> new technology we may be missing out on <strong>the</strong> ability to provide<br />

significant opportunities <strong>for</strong> our learners (Dearing,1997; Higginson,1996). A team was set-up comprising a project<br />

manager and a number of consultants who evaluate content, design and production and assist with On-Line Campus<br />

IT support. We considered a number of principles and values to influence <strong>the</strong> design and production process:<br />

(a) Content is in<strong>for</strong>med by primary and secondary research.<br />

(b) A contemporary approach to learning is taken<br />

(c) Metaphor is used to develop interface design<br />

(d) An iterative design process (development - testing with end users - development) is used to ensure accessibility<br />

and user-friendliness.<br />

(a) Research.<br />

Mentoring is an evolving field of research. It was critical to combine an understanding of current good practice and<br />

link this with our own local research carried out in our particular context. For example, interactive learning contracts<br />

were constructed in response to <strong>the</strong> local view, held by student teachers, which confirmed <strong>the</strong>ir beneficial use.<br />

Student teachers also reported, <strong>for</strong> example, on <strong>the</strong> value of well-managed first meetings. Interactive approaches<br />

were devised to assist mentors to manage time and environment issues <strong>for</strong> first meetings. Sound bites and video<br />

clips of some of our student teacher's experiences are used to provide au<strong>the</strong>nticity and context.<br />

(b) Constructivist principles of learning<br />

We chose to reject traditional instructional design favoured by much training material, which tends to rely on <strong>the</strong><br />

circulation of existing knowledge (Boyle 1998). Instead we favoured <strong>the</strong> use of Constructivist principles of learning;<br />

design strategies are considered which engage <strong>the</strong> user in <strong>the</strong>ir own construction of knowledge - <strong>the</strong> production of<br />

knowledgeability ra<strong>the</strong>r than <strong>the</strong> reproduction of knowledge (Guile & Young 1997). For example, users are<br />

encouraged to prioritise emotional events, create lists and agendas <strong>for</strong> meetings, identify and analyse needs, select<br />

and structure <strong>the</strong> content and derive <strong>the</strong>ir own understanding through problem solving. These activities are<br />

supported by a system of scaffolding that uses resources like prompts and hints as tools to help mentors reflect on<br />

<strong>the</strong>ir understanding and progress. The use of <strong>the</strong> resources and <strong>the</strong> results of interactions permit <strong>the</strong> user to construct<br />

<strong>the</strong>ir own understanding. This is fur<strong>the</strong>r developed by links to <strong>the</strong> On-Line Campus, (using Lotus Notes as <strong>the</strong><br />

medium) which provide <strong>the</strong> mentors with <strong>the</strong> opportunities to `problemitize' <strong>the</strong>ir role and share <strong>the</strong>ir ideas,<br />

confidentially, through conferencing with o<strong>the</strong>r mentors and tutors. The aim is to create distributed networks of<br />

knowledge and a `virtual' mentor community<br />

(c) The physical nature of <strong>the</strong> environment.<br />

A major dilemma that faced us was how to physically combine an effective interface with an appropriate structure.<br />

This represents <strong>the</strong> major factor governing <strong>the</strong> continued use of <strong>the</strong> environment. Metaphor is a powerful tool <strong>for</strong><br />

developing content, structure and navigation and our first task was to evaluate <strong>the</strong> use of metaphors in o<strong>the</strong>r<br />

interactive multimedia learning environments. Many used a <strong>for</strong>mal hierarchical structure based upon domain<br />

knowledge. We felt that a functional, minimalist approach (Carroll 1990) would be more effective in appealing to<br />

mentor / teachers who are busy people and need to engage with in<strong>for</strong>mation quickly on a need to know basis. The<br />

main navigational device that has been developed is a time-line which links content with hints of when to best learn<br />

processes and per<strong>for</strong>m activities. An overview permits <strong>the</strong> mentor to catch up on missed in<strong>for</strong>mation and to better<br />

manage <strong>the</strong>ir mentor tasks. Although <strong>the</strong> roots of mentoring lie in <strong>the</strong> notion of apprenticeship, its origin is located<br />

in Greek mythology. This provided a useful visual metaphor that is used in <strong>the</strong> interface.<br />

(d) Evaluation.<br />

Mentors, tutors and trainee teachers evaluate <strong>the</strong> software as it is developed. We use criteria such as clarity,<br />

interactivity, richness and accessibility. We consider iterative prototyping to be highly effective as a means to<br />

development. We have found that <strong>the</strong> semi-structured interview, questionnaire and videoing users in action are very<br />

useful tools that provide instructive feedback - critical to <strong>the</strong> development process. The development of IMLEs is<br />

similar to a construction site - a slow process of initial design, implementing plans, building structures, wea<strong>the</strong>ring<br />

storms & putting right mistakes. We have made necessary alterations to <strong>the</strong> navigational devices used, <strong>the</strong> number<br />

and range of elements, <strong>the</strong> structuring of content and use of metaphor towards <strong>the</strong> refinement of <strong>the</strong> product.


Conclusion<br />

The project is still under construction, however initial evaluations have suggested that Dearing's conclusion<br />

regarding <strong>the</strong> use of Communications and In<strong>for</strong>mation technology might provide a basis <strong>for</strong> (a) improving <strong>the</strong><br />

quality of professional mentoring in <strong>the</strong> workplace and (b) an investigation into <strong>the</strong> effectiveness of using hybrid<br />

CD-ROM technology to establish virtual communities.<br />

Bibliography<br />

Boyle T. (1997) Design <strong>for</strong> Multimedia Learning. Prentice Hall<br />

Carroll, J.M. (1990) The Nurnberg funnel; designing Minimalist Instruction <strong>for</strong> practical computer skill. MIT Press<br />

Guile & Young (1998) Journal of Education and Training Vol .50, No 2<br />

Dearing (1997) National Inquiry into Higher Education. HMSO<br />

Report of <strong>the</strong> FEFC Learning and Technology Committee (Higginson Report) (1996) FEFC


Using Multimedia to support mentors<br />

Simon Walker<br />

University of Greenwich<br />

United Kingdom<br />

This poster session will demonstrate <strong>the</strong> work in progress of an interactive multimedia learning environment (IMLE)<br />

<strong>for</strong> training mentors of student teachers in Post Compulsory Education & Training. The system combines interactive<br />

multimedia with an On-Line campus linked to <strong>the</strong> University of Greenwich’s home page with dedicated mentor<br />

conference areas.<br />

A functional, minimalist approach is used <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> structure and interface. The main navigational device is a timeline<br />

which links content with hints of when to best learn processes and per<strong>for</strong>m activities. This functional device<br />

also permits <strong>the</strong> mentor to catch up on missed in<strong>for</strong>mation and to better manage <strong>the</strong>ir mentor tasks. The content has<br />

been in<strong>for</strong>med by local research with mentors and student teachers. Although <strong>the</strong> roots of mentoring lie in <strong>the</strong><br />

notion of apprenticeship, its origin is located in Greek mythology. This provides a useful visual metaphor <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong><br />

interface.<br />

Topics <strong>for</strong> discussion may focus on:<br />

- <strong>the</strong> transferability and adaptation of ‘interactive modules’ to capitalize on economies of scale<br />

- <strong>the</strong> development of virtual communities<br />

- user-friendliness


An Investigation into Faculty Attitudes Regarding<br />

Distance Learning Instruction<br />

Dr. Gail West, College of Education,<br />

University of Central Florida, gwest@pegasus.cc.ucf.edu<br />

Carol S. Halfhill, Department of Management,<br />

College of Business, University of Central Florida, USA, halfhill@mail.ucf.edu<br />

This research, conducted by Gail West and Carol Halfhill, investigated <strong>the</strong> affects of faculty<br />

attitudes concerning distance learning instruction. Previous research indicated <strong>the</strong>re are significant<br />

negative faculty perceptions of and attitudes toward distance learning which may be a barrier to its<br />

implementation. The purpose of this study was to investigate how <strong>the</strong> Theory of Planned Behavior<br />

could be used to predict which faculty might be encouraged to participate successfully in instruction<br />

using distance learning technology. Specifically this research studied faculty attitudes, <strong>the</strong> perceived<br />

attitudes of peers, as well as faculty beliefs in <strong>the</strong>ir ability to be successful with instruction via distance<br />

learning technology. The investigation was modeled after Icek Ajzen’s Theory of Planned Behavior, a<br />

well documented intention model that has successfully predicted and explained behavior in a wide<br />

number of behavior-related areas. The <strong>the</strong>ory suggests that attitudes regarding a behavior as well as<br />

motivation to per<strong>for</strong>m <strong>the</strong> behavior can be measured and this measurement can be used as a predictor<br />

of actual behavior.<br />

A quantitative and qualitative study was conducted to determine if <strong>the</strong> <strong>the</strong>ory successfully<br />

predicted a faculty member’s intention to instruct a course using distance learning technology. A<br />

survey of faculty in <strong>the</strong> Florida State University System, which is comprised of ten accredited public<br />

universities within Florida, was conducted. A stratified random sampling of faculty chosen by a<br />

random number generator method was obtained from <strong>the</strong> 1997-98 faculty lists in <strong>the</strong> college catalogs<br />

from each of <strong>the</strong> ten universities. Selections from each institution were adjusted proportionally to<br />

insure each institution was properly represented. In an attempt to insure that <strong>the</strong> survey would include<br />

faculty who have experience with distance learning technology, ef<strong>for</strong>ts were made to add faculty to <strong>the</strong><br />

survey mailing list who had taught a variety of courses via distance learning using ei<strong>the</strong>r interactive<br />

television or <strong>the</strong> World Wide Web.<br />

Faculty members were questioned regarding <strong>the</strong>ir intention to instruct a course via distance<br />

learning during <strong>the</strong> 1998-<strong>1999</strong> academic year as well as <strong>the</strong>ir attitudes regarding distance instruction.<br />

They were also surveyed on <strong>the</strong>ir perceptions of <strong>the</strong>ir peers' attitudes regarding distance learning.<br />

Finally, faculty were asked items to determine how successful <strong>the</strong>y expected <strong>the</strong>y would be if <strong>the</strong>y<br />

taught a course via distance learning. The three constructs, faculty members' personal attitudes, <strong>the</strong><br />

attitudes of <strong>the</strong>ir peers, and <strong>the</strong> strength of <strong>the</strong>ir belief in success <strong>for</strong>m <strong>the</strong> foundation of Ajzen's <strong>the</strong>ory.<br />

Survey items were constructed to measure <strong>the</strong> power of each construct. Personal attitudes, peer<br />

attitudes, and belief in success were combined ma<strong>the</strong>matically according to Ajzen's model to measure<br />

intention. Qualitative interviews were also conducted to fur<strong>the</strong>r explore <strong>the</strong> survey results.<br />

Faculty returned 345 usable survey instruments representing a 60 percent return rate. Of<br />

those responding, 73 percent were male with 27 percent female. Mean age was 50 years. Of those<br />

who indicated, 68.2 percent were tenured, 15.2 percent were on a tenure track and 15.2 percent were<br />

non-tenured. Instructional experience ranged from none to 51 years with a mean of 17.8 years. Past<br />

distance experience was limited among <strong>the</strong> respondents: 65 percent of <strong>the</strong> respondents had no previous<br />

distance instruction experience. Of those with pervious experience, most had taught between one and<br />

five courses. The majority did not intend to instruct using distance learning technology: 67.3 percent<br />

described <strong>the</strong>mselves as very unlikely or unlikely to instruct using distance learning technology.<br />

Findings revealed that <strong>the</strong> Theory of Planned Behavior could predict correctly a faculty<br />

member’s intention to instruct a distance learning course 83 percent of <strong>the</strong> time. The <strong>the</strong>ory predicted<br />

with great accuracy those faculty who do not intend to instruct via distance learning (93.9 percent). It<br />

had less success predicting faculty who do intend to instruct (56.6 percent).


The research highlighted <strong>the</strong> importance of peer influence in a faculty member’s decision to<br />

instruct or not instruct at a distance. More than half (52 percent) of <strong>the</strong> faculty who intended to instruct<br />

at a distance reported <strong>the</strong>y felt <strong>the</strong>ir peers thought <strong>the</strong>y should be involved in distance instruction.<br />

Only 3 percent of those who did not intend to instruct thought <strong>the</strong>ir peers believed <strong>the</strong>y should teach a<br />

course using distance technology. Approximately 79 percent of faculty who intended to instruct at a<br />

distance reported that faculty members <strong>the</strong>y respected were involved in instruction via distance<br />

learning. Only 31 percent of those with no intention to instruct at a distance reported respected faculty<br />

members involved in distance instruction.<br />

While <strong>the</strong> faculty sensed strong university support <strong>for</strong> distance learning, <strong>the</strong> role of <strong>the</strong><br />

department chair appeared to play a significant role in how strongly <strong>the</strong> administration’s goals <strong>for</strong><br />

distance learning are implemented. Over 79 percent of faculty who intended to instruct via distance<br />

learning believed <strong>the</strong>ir chair supported distance learning instruction while only 45 percent of faculty<br />

who did not intend to instruct via distance learning believed <strong>the</strong>ir chair supported distance learning<br />

ef<strong>for</strong>ts.<br />

Exposure to distance learning seemed to reduce faculty anxiety. Faculty with distance<br />

instruction experience expressed fewer reservations regarding distance learning and were more positive<br />

about its benefits. While 65 percent of faculty with previous distance instruction experience thought<br />

distance courses maintained academic rigor, only 26 percent of those with no distance experience<br />

expressed confidence in <strong>the</strong> academic rigor of distance courses. Only 20 percent of those with no<br />

distance experience were com<strong>for</strong>table with <strong>the</strong>ir ability to interact at a distance; 67 percent of those<br />

with distance experience were confident of <strong>the</strong>ir ability to interact.<br />

O<strong>the</strong>r factors appear to influence a faculty member's intention to instruct via distance<br />

learning technology. Gender and tenure status were statistically significant. Female faculty members<br />

were more likely to have a greater degree of confidence in distance learning instruction, know a<br />

respected faculty member involved with distance instruction, feel peer pressure to instruct at a distance<br />

and consider <strong>the</strong>mselves risk takers. Tenure track and non-tenured track faculty expressed similar<br />

indicators regarding distance instruction. Age was not a statistically significant indicator.<br />

Faculty responding to <strong>the</strong> survey confirmed concerns expressed in <strong>the</strong> literature regarding<br />

distance learning. Worry over interaction, heavier workload, <strong>the</strong> need <strong>for</strong> new instructional skills, lack<br />

of technical support, and professional concerns were expressed. Forty percent of those who intended<br />

to instruct distance learning classes agreed that technology may be used to replace faculty; 44.2 percent<br />

of those who do not intend to instruct distance courses agreed.<br />

The research concluded that university administration can support faculty ef<strong>for</strong>ts in distance<br />

learning instruction by providing release time to compensate <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> heavy time commitment distance<br />

learning courses appear to require. Evaluation <strong>for</strong> tenure and promotion should be adjusted to reward<br />

faculty ef<strong>for</strong>ts in this area. O<strong>the</strong>r support services popular with <strong>the</strong> survey respondents include salary<br />

enhancements, adequate computer systems, student assistants and technical support. Administrative<br />

officials may want to create opportunities to spotlight successful distance instruction and support<br />

mentoring ef<strong>for</strong>ts in an attempt to allay faculty concerns.<br />

Recommendations <strong>for</strong> fur<strong>the</strong>r research included <strong>the</strong> suggestion to fur<strong>the</strong>r explore <strong>the</strong><br />

interaction of gender, age and tenure status in determining a faculty member’s intention to instruct a<br />

distance learning course. Although this research was not designed to explore such issues, <strong>the</strong>re were<br />

intriguing hints that gender may be a stronger determinant of a faculty member’s intention to instruct<br />

distance courses than age or tenure status. It is also possible that <strong>the</strong>re was not enough diversity in <strong>the</strong><br />

respondents’ demographics and fur<strong>the</strong>r research may lead to greater insight.<br />

References<br />

Ajzen, I. (1989). Attitude Structure and Behavior. In A. R. Pratkanis, S. J. Breckler and A. G.<br />

Greenwald (Ed.), Attitude Structure and Function (pp. 241-274). Hillsdale, NJ: Lawrence Erlbaum<br />

Associates<br />

Freberg, L., Floyd, B. & Marr, K. . (1995). Faculty attitudes toward distance education. Journal on<br />

Excellence in College Teaching, 6(2), 145-159.


Web-Based Testing in Distance Education: Challenges and Implications<br />

C. James Wong<br />

Learning Resources Division, Belleville Area College, Belleville, IL 62221, U.S.A.<br />

E-mail: wongcj@smtp.bacnet.edu<br />

Introduction<br />

Distance education has gained general acceptance in American higher education (Moore &<br />

Kearsley, 1996; Saba, 1997). Among a variety of instructional delivery media, <strong>the</strong> Internet, especially <strong>the</strong><br />

World Wide Web, has been commonly adopted by many distance education programs (Khan, 1997; Porter,<br />

1997). As educational providers will often need to validate students' learning outcome, testing on <strong>the</strong><br />

Internet is becoming a reality (Chute, Sayers, & Gardner, 1997). However, one may not be successful as a<br />

distance instructor by simply transferring classroom-based testing strategies to <strong>the</strong> distance education<br />

environment. This paper addresses issues on how tests can be administered on <strong>the</strong> Web, <strong>the</strong> difficulties of<br />

Web-based testing, and <strong>the</strong> implications of <strong>the</strong>se challenges in a distance education setting.<br />

Web-Based Testing Tools<br />

Many distance education programs utilize a Web-based course delivery and management software.<br />

For example, about 1,200 American higher education institutions have adopted WebCT. Similar products<br />

include CourseInfo, LearningSpace, and Web Course in a Box. Some testing features have been<br />

incorporated into most of <strong>the</strong>se products, but functionality and features tend to vary from one to <strong>the</strong> o<strong>the</strong>r.<br />

There are also software vendors that develop Web-based test authoring and delivery tools, such as<br />

QuestionMark and CAT. Such tools are usually better designed and have more features than <strong>the</strong> Webbased<br />

course delivery and management software mentioned above. For instance, <strong>the</strong>y have test analysis<br />

functions such as determining test item difficulty level and generating statistical reports. However, <strong>the</strong><br />

costs of <strong>the</strong>se tools could be ra<strong>the</strong>r expensive.<br />

Objective Testing<br />

Traditional objective tests with question types such as true or false, multiple choice, and matching<br />

can be created, administered, and immediately graded via <strong>the</strong> Web by most of <strong>the</strong> Web-based testing<br />

packages. Feedback can be provided to <strong>the</strong> student right after an answer has been submitted and graded,<br />

allowing <strong>the</strong> student to check his or her understanding of <strong>the</strong> course content and thus promoting <strong>the</strong> concept<br />

of testing as a learning tool as well.<br />

Fill-in-<strong>the</strong>-blank type of questions must be carefully authored. Specifically, <strong>the</strong> instructor will<br />

have to include as many correct answers as possible <strong>for</strong> each question to <strong>the</strong> database of <strong>the</strong> Web-based<br />

testing software. For instance, <strong>the</strong> instructor has to determine whe<strong>the</strong>r matching <strong>the</strong> case in an answer is<br />

significant or not, provided that <strong>the</strong> Web-based testing package is capable of checking <strong>the</strong> case matching of<br />

an answer.<br />

Subjective Testing<br />

Some researchers are working on an artificial intelligence tool to evaluate student writing by<br />

comparing it with a number of model essays previously parsed and analyzed by <strong>the</strong> computer, but <strong>the</strong><br />

reliability of this experimental software is questionable. At this point, students can submit <strong>the</strong>ir answers to<br />

essay test questions to <strong>the</strong>ir instructors via <strong>the</strong> Internet (e.g., Web-based e-mail, Web <strong>for</strong>m submission, or<br />

file upload on <strong>the</strong> Web server), and instructors will have to grade <strong>the</strong>se subjective tests manually.<br />

Test Security<br />

Distance education provides <strong>the</strong> availability of learning opportunities to students without <strong>the</strong><br />

boundaries of time and space. Separated by time and space from <strong>the</strong>ir students, how can instructors know<br />

<strong>for</strong> sure who has actually completed an examination<br />

Even with <strong>the</strong> advanced technology such as fingerprint checking, if students at a distance take an<br />

examination with no supervision, it would not be possible to ensure <strong>the</strong> integrity of <strong>the</strong> examination. The<br />

following could happen if a proctor is absent:<br />

- students can copy test question items that will become insecure <strong>for</strong> future recycling,


- students can take it as an open-book, open-note examination, and<br />

- <strong>the</strong> examination can be taken by a different person from <strong>the</strong> enrolled student.<br />

It is suggested that students be required to arrange <strong>for</strong> an approved test proctor who follows<br />

guidelines provided by <strong>the</strong> distance learning institution (Chute, Thompson, & Hancock, <strong>1999</strong>).<br />

Consequently, in many distance education programs, students must complete <strong>the</strong> examinations in a<br />

proctored environment at a library or school, and proctors are usually teachers, school administrators, or<br />

librarians who are selected by <strong>the</strong> student and approved by <strong>the</strong> distance learning institution (Moore &<br />

Kearsley, 1996). However, sometimes it might be difficult to identify <strong>the</strong> qualifications of a proctor when<br />

he or she resides in a remote state or in a <strong>for</strong>eign country. Fur<strong>the</strong>rmore, shipping and handling could be<br />

time consuming due to custom check and wait between countries.<br />

Alternative Evaluation Methods<br />

Because students have <strong>the</strong> ability to collaborate with o<strong>the</strong>rs if a test is not proctored, some<br />

instructors use Web-based testing only <strong>for</strong> quizzes, but not <strong>for</strong> examinations. However, with <strong>the</strong><br />

permission of <strong>the</strong> instructor, such collaboration (students are working on <strong>the</strong>se quizzes toge<strong>the</strong>r) could be a<br />

very positive cooperative learning activity (Chute, Sayers, & Gardner, 1997).<br />

Instructors should consider evaluating a multiplicity of evidence of students' learning outcome,<br />

such as participation, writing assessment, portfolio assessment, and teacher-based assessment (Harrasim,<br />

Hiltz, Teles, & Turoff, 1997). Requiring students submitting multiple drafts of <strong>the</strong>ir work is ano<strong>the</strong>r way of<br />

checking <strong>the</strong>ir learning progress and reducing <strong>the</strong> chance of plagiarism.<br />

While <strong>the</strong>se non-traditional <strong>for</strong>ms of testing and evaluation do not eliminate <strong>the</strong> possibility of a<br />

student cheating, <strong>the</strong>y reduce it to a level of insignificance (Moore & Kearsley, 1996).<br />

Summary<br />

Web-based testing software packages open an innovative way to delivering tests at a distance.<br />

Without <strong>the</strong> kind of traditional test administration that requires <strong>the</strong> presence of a proctor checking students'<br />

identification and watching <strong>for</strong> cheating, <strong>the</strong> integrity of <strong>the</strong> test cannot be maintained. It is important that<br />

<strong>the</strong> faculty and administration responsible <strong>for</strong> distance education (1) be aware of <strong>the</strong> strengths and<br />

limitations of Web-based testing software, (2) determine appropriate adoption of evaluation strategies that<br />

best match <strong>the</strong> course goals and design, and thus (3) strive <strong>for</strong> an accurate, valid, and reliable assessment of<br />

student learning per<strong>for</strong>mance or competency at a distance.<br />

References<br />

Chute, A. G., Sayers, P. K., & Gardner, R. P. (1997). Networked learning environments. In T. E. Cyrs<br />

(Ed.), Teaching and Learning at a Distance: What It Takes to Effectively Design, Deliver, and Evaluate<br />

Programs (pp.75-83). San Francisco: Jossey-Bass.<br />

Chute, A. G., Thompson, M. M., & Hancock, B. W. (<strong>1999</strong>). The McGraw-Hill handbook of distance<br />

learning. New York: McGraw-Hill.<br />

Harrasim, L., Hiltz, S. R., Teles, L. & Turoff, M. (1997). Learning networks: A field guide to teaching<br />

and learning online. Cambridge, MA: MIT Press.<br />

Khan, B. H. (1997). Wed-based instruction. Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Educational Technology Publications.<br />

Moore, M. G., & Kearsley, G. (1996). Distance education: A systems view. Belmont, CA: Wadsworth.<br />

Porter, L. R. (1997). Creating virtual classroom: Distance learning with <strong>the</strong> Internet. New York: Wiley.<br />

Saba, F. (Ed.). Future of post secondary education. Distance Education Report, 1 (1). [On-line].<br />

Available: http://www.distance-educator.com/Gov.html<br />

Acknowledgements<br />

The author would like to gratefully acknowledge <strong>the</strong> support from Mr. Philip Carlock, Mr. Ken Turner, and<br />

Belleville Area College.


Selecting Internet Technologies to Support Interactive Teaching and Learning at a Distance<br />

C. James Wong<br />

Learning Resources Division, Belleville Area College, Belleville, IL 62221, U.S.A.<br />

E-mail: wongcj@smtp.bacnet.edu<br />

Introduction<br />

Apparently <strong>the</strong> Internet is becoming increasingly accessible to Americans; according to <strong>the</strong> Associated Press, <strong>the</strong>re are 74 million<br />

Internet users in <strong>the</strong> United States (Gearan, <strong>1999</strong>). The U.S. Department of Education (<strong>1999</strong>) reports that, in 1998, 89% of public schools have<br />

access to <strong>the</strong> Internet, and 51% of all American classrooms are connected to <strong>the</strong> Internet. This paper examines <strong>the</strong> advantages and limitations of<br />

various Internet technologies so that educators can make appropriate decisions to select and utilize <strong>the</strong>m to facilitate interactive teaching and<br />

learning in a distance education program.<br />

Traditional Distance Education Programs<br />

Traditional distance education was considered as non-mainstream instruction by many educators because <strong>the</strong>y thought such distance<br />

instruction could not be truly interactive. For example, enrolled in a correspondence type of independent study course, students might not be able<br />

to ask question or receive feedback from <strong>the</strong> author who wrote <strong>the</strong> course or a tutor/instructor who is a content expert; that is <strong>the</strong> nature of<br />

independent study, some explain. Likewise, television courses rely on one-way communication.<br />

Internet Technologies<br />

Until comparatively recently, education has been influenced by <strong>the</strong> trans<strong>for</strong>mation into an in<strong>for</strong>mation society (Chute, Thompson, &<br />

Hancock, <strong>1999</strong>). By employing various Internet technologies, in<strong>for</strong>mation such as pedagogical dialogues and content materials can be exchanged<br />

between <strong>the</strong> instructor and students and/or among students <strong>the</strong>mselves with ease and immediacy. The Internet is being used as supplementary<br />

communication channels after class in both face-to-face courses and distance education courses that utilize interactive video. Meanwhile, more<br />

and more higher education institutions are delivering Internet-based (on-line) courses to students at a distance (Barnard, 1997; Khan, 1997;<br />

Moore & Kearsley, 1996; Porter, 1997).<br />

A typical Internet-based distance education environment incorporates a combination of technologies to deliver instructional content<br />

and foster interaction, with <strong>the</strong> technologies matched to <strong>the</strong> course goals and design. There are a variety of communication and collaboration<br />

tools available, and it is essential to understand <strong>the</strong> strengths and weaknesses of <strong>the</strong> most common asynchronous and synchronous communication<br />

tools.<br />

Asynchronous Tools<br />

E-mail<br />

Advantages<br />

- It is easy to use.<br />

- It is a fast, inexpensive communication channel.<br />

- In<strong>for</strong>mation transferred is not limited only to text.<br />

E-mail Discussion List<br />

Advantages<br />

Limitations<br />

- There are numerous different software packages <strong>for</strong> e-mail available. During communication<br />

between users with different e-mail software, e-mail messages and/or attached files might lose<br />

<strong>the</strong>ir <strong>for</strong>matting and will not be viewable.<br />

- It provides a discussion <strong>for</strong>um <strong>for</strong> students.<br />

- Students tend to access <strong>the</strong> list postings more often while checking <strong>the</strong>ir personal e-mail.<br />

- This one-to-many communication medium is useful <strong>for</strong> sharing documents, peer review, and peer editing.<br />

- Because students do not have to meet at any certain time, working on collaborative group projects is convenient and<br />

flexible.<br />

- Students who are hesitant to speak up in a face-to-face classroom environment will contribute more to class<br />

discussions in this type of environment.<br />

- It is also possible to archive discussion lists.<br />

Discussion Bulletin Board<br />

Advantages<br />

Limitations<br />

- It has similar features as an e-mail discussion list.<br />

- Messages do not reside on one's e-mail in-box.<br />

- Discussions may be threaded.<br />

- It is fairly inexpensive.<br />

Limitations<br />

- Participant's mailbox can get<br />

overloaded with messages,<br />

especially in large classes and<br />

when <strong>the</strong> use of <strong>the</strong> e-mail list is<br />

required.<br />

- Discussion lists also require<br />

good electronic-moderating skills<br />

on <strong>the</strong> part of <strong>the</strong> teacher.<br />

- Participants might not check messages posted if not motivated.<br />

- It also requires good electronic-moderating skills on <strong>the</strong> part of <strong>the</strong> teacher.<br />

Synchronous Tools<br />

.Text Chat<br />

Advantages<br />

- They can help to build a community of learners, and allow<br />

students to get to know each o<strong>the</strong>r better.<br />

- They also foster immediacy and social presence and are useful<br />

<strong>for</strong> brainstorming activities.<br />

- Because <strong>the</strong>y are a completely textual communication medium,<br />

<strong>the</strong>y allow classes that use <strong>the</strong>m to focus on writing. Everything<br />

that is uttered, created, or described must be typed in as text,<br />

<strong>for</strong>cing us to recognize <strong>the</strong> power of <strong>the</strong> written word.<br />

- Hardware and software requirements are minimal.<br />

Collaboration Tools<br />

Advantages<br />

Limitations<br />

- There are many different ways to do chats on <strong>the</strong> Internet: <strong>for</strong> instance, closed<br />

conference chat, MUDs and MOOs, web-based chat, Internet Relay Chat, and so on.<br />

- Limitation of interoperability implies that a user of IRC cannot chat with a user of<br />

MOO.<br />

- They require good typing skills.<br />

- Conversations tend to overlap in a large class.<br />

- The differences in time zones must be dealt with.<br />

- They also require good electronic-moderating skills on <strong>the</strong> part of <strong>the</strong> teacher.<br />

Limitations


Internet collaboration products allow people at multiple sites to conference simultaneously and<br />

offer a wealth of collaborative features including:<br />

- application sharing where multiple parties to view and edit a file in an application (e.g.,<br />

Microsoft Word) on one of <strong>the</strong> participants’ computer.<br />

- whiteboard that provides freehand drawing tools around a canvas. Most whiteboards can also<br />

paste files copied from o<strong>the</strong>r programs such as word processors and spreadsheets.<br />

- text-chat, file transfer, audio conferencing, and video conferencing.<br />

Desktop Video Conferencing<br />

Advantages<br />

- It allows users to send and receive video, audio, and text in real time via <strong>the</strong> Internet.<br />

- Some support two-way point-to-point video conference, while o<strong>the</strong>rs support point-to-point<br />

conference, multi-point conference, and/or one-to-many broadcast.<br />

- Some products like White Pine’s CU-SeeMe and Microsoft NetMeeting have most of <strong>the</strong><br />

features of collaboration tools mentioned above.<br />

- Conference participants are not required to use <strong>the</strong> same plat<strong>for</strong>m and software as long as <strong>the</strong>ir<br />

software complies with <strong>the</strong> same videoconferencing standards.<br />

- They are inexpensive, and some can be downloaded <strong>for</strong> free like Microsoft NetMeeting and<br />

Cornell University’s CU-SeeMe.<br />

Conferencing/Messaging Software<br />

Advantages<br />

- It contains synchronous tools like e-mail and discussion board and asynchronous tools like chat.<br />

- Conferencing systems like FirstClass or Lotus Notes offer <strong>the</strong> advantages of accessing in<strong>for</strong>mation, downloading it,<br />

and working offline (thus reducing <strong>the</strong> Internet connection charges).<br />

- These systems can incorporate both public and private areas.<br />

- The systems are generally very stable.<br />

- They are generally easy <strong>for</strong> both faculty and students to use.<br />

- They have <strong>the</strong> ability to transfer text, audio, graphics, and application-dependent files without <strong>for</strong>mat loss problems<br />

that might happen with e-mail.<br />

- There are many different products out <strong>the</strong>re, each<br />

with <strong>the</strong>ir own strengths and weaknesses and different<br />

features. For instance, not all of <strong>the</strong>m include video<br />

conferencing capability.<br />

- Some may also require additional hardware<br />

accessories.<br />

- The initial learning curve <strong>for</strong> some packages can also<br />

be steep.<br />

Limitations<br />

- Problems with slow frame rates and with audio breakup<br />

are possible at low bandwidths.<br />

- Multi-point video conference might require <strong>the</strong> use of a<br />

group video conferencing server.<br />

- Video conferencing requires that all users have audio<br />

and video hardware: <strong>for</strong> example, digital cameras,<br />

speakers, microphones, and sound cards.<br />

- The initial set-up and customization of bandwidths can<br />

be somewhat of a challenge.<br />

Limitations<br />

- The costs <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> licensing and<br />

hardware required to run <strong>the</strong><br />

system could be quite costly.<br />

- These systems can also require<br />

extensive technical support and<br />

administration skills.<br />

World-Wide Web<br />

The Web has become <strong>the</strong> most powerful communication tool since it is capable of most of <strong>the</strong> functions of <strong>the</strong> asynchronous and<br />

synchronous tools outlined previously. For example, E-mail can be sent and received on <strong>the</strong> Web, E-mail discussion list can be archived on <strong>the</strong><br />

Web, closed conferencing software are geared toward a web-based interface, and online chats and discussion boards are built on <strong>the</strong> Web as well.<br />

As far as Internet-based distance education is concerned, <strong>the</strong> Web is <strong>the</strong> predominant medium <strong>for</strong> course content delivery.<br />

Summary<br />

The Internet can make great strides in providing alternative and flexible availability to quality instruction and a variety of resources<br />

that o<strong>the</strong>rwise would be inaccessible. Quality and cost-effective instruction can be made available around <strong>the</strong> world through distance education<br />

with <strong>the</strong> appropriate use of <strong>the</strong> Internet technologies. By examining <strong>the</strong> advantages and limitations of <strong>the</strong>se Internet technologies, educators can<br />

choose <strong>the</strong> right tools to meet <strong>the</strong> instructional needs and allow distance learners to accomplish <strong>the</strong> expected competencies in <strong>the</strong>ir distance<br />

learning experience.<br />

References<br />

Barnard, J. (1997). The World Wide Web and higher education: The promise of virtual universities and online libraries. Educational Technology,<br />

37(3), 30-35.<br />

Chute, A. G., Thompson, M. M., & Hancock, B. W. (<strong>1999</strong>). The McGraw-Hill handbook of distance learning. New York: McGraw-Hill.<br />

Gearan, A. (<strong>1999</strong>, January 14). A New breed of Internet surfers. Washington: The Associated Press.<br />

Moore, M. G., & Kearsley, G. (1996). Distance education: A systems view. Belmont, CA: Wadsworth.<br />

Porter, L. R. (1997). Creating virtual classroom: Distance learning with <strong>the</strong> Internet. New York: Wiley.<br />

U.S. Department of Education. (<strong>1999</strong>). Internet Access in Public Schools and Classrooms: 1994-98. (NCES Publication No. <strong>1999</strong>-017).<br />

Washington, DC: National Center <strong>for</strong> Education Statistics.<br />

Acknowledgements<br />

The author would like to gratefully acknowledge <strong>the</strong> support from Mr. Philip Carlock, Mr. Ken Turner, and Belleville Area College.


Designing and Implementing Web-Based Instructional Systems<br />

Michael D. Chen<br />

Eastern Illinois University<br />

Media Service<br />

Charleston, IL, U.S.A.<br />

cfdxc@eiu.edu<br />

http://www.ux1.eiu.edu/~cfdxc/<br />

Many have predicted that <strong>the</strong> Internet, particularly <strong>the</strong> World Wide Web, will trans<strong>for</strong>m education. But <strong>the</strong> claimed<br />

potential will not come automatically. Without careful and deliberate design that takes into consideration <strong>the</strong><br />

specific conditions and constraints of various educational settings, <strong>the</strong> much hailed Web will only prove to be an<br />

empty promise. As more schools are connected to <strong>the</strong> Internet and more teachers and students become increasingly<br />

interested in using it in <strong>the</strong>ir teaching and learning, <strong>the</strong> need <strong>for</strong> easy-to-use and meaningful Web tools has grown<br />

dramatically. So far, <strong>the</strong> tools available are ei<strong>the</strong>r not really easy-to-use or meaningful <strong>for</strong> many teachers, whose<br />

primary concern is teaching instead of technology. For example, while applications like Adobe PageMill, Microsoft<br />

Internet Assistant, and Netscape Communicator have made it easier to produce HTML documents, <strong>the</strong> technical<br />

skills required to use HTML documents <strong>for</strong> teaching and learning (linking, serving and managing <strong>the</strong>m on <strong>the</strong> Web)<br />

are beyond most users. Moreover, many existing tools bear little explicit pedagogical connection to <strong>the</strong> classrooms.<br />

Designing of eWeb and HomePage Maker<br />

There has been a growing interest in using computers to enhance instruction and learning through collaboration,<br />

which resulted in a number of network-based learning environments. These environments often focus on a specific<br />

domain or discipline and are often embedded with a set of particular pedagogical beliefs. Fur<strong>the</strong>rmore, <strong>the</strong>se<br />

environments often require a set of unique hardware and software or a combination of several packages. Most of<br />

<strong>the</strong>se environments run on local networks. There have been relatively few environments that support <strong>the</strong> entire<br />

process of instruction, from <strong>the</strong> preparation of instruction to per<strong>for</strong>mance assessment <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> instructor and from<br />

accessing learning materials to collaborating with peers <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong> students, over a global network.<br />

eWeb and HomePage Maker, two integrated education environments, exemplify a framework that strives to balance<br />

technological innovations, educational changes, and classroom realities.<br />

The conceptual framework <strong>for</strong> eWeb and HomePage Maker consists of three basic arguments:<br />

• Adoption precedes change. For any intended change to occur, <strong>the</strong> innovation has to be adopted by <strong>the</strong><br />

teachers and students first.<br />

• Realization is re-creation. The process of implementing an innovation is in essence a process of re-creation<br />

in which teachers and students re-interpret <strong>the</strong> innovation in <strong>the</strong>ir own terms. Thus <strong>the</strong> realization of an<br />

innovation often reflects a set of compromises between old and new ways of doing things.<br />

• Learning is <strong>the</strong> evolution of knowledge. Human beings are active and fallible creators of knowledge that is<br />

refined through criticism.<br />

There<strong>for</strong>e, <strong>the</strong> goals of designing eWeb and HomePage maker are (1) to promote adoption of <strong>the</strong> Web as an<br />

education environment, (2) to foster, not impose, pedagogical changes by supporting re-creation, and (3) to<br />

encourage <strong>the</strong> evolution of knowledge (<strong>for</strong> both teachers and students).


Implementation<br />

In order to realize <strong>the</strong> goals set <strong>for</strong>th during <strong>the</strong> designing phase, <strong>the</strong> following principles underline <strong>the</strong><br />

implementation of eWeb and HomePage Maker:<br />

1. Fully integrated: eWeb and HomePage Maker consist of an array of inter-linked tools <strong>for</strong> both teachers<br />

and instructors throughout <strong>the</strong> learning process. An integrated application enables teachers and students to<br />

interact at multiple dimensions, analyze <strong>the</strong> same data with various tools, and achieve multiple goals within<br />

a single application. It has also been suggested that fully integrated applications are more likely to be<br />

adopted by schools and teachers.<br />

2. Global collaboration: Since eWeb and HomePage Maker use <strong>the</strong> standard Internet protocol, it enables<br />

global collaboration. Moreover, <strong>the</strong> system was designed to facilitate both intra- and inter-school<br />

collaboration among teachers and students. Teachers from different institutions can work on <strong>the</strong> same set of<br />

teaching materials at <strong>the</strong> same time. They can also co-manage a collaborative learning project <strong>for</strong> <strong>the</strong>ir<br />

students. Students can not only collaborate in projects with collaborators assigned to <strong>the</strong>m, but also initiate<br />

new projects and find new collaborators. Both students and teachers can use a public in<strong>for</strong>mation area to<br />

contact o<strong>the</strong>r eWeb users to find potential collaborators.<br />

3. Transparent and common technology: First of all, a standard Web browser is used as <strong>the</strong> user interface.<br />

Technically, <strong>the</strong> software a user needs to learn is <strong>the</strong> browser, which can be expected to be fairly easy since<br />

many already use it <strong>for</strong> o<strong>the</strong>r purposes as well. Second, <strong>the</strong> plat<strong>for</strong>m independent nature of <strong>the</strong> Web makes<br />

it unnecessary <strong>for</strong> users to switch from one plat<strong>for</strong>m to ano<strong>the</strong>r, which often causes discom<strong>for</strong>t. Third, it<br />

allows users to reuse what <strong>the</strong>y already have and are com<strong>for</strong>table with. It saves time and <strong>the</strong> frustration<br />

when users have to learn several applications. For example, a user can input course contents in three<br />

different ways: typing directly into <strong>the</strong> browser’s text field, copy and paste from a word processor, or<br />

upload a text file. Lastly, <strong>the</strong>y have built-in structures and mechanisms to help users manage and distribute<br />

contents on <strong>the</strong> server without knowing anything about HTML, cgi, or file transfer protocols.<br />

4. Flexibility: To promote adoption and re-creation, eWeb and HomePage Maker are designed with maximum<br />

flexibility in terms of pedagogical beliefs and management styles. Pedagogically, <strong>the</strong>y provide tools to<br />

support both traditional and newer ways of teaching and learning. While some tools are explicitly designed<br />

to help students develop higher order thinking skill through collaboration, o<strong>the</strong>rs also allow teachers to<br />

develop and administer objective tests. In terms of management, <strong>the</strong>y not only allow teachers to have<br />

administrative control of <strong>the</strong>ir students, but also allows <strong>the</strong>m to change <strong>the</strong> <strong>for</strong>mat and mode of many builtin<br />

functions.<br />

5. Facilitating knowledge construction and refinement: Criticism is key to learning, but social pressure often<br />

precludes criticism among peers. To encourage critical feedback, eWeb provides optional protection of<br />

identity in its chat and <strong>for</strong>um sections. Exchanges of in<strong>for</strong>mation can be set at different modes, from<br />

completely anonymous to identifiable. eWeb also provides mechanisms <strong>for</strong> users to revise <strong>the</strong>ir<br />

contributions be<strong>for</strong>e making <strong>the</strong>m available to o<strong>the</strong>rs. To help <strong>the</strong> learners see <strong>the</strong> knowledge growth<br />

process, <strong>the</strong> revision history is archived.<br />

6. Evolution of knowledge and skills: Instead of providing a fixed set of instructional materials, eWeb remains<br />

open-ended to maximize flexibility <strong>for</strong> use and future growth, to be adapt to <strong>the</strong> growing knowledge and<br />

skills of each user. Each group or class can choose any combination of tools and activities based on <strong>the</strong>ir<br />

needs and skill levels.<br />

7. Data reduction/management: eWeb not only enhances communication and collaboration, but also provides<br />

ways to help make sense of <strong>the</strong> in<strong>for</strong>mation generated. eWeb keeps record of its users' activities. Thus<br />

when a user logins, he or she is in<strong>for</strong>med of what has been completed and what needs to be done. eWeb<br />

also allow users to trace <strong>the</strong>ir per<strong>for</strong>mances. For example, a teacher can quickly generate an electronic<br />

portfolio <strong>for</strong> a particular student or every student in his class.

Hooray! Your file is uploaded and ready to be published.

Saved successfully!

Ooh no, something went wrong!